From 57c91ad391ab148036a5c6e4f0fdee7381352a85 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: dkf Date: Fri, 13 Apr 2007 14:51:17 +0000 Subject: Reduce the #ifdef count a lot by adding debug-print macros --- ChangeLog | 25 +- macosx/tkMacOSXBitmap.c | 270 +-- macosx/tkMacOSXButton.c | 1969 ++++++++++---------- macosx/tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c | 399 +++-- macosx/tkMacOSXClipboard.c | 343 ++-- macosx/tkMacOSXCursor.c | 8 +- macosx/tkMacOSXDialog.c | 1013 +++++------ macosx/tkMacOSXDraw.c | 800 +++++---- macosx/tkMacOSXEvent.c | 235 +-- macosx/tkMacOSXFont.c | 2364 +++++++++++------------- macosx/tkMacOSXInit.c | 44 +- macosx/tkMacOSXInt.h | 180 +- macosx/tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c | 1418 +++++++-------- macosx/tkMacOSXMenu.c | 3954 ++++++++++++++++++++--------------------- macosx/tkMacOSXMenubutton.c | 977 +++++----- macosx/tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c | 22 +- macosx/tkMacOSXScale.c | 308 ++-- macosx/tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c | 62 +- macosx/tkMacOSXWm.c | 1408 +++++++-------- 19 files changed, 7665 insertions(+), 8134 deletions(-) diff --git a/ChangeLog b/ChangeLog index 573695a..a52eaef 100644 --- a/ChangeLog +++ b/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,8 @@ +2007-04-13 Donal K. Fellows + + * macosx/tkMacOSXInt.h (LOG_MSG, LOG_ON_ERROR): Added macros to make + the OSX code much less #ifdef-full. + 2007-04-12 Jeff Hobbs * library/ttk/panedwindow.tcl (ttk::panedwindow::Press): handle @@ -5,23 +10,23 @@ 2007-04-10 Joe English - * win/ttkWinMonitor.c, win/ttkWinXPTheme.c: Re-sync - with Tile codebase so patches can flow back and forth. - * win/ttkWinXPTheme.c: Skip OS version test, should work on - Vista/Aero now as well as XP [Fixes #1687299, thanks - to George Petasis for tracking this down]. + * win/ttkWinMonitor.c, win/ttkWinXPTheme.c: Re-sync with Tile codebase + so patches can flow back and forth. + * win/ttkWinXPTheme.c: Skip OS version test, should work on Vista/Aero + now as well as XP [Fixes #1687299, thanks to George Petasis for + tracking this down]. 2007-03-21 Joe English - * generic/ttk/ttkLayout.c(Ttk_BuildLayoutTemplate): BUGFIX: - Nested TTK_GROUP nodes did not work unless they appeared - at the end of the layout (and only by accident then). + * generic/ttk/ttkLayout.c(Ttk_BuildLayoutTemplate): BUGFIX: Nested + TTK_GROUP nodes did not work unless they appeared at the end of the + layout (and only by accident then). 2007-03-08 Joe English * tests/grid.test(grid-21.7): Reset wm geometry . and pack propagate . - at end of test. 'pack propagate . 0' was causing cascading failures in - subsequent tests [Bug 1676770]. + at end of test. 'pack propagate . 0' was causing cascading failures in + subsequent tests. [Bug 1676770] 2007-03-07 Daniel Steffen diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXBitmap.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXBitmap.c index 369759e..9735d98 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXBitmap.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXBitmap.c @@ -1,34 +1,36 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXBitmap.c -- * - * This file handles the implementation of native bitmaps. + * This file handles the implementation of native bitmaps. * * Copyright (c) 1996-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXBitmap.c,v 1.4 2006/03/24 14:58:01 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXBitmap.c,v 1.5 2007/04/13 14:51:17 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" /* - * Depending on the resource type there are different ways to - * draw native icons. + * Depending on the resource type there are different ways to draw native + * icons. */ -#define TYPE1 0 /* Family icon suite. */ -#define TYPE2 1 /* ICON resource. */ -#define TYPE3 2 /* cicn resource. */ + +#define TYPE1 0 /* Family icon suite. */ +#define TYPE2 1 /* ICON resource. */ +#define TYPE3 2 /* cicn resource. */ /* - * This data structure describes the id and type of a given icon. - * It is used as the source for native icons. + * This data structure describes the id and type of a given icon. It is used + * as the source for native icons. */ + typedef struct { - int id; /* Resource Id for Icon. */ - long int type; /* Type of icon. */ + int id; /* Resource Id for Icon. */ + long int type; /* Type of icon. */ } NativeIcon; /* @@ -36,35 +38,35 @@ typedef struct { */ typedef struct { - char *name; /* Name of icon. */ - long int type; /* Type of icon. */ - int id; /* Id of icon. */ - int size; /* Size of icon. */ + char *name; /* Name of icon. */ + long int type; /* Type of icon. */ + int id; /* Id of icon. */ + int size; /* Size of icon. */ } BuiltInIcon; /* - * This array mapps a string name to the supported builtin icons - * on the Macintosh. + * This array mapps a string name to the supported builtin icons on the + * Macintosh. */ static BuiltInIcon builtInIcons[] = { - {"document", TYPE1, kGenericDocumentIconResource, 32}, - {"stationery", TYPE1, kGenericStationeryIconResource, 32}, - {"edition", TYPE1, kGenericEditionFileIconResource, 32}, - {"application", TYPE1, kGenericApplicationIconResource, 32}, - {"accessory", TYPE1, kGenericDeskAccessoryIconResource, 32}, - {"folder", TYPE1, kGenericFolderIconResource, 32}, - {"pfolder", TYPE1, kPrivateFolderIconResource, 32}, - {"trash", TYPE1, kTrashIconResource, 32}, - {"floppy", TYPE1, kFloppyIconResource, 32}, - {"ramdisk", TYPE1, kGenericRAMDiskIconResource, 32}, - {"cdrom", TYPE1, kGenericCDROMIconResource, 32}, - {"preferences", TYPE1, kGenericPreferencesIconResource, 32}, - {"querydoc", TYPE1, kGenericQueryDocumentIconResource, 32}, - {"stop", TYPE2, kStopIcon, 32}, - {"note", TYPE2, kNoteIcon, 32}, - {"caution", TYPE2, kCautionIcon, 32}, - {(char *) NULL, 0, 0, 0} + {"document", TYPE1, kGenericDocumentIconResource, 32}, + {"stationery", TYPE1, kGenericStationeryIconResource, 32}, + {"edition", TYPE1, kGenericEditionFileIconResource, 32}, + {"application", TYPE1, kGenericApplicationIconResource, 32}, + {"accessory", TYPE1, kGenericDeskAccessoryIconResource, 32}, + {"folder", TYPE1, kGenericFolderIconResource, 32}, + {"pfolder", TYPE1, kPrivateFolderIconResource, 32}, + {"trash", TYPE1, kTrashIconResource, 32}, + {"floppy", TYPE1, kFloppyIconResource, 32}, + {"ramdisk", TYPE1, kGenericRAMDiskIconResource, 32}, + {"cdrom", TYPE1, kGenericCDROMIconResource, 32}, + {"preferences", TYPE1, kGenericPreferencesIconResource, 32}, + {"querydoc", TYPE1, kGenericQueryDocumentIconResource, 32}, + {"stop", TYPE2, kStopIcon, 32}, + {"note", TYPE2, kNoteIcon, 32}, + {"caution", TYPE2, kCautionIcon, 32}, + {(char *) NULL, 0, 0, 0} }; /* @@ -72,46 +74,46 @@ static BuiltInIcon builtInIcons[] = { * * TkpDefineNativeBitmaps -- * - * Add native bitmaps. + * Add native bitmaps. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl result. If an error occurs then TCL_ERROR is - * returned and a message is left in the interp's result. + * A standard Tcl result. If an error occurs then TCL_ERROR is returned + * and a message is left in the interp's result. * * Side effects: - * "Name" is entered into the bitmap table and may be used from - * here on to refer to the given bitmap. + * "Name" is entered into the bitmap table and may be used from here on + * to refer to the given bitmap. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkpDefineNativeBitmaps() +TkpDefineNativeBitmaps(void) { - int new; - Tcl_HashEntry *predefHashPtr; - TkPredefBitmap *predefPtr; - CONST char * name; + Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr = TkGetBitmapPredefTable(); BuiltInIcon *builtInPtr; - NativeIcon *nativeIconPtr; - Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr; - - for (builtInPtr = builtInIcons; builtInPtr->name != NULL; builtInPtr++) { - name = Tk_GetUid(builtInPtr->name); - tablePtr = TkGetBitmapPredefTable(); - predefHashPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(tablePtr, name, &new); - if (!new) { - continue; - } - predefPtr = (TkPredefBitmap *) ckalloc(sizeof(TkPredefBitmap)); - nativeIconPtr = (NativeIcon *) ckalloc(sizeof(NativeIcon)); - nativeIconPtr->id = builtInPtr->id; - nativeIconPtr->type = builtInPtr->type; - predefPtr->source = (char *) nativeIconPtr; - predefPtr->width = builtInPtr->size; - predefPtr->height = builtInPtr->size; - predefPtr->native = 1; - Tcl_SetHashValue(predefHashPtr, predefPtr); + + for (builtInPtr=builtInIcons ; builtInPtr->name!=NULL ; builtInPtr++) { + Tcl_HashEntry *predefHashPtr; + CONST char *name; + int isNew; + + name = Tk_GetUid(builtInPtr->name); + predefHashPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(tablePtr, name, &isNew); + if (isNew) { + TkPredefBitmap *predefPtr = (TkPredefBitmap *) + ckalloc(sizeof(TkPredefBitmap)); + NativeIcon *nativeIconPtr = (NativeIcon *) + ckalloc(sizeof(NativeIcon)); + + nativeIconPtr->id = builtInPtr->id; + nativeIconPtr->type = builtInPtr->type; + predefPtr->source = (char *) nativeIconPtr; + predefPtr->width = builtInPtr->size; + predefPtr->height = builtInPtr->size; + predefPtr->native = 1; + Tcl_SetHashValue(predefHashPtr, predefPtr); + } } } @@ -120,15 +122,15 @@ TkpDefineNativeBitmaps() * * TkpCreateNativeBitmap -- * - * Add native bitmaps. + * Add native bitmaps. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl result. If an error occurs then TCL_ERROR is - * returned and a message is left in the interp's result. + * A standard Tcl result. If an error occurs then TCL_ERROR is returned + * and a message is left in the interp's result. * * Side effects: - * "Name" is entered into the bitmap table and may be used from - * here on to refer to the given bitmap. + * "Name" is entered into the bitmap table and may be used from here on + * to refer to the given bitmap. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -136,16 +138,15 @@ TkpDefineNativeBitmaps() Pixmap TkpCreateNativeBitmap( Display *display, - CONST char * source) /* Info about the icon to build. */ + CONST char *source) /* Info about the icon to build. */ { Pixmap pix; GWorldPtr destPort; Rect destRect; - Handle icon; CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; NativeIcon *nativeIconPtr; - + pix = Tk_GetPixmap(display, None, 32, 32, 0); destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(pix); @@ -155,20 +156,21 @@ TkpCreateNativeBitmap( nativeIconPtr = (NativeIcon *) source; SetRect(&destRect, 0, 0, 32, 32); if (nativeIconPtr->type == TYPE1) { - RGBColor white = {0xFFFF, 0xFFFF, 0xFFFF}; + RGBColor white = {0xFFFF, 0xFFFF, 0xFFFF}; - RGBForeColor(&white); - PaintRect(&destRect); - PlotIconID(&destRect, atAbsoluteCenter, ttNone, nativeIconPtr->id); + RGBForeColor(&white); + PaintRect(&destRect); + PlotIconID(&destRect, atAbsoluteCenter, ttNone, nativeIconPtr->id); } else if (nativeIconPtr->type == TYPE2) { - icon = GetIcon(nativeIconPtr->id); - if (icon != NULL) { - RGBColor black = {0, 0, 0}; - - RGBForeColor(&black); - PlotIcon(&destRect, icon); - ReleaseResource(icon); - } + Handle icon = GetIcon(nativeIconPtr->id); + + if (icon != NULL) { + RGBColor black = {0, 0, 0}; + + RGBForeColor(&black); + PlotIcon(&destRect, icon); + ReleaseResource(icon); + } } SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); @@ -180,24 +182,24 @@ TkpCreateNativeBitmap( * * TkpGetNativeAppBitmap -- * - * Add native bitmaps. + * Add native bitmaps. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl result. If an error occurs then TCL_ERROR is - * returned and a message is left in the interp's result. + * A standard Tcl result. If an error occurs then TCL_ERROR is returned + * and a message is left in the interp's result. * * Side effects: - * "Name" is entered into the bitmap table and may be used from - * here on to refer to the given bitmap. + * "Name" is entered into the bitmap table and may be used from here on + * to refer to the given bitmap. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ Pixmap TkpGetNativeAppBitmap( - Display *display, /* The display. */ - CONST char *name, /* The name of the bitmap. */ - int *width, /* The width & height of the bitmap. */ + Display *display, /* The display. */ + CONST char *name, /* The name of the bitmap. */ + int *width, /* The width & height of the bitmap. */ int *height) { Pixmap pix; @@ -208,66 +210,74 @@ TkpGetNativeAppBitmap( Handle resource; int type = -1, destWrote; Str255 nativeName; - + /* * macRoman is the encoding that the resource fork uses. */ Tcl_UtfToExternal(NULL, Tcl_GetEncoding(NULL, "macRoman"), name, - strlen(name), 0, NULL, - (char *) &nativeName[1], - 255, NULL, &destWrote, NULL); /* Internalize native */ + strlen(name), 0, NULL, (char *) &nativeName[1], 255, NULL, + &destWrote, NULL); /* Internalize native */ nativeName[0] = destWrote; resource = GetNamedResource('cicn', nativeName); if (resource != NULL) { - type = TYPE3; + type = TYPE3; } else { - resource = GetNamedResource('ICON', nativeName); - if (resource != NULL) { - type = TYPE2; - } + resource = GetNamedResource('ICON', nativeName); + if (resource != NULL) { + type = TYPE2; + } } - + if (resource == NULL) { - return (Pixmap) NULL; + return (Pixmap) NULL; } - + pix = Tk_GetPixmap(display, None, 32, 32, 0); destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(pix); GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); - + SetRect(&destRect, 0, 0, 32, 32); if (type == TYPE2) { - RGBColor black = {0, 0, 0}; - - RGBForeColor(&black); - PlotIcon(&destRect, resource); - ReleaseResource(resource); + RGBColor black = {0, 0, 0}; + + RGBForeColor(&black); + PlotIcon(&destRect, resource); + ReleaseResource(resource); } else if (type == TYPE3) { - RGBColor white = {0xFFFF, 0xFFFF, 0xFFFF}; - short id; - ResType theType; - Str255 dummy; - - /* - * We need to first paint the background white. Also, for - * some reason we *must* use GetCIcon instead of GetNamedResource - * for PlotCIcon to work - so we use GetResInfo to get the id. - */ - RGBForeColor(&white); - PaintRect(&destRect); - GetResInfo(resource, &id, &theType, dummy); - ReleaseResource(resource); - resource = (Handle) GetCIcon(id); - PlotCIcon(&destRect, (CIconHandle) resource); - DisposeCIcon((CIconHandle) resource); + RGBColor white = {0xFFFF, 0xFFFF, 0xFFFF}; + short id; + ResType theType; + Str255 dummy; + + /* + * We need to first paint the background white. Also, for some reason + * we *must* use GetCIcon instead of GetNamedResource for PlotCIcon to + * work - so we use GetResInfo to get the id. + */ + + RGBForeColor(&white); + PaintRect(&destRect); + GetResInfo(resource, &id, &theType, dummy); + ReleaseResource(resource); + resource = (Handle) GetCIcon(id); + PlotCIcon(&destRect, (CIconHandle) resource); + DisposeCIcon((CIconHandle) resource); } - + *width = 32; *height = 32; SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); return pix; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXButton.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXButton.c index c7577f3..1fc95aa 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXButton.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXButton.c @@ -1,16 +1,16 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXButton.c -- * - * This file implements the Macintosh specific portion of the - * button widgets. + * This file implements the Macintosh specific portion of the button + * widgets. * * Copyright (c) 1996-1997 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXButton.c,v 1.20 2006/08/18 07:30:54 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXButton.c,v 1.21 2007/04/13 14:51:17 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -23,6 +23,7 @@ /* * Default insets for controls */ + #define DEF_INSET_LEFT 2 #define DEF_INSET_RIGHT 2 #define DEF_INSET_TOP 2 @@ -37,7 +38,7 @@ #define DRAW_CUSTOM 2 /* Make our own button drawing. */ #define DRAW_BEVEL 3 -/* +/* * Declaration of Mac specific button structure. */ @@ -46,75 +47,77 @@ typedef struct { SInt16 minValue; SInt16 maxValue; SInt16 procID; - int isBevel; + int isBevel; } MacControlParams; typedef struct { int drawType; Tk_3DBorder border; int relief; - int offset; /* 0 means this is a normal widget. 1 means - * it is an image button, so we offset the - * image to make the button appear to move - * up and down as the relief changes. */ - GC gc; + int offset; /* 0 means this is a normal widget. 1 means it + * is an image button, so we offset the image + * to make the button appear to move up and + * down as the relief changes. */ + GC gc; int hasImageOrBitmap; } DrawParams; - typedef struct { - TkButton info; /* generic button info */ - int id; - int usingControl; - int useTkText; - int flags; /* initialisation status */ - MacControlParams params; - WindowRef windowRef; - RGBColor userPaneBackground; - ControlRef userPane; /* Carbon control */ - ControlRef control; /* Carbon control */ - Str255 controlTitle; - ControlFontStyleRec fontStyle; - /* - * the following are used to store the image content for - * beveled buttons - i.e. buttons with images. + TkButton info; /* Generic button info */ + int id; + int usingControl; + int useTkText; + int flags; /* Initialisation status */ + MacControlParams params; + WindowRef windowRef; + RGBColor userPaneBackground; + ControlRef userPane; /* Carbon control */ + ControlRef control; /* Carbon control */ + Str255 controlTitle; + ControlFontStyleRec fontStyle; + /* + * The following are used to store the image content for beveled buttons - + * i.e. buttons with images. */ - CCTabHandle tabHandle; + CCTabHandle tabHandle; ControlButtonContentInfo bevelButtonContent; - OpenCPicParams picParams; - Pixmap picPixmap; + OpenCPicParams picParams; + Pixmap picPixmap; } MacButton; /* * Forward declarations for procedures defined later in this file: */ - -static OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc(ControlRef control, - ControlUserPaneDrawProcPtr upp); -static OSErr SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc(ControlRef control, - ControlUserPaneBackgroundProcPtr upp); -static void UserPaneDraw(ControlRef control, ControlPartCode cpc); -static void UserPaneBackgroundProc(ControlHandle, - ControlBackgroundPtr info); - -static void ButtonEventProc _ANSI_ARGS_(( ClientData clientData, XEvent *eventPtr)); -static int UpdateControlColors _ANSI_ARGS_((MacButton *mbPtr )); -static void TkMacOSXComputeControlParams _ANSI_ARGS_((TkButton * butPtr, MacControlParams * paramsPtr)); -static int TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams _ANSI_ARGS_((TkButton * butPtr, DrawParams * dpPtr)); -static void TkMacOSXDrawControl _ANSI_ARGS_((MacButton *butPtr, - GWorldPtr destPort, GC gc, Pixmap pixmap)); -static void SetupBevelButton _ANSI_ARGS_((MacButton *butPtr, - ControlRef controlHandle, - GWorldPtr destPort, GC gc, Pixmap pixmap)); +static OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc(ControlRef control, + ControlUserPaneDrawProcPtr upp); +static OSErr SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc( + ControlRef control, + ControlUserPaneBackgroundProcPtr upp); +static void UserPaneDraw(ControlRef control, ControlPartCode cpc); +static void UserPaneBackgroundProc(ControlHandle, + ControlBackgroundPtr info); + +static void ButtonEventProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static int UpdateControlColors(MacButton *mbPtr); +static void TkMacOSXComputeControlParams(TkButton *butPtr, + MacControlParams *paramsPtr); +static int TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams(TkButton *butPtr, + DrawParams *dpPtr); +static void TkMacOSXDrawControl(MacButton *butPtr, + GWorldPtr destPort, GC gc, Pixmap pixmap); +static void SetupBevelButton(MacButton *butPtr, + ControlRef controlHandle, GWorldPtr destPort, + GC gc, Pixmap pixmap); /* * The class procedure table for the button widgets. */ -Tk_ClassProcs tkpButtonProcs = { - sizeof(Tk_ClassProcs), /* size */ - TkButtonWorldChanged, /* worldChangedProc */ +Tk_ClassProcs tkpButtonProcs = { + sizeof(Tk_ClassProcs), /* size */ + TkButtonWorldChanged, /* worldChangedProc */ }; static int bCount; @@ -126,13 +129,13 @@ int tkPictureIsOpen; * * TkpCreateButton -- * - * Allocate a new TkButton structure. + * Allocate a new TkButton structure. * * Results: - * Returns a newly allocated TkButton structure. + * Returns a newly allocated TkButton structure. * * Side effects: - * Registers an event handler for the widget. + * Registers an event handler for the widget. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -141,10 +144,10 @@ TkButton * TkpCreateButton( Tk_Window tkwin) { - MacButton *macButtonPtr; - macButtonPtr = (MacButton *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacButton)); + MacButton *macButtonPtr = (MacButton *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacButton)); + Tk_CreateEventHandler(tkwin, ActivateMask, - ButtonEventProc, (ClientData) macButtonPtr); + ButtonEventProc, (ClientData) macButtonPtr); macButtonPtr->id = bCount++; macButtonPtr->usingControl = 0; macButtonPtr->flags = 0; @@ -165,6 +168,7 @@ TkpCreateButton( macButtonPtr->bevelButtonContent.contentType = kControlContentPictHandle; bzero(&macButtonPtr->params, sizeof(macButtonPtr->params)); bzero(&macButtonPtr->fontStyle,sizeof(macButtonPtr->fontStyle)); + return (TkButton *)macButtonPtr; } @@ -173,309 +177,298 @@ TkpCreateButton( * * TkpDisplayButton -- * - * This procedure is invoked to display a button widget. It is - * normally invoked as an idle handler. + * This procedure is invoked to display a button widget. It is normally + * invoked as an idle handler. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the button in its - * current mode. The REDRAW_PENDING flag is cleared. + * Commands are output to X to display the button in its current mode. + * The REDRAW_PENDING flag is cleared. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpDisplayButton( - ClientData clientData) /* Information about widget. */ + ClientData clientData) /* Information about widget. */ { MacButton *macButtonPtr = (MacButton *)clientData; - TkButton *butPtr = (TkButton *) clientData; - Tk_Window tkwin = butPtr->tkwin; - int width, height, fullWidth, fullHeight; - int textXOffset, textYOffset; - int haveImage = 0, haveText = 0; + TkButton *butPtr = (TkButton *) clientData; + Tk_Window tkwin = butPtr->tkwin; GWorldPtr destPort; - int borderWidth; Pixmap pixmap; - int wasUsingControl; - int imageWidth = 0, imageHeight = 0; - int imageXOffset = 0, imageYOffset = 0; /* image information that will - * be used to restrict disabled - * pixmap as well */ - DrawParams drawParams, * dpPtr = &drawParams; + int width, height, fullWidth, fullHeight, textXOffset, textYOffset; + int borderWidth, wasUsingControl; + int haveImage = 0, haveText = 0, imageWidth = 0, imageHeight = 0; + int imageXOffset = 0, imageYOffset = 0; + /* Image information that will be used to + * restrict disabled pixmap as well. */ + DrawParams drawParams, *dpPtr = &drawParams; butPtr->flags &= ~REDRAW_PENDING; if ((butPtr->tkwin == NULL) || !Tk_IsMapped(tkwin)) { - return; + return; } pixmap = (Pixmap) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); wasUsingControl = macButtonPtr->usingControl; if (TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams(butPtr, &drawParams) ) { - macButtonPtr->usingControl = 1; - if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { - macButtonPtr->useTkText = 0; - } else { - macButtonPtr->useTkText = 1; - } + macButtonPtr->usingControl = 1; + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { + macButtonPtr->useTkText = 0; + } else { + macButtonPtr->useTkText = 1; + } } else { - macButtonPtr->usingControl = 0; - macButtonPtr->useTkText = 1; + macButtonPtr->usingControl = 0; + macButtonPtr->useTkText = 1; } - - /* - * set up clipping region. Make sure the we are using the port - * for this button, or we will set the wrong window's clip. + + /* + * Set up clipping region. Make sure the we are using the port for this + * button, or we will set the wrong window's clip. */ - + destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(pixmap); SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(pixmap); - /* - * See the comment in UpdateControlColors as to why we use the + * See the comment in UpdateControlColors as to why we use the * highlightbackground for the border of Macintosh buttons. */ if (macButtonPtr->useTkText) { - if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, butPtr->highlightBorder, 0, 0, - Tk_Width(tkwin), Tk_Height(tkwin), 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - } else { - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, butPtr->normalBorder, 0, 0, - Tk_Width(tkwin), Tk_Height(tkwin), 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - } + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { + Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, butPtr->highlightBorder, 0, 0, + Tk_Width(tkwin), Tk_Height(tkwin), 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); + } else { + Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, butPtr->normalBorder, 0, 0, + Tk_Width(tkwin), Tk_Height(tkwin), 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); + } } /* * Draw the native portion of the buttons. Start by creating the control - * if it doesn't already exist. Then configure the Macintosh control from - * the Tk info. Finally, we call Draw1Control to draw to the screen. + * if it doesn't already exist. Then configure the Macintosh control from + * the Tk info. Finally, we call Draw1Control to draw to the screen. */ if (macButtonPtr->usingControl) { - borderWidth = 0; - TkMacOSXDrawControl(macButtonPtr, destPort, dpPtr->gc, pixmap); - } else { - if (wasUsingControl && macButtonPtr->userPane) { - DisposeControl(macButtonPtr->userPane); - macButtonPtr->userPane = NULL; - macButtonPtr->control = NULL; - macButtonPtr->flags = 0; - } + borderWidth = 0; + TkMacOSXDrawControl(macButtonPtr, destPort, dpPtr->gc, pixmap); + } else if (wasUsingControl && macButtonPtr->userPane) { + DisposeControl(macButtonPtr->userPane); + macButtonPtr->userPane = NULL; + macButtonPtr->control = NULL; + macButtonPtr->flags = 0; } if ((dpPtr->drawType == DRAW_CUSTOM) || (dpPtr->drawType == DRAW_LABEL)) { - borderWidth = butPtr->borderWidth; + borderWidth = butPtr->borderWidth; } /* - * Display image or bitmap or text for button. This has - * already been done under Appearance with the Bevel - * button types. + * Display image or bitmap or text for button. This has already been done + * under Appearance with the Bevel button types. */ if (dpPtr->drawType == DRAW_BEVEL) { - /* Empty Body */ - } else { - if (butPtr->image != None) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); - haveImage = 1; - } else if (butPtr->bitmap != None) { - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); - haveImage = 1; - } - imageWidth = width; - imageHeight = height; - - haveText = (butPtr->textWidth != 0 && butPtr->textHeight != 0); - if (butPtr->compound != COMPOUND_NONE && haveImage && haveText) { - int x; - int y; - textXOffset = 0; - textYOffset = 0; - fullWidth = 0; - fullHeight = 0; - - switch ((enum compound) butPtr->compound) { - case COMPOUND_TOP: - case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: { - /* Image is above or below text */ - if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_TOP) { - textYOffset = height + butPtr->padY; - } else { - imageYOffset = butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; - } - fullHeight = height + butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; - fullWidth = (width > butPtr->textWidth ? width : - butPtr->textWidth); - textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; - imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; - break; - } - case COMPOUND_LEFT: - case COMPOUND_RIGHT: { - /* - * Image is left or right of text - */ - - if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_LEFT) { - textXOffset = width + butPtr->padX; - } else { - imageXOffset = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX; - } - fullWidth = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX + width; - fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : - butPtr->textHeight); - textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; - imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; - break; - } - case COMPOUND_CENTER: { - /* - * Image and text are superimposed - */ - - fullWidth = (width > butPtr->textWidth ? width : - butPtr->textWidth); - fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : - butPtr->textHeight); - textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; - imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; - textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; - imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; - break; - } - case COMPOUND_NONE: {break;} - } - - TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, butPtr->padX, butPtr->padY, - butPtr->indicatorSpace + fullWidth, fullHeight, &x, &y); - - x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; - - x += dpPtr->offset; - y += dpPtr->offset; - if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_RAISED) { - x -= dpPtr->offset; - y -= dpPtr->offset; - } else if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { - x += dpPtr->offset; - y += dpPtr->offset; - } - imageXOffset += x; - imageYOffset += y; - if (butPtr->image != NULL) { - if ((butPtr->selectImage != NULL) && - (butPtr->flags & SELECTED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0, 0, - width, height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) && - (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0, 0, - width, height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } else { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, - height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } - } else { - XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, + goto applyStipple; + } + + if (butPtr->image != None) { + Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); + haveImage = 1; + } else if (butPtr->bitmap != None) { + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); + haveImage = 1; + } + imageWidth = width; + imageHeight = height; + + haveText = (butPtr->textWidth != 0 && butPtr->textHeight != 0); + if (butPtr->compound != COMPOUND_NONE && haveImage && haveText) { + int x, y; + + textXOffset = 0; + textYOffset = 0; + fullWidth = 0; + fullHeight = 0; + + switch ((enum compound) butPtr->compound) { + case COMPOUND_TOP: + case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: + /* + * Image is above or below text. + */ + + if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_TOP) { + textYOffset = height + butPtr->padY; + } else { + imageYOffset = butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; + } + fullHeight = height + butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; + fullWidth = (width>butPtr->textWidth ? width : butPtr->textWidth); + textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; + imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; + break; + + case COMPOUND_LEFT: + case COMPOUND_RIGHT: + /* + * Image is left or right of text. + */ + + if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_LEFT) { + textXOffset = width + butPtr->padX; + } else { + imageXOffset = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX; + } + fullWidth = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX + width; + fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : + butPtr->textHeight); + textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; + imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; + break; + + case COMPOUND_CENTER: + /* + * Image and text are superimposed. + */ + + fullWidth = (width>butPtr->textWidth ? width : butPtr->textWidth); + fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : + butPtr->textHeight); + textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; + imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; + textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; + imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; + break; + + case COMPOUND_NONE: + break; + } + + TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, butPtr->padX, butPtr->padY, + butPtr->indicatorSpace + fullWidth, fullHeight, &x, &y); + + x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; + + x += dpPtr->offset; + y += dpPtr->offset; + if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_RAISED) { + x -= dpPtr->offset; + y -= dpPtr->offset; + } else if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { + x += dpPtr->offset; + y += dpPtr->offset; + } + imageXOffset += x; + imageYOffset += y; + if (butPtr->image != NULL) { + if ((butPtr->selectImage != NULL) && (butPtr->flags & SELECTED)) { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0, 0, width, height, + pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); + } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) && + (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0, 0, width, height, + pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); + } else { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, + imageXOffset, imageYOffset); + } + } else { + XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, imageXOffset, + imageYOffset); + XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, + 0, 0, (unsigned int) width, (unsigned int) height, + imageXOffset, imageYOffset, 1); + XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, 0, 0); + } + + if (macButtonPtr->useTkText) { + Tk_DrawTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, + butPtr->textLayout, x + textXOffset, y + textYOffset, + 0, -1); + Tk_UnderlineTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, + butPtr->textLayout, x + textXOffset, y + textYOffset, + butPtr->underline); + } + y += fullHeight/2; + } else if (haveImage) { + int x = 0, y; + + TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, 0, 0, + butPtr->indicatorSpace + width, height, &x, &y); + x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; + + x += dpPtr->offset; + y += dpPtr->offset; + if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_RAISED) { + x -= dpPtr->offset; + y -= dpPtr->offset; + } else if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { + x += dpPtr->offset; + y += dpPtr->offset; + } + imageXOffset += x; + imageYOffset += y; + if (butPtr->image != NULL) { + if ((butPtr->selectImage != NULL) && (butPtr->flags & SELECTED)) { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0, 0, width, height, + pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); + } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) && + (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0, 0, width, height, + pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); + } else { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, - 0, 0, (unsigned int) width, (unsigned int) height, - imageXOffset, imageYOffset, 1); - XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, 0, 0); - } - - if (macButtonPtr->useTkText) { - Tk_DrawTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, - dpPtr->gc, butPtr->textLayout, - x + textXOffset, y + textYOffset, 0, -1); - Tk_UnderlineTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, - butPtr->textLayout, - x + textXOffset, y + textYOffset, - butPtr->underline); - } - y += fullHeight/2; - } else { - if (haveImage) { - int x = 0; - int y; - - TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, 0, 0, - butPtr->indicatorSpace + width, height, &x, &y); - x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; - - x += dpPtr->offset; - y += dpPtr->offset; - if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_RAISED) { - x -= dpPtr->offset; - y -= dpPtr->offset; - } else if (dpPtr->relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { - x += dpPtr->offset; - y += dpPtr->offset; - } - imageXOffset += x; - imageYOffset += y; - if (butPtr->image != NULL) { - if ((butPtr->selectImage != NULL) && - (butPtr->flags & SELECTED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0, 0, width, - height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) && - (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0, 0, width, - height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } else { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, height, - pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } - } else { - XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, x, y); - XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, - pixmap, dpPtr->gc, - 0, 0, (unsigned int) width, - (unsigned int) height, x, y, 1); - XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, 0, 0); - } - y += height/2; - } else if (macButtonPtr->useTkText) { - int x = 0; - int y; - TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, butPtr->padX, - butPtr->padY, - butPtr->indicatorSpace + butPtr->textWidth, - butPtr->textHeight, &x, &y); - x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; - Tk_DrawTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, - butPtr->textLayout, x, y, 0, -1); - } - } + } + } else { + XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, x, y); + XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, + 0, 0, (unsigned) width, (unsigned) height, x, y, 1); + XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, dpPtr->gc, 0, 0); + } + y += height/2; + } else if (macButtonPtr->useTkText) { + int x = 0, y; + + TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, butPtr->padX, butPtr->padY, + butPtr->indicatorSpace + butPtr->textWidth, + butPtr->textHeight, &x, &y); + x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; + Tk_DrawTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, dpPtr->gc, + butPtr->textLayout, x, y, 0, -1); } /* * If the button is disabled with a stipple rather than a special - * foreground color, generate the stippled effect. If the widget - * is selected and we use a different background color when selected, - * must temporarily modify the GC so the stippling is the right color. + * foreground color, generate the stippled effect. If the widget is + * selected and we use a different background color when selected, must + * temporarily modify the GC so the stippling is the right color. */ + applyStipple: if (macButtonPtr->useTkText) { - if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) - && ((butPtr->disabledFg == NULL) || (butPtr->image != NULL))) { - if ((butPtr->flags & SELECTED) && !butPtr->indicatorOn + if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) + && ((butPtr->disabledFg == NULL) || (butPtr->image != NULL))) { + if ((butPtr->flags & SELECTED) && !butPtr->indicatorOn && (butPtr->selectBorder != NULL)) { - XSetForeground(butPtr->display, butPtr->stippleGC, + XSetForeground(butPtr->display, butPtr->stippleGC, Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->selectBorder)->pixel); - } + } + /* * Stipple the whole button if no disabledFg was specified, * otherwise restrict stippling only to displayed image */ + if (butPtr->disabledFg == NULL) { XFillRectangle(butPtr->display, pixmap, butPtr->stippleGC, 0, 0, (unsigned) Tk_Width(tkwin), @@ -485,24 +478,25 @@ TkpDisplayButton( imageXOffset, imageYOffset, (unsigned) imageWidth, (unsigned) imageHeight); } - if ((butPtr->flags & SELECTED) && !butPtr->indicatorOn + if ((butPtr->flags & SELECTED) && !butPtr->indicatorOn && (butPtr->selectBorder != NULL)) { XSetForeground(butPtr->display, butPtr->stippleGC, Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->normalBorder)->pixel); } - } - - /* - * Draw the border and traversal highlight last. This way, if the - * button's contents overflow they'll be covered up by the border. - */ - - if (dpPtr->relief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT) { - int inset = butPtr->highlightWidth; - Tk_Draw3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, dpPtr->border, inset, inset, - Tk_Width(tkwin) - 2*inset, Tk_Height(tkwin) - 2*inset, - butPtr->borderWidth, dpPtr->relief); - } + } + + /* + * Draw the border and traversal highlight last. This way, if the + * button's contents overflow they'll be covered up by the border. + */ + + if (dpPtr->relief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT) { + int inset = butPtr->highlightWidth; + + Tk_Draw3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, dpPtr->border, inset, inset, + Tk_Width(tkwin) - 2*inset, Tk_Height(tkwin) - 2*inset, + butPtr->borderWidth, dpPtr->relief); + } } } @@ -511,236 +505,228 @@ TkpDisplayButton( * * TkpComputeButtonGeometry -- * - * After changes in a button's text or bitmap, this procedure - * recomputes the button's geometry and passes this information - * along to the geometry manager for the window. + * After changes in a button's text or bitmap, this procedure recomputes + * the button's geometry and passes this information along to the + * geometry manager for the window. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The button's window may change size. + * The button's window may change size. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpComputeButtonGeometry( - TkButton *butPtr) /* Button whose geometry may have changed. */ + TkButton *butPtr) /* Button whose geometry may have changed. */ { int width, height, avgWidth, haveImage = 0, haveText = 0; - int xInset, yInset; - int txtWidth, txtHeight; + int xInset, yInset, txtWidth, txtHeight; Tk_FontMetrics fm; DrawParams drawParams; /* * First figure out the size of the contents of the button. */ - + width = 0; height = 0; txtWidth = 0; txtHeight = 0; avgWidth = 0; - butPtr->indicatorSpace = 0; if (butPtr->image != NULL) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); - haveImage = 1; + Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); + haveImage = 1; } else if (butPtr->bitmap != None) { - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); - haveImage = 1; + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); + haveImage = 1; } if (haveImage == 0 || butPtr->compound != COMPOUND_NONE) { - Tk_FreeTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout); - butPtr->textLayout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(butPtr->tkfont, - Tcl_GetString(butPtr->textPtr), -1, butPtr->wrapLength, - butPtr->justify, 0, &butPtr->textWidth, &butPtr->textHeight); - - txtWidth = butPtr->textWidth; - txtHeight = butPtr->textHeight; - avgWidth = Tk_TextWidth(butPtr->tkfont, "0", 1); - Tk_GetFontMetrics(butPtr->tkfont, &fm); - haveText = (txtWidth != 0 && txtHeight != 0); + Tk_FreeTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout); + butPtr->textLayout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(butPtr->tkfont, + Tcl_GetString(butPtr->textPtr), -1, butPtr->wrapLength, + butPtr->justify, 0, &butPtr->textWidth, &butPtr->textHeight); + + txtWidth = butPtr->textWidth; + txtHeight = butPtr->textHeight; + avgWidth = Tk_TextWidth(butPtr->tkfont, "0", 1); + Tk_GetFontMetrics(butPtr->tkfont, &fm); + haveText = (txtWidth != 0 && txtHeight != 0); } /* - * If the button is compound (ie, it shows both an image and text), - * the new geometry is a combination of the image and text geometry. - * We only honor the compound bit if the button has both text and an - * image, because otherwise it is not really a compound button. + * If the button is compound (ie, it shows both an image and text), the + * new geometry is a combination of the image and text geometry. We only + * honor the compound bit if the button has both text and an image, + * because otherwise it is not really a compound button. */ if (butPtr->compound != COMPOUND_NONE && haveImage && haveText) { - switch ((enum compound) butPtr->compound) { - case COMPOUND_TOP: - case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: { - /* - * Image is above or below text - */ - - height += txtHeight + butPtr->padY; - width = (width > txtWidth ? width : txtWidth); - break; - } - case COMPOUND_LEFT: - case COMPOUND_RIGHT: { - /* - * Image is left or right of text - */ - - width += txtWidth + butPtr->padX; - height = (height > txtHeight ? height : txtHeight); - break; - } - case COMPOUND_CENTER: { - /* - * Image and text are superimposed - */ - - width = (width > txtWidth ? width : txtWidth); - height = (height > txtHeight ? height : txtHeight); - break; - } - case COMPOUND_NONE: {break;} - } - if (butPtr->width > 0) { - width = butPtr->width; - } - if (butPtr->height > 0) { - height = butPtr->height; - } - - if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn) { - butPtr->indicatorSpace = height; - if (butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { - butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (65 * height)/100; - } else { - butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (75 * height)/100; - } - } - - width += 2 * butPtr->padX; - height += 2 * butPtr->padY; + switch ((enum compound) butPtr->compound) { + case COMPOUND_TOP: + case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: + /* + * Image is above or below text. + */ + + height += txtHeight + butPtr->padY; + width = (width > txtWidth ? width : txtWidth); + break; + case COMPOUND_LEFT: + case COMPOUND_RIGHT: + /* + * Image is left or right of text. + */ + + width += txtWidth + butPtr->padX; + height = (height > txtHeight ? height : txtHeight); + break; + case COMPOUND_CENTER: + /* + * Image and text are superimposed. + */ + + width = (width > txtWidth ? width : txtWidth); + height = (height > txtHeight ? height : txtHeight); + break; + case COMPOUND_NONE: + break; + } + if (butPtr->width > 0) { + width = butPtr->width; + } + if (butPtr->height > 0) { + height = butPtr->height; + } + if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn) { + butPtr->indicatorSpace = height; + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { + butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (65 * height)/100; + } else { + butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (75 * height)/100; + } + } + + width += 2 * butPtr->padX; + height += 2 * butPtr->padY; + } else if (haveImage) { + if (butPtr->width > 0) { + width = butPtr->width; + } + if (butPtr->height > 0) { + height = butPtr->height; + } + if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn) { + butPtr->indicatorSpace = height; + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { + butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (65 * height)/100; + } else { + butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (75 * height)/100; + } + } } else { - if (haveImage) { - if (butPtr->width > 0) { - width = butPtr->width; - } - if (butPtr->height > 0) { - height = butPtr->height; - } - if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn) { - butPtr->indicatorSpace = height; - if (butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { - butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (65 * height)/100; - } else { - butPtr->indicatorDiameter = (75 * height)/100; - } - } - } else { - width = txtWidth; - height = txtHeight; - if (butPtr->width > 0) { - width = butPtr->width * avgWidth; - } - if (butPtr->height > 0) { - height = butPtr->height * fm.linespace; - } - if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn) { - butPtr->indicatorDiameter = fm.linespace; - if (butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { - butPtr->indicatorDiameter = - (80 * butPtr->indicatorDiameter)/100; - } - butPtr->indicatorSpace = butPtr->indicatorDiameter + avgWidth; - } - } + width = txtWidth; + height = txtHeight; + if (butPtr->width > 0) { + width = butPtr->width * avgWidth; + } + if (butPtr->height > 0) { + height = butPtr->height * fm.linespace; + } + if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn) { + butPtr->indicatorDiameter = fm.linespace; + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { + butPtr->indicatorDiameter = + (80 * butPtr->indicatorDiameter)/100; + } + butPtr->indicatorSpace = butPtr->indicatorDiameter + avgWidth; + } } /* * Now figure out the size of the border decorations for the button. */ - + if (butPtr->highlightWidth < 0) { - butPtr->highlightWidth = 0; + butPtr->highlightWidth = 0; } - + /* - * The width and height calculation for Appearance buttons with images & - * non-Appearance buttons with images is different. In the latter case, - * we add the borderwidth to the inset, since we are going to stamp a - * 3-D border over the image. In the former, we add it to the height, + * The width and height calculation for Appearance buttons with images & + * non-Appearance buttons with images is different. In the latter case, we + * add the borderwidth to the inset, since we are going to stamp a 3-D + * border over the image. In the former, we add it to the height, * directly, since Appearance will draw the border as part of our control. * * When issuing the geometry request, add extra space for the indicator, - * if any, and for the border and padding, plus if this is an image two + * if any, and for the border and padding, plus if this is an image two * extra pixels so the display can be offset by 1 pixel in either * direction for the raised or lowered effect. * * The highlight width corresponds to the default ring on the Macintosh. * As such, the highlight width is only added if the button is the default - * button. The actual width of the default ring is one less than the - * highlight width as there is also one pixel of spacing. - * Appearance buttons with images do not have a highlight ring, because the - * Bevel button type does not support one. + * button. The actual width of the default ring is one less than the + * highlight width as there is also one pixel of spacing. Appearance + * buttons with images do not have a highlight ring, because the Bevel + * button type does not support one. */ if ((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) { - width += 2*butPtr->padX; - height += 2*butPtr->padY; + width += 2*butPtr->padX; + height += 2*butPtr->padY; } - + if ((butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON)) { - if ((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) { - butPtr->inset = 0; - if (butPtr->defaultState != STATE_DISABLED) { - butPtr->inset += butPtr->highlightWidth; - } - } else { - butPtr->inset = 0; - width += (2 * butPtr->borderWidth + 4); - height += (2 * butPtr->borderWidth + 4); - } - } else if ((butPtr->type != TYPE_LABEL)) { - if (butPtr->indicatorOn) { - butPtr->inset = 0; - } else { - /* - * Under Appearance, the Checkbutton or radiobutton with an image - * is represented by a BevelButton with the Sticky defProc... - * So we must set its height in the same way as the Button - * with an image or bitmap. - */ - - if ( (butPtr->image != None) || (butPtr->bitmap != None)) { - int border; - butPtr->inset = 0; - if ( butPtr->borderWidth <= 2 ) { - border = 6; - } else { - border = 2 * butPtr->borderWidth + 2; - } - width += border; - height += border; - } else { - butPtr->inset = butPtr->borderWidth; - } - } + if ((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) { + butPtr->inset = 0; + if (butPtr->defaultState != STATE_DISABLED) { + butPtr->inset += butPtr->highlightWidth; + } + } else { + butPtr->inset = 0; + width += (2 * butPtr->borderWidth + 4); + height += (2 * butPtr->borderWidth + 4); + } + } else if (butPtr->type == TYPE_LABEL) { + butPtr->inset = butPtr->borderWidth; + } else if (butPtr->indicatorOn) { + butPtr->inset = 0; } else { - butPtr->inset = butPtr->borderWidth; + /* + * Under Appearance, the Checkbutton or radiobutton with an image is + * represented by a BevelButton with the Sticky defProc... So we must + * set its height in the same way as the Button with an image or + * bitmap. + */ + + if ((butPtr->image != None) || (butPtr->bitmap != None)) { + int border; + + butPtr->inset = 0; + if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { + border = 6; + } else { + border = 2 * butPtr->borderWidth + 2; + } + width += border; + height += border; + } else { + butPtr->inset = butPtr->borderWidth; + } } if (TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams(butPtr,&drawParams)) { - xInset = butPtr->indicatorSpace + DEF_INSET_LEFT + DEF_INSET_RIGHT; - yInset = DEF_INSET_TOP + DEF_INSET_BOTTOM; + xInset = butPtr->indicatorSpace + DEF_INSET_LEFT + DEF_INSET_RIGHT; + yInset = DEF_INSET_TOP + DEF_INSET_BOTTOM; } else { - xInset = butPtr->indicatorSpace+butPtr->inset*2; - yInset = butPtr->inset*2; + xInset = butPtr->indicatorSpace+butPtr->inset*2; + yInset = butPtr->inset*2; } Tk_GeometryRequest(butPtr->tkwin, width + xInset, height + yInset); Tk_SetInternalBorder(butPtr->tkwin, butPtr->inset); @@ -751,13 +737,13 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry( * * TkpDestroyButton -- * - * Free data structures associated with the button control. + * Free data structures associated with the button control. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Restores the default control state. + * Restores the default control state. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -766,10 +752,11 @@ void TkpDestroyButton( TkButton *butPtr) { - MacButton *mbPtr = ( MacButton *) butPtr; /* Mac button. */ + MacButton *mbPtr = (MacButton *) butPtr; /* Mac button. */ + if (mbPtr->userPane) { - DisposeControl(mbPtr->userPane); - mbPtr->userPane = NULL; + DisposeControl(mbPtr->userPane); + mbPtr->userPane = NULL; } } @@ -778,246 +765,220 @@ TkpDestroyButton( * * TkMacOSXInitControl -- * - * This procedure initialises a Carbon control + * This procedure initialises a Carbon control. * * Results: - * 0 on success, 1 on failure. + * 0 on success, 1 on failure. * * Side effects: - * A background pane control and the control itself is created - * The contol is embedded in the background control - * The background control is embedded in the root control - * of the containing window - * The creation parameters for the control are also computed + * A background pane control and the control itself is created. The + * contol is embedded in the background control. The background control + * is embedded in the root control of the containing window. The creation + * parameters for the control are also computed. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int -TkMacOSXInitControl ( - MacButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ - GWorldPtr destPort, - GC gc, - Pixmap pixmap, - Rect *paneRect, - Rect *cntrRect -) +TkMacOSXInitControl( + MacButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ + GWorldPtr destPort, + GC gc, + Pixmap pixmap, + Rect *paneRect, + Rect *cntrRect) { - OSErr status; - TkButton * butPtr = ( TkButton * )mbPtr; + OSErr status; + TkButton *butPtr = (TkButton *) mbPtr; ControlRef rootControl; - SInt16 procID; - Boolean initiallyVisible; - SInt16 initialValue; - SInt16 minValue; - SInt16 maxValue; - SInt32 controlReference; + SInt16 procID, initialValue, minValue, maxValue; + Boolean initiallyVisible; + SInt32 controlReference; rootControl = TkMacOSXGetRootControl(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin)); - mbPtr->windowRef - = GetWindowFromPort(TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin))); + mbPtr->windowRef = GetWindowFromPort( + TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin))); - /* - * Set up the user pane + /* + * Set up the user pane. */ initiallyVisible = false; - initialValue = kControlSupportsEmbedding|kControlHasSpecialBackground; - minValue = 0; - maxValue = 1; - procID = kControlUserPaneProc; + initialValue = kControlSupportsEmbedding|kControlHasSpecialBackground; + minValue = 0; + maxValue = 1; + procID = kControlUserPaneProc; controlReference = (SInt32)mbPtr; - mbPtr->userPane = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, - paneRect, "\p", - initiallyVisible, - initialValue, - minValue, - maxValue, - procID, - controlReference ); - + mbPtr->userPane = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, paneRect, "\p", + initiallyVisible, initialValue, minValue, maxValue, procID, + controlReference); + if (!mbPtr->userPane) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Failed to create user pane control\n"); -#endif - return 1; + LOG_MSG("Failed to create user pane control"); + return 1; } - + if ((status = EmbedControl(mbPtr->userPane,rootControl)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Failed to embed user pane control %d\n", status); -#endif - return 1; + LOG_MSG("Failed to embed user pane control %d", status); + return 1; } - + SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc(mbPtr->userPane, - UserPaneBackgroundProc); + UserPaneBackgroundProc); SetUserPaneDrawProc(mbPtr->userPane,UserPaneDraw); initiallyVisible = false; TkMacOSXComputeControlParams(butPtr,&mbPtr->params); - mbPtr->control = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, - cntrRect, "\p", - initiallyVisible, - mbPtr->params.initialValue, - mbPtr->params.minValue, - mbPtr->params.maxValue, - mbPtr->params.procID, - controlReference ); - + mbPtr->control = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, cntrRect, "\p", + initiallyVisible, mbPtr->params.initialValue, + mbPtr->params.minValue, mbPtr->params.maxValue, + mbPtr->params.procID, controlReference); + if (!mbPtr->control) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"failed to create control of type %d\n",procID); -#endif - return 1; + LOG_MSG("failed to create control of type %d", procID); + return 1; } - - if (EmbedControl(mbPtr->control,mbPtr->userPane) != noErr ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"failed to embed control of type %d\n",procID); -#endif - return 1; + + if (EmbedControl(mbPtr->control,mbPtr->userPane) != noErr) { + LOG_MSG("failed to embed control of type %d", procID); + return 1; } - + mbPtr->flags |= (1 + 2); return 0; } - + /* *-------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXDrawControl -- * - * This function draws the tk button using Mac controls - * In addition, this code may apply custom colors passed - * in the TkButton. + * This function draws the tk button using Mac controls. In addition, + * this code may apply custom colors passed in the TkButton. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The control is created, or reinitialised as needed - * + * The control is created, or reinitialised as needed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void TkMacOSXDrawControl( - MacButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ - GWorldPtr destPort, /* Off screen GWorld. */ - GC gc, /* The GC we are drawing into - needed for - * the bevel button */ - Pixmap pixmap) /* The pixmap we are drawing into - needed - * for the bevel button */ - + MacButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ + GWorldPtr destPort, /* Off screen GWorld. */ + GC gc, /* The GC we are drawing into - needed for the + * bevel button */ + Pixmap pixmap) /* The pixmap we are drawing into - needed for + * the bevel button */ { - TkButton * butPtr = ( TkButton *)mbPtr; - int err; - TkWindow * winPtr; - Rect paneRect; - Rect cntrRect; - - winPtr = (TkWindow *)butPtr->tkwin; - - paneRect.left = winPtr->privatePtr->xOff; - paneRect.top = winPtr->privatePtr->yOff; - paneRect.right = paneRect.left + Tk_Width(butPtr->tkwin); + TkButton *butPtr = (TkButton *) mbPtr; + int err; + TkWindow *winPtr; + Rect paneRect, cntrRect; + + winPtr = (TkWindow *) butPtr->tkwin; + + paneRect.left = winPtr->privatePtr->xOff; + paneRect.top = winPtr->privatePtr->yOff; + paneRect.right = paneRect.left + Tk_Width(butPtr->tkwin); paneRect.bottom = paneRect.top + Tk_Height(butPtr->tkwin); cntrRect = paneRect; /* - cntrRect.left += butPtr->inset; - cntrRect.top += butPtr->inset; - cntrRect.right -= butPtr->inset; + cntrRect.left += butPtr->inset; + cntrRect.top += butPtr->inset; + cntrRect.right -= butPtr->inset; cntrRect.bottom -= butPtr->inset; */ - cntrRect.left += DEF_INSET_LEFT; - cntrRect.top += DEF_INSET_TOP; - cntrRect.right -= DEF_INSET_RIGHT; + cntrRect.left += DEF_INSET_LEFT; + cntrRect.top += DEF_INSET_TOP; + cntrRect.right -= DEF_INSET_RIGHT; cntrRect.bottom -= DEF_INSET_BOTTOM; - /* - * The control has been previously initialised - * It may need to be re-initialised + /* + * The control has been previously initialised. It may need to be + * re-initialised. */ - + if (mbPtr->flags) { - MacControlParams params; - TkMacOSXComputeControlParams(butPtr, ¶ms); - if (bcmp(¶ms, &mbPtr->params, sizeof(params))) { - /* - * the type of control has changed - * Clean it up and clear the flag - */ - - if (mbPtr->userPane) { - DisposeControl(mbPtr->userPane); - mbPtr->userPane = NULL; - mbPtr->control = NULL; - } - mbPtr->flags = 0; - } + MacControlParams params; + + TkMacOSXComputeControlParams(butPtr, ¶ms); + if (bcmp(¶ms, &mbPtr->params, sizeof(params))) { + /* + * The type of control has changed. Clean it up and clear the + * flag. + */ + + if (mbPtr->userPane) { + DisposeControl(mbPtr->userPane); + mbPtr->userPane = NULL; + mbPtr->control = NULL; + } + mbPtr->flags = 0; + } } if (!(mbPtr->flags & 1)) { - if (TkMacOSXInitControl(mbPtr, destPort, gc, - pixmap, &paneRect, &cntrRect) ) { - return; - } + if (TkMacOSXInitControl(mbPtr, destPort, gc, pixmap, + &paneRect, &cntrRect)) { + return; + } } SetControlBounds(mbPtr->userPane, &paneRect); SetControlBounds(mbPtr->control, &cntrRect); if (!mbPtr->useTkText) { - Str255 controlTitle; - ControlFontStyleRec fontStyle; - Tk_Font font; - int len; - - if (((mbPtr->info.image == NULL) && (mbPtr->info.bitmap == None)) - || (mbPtr->info.compound != COMPOUND_NONE)) { - len = TkFontGetFirstTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout, - &font, (char*) controlTitle); - controlTitle[len] = 0; - } else { - len = 0; - controlTitle[0] = 0; - } - if (bcmp(mbPtr->controlTitle, controlTitle, len+1)) { - CFStringRef cf; - cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, - (char*) controlTitle, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); - if (cf != NULL) { - SetControlTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->control, cf); - CFRelease(cf); - } - bcopy(controlTitle, mbPtr->controlTitle, len+1); - } - if (len) { - TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle(font, &fontStyle); - if (bcmp(&mbPtr->fontStyle, &fontStyle, sizeof(fontStyle)) ) { - if (SetControlFontStyle(mbPtr->control, &fontStyle) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetControlFontStyle failed\n"); -#endif - } - bcopy(&fontStyle, &mbPtr->fontStyle, - sizeof(fontStyle)); - } - } + Str255 controlTitle; + ControlFontStyleRec fontStyle; + Tk_Font font; + int len; + + if (((mbPtr->info.image == NULL) && (mbPtr->info.bitmap == None)) + || (mbPtr->info.compound != COMPOUND_NONE)) { + len = TkFontGetFirstTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout, + &font, (char*) controlTitle); + controlTitle[len] = 0; + } else { + len = 0; + controlTitle[0] = 0; + } + if (bcmp(mbPtr->controlTitle, controlTitle, len+1)) { + CFStringRef cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, + (char*) controlTitle, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + + if (cf != NULL) { + SetControlTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->control, cf); + CFRelease(cf); + } + bcopy(controlTitle, mbPtr->controlTitle, len+1); + } + if (len) { + TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle(font, &fontStyle); + if (bcmp(&mbPtr->fontStyle, &fontStyle, sizeof(fontStyle)) ) { + if (SetControlFontStyle(mbPtr->control, &fontStyle) != noErr) { + LOG_MSG("SetControlFontStyle failed"); + } + bcopy(&fontStyle, &mbPtr->fontStyle, sizeof(fontStyle)); + } + } } if (mbPtr->params.isBevel) { - /* Initialiase the image/button parameters */ - SetupBevelButton(mbPtr, mbPtr->control, destPort, - gc, pixmap); + /* + * Initialiase the image/button parameters. + */ + + SetupBevelButton(mbPtr, mbPtr->control, destPort, gc, pixmap); } if (butPtr->flags & SELECTED) { - SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 1); + SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 1); } else if (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED) { - SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 2); + SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 2); } else { - SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 0); + SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 0); } if (!Tk_MacOSXIsAppInFront() || butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) { @@ -1027,6 +988,7 @@ TkMacOSXDrawControl( * Use NoPart for normal and to ensure correct direct transition from * disabled to active -state. [Bug 706446] */ + HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlNoPart); if (butPtr->state == STATE_ACTIVE) { @@ -1034,15 +996,15 @@ TkMacOSXDrawControl( HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlButtonPart); } else { switch (butPtr->type) { - case TYPE_BUTTON: - HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlButtonPart); - break; - case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: - HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlRadioButtonPart); - break; - case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: - HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlCheckBoxPart); - break; + case TYPE_BUTTON: + HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlButtonPart); + break; + case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: + HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlRadioButtonPart); + break; + case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: + HiliteControl(mbPtr->control, kControlCheckBoxPart); + break; } } } @@ -1050,30 +1012,30 @@ TkMacOSXDrawControl( UpdateControlColors(mbPtr); if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { - Boolean isDefault; - - if (butPtr->defaultState == STATE_ACTIVE) { - isDefault = true; - } else { - isDefault = false; - } - if ((err=SetControlData(mbPtr->control, kControlNoPart, - kControlPushButtonDefaultTag, - sizeof(isDefault), (Ptr) &isDefault)) != noErr) { - } + Boolean isDefault; + + if (butPtr->defaultState == STATE_ACTIVE) { + isDefault = true; + } else { + isDefault = false; + } + if (SetControlData(mbPtr->control, kControlNoPart, + kControlPushButtonDefaultTag, + sizeof(isDefault), (Ptr) &isDefault) != noErr) { + } } if (mbPtr->flags&2) { - ShowControl(mbPtr->userPane); - ShowControl(mbPtr->control); - mbPtr->flags ^= 2; + ShowControl(mbPtr->userPane); + ShowControl(mbPtr->control); + mbPtr->flags ^= 2; } else { - SetControlVisibility(mbPtr->control, true, true); - Draw1Control(mbPtr->userPane); + SetControlVisibility(mbPtr->control, true, true); + Draw1Control(mbPtr->userPane); } if (mbPtr->params.isBevel) { - KillPicture(mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture); + KillPicture(mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture); } } @@ -1082,150 +1044,131 @@ TkMacOSXDrawControl( * * SetupBevelButton -- * - * Sets up the Bevel Button with image by copying the - * source image onto the PicHandle for the button. + * Sets up the Bevel Button with image by copying the source image onto + * the PicHandle for the button. * * Results: - * None + * None * * Side effects: - * The image or bitmap for the button is copied over to a picture. + * The image or bitmap for the button is copied over to a picture. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void SetupBevelButton( - MacButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ - ControlRef controlHandle, /* The control to set this picture to */ - GWorldPtr destPort, /* Off screen GWorld. */ - GC gc, /* The GC we are drawing into - needed for - * the bevel button */ - Pixmap pixmap /* The pixmap we are drawing into - needed - for the bevel button */ - ) + MacButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ + ControlRef controlHandle, /* The control to set this picture to */ + GWorldPtr destPort, /* Off screen GWorld. */ + GC gc, /* The GC we are drawing into - needed for the + * bevel button */ + Pixmap pixmap) /* The pixmap we are drawing into - needed for + * the bevel button */ { - int err; - TkButton *butPtr = ( TkButton *)mbPtr; - int height, width; + int err, height, width; + TkButton *butPtr = (TkButton *) mbPtr; ControlButtonGraphicAlignment theAlignment; - + SetPort(destPort); if (butPtr->image != None) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, - &width, &height); + Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); } else { - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, - &width, &height); + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); } - + if ((butPtr->width > 0) && (butPtr->width < width)) { - width = butPtr->width; + width = butPtr->width; } if ((butPtr->height > 0) && (butPtr->height < height)) { - height = butPtr->height; + height = butPtr->height; } mbPtr->picParams.srcRect.right = width; mbPtr->picParams.srcRect.bottom = height; - /* - * Set the flag to circumvent clipping and bounds problems with OS 10.0.4 + /* + * Set the flag to circumvent clipping and bounds problems with OS 10.0.4 */ - - if (!(mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture - = OpenCPicture(&mbPtr->picParams)) ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"OpenCPicture failed\n"); -#endif + + mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture = OpenCPicture(&mbPtr->picParams); + if (!mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture) { + LOG_MSG("OpenCPicture failed"); } tkPictureIsOpen = 1; - + /* - * TO DO - There is one case where XCopyPlane calls CopyDeepMask, - * which does not get recorded in the picture. So the bitmap code - * will fail in that case. + * TO DO - There is one case where XCopyPlane calls CopyDeepMask, which + * does not get recorded in the picture. So the bitmap code will fail in + * that case. */ - + if ((butPtr->selectImage != NULL) && (butPtr->flags & SELECTED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0, 0, width, height, - pixmap, 0, 0); - } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) && (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0, 0, width, height, - pixmap, 0, 0); + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0,0, width, height, pixmap, 0,0); + } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage!=NULL) && (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0,0, width,height, pixmap, 0,0); } else if (butPtr->image != NULL) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, - height, pixmap, 0, 0); - } else { - XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, gc, 0, 0); - XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, gc, 0, 0, - (unsigned int) width, (unsigned int) height, 0, 0, 1); + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, 0, 0); + } else { + XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, gc, 0, 0); + XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, gc, 0, 0, + (unsigned int) width, (unsigned int) height, 0, 0, 1); } - + ClosePicture(); tkPictureIsOpen = 0; - - if ((err = SetControlData(controlHandle, kControlButtonPart, - kControlBevelButtonContentTag, - sizeof(ControlButtonContentInfo), - (char *) &mbPtr->bevelButtonContent)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, - "SetControlData BevelButtonContent failed, %d\n", err ); -#endif - } - + + err = SetControlData(controlHandle, kControlButtonPart, + kControlBevelButtonContentTag, + sizeof(ControlButtonContentInfo), + (char *) &mbPtr->bevelButtonContent); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlData_BevelButtonContent); + if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_N) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTop; - } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_NE) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopRight; - } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_E) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignRight; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTop; + } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_NE) { + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopRight; + } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_E) { + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignRight; } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_SE) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomRight; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomRight; } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_S) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottom; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottom; } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_SW) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomLeft; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomLeft; } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_W) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignLeft; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignLeft; } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_NW) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopLeft; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopLeft; } else if (butPtr->anchor == TK_ANCHOR_CENTER) { - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignCenter; + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignCenter; } - if ((err = SetControlData(controlHandle, kControlButtonPart, - kControlBevelButtonGraphicAlignTag, - sizeof(ControlButtonGraphicAlignment), - (char *) &theAlignment)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, - "SetControlData BevelButtonGraphicAlign failed, %d\n", err ); -#endif - } + err = SetControlData(controlHandle, kControlButtonPart, + kControlBevelButtonGraphicAlignTag, + sizeof(ControlButtonGraphicAlignment), + (char *) &theAlignment); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlData_BevelButtonGraphicAlign); if (butPtr->compound != COMPOUND_NONE) { - ControlButtonTextPlacement thePlacement = \ - kControlBevelButtonPlaceNormally; - if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_TOP) { - thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceBelowGraphic; - } else if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_BOTTOM) { - thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceAboveGraphic; - } else if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_LEFT) { - thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceToRightOfGraphic; - } else if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_RIGHT) { - thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceToLeftOfGraphic; - } - if ((err = SetControlData(controlHandle, kControlButtonPart, - kControlBevelButtonTextPlaceTag, - sizeof(ControlButtonTextPlacement), - (char *) &thePlacement)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, - "SetControlData BevelButtonTextPlace failed, %d\n", err ); -#endif - } + ControlButtonTextPlacement thePlacement = + kControlBevelButtonPlaceNormally; + + if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_TOP) { + thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceBelowGraphic; + } else if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_BOTTOM) { + thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceAboveGraphic; + } else if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_LEFT) { + thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceToRightOfGraphic; + } else if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_RIGHT) { + thePlacement = kControlBevelButtonPlaceToLeftOfGraphic; + } + err = SetControlData(controlHandle, kControlButtonPart, + kControlBevelButtonTextPlaceTag, + sizeof(ControlButtonTextPlacement), + (char *) &thePlacement); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlData_BevelButtonTextPlace); } } @@ -1234,28 +1177,30 @@ SetupBevelButton( * * SetUserPaneDrawProc -- * - * Utility function to add a UserPaneDrawProc - * to a userPane control. From MoreControls code - * from Apple DTS. + * Utility function to add a UserPaneDrawProc to a userPane control. From + * MoreControls code from Apple DTS. * * Results: - * MacOS system error. + * MacOS system error. * * Side effects: - * The user pane gets a new UserPaneDrawProc. + * The user pane gets a new UserPaneDrawProc. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ -OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc ( + +OSErr +SetUserPaneDrawProc( ControlRef control, ControlUserPaneDrawProcPtr upp) { ControlUserPaneDrawUPP myControlUserPaneDrawUPP; - myControlUserPaneDrawUPP = NewControlUserPaneDrawUPP(upp); - return SetControlData (control, - kControlNoPart, kControlUserPaneDrawProcTag, - sizeof(myControlUserPaneDrawUPP), - (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneDrawUPP); + + myControlUserPaneDrawUPP = NewControlUserPaneDrawUPP(upp); + return SetControlData(control, kControlNoPart, + kControlUserPaneDrawProcTag, + sizeof(myControlUserPaneDrawUPP), + (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneDrawUPP); } /* @@ -1263,28 +1208,29 @@ OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc ( * * SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc -- * - * Utility function to add a UserPaneBackgroundProc - * to a userPane control + * Utility function to add a UserPaneBackgroundProc to a userPane control * * Results: - * MacOS system error. + * MacOS system error. * * Side effects: - * The user pane gets a new UserPaneBackgroundProc. + * The user pane gets a new UserPaneBackgroundProc. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ + OSErr SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc( - ControlRef control, + ControlRef control, ControlUserPaneBackgroundProcPtr upp) { ControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP; + myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP = NewControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP(upp); - return SetControlData (control, kControlNoPart, - kControlUserPaneBackgroundProcTag, - sizeof(myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP), - (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP); + return SetControlData(control, kControlNoPart, + kControlUserPaneBackgroundProcTag, + sizeof(myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP), + (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP); } /* @@ -1292,28 +1238,29 @@ SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc( * * UserPaneDraw -- * - * This function draws the background of the user pane that will - * lie under checkboxes and radiobuttons. + * This function draws the background of the user pane that will lie + * under checkboxes and radiobuttons. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The user pane gets updated to the current color. + * The user pane gets updated to the current color. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void UserPaneDraw( ControlRef control, ControlPartCode cpc) { + MacButton *mbPtr = (MacButton *) GetControlReference(control); Rect contrlRect; - MacButton * mbPtr; - mbPtr = ( MacButton *)GetControlReference(control); + GetControlBounds(control,&contrlRect); - RGBBackColor (&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); - EraseRect (&contrlRect); + RGBBackColor(&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); + EraseRect(&contrlRect); } /* @@ -1321,14 +1268,14 @@ UserPaneDraw( * * UserPaneBackgroundProc -- * - * This function sets up the background of the user pane that will - * lie under checkboxes and radiobuttons. + * This function sets up the background of the user pane that will lie + * under checkboxes and radiobuttons. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The user pane background gets set to the current color. + * The user pane background gets set to the current color. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1338,10 +1285,10 @@ UserPaneBackgroundProc( ControlHandle control, ControlBackgroundPtr info) { - MacButton * mbPtr; - mbPtr = ( MacButton *)GetControlReference(control); + MacButton *mbPtr = (MacButton *) GetControlReference(control); + if (info->colorDevice) { - RGBBackColor (&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); + RGBBackColor(&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); } } @@ -1350,82 +1297,83 @@ UserPaneBackgroundProc( * * UpdateControlColors -- * - * This function will review the colors used to display - * a Macintosh button. If any non-standard colors are - * used we create a custom palette for the button, populate - * with the colors for the button and install the palette. + * This function will review the colors used to display a Macintosh + * button. If any non-standard colors are used we create a custom palette + * for the button, populate with the colors for the button and install + * the palette. * - * Under Appearance, we just set the pointer that will be - * used by the UserPaneDrawProc. + * Under Appearance, we just set the pointer that will be used by the + * UserPaneDrawProc. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The Macintosh control may get a custom palette installed. + * The Macintosh control may get a custom palette installed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int -UpdateControlColors(MacButton * mbPtr) +UpdateControlColors( + MacButton *mbPtr) { XColor *xcolor; - TkButton * butPtr = ( TkButton * )mbPtr; - + TkButton *butPtr = (TkButton *) mbPtr; + /* - * Under Appearance we cannot change the background of the - * button itself. However, the color we are setting is the color - * of the containing userPane. This will be the color that peeks - * around the rounded corners of the button. - * We make this the highlightbackground rather than the background, - * because if you color the background of a frame containing a - * button, you usually also color the highlightbackground as well, - * or you will get a thin grey ring around the button. + * Under Appearance we cannot change the background of the button itself. + * However, the color we are setting is the color of the containing + * userPane. This will be the color that peeks around the rounded corners + * of the button. We make this the highlightbackground rather than the + * background, because if you color the background of a frame containing a + * button, you usually also color the highlightbackground as well, or you + * will get a thin grey ring around the button. */ - + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { - xcolor = Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->highlightBorder); + xcolor = Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->highlightBorder); } else { - xcolor = Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->normalBorder); + xcolor = Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->normalBorder); } TkSetMacColor(xcolor->pixel, &mbPtr->userPaneBackground); - + return false; -} +} + /* *-------------------------------------------------------------- * * ButtonEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by the Tk dispatcher for various - * events on buttons. + * This procedure is invoked by the Tk dispatcher for various events on + * buttons. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * When it gets exposed, it is redisplayed. + * When it gets exposed, it is redisplayed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void ButtonEventProc( - ClientData clientData, /* Information about window. */ - XEvent *eventPtr) /* Information about event. */ + ClientData clientData, /* Information about window. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* Information about event. */ { TkButton *buttonPtr = (TkButton *) clientData; + if (eventPtr->type == ActivateNotify - || eventPtr->type == DeactivateNotify) { - if ((buttonPtr->tkwin == NULL) - || (!Tk_IsMapped(buttonPtr->tkwin))) { - return; - } - if ((buttonPtr->flags & REDRAW_PENDING) == 0) { - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(TkpDisplayButton, (ClientData) buttonPtr); - buttonPtr->flags |= REDRAW_PENDING; - } + || eventPtr->type == DeactivateNotify) { + if ((buttonPtr->tkwin == NULL) || (!Tk_IsMapped(buttonPtr->tkwin))) { + return; + } + if ((buttonPtr->flags & REDRAW_PENDING) == 0) { + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(TkpDisplayButton, (ClientData) buttonPtr); + buttonPtr->flags |= REDRAW_PENDING; + } } } @@ -1434,216 +1382,221 @@ ButtonEventProc( * * TkMacOSXComputeControlParams -- * - * This procedure computes the various parameters used - * when creating a Carbon control (NewControl) - * These are determined by the various tk button parameters + * This procedure computes the various parameters used when creating a + * Carbon control (NewControl). These are determined by the various Tk + * button parameters * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Sets the control initialisation parameters + * Sets the control initialisation parameters * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -TkMacOSXComputeControlParams(TkButton * butPtr, MacControlParams * paramsPtr ) +TkMacOSXComputeControlParams( + TkButton *butPtr, + MacControlParams *paramsPtr) { paramsPtr->isBevel = 0; - - /* - * Determine ProcID based on button type and dimensions + + /* + * Determine ProcID based on button type and dimensions. */ - + switch (butPtr->type) { - case TYPE_BUTTON: - if ((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 1; - paramsPtr->minValue = 0; - paramsPtr->maxValue = 1; - paramsPtr->procID = kControlPushButtonProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; - paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorOffsetContents - | kControlContentPictHandle; - paramsPtr->maxValue = 1; - if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; - } else if (butPtr->borderWidth == 3) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; - } - paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; - } - break; - case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: - if (((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) - || (butPtr->indicatorOn)) { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 1; - paramsPtr->minValue = 0; - paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; - paramsPtr->procID = kControlRadioButtonProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; - paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorOffsetContents| - kControlBehaviorSticky| - kControlContentPictHandle; - paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; - if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; - } else if (butPtr->borderWidth == 3) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; - } - paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; - } - break; - case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: - if (((butPtr->image == None) - && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) - || (butPtr->indicatorOn)) { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 1; - paramsPtr->minValue = 0; - paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; - paramsPtr->procID = kControlCheckBoxProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; - paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorOffsetContents - | kControlBehaviorSticky - | kControlContentPictHandle; - paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; - if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; - } else if (butPtr->borderWidth == 3) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; - } - paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; - } - break; + case TYPE_BUTTON: + if ((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 1; + paramsPtr->minValue = 0; + paramsPtr->maxValue = 1; + paramsPtr->procID = kControlPushButtonProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; + paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorOffsetContents + | kControlContentPictHandle; + paramsPtr->maxValue = 1; + if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; + } else if (butPtr->borderWidth == 3) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; + } + paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; + } + break; + case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: + if (((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) + || (butPtr->indicatorOn)) { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 1; + paramsPtr->minValue = 0; + paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; + paramsPtr->procID = kControlRadioButtonProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; + paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorOffsetContents | + kControlBehaviorSticky | kControlContentPictHandle; + paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; + if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; + } else if (butPtr->borderWidth == 3) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; + } + paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; + } + break; + case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: + if (((butPtr->image == None) && (butPtr->bitmap == None)) + || (butPtr->indicatorOn)) { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 1; + paramsPtr->minValue = 0; + paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; + paramsPtr->procID = kControlCheckBoxProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; + paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorOffsetContents | + kControlBehaviorSticky | kControlContentPictHandle; + paramsPtr->maxValue = 2; + if (butPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; + } else if (butPtr->borderWidth == 3) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; + } + paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; + } + break; } -} +} + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams -- * - * This procedure computes the various parameters used - * when drawing a button - * These are determined by the various tk button parameters + * This procedure computes the various parameters used when drawing a + * button. These are determined by the various Tk button parameters. * * Results: - * 1 if control will be used, 0 otherwise. + * 1 if control will be used, 0 otherwise. * * Side effects: - * Sets the button draw parameters + * Sets the button draw parameters * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int -TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams(TkButton * butPtr, DrawParams * dpPtr) +TkMacOSXComputeDrawParams( + TkButton *butPtr, + DrawParams *dpPtr) { - dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap = ((butPtr->image != NULL) - || (butPtr->bitmap != None)); - dpPtr->offset = (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) - && dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap; + dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap = ((butPtr->image != NULL) + || (butPtr->bitmap != None)); + dpPtr->offset = (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) + && dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap; dpPtr->border = butPtr->normalBorder; - if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) - && (butPtr->disabledFg != NULL)) { - dpPtr->gc = butPtr->disabledGC; - } else if ((butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) - && (butPtr->state == STATE_ACTIVE)) { - dpPtr->gc = butPtr->activeTextGC; - dpPtr->border = butPtr->activeBorder; + if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) && (butPtr->disabledFg != NULL)) { + dpPtr->gc = butPtr->disabledGC; + } else if ((butPtr->type==TYPE_BUTTON) && (butPtr->state==STATE_ACTIVE)) { + dpPtr->gc = butPtr->activeTextGC; + dpPtr->border = butPtr->activeBorder; } else { - dpPtr->gc = butPtr->normalTextGC; + dpPtr->gc = butPtr->normalTextGC; } - if ((butPtr->flags & SELECTED) - && (butPtr->state != STATE_ACTIVE) - && (butPtr->selectBorder != NULL) - && !butPtr->indicatorOn) { - dpPtr->border = butPtr->selectBorder; + if ((butPtr->flags & SELECTED) && (butPtr->state != STATE_ACTIVE) + && (butPtr->selectBorder != NULL) && !butPtr->indicatorOn) { + dpPtr->border = butPtr->selectBorder; } - + /* - * Override the relief specified for the button if this is a - * checkbutton or radiobutton and there's no indicator. - * However, don't do this in the presence of Appearance, since - * then the bevel button will take care of the relief. + * Override the relief specified for the button if this is a checkbutton + * or radiobutton and there's no indicator. However, don't do this in the + * presence of Appearance, since then the bevel button will take care of + * the relief. */ dpPtr->relief = butPtr->relief; if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && !butPtr->indicatorOn) { - if (!dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap) { - dpPtr->relief = (butPtr->flags & SELECTED) ? TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN - : TK_RELIEF_RAISED; - } + if (!dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap) { + dpPtr->relief = (butPtr->flags & SELECTED) ? TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN + : TK_RELIEF_RAISED; + } } /* * Determine the draw type */ + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_LABEL) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_LABEL; + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_LABEL; } else if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON) { - if (!dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CONTROL; - } else if (butPtr->image != None) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; - } else { - /* - * TO DO - The current way the we draw bitmaps (XCopyPlane) - * uses CopyDeepMask in this one case. The Picture recording - * does not record this call, and so we can't use the - * Appearance bevel button here. The only case that would - * exercise this is if you use a bitmap, with - * -data & -mask specified. We should probably draw the - * appearance button and overprint the image in this case. - * This just punts and draws the old-style, ugly, button. - */ - - if (dpPtr->gc->clip_mask == 0) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; - } else { - TkpClipMask *clipPtr = (TkpClipMask*) dpPtr->gc->clip_mask; - if ((clipPtr->type == TKP_CLIP_PIXMAP) && - (clipPtr->value.pixmap != butPtr->bitmap)) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CUSTOM; - } else { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; - } - } - } + if (!dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CONTROL; + } else if (butPtr->image != None) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; + } else { + /* + * TO DO - The current way the we draw bitmaps (XCopyPlane) uses + * CopyDeepMask in this one case. The Picture recording does not + * record this call, and so we can't use the Appearance bevel + * button here. The only case that would exercise this is if you + * use a bitmap, with -data & -mask specified. We should probably + * draw the appearance button and overprint the image in this + * case. This just punts and draws the old-style, ugly, button. + */ + + if (dpPtr->gc->clip_mask == 0) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; + } else { + TkpClipMask *clipPtr = (TkpClipMask *) dpPtr->gc->clip_mask; + + if ((clipPtr->type == TKP_CLIP_PIXMAP) && + (clipPtr->value.pixmap != butPtr->bitmap)) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CUSTOM; + } else { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; + } + } + } + } else if (butPtr->indicatorOn) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CONTROL; + } else if (dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap) { + if (dpPtr->gc->clip_mask == 0) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; + } else { + TkpClipMask *clipPtr = (TkpClipMask*) dpPtr->gc->clip_mask; + + if ((clipPtr->type == TKP_CLIP_PIXMAP) && + (clipPtr->value.pixmap != butPtr->bitmap)) { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CUSTOM; + } else { + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; + } + } } else { - if (butPtr->indicatorOn) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CONTROL; - } else if (dpPtr->hasImageOrBitmap) { - if (dpPtr->gc->clip_mask == 0) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; - } else { - TkpClipMask *clipPtr = (TkpClipMask*) dpPtr->gc->clip_mask; - if ((clipPtr->type == TKP_CLIP_PIXMAP) && - (clipPtr->value.pixmap != butPtr->bitmap)) { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CUSTOM; - } else { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_BEVEL; - } - } - } else { - dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CUSTOM; - } + dpPtr->drawType = DRAW_CUSTOM; } if ((dpPtr->drawType == DRAW_CONTROL) || (dpPtr->drawType == DRAW_BEVEL)) { - return 1; + return 1; } else { - return 0; + return 0; } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c index d9eba35..81706ba 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c @@ -1,14 +1,13 @@ /* * tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c -- * - * This file implements functions that register for and handle - * various Carbon Events and Timers. Most carbon events of interest - * to TkAqua are processed in a handler registered on the dispatcher - * event target so that we get first crack at them before HIToolbox - * dispatchers/processes them further. - * As some events are sent directly to the focus or app event target - * and not dispatched normally, we also register a handler on the - * application event target. + * This file implements functions that register for and handle various + * Carbon Events and Timers. Most carbon events of interest to TkAqua are + * processed in a handler registered on the dispatcher event target so + * that we get first crack at them before HIToolbox dispatchers/processes + * them further. As some events are sent directly to the focus or app + * event target and not dispatched normally, we also register a handler + * on the application event target. * * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2005 Daniel A. Steffen @@ -16,51 +15,45 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * The following terms apply to all files originating from Apple - * Computer, Inc. ("Apple") and associated with the software - * unless explicitly disclaimed in individual files. - * - * - * Apple hereby grants permission to use, copy, modify, - * distribute, and license this software and its documentation - * for any purpose, provided that existing copyright notices are - * retained in all copies and that this notice is included - * verbatim in any distributions. No written agreement, license, - * or royalty fee is required for any of the authorized - * uses. Modifications to this software may be copyrighted by - * their authors and need not follow the licensing terms - * described here, provided that the new terms are clearly - * indicated on the first page of each file where they apply. - * - * - * IN NO EVENT SHALL APPLE, THE AUTHORS OR DISTRIBUTORS OF THE - * SOFTWARE BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY FOR DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, - * INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF - * THIS SOFTWARE, ITS DOCUMENTATION, OR ANY DERIVATIVES THEREOF, - * EVEN IF APPLE OR THE AUTHORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE - * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. APPLE, THE AUTHORS AND - * DISTRIBUTORS SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, - * BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, - * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. THIS - * SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, AND APPLE,THE - * AUTHORS AND DISTRIBUTORS HAVE NO OBLIGATION TO PROVIDE - * MAINTENANCE, SUPPORT, UPDATES, ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS. - * - * GOVERNMENT USE: If you are acquiring this software on behalf - * of the U.S. government, the Government shall have only - * "Restricted Rights" in the software and related documentation - * as defined in the Federal Acquisition Regulations (FARs) in - * Clause 52.227.19 (c) (2). If you are acquiring the software - * on behalf of the Department of Defense, the software shall be - * classified as "Commercial Computer Software" and the - * Government shall have only "Restricted Rights" as defined in - * Clause 252.227-7013 (c) (1) of DFARs. Notwithstanding the - * foregoing, the authors grant the U.S. Government and others - * acting in its behalf permission to use and distribute the - * software in accordance with the terms specified in this - * license. - * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c,v 1.13 2006/10/31 22:33:34 das Exp $ + * The following terms apply to all files originating from Apple + * Computer, Inc. ("Apple") and associated with the software unless + * explicitly disclaimed in individual files. + * + * Apple hereby grants permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and + * license this software and its documentation for any purpose, provided + * that existing copyright notices are retained in all copies and that + * this notice is included verbatim in any distributions. No written + * agreement, license, or royalty fee is required for any of the + * authorized uses. Modifications to this software may be copyrighted by + * their authors and need not follow the licensing terms described here, + * provided that the new terms are clearly indicated on the first page of + * each file where they apply. + * + * IN NO EVENT SHALL APPLE, THE AUTHORS OR DISTRIBUTORS OF THE SOFTWARE + * BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY FOR DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR + * CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, ITS + * DOCUMENTATION, OR ANY DERIVATIVES THEREOF, EVEN IF APPLE OR THE + * AUTHORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. APPLE, + * THE AUTHORS AND DISTRIBUTORS SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES, + * INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF + * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND + * NON-INFRINGEMENT. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, AND + * APPLE,THE AUTHORS AND DISTRIBUTORS HAVE NO OBLIGATION TO PROVIDE + * MAINTENANCE, SUPPORT, UPDATES, ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS. + * + * GOVERNMENT USE: If you are acquiring this software on behalf of the + * U.S. government, the Government shall have only "Restricted Rights" in + * the software and related documentation as defined in the Federal + * Acquisition Regulations (FARs) in Clause 52.227.19 (c) (2). If you are + * acquiring the software on behalf of the Department of Defense, the + * software shall be classified as "Commercial Computer Software" and the + * Government shall have only "Restricted Rights" as defined in Clause + * 252.227-7013 (c) (1) of DFARs. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the + * authors grant the U.S. Government and others acting in its behalf + * permission to use and distribute the software in accordance with the + * terms specified in this license. + * + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXCarbonEvents.c,v 1.14 2007/04/13 14:51:17 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -73,44 +66,51 @@ #endif */ -/* Declarations of functions used only in this file */ -static OSStatus CarbonEventHandlerProc(EventHandlerCallRef callRef, - EventRef event, void *userData); -static OSStatus InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler(); -static void ExitRaelEventHandlerProc (EventHandlerCallRef, EventRef, void*) - __attribute__ ((__noreturn__)); -static void CarbonTimerProc(EventLoopTimerRef timer, void *userData); +/* + * Declarations of functions used only in this file: + */ + +static OSStatus CarbonEventHandlerProc(EventHandlerCallRef callRef, + EventRef event, void *userData); +static OSStatus InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler(void); +static void ExitRaelEventHandlerProc(EventHandlerCallRef, + EventRef, void *) __attribute__ ((__noreturn__)); +static void CarbonTimerProc(EventLoopTimerRef timer, + void *userData); + +/* + * Static data used by several functions in this file: + */ -/* Static data used by several functions in this file */ static jmp_buf exitRaelJmpBuf; static EventLoopTimerRef carbonTimer = NULL; static int carbonTimerEnabled = 0; - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * CarbonEventHandlerProc -- * - * This procedure is the handler for all registered CarbonEvents. + * This procedure is the handler for all registered CarbonEvents. * * Results: - * OS status code. + * OS status code. * * Side effects: - * Dispatches CarbonEvents. + * Dispatches CarbonEvents. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static OSStatus -CarbonEventHandlerProc ( - EventHandlerCallRef callRef, - EventRef event, - void *userData) +CarbonEventHandlerProc( + EventHandlerCallRef callRef, + EventRef event, + void *userData) { - OSStatus result = eventNotHandledErr; - TkMacOSXEvent macEvent; - MacEventStatus eventStatus; + OSStatus result = eventNotHandledErr; + TkMacOSXEvent macEvent; + MacEventStatus eventStatus; macEvent.eventRef = event; macEvent.eClass = GetEventClass(macEvent.eventRef); @@ -123,11 +123,14 @@ CarbonEventHandlerProc ( if (macEvent.eKind != kEventMouseMoved && macEvent.eKind != kEventMouseDragged) { TkMacOSXCarbonEventToAscii(event, buf); - fprintf(stderr, "CarbonEventHandlerProc started handling %s\n", buf); + LOG_MSG("CarbonEventHandlerProc started handling %s", buf); TkMacOSXInitNamedDebugSymbol(HIToolbox, void, _DebugPrintEvent, EventRef inEvent); if (_DebugPrintEvent) { - /* Carbon-internal event debugging (c.f. Technote 2124) */ + /* + * Carbon-internal event debugging (c.f. Technote 2124) + */ + _DebugPrintEvent(event); } } @@ -141,8 +144,7 @@ CarbonEventHandlerProc ( #if defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG) && defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG_CARBON_EVENTS) if (macEvent.eKind != kEventMouseMoved && macEvent.eKind != kEventMouseDragged) { - fprintf(stderr, - "CarbonEventHandlerProc finished handling %s: %s handled\n", + LOG_MSG("CarbonEventHandlerProc finished handling %s: %s handled", buf, eventStatus.stopProcessing ? " " : "not"); } #endif /* TK_MAC_DEBUG_CARBON_EVENTS */ @@ -154,81 +156,71 @@ CarbonEventHandlerProc ( * * TkMacOSXInitCarbonEvents -- * - * This procedure initializes all CarbonEvent handlers. + * This procedure initializes all CarbonEvent handlers. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Handlers for Carbon Events are registered. + * Handlers for Carbon Events are registered. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE void -TkMacOSXInitCarbonEvents ( - Tcl_Interp *interp) +TkMacOSXInitCarbonEvents( + Tcl_Interp *interp) { OSStatus err; const EventTypeSpec dispatcherEventTypes[] = { - {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseDown}, - {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseUp}, - {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseMoved}, - {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseDragged}, - {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseWheelMoved}, - {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowUpdate}, - {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowActivated}, - {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowDeactivated}, - {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyDown}, - {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyRepeat}, - {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyUp}, - {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyModifiersChanged}, - {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyRepeat}, - {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppActivated}, - {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppDeactivated}, - {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppQuit}, + {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseDown}, + {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseUp}, + {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseMoved}, + {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseDragged}, + {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseWheelMoved}, + {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowUpdate}, + {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowActivated}, + {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowDeactivated}, + {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyDown}, + {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyRepeat}, + {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyUp}, + {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyModifiersChanged}, + {kEventClassKeyboard, kEventRawKeyRepeat}, + {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppActivated}, + {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppDeactivated}, + {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppQuit}, }; const EventTypeSpec applicationEventTypes[] = { - {kEventClassMenu, kEventMenuBeginTracking}, - {kEventClassMenu, kEventMenuEndTracking}, - {kEventClassCommand, kEventCommandProcess}, - {kEventClassCommand, kEventCommandUpdateStatus}, - {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseWheelMoved}, - {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowExpanded}, - {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppHidden}, - {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppShown}, - {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppAvailableWindowBoundsChanged}, + {kEventClassMenu, kEventMenuBeginTracking}, + {kEventClassMenu, kEventMenuEndTracking}, + {kEventClassCommand, kEventCommandProcess}, + {kEventClassCommand, kEventCommandUpdateStatus}, + {kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseWheelMoved}, + {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowExpanded}, + {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppHidden}, + {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppShown}, + {kEventClassApplication, kEventAppAvailableWindowBoundsChanged}, }; EventHandlerUPP handler = NewEventHandlerUPP(CarbonEventHandlerProc); err = InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler(); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler failed, %d\n", - (int) err); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler); err = InstallEventHandler(GetEventDispatcherTarget(), handler, GetEventTypeCount(dispatcherEventTypes), dispatcherEventTypes, (void *) interp, NULL); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "InstallEventHandler failed, %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(InstallEventHandler); err = InstallEventHandler(GetApplicationEventTarget(), handler, GetEventTypeCount(applicationEventTypes), applicationEventTypes, (void *) interp, NULL); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "InstallEventHandler failed, %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(InstallEventHandler); #if defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG) && defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG_CARBON_EVENTS) TkMacOSXInitNamedDebugSymbol(HIToolbox, void, TraceEventByName, char*); if (TraceEventByName) { - /* Carbon-internal event debugging (c.f. Technote 2124) */ + /* + * Carbon-internal event debugging (c.f. Technote 2124) + */ + TraceEventByName("kEventMouseDown"); TraceEventByName("kEventMouseUp"); TraceEventByName("kEventMouseWheelMoved"); @@ -261,34 +253,38 @@ TkMacOSXInitCarbonEvents ( * * InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler -- * - * This procedure installs the carbon standard application event - * handler. + * This procedure installs the carbon standard application event handler. * * Results: - * OS status code. + * OS status code. * * Side effects: - * Standard handlers for application Carbon Events are registered. + * Standard handlers for application Carbon Events are registered. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static OSStatus -InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler() +InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler(void) { - /* - * This is a hack to workaround missing Carbon API to install the standard - * application event handler (InstallStandardEventHandler() does not work - * on the application target). The only way to install the standard app - * handler is to call RunApplicationEventLoop(), but since we are running - * our own event loop, we'll immediately need to break out of RAEL again: - * we do this via longjmp out of the ExitRaelEventHandlerProc event handler - * called first off from RAEL by posting a high priority dummy event. - * This workaround is derived from a similar approach in Technical Q&A 1061. - */ - enum { kExitRaelEvent = 'ExiT' }; - const EventTypeSpec exitRaelEventType = - { kExitRaelEvent, kExitRaelEvent}; + /* + * This is a hack to workaround missing Carbon API to install the standard + * application event handler (InstallStandardEventHandler() does not work + * on the application target). The only way to install the standard app + * handler is to call RunApplicationEventLoop(), but since we are running + * our own event loop, we'll immediately need to break out of RAEL again: + * we do this via longjmp out of the ExitRaelEventHandlerProc event + * handler called first off from RAEL by posting a high priority dummy + * event. This workaround is derived from a similar approach in Technical + * Q&A 1061. + */ + + enum { + kExitRaelEvent = 'ExiT' + }; + const EventTypeSpec exitRaelEventType = { + kExitRaelEvent, kExitRaelEvent + }; EventHandlerUPP exitRaelEventHandler; EventHandlerRef exitRaelEventHandlerRef = NULL; EventRef exitRaelEvent = NULL; @@ -302,7 +298,7 @@ InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler() &exitRaelEventHandlerRef); } if (err == noErr) { - err = CreateEvent(NULL, kExitRaelEvent, kExitRaelEvent, + err = CreateEvent(NULL, kExitRaelEvent, kExitRaelEvent, GetCurrentEventTime(), kEventAttributeNone, &exitRaelEvent); } if (err == noErr) { @@ -312,7 +308,11 @@ InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler() if (err == noErr) { if (!setjmp(exitRaelJmpBuf)) { RunApplicationEventLoop(); - /* This point should never be reached ! */ + + /* + * This point should never be reached! + */ + Tcl_Panic("RunApplicationEventLoop exited !"); } } @@ -333,23 +333,24 @@ InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler() * * ExitRaelEventHandlerProc -- * - * This procedure is the dummy event handler used to break out of - * RAEL via longjmp, it is called as the first ever event handler - * in RAEL by posting a high priority dummy event. + * This procedure is the dummy event handler used to break out of RAEL + * via longjmp(), it is called as the first ever event handler in RAEL by + * posting a high priority dummy event. * * Results: - * None. Never returns ! + * None. Never returns! * * Side effects: - * longjmp back to InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler(). + * longjmp()s back to InstallStandardApplicationEventHandler(). * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -ExitRaelEventHandlerProc ( - EventHandlerCallRef callRef, - EventRef event, void *userData) +ExitRaelEventHandlerProc( + EventHandlerCallRef callRef, + EventRef event, + void *userData) { longjmp(exitRaelJmpBuf, 1); } @@ -359,33 +360,36 @@ ExitRaelEventHandlerProc ( * * CarbonTimerProc -- * - * This procedure is the carbon timer handler that runs the tcl - * event loop periodically. It does not process TCL_WINDOW_EVENTS - * to avoid reentry issues with Carbon, nor TCL_IDLE_EVENTS since - * it is only intended to be called during short periods of busy - * time such as during menu tracking. + * This procedure is the carbon timer handler that runs the tcl event + * loop periodically. It does not process TCL_WINDOW_EVENTS to avoid + * reentry issues with Carbon, nor TCL_IDLE_EVENTS since it is only + * intended to be called during short periods of busy time such as during + * menu tracking. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Runs the Tcl event loop. + * Runs the Tcl event loop. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -CarbonTimerProc ( - EventLoopTimerRef timer, - void *userData) +CarbonTimerProc( + EventLoopTimerRef timer, + void *userData) { - if(carbonTimerEnabled) { - /* Avoid starving main event loop: process at most 4 events. */ + if (carbonTimerEnabled) { + /* + * Avoid starving main event loop: process at most 4 events. + */ + int i = 4; - while(--i && Tcl_DoOneEvent( + while (--i && Tcl_DoOneEvent( TCL_FILE_EVENTS|TCL_TIMER_EVENTS|TCL_DONT_WAIT)) { -#if defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG) && defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG_CARBON_EVENTS) - fprintf(stderr, "Processed tcl event from carbon timer\n"); +#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_CARBON_EVENTS + LOG_MSG("Processed tcl event from carbon timer"); #endif /* TK_MAC_DEBUG_CARBON_EVENTS */ } } @@ -396,80 +400,75 @@ CarbonTimerProc ( * * TkMacOSXStartTclEventLoopCarbonTimer -- * - * This procedure installs (if necessary) and starts a carbon - * event timer that runs the tcl event loop periodically. - * It should be called whenever a nested carbon event loop is - * run by HIToolbox (e.g. during menutracking) to ensure that - * non-window non-idle tcl events are processed. + * This procedure installs (if necessary) and starts a carbon event timer + * that runs the tcl event loop periodically. It should be called + * whenever a nested carbon event loop is run by HIToolbox (e.g. during + * menutracking) to ensure that non-window non-idle tcl events are + * processed. * * Results: - * OS status code. + * OS status code. * * Side effects: - * Carbon event timer is installed and started. + * Carbon event timer is installed and started. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE OSStatus -TkMacOSXStartTclEventLoopCarbonTimer() +TkMacOSXStartTclEventLoopCarbonTimer(void) { OSStatus err; - if(!carbonTimer) { + if (!carbonTimer) { EventLoopTimerUPP timerUPP = NewEventLoopTimerUPP(CarbonTimerProc); + err = InstallEventLoopTimer(GetMainEventLoop(), kEventDurationNoWait, 5 * kEventDurationMillisecond, timerUPP, NULL, &carbonTimer); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "InstallEventLoopTimer failed, %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(InstallEventLoopTimer); } else { err = SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime(carbonTimer, kEventDurationNoWait); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime failed, %d\n", - (int) err); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime); } carbonTimerEnabled = 1; return err; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXStopTclEventLoopCarbonTimer -- * - * This procedure stops the carbon event timer started by - * TkMacOSXStartTclEventLoopCarbonTimer(). + * This procedure stops the carbon event timer started by + * TkMacOSXStartTclEventLoopCarbonTimer(). * * Results: - * OS status code. + * OS status code. * * Side effects: - * Carbon event timer is stopped. + * Carbon event timer is stopped. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE OSStatus -TkMacOSXStopTclEventLoopCarbonTimer() +TkMacOSXStopTclEventLoopCarbonTimer(void) { OSStatus err = noErr; - if(carbonTimer) { - err = SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime(carbonTimer, kEventDurationForever); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime failed, %d\n", - (int) err); -#endif - } + if (carbonTimer) { + err = SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime(carbonTimer, + kEventDurationForever); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetEventLoopTimerNextFireTime); } carbonTimerEnabled = 0; return err; } +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXClipboard.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXClipboard.c index 03f700c..b4008c6 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXClipboard.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXClipboard.c @@ -1,15 +1,15 @@ /* * tkMacOSXClipboard.c -- * - * This file manages the clipboard for the Tk toolkit. + * This file manages the clipboard for the Tk toolkit. * * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXClipboard.c,v 1.7 2007/01/19 00:36:45 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXClipboard.c,v 1.8 2007/04/13 14:51:17 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -21,59 +21,58 @@ * * TkSelGetSelection -- * - * Retrieve the specified selection from another process. For - * now, only fetching XA_STRING from CLIPBOARD is supported. - * Eventually other types should be allowed. - * + * Retrieve the specified selection from another process. For now, only + * fetching XA_STRING from CLIPBOARD is supported. Eventually other types + * should be allowed. + * * Results: - * The return value is a standard Tcl return value. - * If an error occurs (such as no selection exists) - * then an error message is left in the interp's result. + * The return value is a standard Tcl return value. If an error occurs + * (such as no selection exists) then an error message is left in the + * interp's result. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int TkSelGetSelection( - Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interpreter to use for reporting - * errors. */ - Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window on whose behalf to retrieve - * the selection (determines display - * from which to retrieve). */ - Atom selection, /* Selection to retrieve. */ - Atom target, /* Desired form in which selection - * is to be returned. */ - Tk_GetSelProc *proc, /* Procedure to call to process the - * selection, once it has been retrieved. */ - ClientData clientData) /* Arbitrary value to pass to proc. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interpreter to use for reporting errors. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window on whose behalf to retrieve the + * selection (determines display from which to + * retrieve). */ + Atom selection, /* Selection to retrieve. */ + Atom target, /* Desired form in which selection is to be + * returned. */ + Tk_GetSelProc *proc, /* Procedure to call to process the selection, + * once it has been retrieved. */ + ClientData clientData) /* Arbitrary value to pass to proc. */ { - int result; - int err; + int result, err; long length; ScrapRef scrapRef; - char * buf; + char *buf; if ((selection == Tk_InternAtom(tkwin, "CLIPBOARD")) - && (target == XA_STRING)) { - /* - * Get the scrap from the Macintosh global clipboard. - */ - - err = GetCurrentScrap(&scrapRef); - if (err != noErr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), - " GetCurrentScrap failed.", (char *) NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } + && (target == XA_STRING)) { + /* + * Get the scrap from the Macintosh global clipboard. + */ + + err = GetCurrentScrap(&scrapRef); + if (err != noErr) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), + " GetCurrentScrap failed.", NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; + } /* * Try UNICODE first */ - err = GetScrapFlavorSize(scrapRef, kScrapFlavorTypeUnicode, &length); - if (err == noErr && length > 0) { + + err = GetScrapFlavorSize(scrapRef, kScrapFlavorTypeUnicode, &length); + if (err == noErr && length > 0) { Tcl_DString ds; char *data; @@ -98,49 +97,49 @@ TkSelGetSelection( } } - err = GetScrapFlavorSize(scrapRef, 'TEXT', &length); - if (err != noErr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), - " GetScrapFlavorSize failed.", (char *) NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (length > 0) { - Tcl_DString encodedText; - char *data; - - buf = (char *) ckalloc(length + 1); + err = GetScrapFlavorSize(scrapRef, 'TEXT', &length); + if (err != noErr) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), + " GetScrapFlavorSize failed.", NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; + } + if (length > 0) { + Tcl_DString encodedText; + char *data; + + buf = (char *) ckalloc(length + 1); buf[length] = 0; err = GetScrapFlavorData(scrapRef, 'TEXT', &length, buf); - if (err != noErr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), - " GetScrapFlavorData failed.", (char *) NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - /* - * Tcl expects '\n' not '\r' as the line break character. - */ - - for (data = buf; *data != '\0'; data++) { - if (*data == '\r') { - *data = '\n'; - } - } - - Tcl_ExternalToUtfDString(TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding, buf, length, - &encodedText); - result = (*proc)(clientData, interp, - Tcl_DStringValue(&encodedText)); - Tcl_DStringFree(&encodedText); - - ckfree(buf); - return result; - } + if (err != noErr) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), + " GetScrapFlavorData failed.", (char *) NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; + } + + /* + * Tcl expects '\n' not '\r' as the line break character. + */ + + for (data = buf; *data != '\0'; data++) { + if (*data == '\r') { + *data = '\n'; + } + } + + Tcl_ExternalToUtfDString(TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding, buf, length, + &encodedText); + result = (*proc)(clientData, interp, + Tcl_DStringValue(&encodedText)); + Tcl_DStringFree(&encodedText); + + ckfree(buf); + return result; + } } - + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), - " selection doesn't exist or form \"", Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, target), - "\" not defined", (char *) NULL); + " selection doesn't exist or form \"", + Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, target), "\" not defined", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -149,48 +148,46 @@ TkSelGetSelection( * * TkSetSelectionOwner -- * - * This function claims ownership of the specified selection. - * If the selection is CLIPBOARD, then we empty the system - * clipboard. + * This function claims ownership of the specified selection. If the + * selection is CLIPBOARD, then we empty the system clipboard. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XSetSelectionOwner( - Display* display, /* X Display. */ - Atom selection, /* What selection to own. */ - Window owner, /* Window to be the owner. */ - Time time) /* The current time? */ + Display *display, /* X Display. */ + Atom selection, /* What selection to own. */ + Window owner, /* Window to be the owner. */ + Time time) /* The current time? */ { Tk_Window tkwin; TkDisplay *dispPtr; /* - * This is a gross hack because the Tk_InternAtom interface is broken. - * It expects a Tk_Window, even though it only needs a Tk_Display. + * This is a gross hack because the Tk_InternAtom interface is broken. It + * expects a Tk_Window, even though it only needs a Tk_Display. */ tkwin = (Tk_Window) TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr; if (selection == Tk_InternAtom(tkwin, "CLIPBOARD")) { + /* + * Only claim and empty the clipboard if we aren't already the owner + * of the clipboard. + */ - /* - * Only claim and empty the clipboard if we aren't already the - * owner of the clipboard. - */ - - dispPtr = TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr->dispPtr; - if (dispPtr->clipboardActive) { - return; - } - ClearCurrentScrap(); + dispPtr = TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr->dispPtr; + if (dispPtr->clipboardActive) { + return; + } + ClearCurrentScrap(); } } @@ -199,23 +196,23 @@ XSetSelectionOwner( * * TkSelUpdateClipboard -- * - * This function is called to force the clipboard to be updated - * after new data is added. On the Mac we don't need to do - * anything. + * This function is called to force the clipboard to be updated after new + * data is added. On the Mac we don't need to do anything. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkSelUpdateClipboard( - TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window associated with clipboard. */ - TkClipboardTarget *targetPtr) /* Info about the content. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window associated with clipboard. */ + TkClipboardTarget *targetPtr) + /* Info about the content. */ { } @@ -224,28 +221,25 @@ TkSelUpdateClipboard( * * TkSelEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked whenever a selection-related - * event occurs. + * This procedure is invoked whenever a selection-related event occurs. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Lots: depends on the type of event. + * Lots: depends on the type of event. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkSelEventProc( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window for which event was - * targeted. */ - register XEvent *eventPtr) /* X event: either SelectionClear, - * SelectionRequest, or - * SelectionNotify. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window for which event was targeted. */ + register XEvent *eventPtr) /* X event: either SelectionClear, + * SelectionRequest, or SelectionNotify. */ { if (eventPtr->type == SelectionClear) { - TkSelClearSelection(tkwin, eventPtr); + TkSelClearSelection(tkwin, eventPtr); } } @@ -254,22 +248,21 @@ TkSelEventProc( * * TkSelPropProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked when property-change events - * occur on windows not known to the toolkit. This is a stub - * function under Windows. + * This procedure is invoked when property-change events occur on windows + * not known to the toolkit. This is a stub function under Windows. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkSelPropProc( - register XEvent *eventPtr) /* X PropertyChange event. */ + register XEvent *eventPtr) /* X PropertyChange event. */ { } @@ -278,20 +271,20 @@ TkSelPropProc( * * TkSuspendClipboard -- * - * Handle clipboard conversion as required by the suppend event. - * This function is also called on exit. + * Handle clipboard conversion as required by the suppend event. This + * function is also called on exit. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The local scrap is moved to the global scrap. + * The local scrap is moved to the global scrap. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkSuspendClipboard() +TkSuspendClipboard(void) { TkClipboardTarget *targetPtr; TkClipboardBuffer *cbPtr; @@ -302,50 +295,50 @@ TkSuspendClipboard() dispPtr = TkGetDisplayList(); if ((dispPtr == NULL) || !dispPtr->clipboardActive) { - return; + return; } for (targetPtr = dispPtr->clipTargetPtr; targetPtr != NULL; - targetPtr = targetPtr->nextPtr) { - if (targetPtr->type == XA_STRING) - break; + targetPtr = targetPtr->nextPtr) { + if (targetPtr->type == XA_STRING) { + break; + } } if (targetPtr != NULL) { - Tcl_DString encodedText; - Tcl_DString unicodedText; - - length = 0; - for (cbPtr = targetPtr->firstBufferPtr; cbPtr != NULL; - cbPtr = cbPtr->nextPtr) { - length += cbPtr->length; - } - - buffer = ckalloc(length); - buffPtr = buffer; - for (cbPtr = targetPtr->firstBufferPtr; cbPtr != NULL; - cbPtr = cbPtr->nextPtr) { - for (p = cbPtr->buffer, endPtr = p + cbPtr->length; - p < endPtr; p++) { - if (*p == '\n') { - *buffPtr++ = '\r'; - } else { - *buffPtr++ = *p; - } - } - } - - ClearCurrentScrap(); - GetCurrentScrap(&scrapRef); - Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding, buffer, - length, &encodedText); - PutScrapFlavor(scrapRef, 'TEXT', 0, - Tcl_DStringLength(&encodedText), - Tcl_DStringValue(&encodedText) ); - Tcl_DStringFree(&encodedText); + Tcl_DString encodedText, unicodedText; + + length = 0; + for (cbPtr = targetPtr->firstBufferPtr; cbPtr != NULL; + cbPtr = cbPtr->nextPtr) { + length += cbPtr->length; + } + + buffer = ckalloc(length); + buffPtr = buffer; + for (cbPtr = targetPtr->firstBufferPtr; cbPtr != NULL; + cbPtr = cbPtr->nextPtr) { + for (p = cbPtr->buffer, endPtr = p + cbPtr->length; + p < endPtr; p++) { + if (*p == '\n') { + *buffPtr++ = '\r'; + } else { + *buffPtr++ = *p; + } + } + } + + ClearCurrentScrap(); + GetCurrentScrap(&scrapRef); + Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding, buffer, length, + &encodedText); + PutScrapFlavor(scrapRef, 'TEXT', 0, Tcl_DStringLength(&encodedText), + Tcl_DStringValue(&encodedText)); + Tcl_DStringFree(&encodedText); /* - * Also put unicode data on scrap + * Also put unicode data on scrap. */ + Tcl_DStringInit(&unicodedText); Tcl_UtfToUniCharDString(buffer, length, &unicodedText); PutScrapFlavor(scrapRef, kScrapFlavorTypeUnicode, 0, @@ -353,20 +346,26 @@ TkSuspendClipboard() Tcl_DStringValue(&unicodedText)); Tcl_DStringFree(&unicodedText); - ckfree(buffer); + ckfree(buffer); } /* - * The system now owns the scrap. We tell Tk that it has - * lost the selection so that it will look for it the next time - * it needs it. (Window list NULL if quiting.) + * The system now owns the scrap. We tell Tk that it has lost the + * selection so that it will look for it the next time it needs it. + * (Window list NULL if quiting.) */ if (TkGetMainInfoList() != NULL) { - Tk_ClearSelection((Tk_Window) TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr, - Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr, - "CLIPBOARD")); + Tk_ClearSelection((Tk_Window) TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr, + Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr, + "CLIPBOARD")); } - - return; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXCursor.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXCursor.c index 5b3cfa4..175af6a 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXCursor.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXCursor.c @@ -9,7 +9,7 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXCursor.c,v 1.8 2006/07/20 06:24:16 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXCursor.c,v 1.9 2007/04/13 14:51:17 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -358,7 +358,7 @@ TkMacOSXInstallCursor( CCrsrHandle ccursor; CursHandle cursor; static unsigned int cursorStep = 0; - + gResizeOverride = resizeOverride; if (resizeOverride) { @@ -366,9 +366,7 @@ TkMacOSXInstallCursor( if (cursor) { SetCursor(*cursor); } else { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Resize cursor failed, %d\n", ResError()); -#endif + LOG_MSG("Resize cursor failed, %d", ResError()); } } else if (macCursorPtr == NULL) { SetThemeCursor(kThemeArrowCursor); diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXDialog.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXDialog.c index 8d0b7c5..4b41cb5 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXDialog.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXDialog.c @@ -6,10 +6,10 @@ * Copyright (c) 1996-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXDialog.c,v 1.21 2006/12/01 07:13:00 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXDialog.c,v 1.22 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -25,6 +25,7 @@ /* * The following are ID's for resources that are defined in tkMacOSXResource.r */ + #define OPEN_BOX 130 #define OPEN_POPUP 131 #define OPEN_MENU 132 @@ -43,46 +44,45 @@ * The following structure is used in the GetFileName() function. It stored * information about the file dialog and the file filters. */ + typedef struct _OpenFileData { FileFilterList fl; /* List of file filters. */ SInt16 curType; /* The filetype currently being listed. */ short popupItem; /* Item number of the popup in the dialog. */ - int usePopup; /* True if we show the popup menu (this is - * an open operation and the -filetypes - * option is set). */ + int usePopup; /* True if we show the popup menu (this is an + * open operation and the -filetypes option is + * set). */ } OpenFileData; - /* - * The following structure is used in the tk_messageBox - * implementation. + * The following structure is used in the tk_messageBox implementation. */ + typedef struct { - WindowRef windowRef; - int buttonIndex; + WindowRef windowRef; + int buttonIndex; } CallbackUserData; - static OSStatus AlertHandler(EventHandlerCallRef callRef, EventRef eventRef, void *userData); -static Boolean MatchOneType(StringPtr fileNamePtr, OSType fileType, +static Boolean MatchOneType(StringPtr fileNamePtr, OSType fileType, OpenFileData *myofdPtr, FileFilter *filterPtr); -static pascal Boolean OpenFileFilterProc(AEDesc* theItem, void* info, +static pascal Boolean OpenFileFilterProc(AEDesc* theItem, void* info, NavCallBackUserData callBackUD, NavFilterModes filterMode); -static pascal void OpenEventProc(NavEventCallbackMessage callBackSelector, +static pascal void OpenEventProc(NavEventCallbackMessage callBackSelector, NavCBRecPtr callBackParms, NavCallBackUserData callBackUD); -static void InitFileDialogs(); -static int NavServicesGetFile(Tcl_Interp *interp, OpenFileData *ofd, - AEDesc *initialDescPtr, +static void InitFileDialogs(void); +static int NavServicesGetFile(Tcl_Interp *interp, + OpenFileData *ofd, AEDesc *initialDescPtr, char *initialFile, AEDescList *selectDescPtr, - CFStringRef title, CFStringRef message, int multiple, int isOpen); -static int HandleInitialDirectory (Tcl_Interp *interp, - char *initialFile, char *initialDir, - FSRef *dirRef, - AEDescList *selectDescPtr, - AEDesc *dirDescPtr); + CFStringRef title, CFStringRef message, + int multiple, int isOpen); +static int HandleInitialDirectory(Tcl_Interp *interp, + char *initialFile, char *initialDir, + FSRef *dirRef, AEDescList *selectDescPtr, + AEDesc *dirDescPtr); /* * Have we initialized the file dialog subsystem @@ -97,16 +97,14 @@ static int fileDlgInited = 0; static NavObjectFilterUPP openFileFilterUPP; static NavEventUPP openFileEventUPP; - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * Tk_ChooseColorObjCmd -- * - * This procedure implements the color dialog box for the Mac - * platform. See the user documentation for details on what it - * does. + * This procedure implements the color dialog box for the Mac platform. + * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -119,10 +117,10 @@ static NavEventUPP openFileEventUPP; int Tk_ChooseColorObjCmd( - ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ + ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { Tk_Window parent; char *title; @@ -131,17 +129,17 @@ Tk_ChooseColorObjCmd( static int inited = 0; static RGBColor in; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { - "-initialcolor", "-parent", "-title", NULL + "-initialcolor", "-parent", "-title", NULL }; enum options { - COLOR_INITIAL, COLOR_PARENT, COLOR_TITLE + COLOR_INITIAL, COLOR_PARENT, COLOR_TITLE }; if (inited == 0) { - /* - * 'in' stores the last color picked. The next time the color dialog - * pops up, the last color will remain in the dialog. - */ + /* + * 'in' stores the last color picked. The next time the color dialog + * pops up, the last color will remain in the dialog. + */ in.red = 0xffff; in.green = 0xffff; @@ -154,46 +152,44 @@ Tk_ChooseColorObjCmd( picked = 0; for (i = 1; i < objc; i += 2) { - int index; - char *option, *value; + int index; + char *option, *value; if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[i], optionStrings, "option", TCL_EXACT, &index) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } if (i + 1 == objc) { - option = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i], NULL); + option = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "value for \"", option, "\" missing", - (char *) NULL); + NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } value = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], NULL); switch ((enum options) index) { - case COLOR_INITIAL: { - XColor *colorPtr; + case COLOR_INITIAL: { + XColor *colorPtr; - colorPtr = Tk_GetColor(interp, parent, value); - if (colorPtr == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - in.red = colorPtr->red; - in.green = colorPtr->green; - in.blue = colorPtr->blue; - Tk_FreeColor(colorPtr); - break; + colorPtr = Tk_GetColor(interp, parent, value); + if (colorPtr == NULL) { + return TCL_ERROR; } - case COLOR_PARENT: { - parent = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, value, parent); - if (parent == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - } - case COLOR_TITLE: { - title = value; - break; + in.red = colorPtr->red; + in.green = colorPtr->green; + in.blue = colorPtr->blue; + Tk_FreeColor(colorPtr); + break; + } + case COLOR_PARENT: + parent = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, value, parent); + if (parent == NULL) { + return TCL_ERROR; } + break; + case COLOR_TITLE: + title = value; + break; } } @@ -213,13 +209,13 @@ Tk_ChooseColorObjCmd( /* This doesn't seem to actually set the title! */ Tcl_UtfToExternal(NULL, NULL, title, -1, 0, NULL, - StrBody(cpinfo.prompt), 255, &srcRead, &dstWrote, NULL); + StrBody(cpinfo.prompt), 255, &srcRead, &dstWrote, NULL); StrLength(cpinfo.prompt) = (unsigned char) dstWrote; if ((PickColor(&cpinfo) == noErr) && (cpinfo.newColorChosen != 0)) { - in.red = cpinfo.theColor.color.rgb.red; - in.green = cpinfo.theColor.color.rgb.green; - in.blue = cpinfo.theColor.color.rgb.blue; + in.red = cpinfo.theColor.color.rgb.red; + in.green = cpinfo.theColor.color.rgb.green; + in.blue = cpinfo.theColor.color.rgb.blue; picked = 1; } @@ -239,24 +235,24 @@ Tk_ChooseColorObjCmd( * * Tk_GetOpenFileObjCmd -- * - * This procedure implements the "open file" dialog box for the - * Mac platform. See the user documentation for details on what - * it does. + * This procedure implements the "open file" dialog box for the Mac + * platform. See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl result. + * A standard Tcl result. * * Side effects: - * See user documentation. + * See user documentation. + * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int Tk_GetOpenFileObjCmd( - ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ + ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { int i, result, multiple; OpenFileData ofd; @@ -268,16 +264,12 @@ Tk_GetOpenFileObjCmd( AEDescList selectDesc = {typeNull, NULL}; char *initialFile = NULL, *initialDir = NULL; static CONST char *openOptionStrings[] = { - "-defaultextension", "-filetypes", - "-initialdir", "-initialfile", - "-message", "-multiple", - "-parent", "-title", NULL + "-defaultextension", "-filetypes", "-initialdir", "-initialfile", + "-message", "-multiple", "-parent", "-title", NULL }; enum openOptions { - OPEN_DEFAULT, OPEN_FILETYPES, - OPEN_INITDIR, OPEN_INITFILE, - OPEN_MESSAGE, OPEN_MULTIPLE, - OPEN_PARENT, OPEN_TITLE + OPEN_DEFAULT, OPEN_FILETYPES, OPEN_INITDIR, OPEN_INITFILE, + OPEN_MESSAGE, OPEN_MULTIPLE, OPEN_PARENT, OPEN_TITLE }; if (!fileDlgInited) { @@ -292,9 +284,9 @@ Tk_GetOpenFileObjCmd( TkInitFileFilters(&ofd.fl); - ofd.curType = 0; - ofd.popupItem = OPEN_POPUP_ITEM; - ofd.usePopup = 1; + ofd.curType = 0; + ofd.popupItem = OPEN_POPUP_ITEM; + ofd.usePopup = 1; for (i = 1; i < objc; i += 2) { char *choice; @@ -315,55 +307,57 @@ Tk_GetOpenFileObjCmd( } switch (index) { - case OPEN_DEFAULT: - break; - case OPEN_FILETYPES: - if (TkGetFileFilters(interp, &ofd.fl, objv[i + 1], 0) - != TCL_OK) { - result = TCL_ERROR; - goto end; - } - break; - case OPEN_INITDIR: - initialDir = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ - if (choiceLen == 0) { initialDir = NULL; } - break; - case OPEN_INITFILE: - initialFile = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], NULL); - /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ - if (choiceLen == 0) { initialFile = NULL; } - break; - case OPEN_MESSAGE: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - message = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, choiceLen, - kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); - break; - case OPEN_MULTIPLE: - if (Tcl_GetBooleanFromObj(interp, objv[i + 1], &multiple) - != TCL_OK) { - result = TCL_ERROR; - goto end; - } - break; - case OPEN_PARENT: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - parent = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, choice, parent); - if (parent == NULL) { - result = TCL_ERROR; - goto end; - } - break; - case OPEN_TITLE: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, choiceLen, - kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); - break; + case OPEN_DEFAULT: + break; + case OPEN_FILETYPES: + if (TkGetFileFilters(interp, &ofd.fl, objv[i + 1], 0) != TCL_OK) { + result = TCL_ERROR; + goto end; + } + break; + case OPEN_INITDIR: + initialDir = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ + if (choiceLen == 0) { + initialDir = NULL; + } + break; + case OPEN_INITFILE: + initialFile = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], NULL); + /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ + if (choiceLen == 0) { + initialFile = NULL; + } + break; + case OPEN_MESSAGE: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + message = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, + choiceLen, kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + break; + case OPEN_MULTIPLE: + if (Tcl_GetBooleanFromObj(interp, objv[i+1], &multiple)!=TCL_OK) { + result = TCL_ERROR; + goto end; + } + break; + case OPEN_PARENT: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + parent = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, choice, parent); + if (parent == NULL) { + result = TCL_ERROR; + goto end; + } + break; + case OPEN_TITLE: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, + choiceLen, kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + break; } } if (HandleInitialDirectory(interp, initialFile, initialDir, &dirRef, - &selectDesc, &initialDesc) != TCL_OK) { + &selectDesc, &initialDesc) != TCL_OK) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } @@ -374,7 +368,7 @@ Tk_GetOpenFileObjCmd( result = NavServicesGetFile(interp, &ofd, initialPtr, NULL, &selectDesc, title, message, multiple, OPEN_FILE); - end: + end: TkFreeFileFilters(&ofd.fl); AEDisposeDesc(&initialDesc); AEDisposeDesc(&selectDesc); @@ -420,12 +414,12 @@ Tk_GetSaveFileObjCmd( CFStringRef title, message; OpenFileData ofd; static CONST char *saveOptionStrings[] = { - "-defaultextension", "-filetypes", "-initialdir", "-initialfile", - "-message", "-parent", "-title", NULL + "-defaultextension", "-filetypes", "-initialdir", "-initialfile", + "-message", "-parent", "-title", NULL }; enum saveOptions { - SAVE_DEFAULT, SAVE_FILETYPES, SAVE_INITDIR, SAVE_INITFILE, - SAVE_MESSAGE, SAVE_PARENT, SAVE_TITLE + SAVE_DEFAULT, SAVE_FILETYPES, SAVE_INITDIR, SAVE_INITFILE, + SAVE_MESSAGE, SAVE_PARENT, SAVE_TITLE }; if (!fileDlgInited) { @@ -438,59 +432,59 @@ Tk_GetSaveFileObjCmd( message = NULL; for (i = 1; i < objc; i += 2) { - char *choice; + char *choice, *string; int index, choiceLen; - char *string; if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[i], saveOptionStrings, "option", TCL_EXACT, &index) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } if (i + 1 == objc) { - string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i], NULL); + string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "value for \"", string, "\" missing", - (char *) NULL); + NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } switch (index) { - case SAVE_DEFAULT: - break; - case SAVE_FILETYPES: - /* Currently unimplemented - what would we do here anyway? */ - break; - case SAVE_INITDIR: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ - if (choiceLen && - HandleInitialDirectory(interp, NULL, choice, &dirRef, - NULL, &initialDesc) != TCL_OK) { - result = TCL_ERROR; - goto end; - } - break; - case SAVE_INITFILE: - initialFile = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ - if (choiceLen == 0) { initialFile = NULL; } - break; - case SAVE_MESSAGE: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - message = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, choiceLen, - kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); - break; - case SAVE_PARENT: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - parent = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, choice, parent); - if (parent == NULL) { - result = TCL_ERROR; - goto end; - } - break; - case SAVE_TITLE: - choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, choiceLen, - kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); - break; + case SAVE_DEFAULT: + break; + case SAVE_FILETYPES: + /* Currently unimplemented - what would we do here anyway? */ + break; + case SAVE_INITDIR: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ + if (choiceLen && HandleInitialDirectory(interp, NULL, choice, + &dirRef, NULL, &initialDesc) != TCL_OK) { + result = TCL_ERROR; + goto end; + } + break; + case SAVE_INITFILE: + initialFile = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + /* empty strings should be like no selection given */ + if (choiceLen == 0) { + initialFile = NULL; + } + break; + case SAVE_MESSAGE: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + message = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, + choiceLen, kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + break; + case SAVE_PARENT: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + parent = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, choice, parent); + if (parent == NULL) { + result = TCL_ERROR; + goto end; + } + break; + case SAVE_TITLE: + choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); + title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, + choiceLen, kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + break; } } @@ -501,10 +495,9 @@ Tk_GetSaveFileObjCmd( initialPtr = &initialDesc; } result = NavServicesGetFile(interp, &ofd, initialPtr, initialFile, NULL, - title, message, false, SAVE_FILE); - - end: + title, message, false, SAVE_FILE); + end: AEDisposeDesc(&initialDesc); if (title != NULL) { CFRelease(title); @@ -521,26 +514,26 @@ Tk_GetSaveFileObjCmd( * * Tk_ChooseDirectoryObjCmd -- * - * This procedure implements the "tk_chooseDirectory" dialog box - * for the Windows platform. See the user documentation for details - * on what it does. + * This procedure implements the "tk_chooseDirectory" dialog box for the + * Windows platform. See the user documentation for details on what it + * does. * * Results: - * See user documentation. + * See user documentation. * * Side effects: - * A modal dialog window is created. Tcl_SetServiceMode() is - * called to allow background events to be processed + * A modal dialog window is created. Tcl_SetServiceMode() is called to + * allow background events to be processed * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int -Tk_ChooseDirectoryObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) - ClientData clientData; /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +Tk_ChooseDirectoryObjCmd( + ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { int i, result; Tk_Window parent; @@ -596,8 +589,8 @@ Tk_ChooseDirectoryObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) break; case CHOOSE_MESSAGE: choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - message = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, choiceLen, - kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + message = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*)choice, + choiceLen, kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); break; case CHOOSE_PARENT: choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); @@ -609,8 +602,8 @@ Tk_ChooseDirectoryObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) break; case CHOOSE_TITLE: choice = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], &choiceLen); - title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, choiceLen, - kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) choice, + choiceLen, kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); break; } } @@ -635,7 +628,7 @@ Tk_ChooseDirectoryObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) return result; } - + int HandleInitialDirectory ( Tcl_Interp *interp, @@ -702,21 +695,21 @@ HandleInitialDirectory ( AEDisposeDesc(&fileDesc); } -end: + end: if (dirName != NULL) { Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); } return result; } - + static void -InitFileDialogs() +InitFileDialogs(void) { fileDlgInited = 1; openFileFilterUPP = NewNavObjectFilterUPP(OpenFileFilterProc); openFileEventUPP = NewNavEventUPP(OpenEventProc); } - + static int NavServicesGetFile( Tcl_Interp *interp, @@ -738,13 +731,13 @@ NavServicesGetFile( int result; err = NavGetDefaultDialogCreationOptions(&diagOptions); - if (err!=noErr) { + if (err != noErr) { return TCL_ERROR; } diagOptions.location.h = -1; diagOptions.location.v = -1; diagOptions.optionFlags = kNavDontAutoTranslate - + kNavDontAddTranslateItems; + + kNavDontAddTranslateItems; if (multiple) { diagOptions.optionFlags += kNavAllowMultipleFiles; } @@ -764,8 +757,8 @@ NavServicesGetFile( int index = 0; ofdPtr->curType = 0; - menuItemNames = (CFStringRef *)ckalloc(ofdPtr->fl.numFilters - * sizeof(CFStringRef)); + menuItemNames = (CFStringRef *) + ckalloc(ofdPtr->fl.numFilters * sizeof(CFStringRef)); for (filterPtr = ofdPtr->fl.filters; filterPtr != NULL; filterPtr = filterPtr->next, index++) { @@ -780,13 +773,14 @@ NavServicesGetFile( } /* - * This is required to allow App packages to be selectable in the - * file dialogs... + * This is required to allow App packages to be selectable in the file + * dialogs... */ diagOptions.optionFlags += kNavSupportPackages; - diagOptions.clientName = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, "Wish", kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + diagOptions.clientName = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, "Wish", + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); diagOptions.message = message; diagOptions.windowTitle = title; if (initialFile) { @@ -801,42 +795,25 @@ NavServicesGetFile( diagOptions.preferenceKey = 0; /* - * Now process the selection list. We have to use the popupExtension - * to fill the menu. + * Now process the selection list. We have to use the popupExtension to + * fill the menu. */ if (isOpen == OPEN_FILE) { - err = NavCreateGetFileDialog(&diagOptions, - NULL, - openFileEventUPP, - NULL, - openFileFilterUPP, - ofdPtr, - &dialogRef); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"NavCreateGetFileDialog failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - dialogRef = NULL; - } + err = NavCreateGetFileDialog(&diagOptions, NULL, openFileEventUPP, + NULL, openFileFilterUPP, ofdPtr, &dialogRef); + LOG_ON_ERROR(NavCreateGetFileDialog); } else if (isOpen == SAVE_FILE) { err = NavCreatePutFileDialog(&diagOptions, 'TEXT', 'WIsH', openFileEventUPP, NULL, &dialogRef); - if (err!=noErr){ -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"NavCreatePutFileDialog failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - dialogRef = NULL; - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(NavCreatePutFileDialog); } else if (isOpen == CHOOSE_FOLDER) { err = NavCreateChooseFolderDialog(&diagOptions, openFileEventUPP, openFileFilterUPP, NULL, &dialogRef); - if (err!=noErr){ -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"NavCreateChooseFolderDialog failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - dialogRef = NULL; - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(NavCreateChooseFolderDialog); + } + if (err != noErr) { + dialogRef = NULL; } if (dialogRef) { @@ -848,16 +825,11 @@ NavServicesGetFile( NavCustomControl(dialogRef, kNavCtlSetSelection, selectDescPtr); } - if ((err = NavDialogRun(dialogRef)) != noErr){ -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"NavDialogRun failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - } else { - if ((err = NavDialogGetReply(dialogRef, &theReply)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"NavGetReply failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - } + err = NavDialogRun(dialogRef); + LOG_ON_ERROR(NavDialogRun); + if (err == noErr) { + err = NavDialogGetReply(dialogRef, &theReply); + LOG_ON_ERROR(NavDialogGetReply); } } @@ -878,68 +850,57 @@ NavServicesGetFile( if (theReply.validRecord && err == noErr) { AEDesc resultDesc; long count; - FSRef fsRef; - char pathPtr[1024]; - int pathValid = 0; + FSRef fsRef; + char pathPtr[1024]; + int pathValid = 0; + err = AECountItems(&theReply.selection, &count); if (err == noErr) { long i; + for (i = 1; i <= count; i++) { - err = AEGetNthDesc(&theReply.selection, - i, typeFSRef, NULL, &resultDesc); + err = AEGetNthDesc(&theReply.selection, i, typeFSRef, NULL, + &resultDesc); pathValid = 0; + if (err != noErr) { + continue; + } + err = AEGetDescData(&resultDesc, &fsRef, sizeof(fsRef)); + LOG_ON_ERROR(AEGetDescData); if (err == noErr) { - if ((err = AEGetDescData(&resultDesc, &fsRef, sizeof(fsRef))) - != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"AEGetDescData failed %d\n", err); -#endif - } else { - if ((err = FSRefMakePath(&fsRef, (unsigned char*) pathPtr, 1024))) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"FSRefMakePath failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - } else { - if (isOpen == SAVE_FILE) { - CFStringRef saveNameRef; - char saveName [1024]; - if ((saveNameRef = NavDialogGetSaveFileName(dialogRef))) { - if (CFStringGetCString(saveNameRef, saveName, - 1024, kCFStringEncodingUTF8)) { - if (strlen(pathPtr) + strlen(saveName) < 1023) { - strcat(pathPtr, "/"); - strcat(pathPtr, saveName); - pathValid = 1; - } else { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "Path name too long\n"); -#endif - } - } else { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "CFStringGetCString failed\n"); -#endif - } - } else { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "NavDialogGetSaveFileName failed\n"); -#endif - } + err = FSRefMakePath(&fsRef, (unsigned char*) pathPtr, + 1024); + LOG_ON_ERROR(FSRefMakePath); + if (err == noErr) { + if (isOpen == SAVE_FILE) { + CFStringRef saveNameRef; + char saveName[1024]; + + saveNameRef = NavDialogGetSaveFileName(dialogRef); + if (!saveNameRef) { + LOG_MSG("NavDialogGetSaveFileName failed"); + } else if (!CFStringGetCString(saveNameRef, + saveName, 1024, kCFStringEncodingUTF8)) { + LOG_MSG("CFStringGetCString failed"); + } else if (strlen(pathPtr)+strlen(saveName)<1023){ + strcat(pathPtr, "/"); + strcat(pathPtr, saveName); + goto pathValid; } else { - pathValid = 1; - } - if (pathValid) { - if (multiple) { - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, theResult, - Tcl_NewStringObj(pathPtr, -1)); - } else { - Tcl_SetStringObj(theResult, pathPtr, -1); - } + LOG_MSG("Path name too long"); } } + } else { + pathValid: + if (multiple) { + Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, theResult, + Tcl_NewStringObj(pathPtr, -1)); + } else { + Tcl_SetStringObj(theResult, pathPtr, -1); + } } - AEDisposeDesc(&resultDesc); } + AEDisposeDesc(&resultDesc); } } err = NavDisposeReply(&theReply); @@ -968,12 +929,14 @@ NavServicesGetFile( if (diagOptions.clientName) { CFRelease(diagOptions.clientName); } + /* * dispose of the CFArray diagOptions.popupExtension */ if (menuItemNames) { int i; + for (i = 0;i < ofdPtr->fl.numFilters; i++) { CFRelease(menuItemNames[i]); } @@ -985,10 +948,11 @@ NavServicesGetFile( return result; } - + static pascal Boolean OpenFileFilterProc( - AEDesc* theItem, void* info, + AEDesc *theItem, + void *info, NavCallBackUserData callBackUD, NavFilterModes filterMode) { @@ -996,94 +960,86 @@ OpenFileFilterProc( if (!ofdPtr || !ofdPtr->usePopup) { return true; - } else { - if (ofdPtr->fl.numFilters == 0) { - return true; - } else { - if ((theItem->descriptorType == typeFSS) - || (theItem->descriptorType = typeFSRef)) { - NavFileOrFolderInfo* theInfo = (NavFileOrFolderInfo *) info; - char fileName[256]; - int result; - - if (!theInfo->isFolder) { - OSType fileType; - StringPtr fileNamePtr; - Tcl_DString fileNameDString; - int i; - FileFilter *filterPtr; - - fileType = - theInfo->fileAndFolder.fileInfo.finderInfo.fdType; - Tcl_DStringInit (&fileNameDString); - - if (theItem->descriptorType == typeFSS) { - int len; - fileNamePtr = (((FSSpec *) *theItem->dataHandle)->name); - len = fileNamePtr[0]; - strncpy(fileName, (char*) fileNamePtr + 1, len); - fileName[len] = '\0'; - fileNamePtr = (unsigned char*) fileName; - - } else if ((theItem->descriptorType = typeFSRef)) { - OSStatus err; - FSRef *theRef = (FSRef *) *theItem->dataHandle; - HFSUniStr255 uniFileName; - err = FSGetCatalogInfo (theRef, kFSCatInfoNone, NULL, - &uniFileName, NULL, NULL); - - if (err == noErr) { - Tcl_UniCharToUtfDString ( - (Tcl_UniChar *) uniFileName.unicode, - uniFileName.length, - &fileNameDString); - fileNamePtr = (unsigned char*) Tcl_DStringValue(&fileNameDString); - } else { - fileNamePtr = NULL; - } - } - if (ofdPtr->usePopup) { - i = ofdPtr->curType; - for (filterPtr = ofdPtr->fl.filters; - filterPtr && i > 0; i--) { - filterPtr = filterPtr->next; - } - if (filterPtr) { - result = MatchOneType(fileNamePtr, fileType, - ofdPtr, filterPtr); - } else { - result = false; - } - } else { - /* - * We are not using the popup menu. In this case, the - * file is considered matched if it matches any of - * the file filters. - */ - - result = UNMATCHED; - for (filterPtr = ofdPtr->fl.filters; filterPtr; - filterPtr = filterPtr->next) { - if (MatchOneType(fileNamePtr, fileType, - ofdPtr, filterPtr) == MATCHED) { - result = MATCHED; - break; - } - } - } + } + + if (ofdPtr->fl.numFilters == 0) { + return true; + } + + if ((theItem->descriptorType == typeFSS) + || (theItem->descriptorType = typeFSRef)) { + NavFileOrFolderInfo* theInfo = (NavFileOrFolderInfo *) info; + char fileName[256]; + int result, i, len; + OSType fileType; + StringPtr fileNamePtr; + Tcl_DString fileNameDString; + FileFilter *filterPtr; - Tcl_DStringFree (&fileNameDString); - return (result == MATCHED); + if (!theInfo->isFolder) { + fileType = theInfo->fileAndFolder.fileInfo.finderInfo.fdType; + Tcl_DStringInit(&fileNameDString); + + if (theItem->descriptorType == typeFSS) { + fileNamePtr = (((FSSpec *) *theItem->dataHandle)->name); + len = fileNamePtr[0]; + strncpy(fileName, (char*) fileNamePtr + 1, len); + fileName[len] = '\0'; + fileNamePtr = (unsigned char*) fileName; + } else if ((theItem->descriptorType = typeFSRef)) { + OSStatus err; + FSRef *theRef = (FSRef *) *theItem->dataHandle; + HFSUniStr255 uniFileName; + + err = FSGetCatalogInfo(theRef, kFSCatInfoNone, NULL, + &uniFileName, NULL, NULL); + + if (err == noErr) { + Tcl_UniCharToUtfDString( + (Tcl_UniChar *) uniFileName.unicode, + uniFileName.length, &fileNameDString); + fileNamePtr = (unsigned char *) + Tcl_DStringValue(&fileNameDString); } else { - return true; + fileNamePtr = NULL; } } - } + if (ofdPtr->usePopup) { + i = ofdPtr->curType; + for (filterPtr=ofdPtr->fl.filters ; filterPtr && i>0 ; i--) { + filterPtr = filterPtr->next; + } + if (filterPtr) { + result = MatchOneType(fileNamePtr, fileType, ofdPtr, + filterPtr); + } else { + result = UNMATCHED; + } + } else { + /* + * We are not using the popup menu. In this case, the file is + * considered matched if it matches any of the file filters. + */ - return true; + result = UNMATCHED; + for (filterPtr = ofdPtr->fl.filters; filterPtr; + filterPtr = filterPtr->next) { + if (MatchOneType(fileNamePtr, fileType, + ofdPtr, filterPtr) == MATCHED) { + result = MATCHED; + break; + } + } + } + + Tcl_DStringFree(&fileNameDString); + return (result == MATCHED); + } } -} + return true; +} + pascal void OpenEventProc( NavEventCallbackMessage callBackSelector, @@ -1097,12 +1053,12 @@ OpenEventProc( |kNavCBCancel|kNavCBAdjustPreview); if (callBackSelector == kNavCBPopupMenuSelect) { - chosenItem = (NavMenuItemSpec *) callBackParams->eventData.eventDataParms.param; + chosenItem = (NavMenuItemSpec *) + callBackParams->eventData.eventDataParms.param; ofd->curType = chosenItem->menuType; } else if (callBackSelector == kNavCBAdjustRect || (callBackSelector & otherEvent) != 0) { - while (Tcl_DoOneEvent(TCL_IDLE_EVENTS - | TCL_DONT_WAIT + while (Tcl_DoOneEvent(TCL_IDLE_EVENTS | TCL_DONT_WAIT | TCL_WINDOW_EVENTS)) { /* Empty Body */ } @@ -1114,51 +1070,52 @@ OpenEventProc( * * MatchOneType -- * - * Match a file with one file type in the list of file types. + * Match a file with one file type in the list of file types. * * Results: - * Returns MATCHED if the file matches with the file type; returns - * UNMATCHED otherwise. + * Returns MATCHED if the file matches with the file type; returns + * UNMATCHED otherwise. * * Side effects: - * None + * None * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static Boolean MatchOneType( - StringPtr fileNamePtr, /* Name of the file */ - OSType fileType, /* Type of the file, 0 means there was no specified type. */ - OpenFileData * ofdPtr, /* Information about this file dialog */ - FileFilter * filterPtr) /* Match the file described by pb against - * this filter */ + StringPtr fileNamePtr, /* Name of the file */ + OSType fileType, /* Type of the file, 0 means there was no + * specified type. */ + OpenFileData *ofdPtr, /* Information about this file dialog */ + FileFilter *filterPtr) /* Match the file described by pb against this + * filter */ { - FileFilterClause * clausePtr; + FileFilterClause *clausePtr; /* - * A file matches with a file type if it matches with at least one - * clause of the type. + * A file matches with a file type if it matches with at least one clause + * of the type. * - * If the clause has both glob patterns and ostypes, the file must - * match with at least one pattern AND at least one ostype. + * If the clause has both glob patterns and ostypes, the file must match + * with at least one pattern AND at least one ostype. * * If the clause has glob patterns only, the file must match with at least * one pattern. * - * If the clause has mac types only, the file must match with at least - * one mac type. + * If the clause has mac types only, the file must match with at least one + * mac type. * - * If the clause has neither glob patterns nor mac types, it's - * considered an error. + * If the clause has neither glob patterns nor mac types, it's considered + * an error. */ for (clausePtr = filterPtr->clauses; clausePtr; clausePtr = clausePtr->next) { - int macMatched = 0; + int macMatched = 0; int globMatched = 0; - GlobPattern * globPtr; - MacFileType * mfPtr; + GlobPattern *globPtr; + MacFileType *mfPtr; if (clausePtr->patterns == NULL) { globMatched = 1; @@ -1196,10 +1153,10 @@ MatchOneType( goto glob_unmatched; } - glob_unmatched: + glob_unmatched: continue; - glob_matched: + glob_matched: globMatched = 1; break; } @@ -1212,13 +1169,12 @@ MatchOneType( } /* - * On Mac OS X, it is not uncommon for files to have NO - * file type. But folks with Tcl code on Classic MacOS pretty - * much assume that a generic file will have type TEXT. So - * if we were strict about matching types when the source file - * had NO type set, they would have to add another rule always - * with no fileType. To avoid that, we pass the macMatch side - * of the test if no fileType is set. + * On Mac OS X, it is not uncommon for files to have NO file type. + * But folks with Tcl code on Classic MacOS pretty much assume that a + * generic file will have type TEXT. So if we were strict about + * matching types when the source file had NO type set, they would + * have to add another rule always with no fileType. To avoid that, we + * pass the macMatch side of the test if no fileType is set. */ if (globMatched && (macMatched || (fileType == 0))) { @@ -1228,26 +1184,26 @@ MatchOneType( return UNMATCHED; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkAboutDlg -- * - * Displays the default Tk About box. This code uses Macintosh - * resources to define the content of the About Box. + * Displays the default Tk About box. This code uses Macintosh resources + * to define the content of the About Box. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkAboutDlg() +TkAboutDlg(void) { DialogPtr aboutDlog; WindowRef windowRef; @@ -1272,95 +1228,83 @@ TkAboutDlg() return; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd -- * - * Implements the tk_messageBox in native Mac OS X style. + * Implements the tk_messageBox in native Mac OS X style. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl result. + * A standard Tcl result. * * Side effects: - * none + * none * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( - ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ + ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { - Tk_Window tkwin = (Tk_Window) clientData; + Tk_Window tkwin = (Tk_Window) clientData; AlertStdCFStringAlertParamRec paramCFStringRec; - AlertType alertType; - DialogRef dialogRef; - CFStringRef messageTextCF = NULL; - CFStringRef finemessageTextCF = NULL; - OSErr osError; - SInt16 itemHit; - Boolean haveDefaultOption = false; - Boolean haveParentOption = false; - char *str; - int index; - int defaultButtonIndex; - int defaultNativeButtonIndex; /* 1, 2, 3: right to left. */ - int typeIndex; - int i; - int indexDefaultOption = 0; - int result = TCL_OK; + AlertType alertType; + DialogRef dialogRef; + CFStringRef messageTextCF = NULL; + CFStringRef finemessageTextCF = NULL; + OSErr osError; + SInt16 itemHit; + Boolean haveDefaultOption = false, haveParentOption = false; + char *str; + int defaultButtonIndex; + int defaultNativeButtonIndex; /* 1, 2, 3: right to left. */ + int index, typeIndex, i; + int indexDefaultOption = 0; + int result = TCL_OK; static CONST char *movableAlertStrings[] = { - "-default", "-detail", "-icon", - "-message", "-parent", - "-title", "-type", - (char *)NULL + "-default", "-detail", "-icon", "-message", "-parent", "-title", + "-type", NULL }; static CONST char *movableTypeStrings[] = { - "abortretryignore", "ok", - "okcancel", "retrycancel", - "yesno", "yesnocancel", - (char *)NULL + "abortretryignore", "ok", "okcancel", "retrycancel", "yesno", + "yesnocancel", NULL }; static CONST char *movableButtonStrings[] = { - "abort", "retry", "ignore", - "ok", "cancel", "yes", "no", - (char *)NULL + "abort", "retry", "ignore", "ok", "cancel", "yes", "no", NULL }; static CONST char *movableIconStrings[] = { - "error", "info", "question", "warning", - (char *)NULL + "error", "info", "question", "warning", NULL }; enum movableAlertOptions { - ALERT_DEFAULT, ALERT_DETAIL, ALERT_ICON, - ALERT_MESSAGE, ALERT_PARENT, + ALERT_DEFAULT, ALERT_DETAIL, ALERT_ICON, ALERT_MESSAGE, ALERT_PARENT, ALERT_TITLE, ALERT_TYPE }; enum movableTypeOptions { - TYPE_ABORTRETRYIGNORE, TYPE_OK, - TYPE_OKCANCEL, TYPE_RETRYCANCEL, + TYPE_ABORTRETRYIGNORE, TYPE_OK, TYPE_OKCANCEL, TYPE_RETRYCANCEL, TYPE_YESNO, TYPE_YESNOCANCEL }; enum movableButtonOptions { - TEXT_ABORT, TEXT_RETRY, TEXT_IGNORE, - TEXT_OK, TEXT_CANCEL, TEXT_YES, TEXT_NO + TEXT_ABORT, TEXT_RETRY, TEXT_IGNORE, TEXT_OK, TEXT_CANCEL, TEXT_YES, + TEXT_NO }; enum movableIconOptions { ICON_ERROR, ICON_INFO, ICON_QUESTION, ICON_WARNING }; /* - * Need to map from 'movableButtonStrings' and its corresponding integer index, - * to the native button index, which is 1, 2, 3, from right to left. - * This is necessary to do for each separate '-type' of button sets. + * Need to map from 'movableButtonStrings' and its corresponding integer + * index, to the native button index, which is 1, 2, 3, from right to + * left. This is necessary to do for each separate '-type' of button sets. */ - short buttonIndexAndTypeToNativeButtonIndex[][7] = { + short buttonIndexAndTypeToNativeButtonIndex[][7] = { /* abort retry ignore ok cancel yes no */ {1, 2, 3, 0, 0, 0, 0}, /* abortretryignore */ {0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0}, /* ok */ @@ -1375,7 +1319,7 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( * descriptive button text string index. */ - short nativeButtonIndexAndTypeToButtonIndex[][4] = { + short nativeButtonIndexAndTypeToButtonIndex[][4] = { {-1, 0, 1, 2}, /* abortretryignore */ {-1, 3, 0, 0}, /* ok */ {-1, 3, 4, 0}, /* okcancel */ @@ -1387,76 +1331,77 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( alertType = kAlertPlainAlert; typeIndex = TYPE_OK; - GetStandardAlertDefaultParams(¶mCFStringRec, kStdCFStringAlertVersionOne); + GetStandardAlertDefaultParams(¶mCFStringRec, + kStdCFStringAlertVersionOne); paramCFStringRec.movable = true; paramCFStringRec.helpButton = false; paramCFStringRec.defaultButton = kAlertStdAlertOKButton; paramCFStringRec.cancelButton = kAlertStdAlertCancelButton; for (i = 1; i < objc; i += 2) { - int iconIndex; - char *string; + int iconIndex; + char *string; if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[i], movableAlertStrings, "option", - TCL_EXACT, &index) != TCL_OK) { + TCL_EXACT, &index) != TCL_OK) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } if (i + 1 == objc) { string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i], NULL); Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "value for \"", string, "\" missing", - (char *) NULL); + NULL); result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } switch (index) { - - case ALERT_DEFAULT: - + case ALERT_DEFAULT: /* - * Need to postpone processing of this option until we are - * sure to know the '-type' as well. + * Need to postpone processing of this option until we are sure to + * know the '-type' as well. */ haveDefaultOption = true; indexDefaultOption = i; break; - case ALERT_DETAIL: + case ALERT_DETAIL: str = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], NULL); - finemessageTextCF = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, str, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + finemessageTextCF = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, str, + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); break; - case ALERT_ICON: - /* not sure about UTF translation here... */ + case ALERT_ICON: + /* not sure about UTF translation here... */ if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[i + 1], movableIconStrings, - "value", TCL_EXACT, &iconIndex) != TCL_OK) { + "value", TCL_EXACT, &iconIndex) != TCL_OK) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } switch (iconIndex) { - case ICON_ERROR: + case ICON_ERROR: alertType = kAlertStopAlert; break; - case ICON_INFO: + case ICON_INFO: alertType = kAlertNoteAlert; break; - case ICON_QUESTION: + case ICON_QUESTION: alertType = kAlertCautionAlert; break; - case ICON_WARNING: + case ICON_WARNING: alertType = kAlertCautionAlert; break; } break; - case ALERT_MESSAGE: + case ALERT_MESSAGE: str = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], NULL); - messageTextCF = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, str, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + messageTextCF = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, str, + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); break; - case ALERT_PARENT: + case ALERT_PARENT: str = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[i + 1], NULL); tkwin = Tk_NameToWindow(interp, str, tkwin); if (tkwin == NULL) { @@ -1466,39 +1411,39 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( haveParentOption = true; break; - case ALERT_TITLE: + case ALERT_TITLE: break; - case ALERT_TYPE: - /* not sure about UTF translation here... */ + case ALERT_TYPE: + /* not sure about UTF translation here... */ if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[i + 1], movableTypeStrings, - "value", TCL_EXACT, &typeIndex) != TCL_OK) { + "value", TCL_EXACT, &typeIndex) != TCL_OK) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } switch (typeIndex) { - case TYPE_ABORTRETRYIGNORE: + case TYPE_ABORTRETRYIGNORE: paramCFStringRec.defaultText = CFSTR("Abort"); paramCFStringRec.cancelText = CFSTR("Retry"); paramCFStringRec.otherText = CFSTR("Ignore"); paramCFStringRec.cancelButton = kAlertStdAlertOtherButton; break; - case TYPE_OK: + case TYPE_OK: paramCFStringRec.defaultText = CFSTR("OK"); break; - case TYPE_OKCANCEL: + case TYPE_OKCANCEL: paramCFStringRec.defaultText = CFSTR("OK"); paramCFStringRec.cancelText = CFSTR("Cancel"); break; - case TYPE_RETRYCANCEL: + case TYPE_RETRYCANCEL: paramCFStringRec.defaultText = CFSTR("Retry"); paramCFStringRec.cancelText = CFSTR("Cancel"); break; - case TYPE_YESNO: + case TYPE_YESNO: paramCFStringRec.defaultText = CFSTR("Yes"); paramCFStringRec.cancelText = CFSTR("No"); break; - case TYPE_YESNOCANCEL: + case TYPE_YESNOCANCEL: paramCFStringRec.defaultText = CFSTR("Yes"); paramCFStringRec.cancelText = CFSTR("No"); paramCFStringRec.otherText = CFSTR("Cancel"); @@ -1512,25 +1457,27 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( if (haveDefaultOption) { /* - * Any '-default' option needs to know the '-type' option, which is why - * we do this here. + * Any '-default' option needs to know the '-type' option, which is + * why we do this here. */ str = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[indexDefaultOption + 1], NULL); if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[indexDefaultOption + 1], - movableButtonStrings, "value", TCL_EXACT, - &defaultButtonIndex) != TCL_OK) { + movableButtonStrings, "value", TCL_EXACT, + &defaultButtonIndex) != TCL_OK) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } - /* Need to map from "ok" etc. to 1, 2, 3, right to left. */ + /* + * Need to map from "ok" etc. to 1, 2, 3, right to left. + */ defaultNativeButtonIndex = buttonIndexAndTypeToNativeButtonIndex[typeIndex][defaultButtonIndex]; if (defaultNativeButtonIndex == 0) { Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, - Tcl_NewStringObj("Illegal default option", -1)); + Tcl_NewStringObj("Illegal default option", -1)); result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } @@ -1542,11 +1489,11 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( SetThemeCursor(kThemeArrowCursor); if (haveParentOption) { - TkWindow *winPtr; - WindowRef windowRef; - EventTargetRef notifyTarget; - EventHandlerUPP handler; - CallbackUserData data; + TkWindow *winPtr; + WindowRef windowRef; + EventTargetRef notifyTarget; + EventHandlerUPP handler; + CallbackUserData data; const EventTypeSpec kEvents[] = { {kEventClassCommand, kEventProcessCommand} }; @@ -1558,12 +1505,12 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( */ windowRef = GetWindowFromPort( - TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(tkwin))); + TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(tkwin))); notifyTarget = GetWindowEventTarget(windowRef); osError = CreateStandardSheet(alertType, messageTextCF, - finemessageTextCF, ¶mCFStringRec, - notifyTarget, &dialogRef); - if(osError != noErr) { + finemessageTextCF, ¶mCFStringRec, notifyTarget, + &dialogRef); + if (osError != noErr) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } @@ -1571,8 +1518,7 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( data.buttonIndex = 1; handler = NewEventHandlerUPP(AlertHandler); InstallEventHandler(notifyTarget, handler, - GetEventTypeCount(kEvents), - kEvents, &data, NULL); + GetEventTypeCount(kEvents), kEvents, &data, NULL); osError = ShowSheetWindow(GetDialogWindow(dialogRef), windowRef); if(osError != noErr) { result = TCL_ERROR; @@ -1587,8 +1533,8 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( DisposeEventHandlerUPP(handler); } else { osError = CreateStandardAlert(alertType, messageTextCF, - finemessageTextCF, ¶mCFStringRec, &dialogRef); - if(osError != noErr) { + finemessageTextCF, ¶mCFStringRec, &dialogRef); + if (osError != noErr) { result = TCL_ERROR; goto end; } @@ -1598,8 +1544,8 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( goto end; } } - if(osError == noErr) { - int ind; + if (osError == noErr) { + int ind; /* * Map 'itemHit' (1, 2, 3) to descriptive text string. @@ -1607,12 +1553,12 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( ind = nativeButtonIndexAndTypeToButtonIndex[typeIndex][itemHit]; Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, - Tcl_NewStringObj(movableButtonStrings[ind], -1)); + Tcl_NewStringObj(movableButtonStrings[ind], -1)); } else { result = TCL_ERROR; } - end: + end: if (finemessageTextCF != NULL) { CFRelease(finemessageTextCF); } @@ -1621,7 +1567,7 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( } return result; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * @@ -1639,24 +1585,27 @@ Tk_MessageBoxObjCmd( */ static OSStatus -AlertHandler(EventHandlerCallRef callRef, EventRef eventRef, void *userData) +AlertHandler( + EventHandlerCallRef callRef, + EventRef eventRef, + void *userData) { - OSStatus result = eventNotHandledErr; - HICommand cmd; - CallbackUserData *dataPtr = (CallbackUserData *) userData; + OSStatus result = eventNotHandledErr; + HICommand cmd; + CallbackUserData *dataPtr = (CallbackUserData *) userData; GetEventParameter(eventRef, kEventParamDirectObject, typeHICommand, - NULL, sizeof(cmd), NULL, &cmd); + NULL, sizeof(cmd), NULL, &cmd); switch (cmd.commandID) { - case kHICommandOK: + case kHICommandOK: dataPtr->buttonIndex = 1; result = noErr; break; - case kHICommandCancel: + case kHICommandCancel: dataPtr->buttonIndex = 2; result = noErr; break; - case kHICommandOther: + case kHICommandOther: dataPtr->buttonIndex = 3; result = noErr; break; diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXDraw.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXDraw.c index 06a52a2..f4b8600 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXDraw.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXDraw.c @@ -1,18 +1,17 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXDraw.c -- * - * This file contains functions that perform drawing to - * Xlib windows. Most of the functions simple emulate - * Xlib functions. + * This file contains functions that perform drawing to Xlib windows. + * Most of the functions simple emulate Xlib functions. * * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2006 Daniel A. Steffen * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXDraw.c,v 1.18 2006/10/16 16:25:38 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXDraw.c,v 1.19 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -24,15 +23,17 @@ #endif */ -#define RGBFLOATRED(c) ((c).red / 65535.0) +#define RGBFLOATRED(c) ((c).red / 65535.0) #define RGBFLOATGREEN(c) ((c).green / 65535.0) -#define RGBFLOATBLUE(c) ((c).blue / 65535.0) -#define radians(d) ((d) * (M_PI/180.0)) +#define RGBFLOATBLUE(c) ((c).blue / 65535.0) +#define radians(d) ((d) * (M_PI/180.0)) /* - * Non-antialiased CG drawing looks better and more like X11 drawing when using - * very fine lines, so decrease all linewidths by the following constant. + * Non-antialiased CG drawing looks better and more like X11 drawing when + * using very fine lines, so decrease all linewidths by the following + * constant. */ + #define NON_AA_CG_OFFSET .999 /* @@ -53,33 +54,35 @@ static int useThemedFrame = 0; /* * Prototypes for functions used only in this file. */ -static unsigned char InvertByte(unsigned char data); -static void TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext(MacDrawable *macWin, CGrafPtr destPort, - GC gc, CGContextRef *contextPtr); -static void TkMacOSXReleaseCGContext(MacDrawable *macWin, CGrafPtr destPort, - CGContextRef *context); + +static unsigned char InvertByte(unsigned char data); +static void TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext(MacDrawable *macWin, + CGrafPtr destPort, GC gc, + CGContextRef *contextPtr); +static void TkMacOSXReleaseCGContext(MacDrawable *macWin, + CGrafPtr destPort, CGContextRef *context); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing -- * - * Initializes link vars that control CG drawing. + * Initializes link vars that control CG drawing. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE int -TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing(interp, enable, limit) - Tcl_Interp *interp; - int enable; - int limit; +TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + int enable, + int limit) { static Boolean initialized = FALSE; @@ -104,12 +107,13 @@ TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing(interp, enable, limit) /* * Piggy-back the themed drawing var init here. */ + if (Tcl_LinkVar(interp, "::tk::mac::useThemedToplevel", - (char *) &useThemedToplevel, TCL_LINK_BOOLEAN) != TCL_OK) { + (char *) &useThemedToplevel, TCL_LINK_BOOLEAN) != TCL_OK) { Tcl_ResetResult(interp); } if (Tcl_LinkVar(interp, "::tk::mac::useThemedFrame", - (char *) &useThemedFrame, TCL_LINK_BOOLEAN) != TCL_OK) { + (char *) &useThemedFrame, TCL_LINK_BOOLEAN) != TCL_OK) { Tcl_ResetResult(interp); } } @@ -121,36 +125,35 @@ TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing(interp, enable, limit) * * XCopyArea -- * - * Copies data from one drawable to another using block transfer - * routines. + * Copies data from one drawable to another using block transfer + * routines. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Data is moved from a window or bitmap to a second window or - * bitmap. + * Data is moved from a window or bitmap to a second window or bitmap. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XCopyArea( - Display* display, /* Display. */ - Drawable src, /* Source drawable. */ - Drawable dst, /* Destination drawable. */ - GC gc, /* GC to use. */ - int src_x, /* X & Y, width & height */ - int src_y, /* define the source rectangle */ - unsigned int width, /* the will be copied. */ + Display *display, /* Display. */ + Drawable src, /* Source drawable. */ + Drawable dst, /* Destination drawable. */ + GC gc, /* GC to use. */ + int src_x, /* X & Y, width & height */ + int src_y, /* define the source rectangle */ + unsigned int width, /* the will be copied. */ unsigned int height, - int dest_x, /* Dest X & Y on dest rect. */ + int dest_x, /* Dest X & Y on dest rect. */ int dest_y) { Rect srcRect, dstRect; - Rect * srcPtr, * dstPtr; - const BitMap * srcBit; - const BitMap * dstBit; + Rect *srcPtr, *dstPtr; + const BitMap *srcBit; + const BitMap *dstBit; MacDrawable *srcDraw = (MacDrawable *) src; MacDrawable *dstDraw = (MacDrawable *) dst; CGrafPtr srcPort, dstPort; @@ -195,20 +198,20 @@ XCopyArea( (short) (dstDraw->yOff + dest_y + height)); } TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(dst); + /* - * We will change the clip rgn in this routine, so we need to - * be able to restore it when we exit. + * We will change the clip rgn in this routine, so we need to be able to + * restore it when we exit. */ GetClip(tmpRgn2); if (tkPictureIsOpen) { /* - * When rendering into a picture, after a call to "OpenCPicture" - * the clipping is seriously WRONG and also INCONSISTENT with the - * clipping for single plane bitmaps. - * To circumvent this problem, we clip to the whole window - * In this case, would have also clipped to the srcRect - * ClipRect(&srcRect); + * When rendering into a picture, after a call to "OpenCPicture" the + * clipping is seriously WRONG and also INCONSISTENT with the clipping + * for single plane bitmaps. To circumvent this problem, we clip to + * the whole window In this case, would have also clipped to the + * srcRect ClipRect(&srcRect); */ GetPortBounds(dstPort,&clpRect); @@ -216,11 +219,12 @@ XCopyArea( ClipRect(&clpRect); } if (!gc->clip_mask) { + /* do nothing */ } else if (((TkpClipMask*)gc->clip_mask)->type == TKP_CLIP_REGION) { RgnHandle clipRgn = (RgnHandle) ((TkpClipMask*)gc->clip_mask)->value.region; - int xOffset = 0, yOffset = 0; + if (tmpRgn == NULL) { tmpRgn = NewRgn(); } @@ -252,39 +256,33 @@ XCopyArea( * * XCopyPlane -- * - * Copies a bitmap from a source drawable to a destination - * drawable. The plane argument specifies which bit plane of - * the source contains the bitmap. Note that this implementation - * ignores the gc->function. + * Copies a bitmap from a source drawable to a destination drawable. The + * plane argument specifies which bit plane of the source contains the + * bitmap. Note that this implementation ignores the gc->function. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Changes the destination drawable. + * Changes the destination drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XCopyPlane( - Display* display, /* Display. */ - Drawable src, /* Source drawable. */ - Drawable dst, /* Destination drawable. */ - GC gc, /* The GC to use. */ - int src_x, /* X, Y, width & height */ - int src_y, /* define the source rect. */ - unsigned int width, - unsigned int height, - int dest_x, /* X & Y on dest where we will copy. */ - int dest_y, - unsigned long plane) /* Which plane to copy. */ + Display *display, /* Display. */ + Drawable src, /* Source drawable. */ + Drawable dst, /* Destination drawable. */ + GC gc, /* The GC to use. */ + int src_x, int src_y, /* X, Y, width & height define the source + * rect. */ + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + int dest_x, int dest_y, /* X & Y on dest where we will copy. */ + unsigned long plane) /* Which plane to copy. */ { - Rect srcRect, dstRect; - Rect * srcPtr, * dstPtr; - const BitMap * srcBit; - const BitMap * dstBit; - const BitMap * mskBit; + Rect srcRect, dstRect, *srcPtr, *dstPtr; + const BitMap *srcBit, *dstBit, *mskBit; MacDrawable *srcDraw = (MacDrawable *) src; MacDrawable *dstDraw = (MacDrawable *) dst; GWorldPtr srcPort, dstPort, mskPort; @@ -311,10 +309,10 @@ XCopyPlane( srcPtr = &srcRect; if (tkPictureIsOpen) { /* - * When rendering into a picture, after a call to "OpenCPicture" - * the clipping is seriously WRONG and also INCONSISTENT with the - * clipping for color bitmaps. - * To circumvent this problem, we clip to the whole window + * When rendering into a picture, after a call to "OpenCPicture" the + * clipping is seriously WRONG and also INCONSISTENT with the clipping + * for color bitmaps. To circumvent this problem, we clip to the whole + * window. */ Rect clpRect; @@ -348,8 +346,8 @@ XCopyPlane( if (clipPtr->value.pixmap == src) { PixMapHandle pm; /* - * Case 2: transparent bitmaps. If it's color we ignore - * the forecolor. + * Case 2: transparent bitmaps. If it's color we ignore the + * forecolor. */ pm = GetPortPixMap(srcPort); @@ -367,8 +365,8 @@ XCopyPlane( tmode = srcCopy; mskPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(clipPtr->value.pixmap); mskBit = GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(mskPort); - CopyDeepMask(srcBit, mskBit, dstBit, - srcPtr, srcPtr, dstPtr, tmode, NULL); + CopyDeepMask(srcBit, mskBit, dstBit, srcPtr, srcPtr, dstPtr, + tmode, NULL); } } @@ -380,14 +378,14 @@ XCopyPlane( * * TkPutImage -- * - * Copies a subimage from an in-memory image to a rectangle of - * of the specified drawable. + * Copies a subimage from an in-memory image to a rectangle of the + * specified drawable. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws the image on the specified drawable. + * Draws the image on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -430,13 +428,14 @@ TkPutImage( SetRect(srcPtr, src_x, src_y, src_x + width, src_y + height); if (tkPictureIsOpen) { /* - * When rendering into a picture, after a call to "OpenCPicture" - * the clipping is seriously WRONG and also INCONSISTENT with the - * clipping for single plane bitmaps. - * To circumvent this problem, we clip to the whole window + * When rendering into a picture, after a call to "OpenCPicture" the + * clipping is seriously WRONG and also INCONSISTENT with the clipping + * for single plane bitmaps. To circumvent this problem, we clip to + * the whole window. */ Rect clpRect; + GetPortBounds(destPort,&clpRect); ClipRect(&clpRect); destPtr = srcPtr; @@ -447,14 +446,19 @@ TkPutImage( } if (image->obdata) { - /* Image from XGetImage, copy from containing GWorld directly */ + /* + * Image from XGetImage, copy from containing GWorld directly. + */ + GWorldPtr srcPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort((Drawable)image->obdata); + CopyBits(GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(srcPort), destBits, srcPtr, destPtr, srcCopy, NULL); } else if (image->depth == 1) { /* * BW image */ + const int maxRowBytes = 0x3ffe; BitMap bitmap; int odd; @@ -487,7 +491,7 @@ TkPutImage( oldPtr = dataPtr; odd = sliceRowBytes % 2; if (!newData) { - newData = (char *) ckalloc(image->height * (sliceRowBytes+odd)); + newData = ckalloc(image->height * (sliceRowBytes+odd)); } newPtr = newData; for (i = 0; i < image->height; i++) { @@ -512,6 +516,7 @@ TkPutImage( /* * Color image */ + const int maxRowBytes = 0x3ffc; PixMap pixmap; @@ -519,7 +524,7 @@ TkPutImage( pixmap.bounds.top = 0; pixmap.bounds.bottom = (short) image->height; pixmap.pixelType = RGBDirect; - pixmap.pmVersion = baseAddr32; /* 32bit clean */ + pixmap.pmVersion = baseAddr32; /* 32bit clean */ pixmap.packType = 0; pixmap.packSize = 0; pixmap.hRes = 0x00480000; @@ -589,23 +594,23 @@ TkPutImage( * * XDrawLines -- * - * Draw connected lines. + * Draw connected lines. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Renders a series of connected lines. + * Renders a series of connected lines. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XDrawLines( - Display* display, /* Display. */ + Display *display, /* Display. */ Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ - XPoint* points, /* Array of points. */ + XPoint *points, /* Array of points. */ int npoints, /* Number of points. */ int mode) /* Line drawing mode. */ { @@ -654,15 +659,19 @@ XDrawLines( TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); ShowPen(); PenPixPat(gPenPat); - /* This is broken for fat lines, it is not possible to correctly - * imitate X11 drawing of oblique fat lines with QD line drawing, - * we should draw a filled polygon instead. */ + + /* + * This is broken for fat lines, it is not possible to correctly + * imitate X11 drawing of oblique fat lines with QD line drawing, we + * should draw a filled polygon instead. + */ + MoveTo((short) (macWin->xOff + points[0].x + o), - (short) (macWin->yOff + points[0].y + o)); + (short) (macWin->yOff + points[0].y + o)); for (i = 1; i < npoints; i++) { if (mode == CoordModeOrigin) { LineTo((short) (macWin->xOff + points[i].x + o), - (short) (macWin->yOff + points[i].y + o)); + (short) (macWin->yOff + points[i].y + o)); } else { Line((short) points[i].x, (short) points[i].y); } @@ -678,23 +687,24 @@ XDrawLines( * * XDrawSegments -- * - * Draw unconnected lines. + * Draw unconnected lines. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Renders a series of unconnected lines. + * Renders a series of unconnected lines. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void XDrawSegments( +void +XDrawSegments( Display *display, - Drawable d, + Drawable d, GC gc, XSegment *segments, - int nsegments) + int nsegments) { MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) d; CGrafPtr saveWorld; @@ -730,14 +740,18 @@ void XDrawSegments( TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); ShowPen(); PenPixPat(gPenPat); - /* This is broken for fat lines, it is not possible to correctly - * imitate X11 drawing of oblique fat lines with QD line drawing, - * we should draw a filled polygon instead. */ + + /* + * This is broken for fat lines, it is not possible to correctly + * imitate X11 drawing of oblique fat lines with QD line drawing, we + * should draw a filled polygon instead. + */ + for (i = 0; i < nsegments; i++) { MoveTo((short) (macWin->xOff + segments[i].x1 + o), - (short) (macWin->yOff + segments[i].y1 + o)); + (short) (macWin->yOff + segments[i].y1 + o)); LineTo((short) (macWin->xOff + segments[i].x2 + o), - (short) (macWin->yOff + segments[i].y2 + o)); + (short) (macWin->yOff + segments[i].y2 + o)); } HidePen(); } @@ -750,13 +764,13 @@ void XDrawSegments( * * XFillPolygon -- * - * Draws a filled polygon. + * Draws a filled polygon. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws a filled polygon on the specified drawable. + * Draws a filled polygon on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -813,11 +827,11 @@ XFillPolygon( PenNormal(); polygon = OpenPoly(); MoveTo((short) (macWin->xOff + points[0].x), - (short) (macWin->yOff + points[0].y)); + (short) (macWin->yOff + points[0].y)); for (i = 1; i < npoints; i++) { if (mode == CoordModeOrigin) { LineTo((short) (macWin->xOff + points[i].x), - (short) (macWin->yOff + points[i].y)); + (short) (macWin->yOff + points[i].y)); } else { Line((short) points[i].x, (short) points[i].y); } @@ -835,25 +849,24 @@ XFillPolygon( * * XDrawRectangle -- * - * Draws a rectangle. + * Draws a rectangle. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws a rectangle on the specified drawable. + * Draws a rectangle on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XDrawRectangle( - Display* display, /* Display. */ - Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ - GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ - int x, /* Upper left corner. */ - int y, - unsigned int width, /* Width & height of rect. */ + Display *display, /* Display. */ + Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ + GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ + int x, int y, /* Upper left corner. */ + unsigned int width, /* Width & height of rect. */ unsigned int height) { MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) d; @@ -891,10 +904,10 @@ XDrawRectangle( TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); ShowPen(); PenPixPat(gPenPat); - theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + x + o); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + y + o); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + width + lw); - theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + height + lw); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + x + o); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + y + o); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + width + lw); + theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + height + lw); FrameRect(&theRect); HidePen(); } @@ -908,27 +921,26 @@ XDrawRectangle( * * XDrawRectangles -- * - * Draws the outlines of the specified rectangles as if a - * five-point PolyLine protocol request were specified for each - * rectangle: + * Draws the outlines of the specified rectangles as if a five-point + * PolyLine protocol request were specified for each rectangle: * - * [x,y] [x+width,y] [x+width,y+height] [x,y+height] - * [x,y] + * [x,y] [x+width,y] [x+width,y+height] [x,y+height] + * [x,y] * - * For the specified rectangles, these functions do not draw a - * pixel more than once. XDrawRectangles draws the rectangles in - * the order listed in the array. If rectangles intersect, the - * intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times. Draws a - * rectangle. + * For the specified rectangles, these functions do not draw a pixel more + * than once. XDrawRectangles draws the rectangles in the order listed in + * the array. If rectangles intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn + * multiple times. Draws a rectangle. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws rectangles on the specified drawable. + * Draws rectangles on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void XDrawRectangles( Display *display, @@ -975,10 +987,10 @@ XDrawRectangles( ShowPen(); PenPixPat(gPenPat); for (i = 0, rectPtr = rectArr; i < nRects;i++, rectPtr++) { - theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + rectPtr->x + o); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + rectPtr->y + o); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + rectPtr->width + lw); - theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + rectPtr->height + lw); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + rectPtr->x + o); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + rectPtr->y + o); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + rectPtr->width + lw); + theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + rectPtr->height + lw); FrameRect(&theRect); } HidePen(); @@ -993,23 +1005,24 @@ XDrawRectangles( * * XFillRectangles -- * - * Fill multiple rectangular areas in the given drawable. + * Fill multiple rectangular areas in the given drawable. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws onto the specified drawable. + * Draws onto the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void XFillRectangles( - Display* display, /* Display. */ - Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ - GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ - XRectangle *rectangles, /* Rectangle array. */ - int n_rectangles) /* Number of rectangles. */ + Display* display, /* Display. */ + Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ + GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ + XRectangle *rectangles, /* Rectangle array. */ + int n_rectangles) /* Number of rectangles. */ { MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) d; CGrafPtr saveWorld; @@ -1033,8 +1046,7 @@ XFillRectangles( if (rectPtr->width == 0 || rectPtr->height == 0) { continue; } - rect = CGRectMake( - macWin->xOff + rectPtr->x, + rect = CGRectMake(macWin->xOff + rectPtr->x, macWin->yOff + rectPtr->y, rectPtr->width, rectPtr->height); CGContextFillRect(outContext, rect); @@ -1045,10 +1057,10 @@ XFillRectangles( TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); for (i = 0, rectPtr = rectangles; i < n_rectangles; i++, rectPtr++) { - theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + rectPtr->x); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + rectPtr->y); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + rectPtr->width); - theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + rectPtr->height); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + rectPtr->x); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + rectPtr->y); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + rectPtr->width); + theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + rectPtr->height); FillCRect(&theRect, gPenPat); } } @@ -1061,28 +1073,27 @@ XFillRectangles( * * XDrawArc -- * - * Draw an arc. + * Draw an arc. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws an arc on the specified drawable. + * Draws an arc on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XDrawArc( - Display* display, /* Display. */ - Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ - GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ - int x, /* Upper left of */ - int y, /* bounding rect. */ - unsigned int width, /* Width & height. */ + Display* display, /* Display. */ + Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ + GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ + int x, int y, /* Upper left of bounding rect. */ + unsigned int width, /* Width & height. */ unsigned int height, - int angle1, /* Staring angle of arc. */ - int angle2) /* Extent of arc. */ + int angle1, /* Staring angle of arc. */ + int angle2) /* Extent of arc. */ { MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) d; CGrafPtr saveWorld; @@ -1142,11 +1153,11 @@ XDrawArc( TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); ShowPen(); PenPixPat(gPenPat); - theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + x + o); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + y + o); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + width + lw); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + x + o); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + y + o); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + width + lw); theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + height + lw); - start = (short) (90 - (angle1/64)); + start = (short) (90 - (angle1/64)); extent = (short) (-(angle2/64)); FrameArc(&theRect, start, extent); HidePen(); @@ -1161,23 +1172,23 @@ XDrawArc( * * XDrawArcs -- * - * Draws multiple circular or elliptical arcs. Each arc is - * specified by a rectangle and two angles. The center of the - * circle or ellipse is the center of the rect- angle, and the - * major and minor axes are specified by the width and height. - * Positive angles indicate counterclock- wise motion, and - * negative angles indicate clockwise motion. If the magnitude - * of angle2 is greater than 360 degrees, XDrawArcs truncates it - * to 360 degrees. + * Draws multiple circular or elliptical arcs. Each arc is specified by a + * rectangle and two angles. The center of the circle or ellipse is the + * center of the rectangle, and the major and minor axes are specified by + * the width and height. Positive angles indicate counterclock- wise + * motion, and negative angles indicate clockwise motion. If the + * magnitude of angle2 is greater than 360 degrees, XDrawArcs truncates + * it to 360 degrees. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws an arc for each array element on the specified drawable. + * Draws an arc for each array element on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void XDrawArcs( Display *display, @@ -1186,12 +1197,11 @@ XDrawArcs( XArc *arcArr, int nArcs) { - MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) d; CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; GWorldPtr destPort; - XArc * arcPtr; + XArc *arcPtr; int i, lw = gc->line_width; destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); @@ -1211,8 +1221,7 @@ XDrawArcs( || arcPtr->angle2 == 0) { continue; } - rect = CGRectMake( - macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o, + rect = CGRectMake(macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o, macWin->yOff + arcPtr->y + o, arcPtr->width, arcPtr->height); @@ -1226,13 +1235,13 @@ XDrawArcs( CGMutablePathRef p = CGPathCreateMutable(); CGAffineTransform t = CGAffineTransformIdentity; CGPoint c = CGPointMake(CGRectGetMidX(rect), - CGRectGetMidY(rect)); + CGRectGetMidY(rect)); float w = CGRectGetWidth(rect); if (arcPtr->width != arcPtr->height) { t = CGAffineTransformMakeScale(1, CGRectGetHeight(rect)/w); c = CGPointApplyAffineTransform(c, - CGAffineTransformInvert(t)); + CGAffineTransformInvert(t)); } CGPathAddArc(p, &t, c.x, c.y, w/2, radians(-arcPtr->angle1/64.0), @@ -1253,11 +1262,11 @@ XDrawArcs( ShowPen(); PenPixPat(gPenPat); for (i = 0, arcPtr = arcArr;i < nArcs;i++, arcPtr++) { - theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + arcPtr->y + o); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + arcPtr->width + lw); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + arcPtr->y + o); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + arcPtr->width + lw); theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + arcPtr->height + lw); - start = (short) (90 - (arcPtr->angle1/64)); + start = (short) (90 - (arcPtr->angle1/64)); extent = (short) (-(arcPtr->angle2/64)); FrameArc(&theRect, start, extent); } @@ -1273,28 +1282,27 @@ XDrawArcs( * * XFillArc -- * - * Draw a filled arc. + * Draw a filled arc. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws a filled arc on the specified drawable. + * Draws a filled arc on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void XFillArc( - Display* display, /* Display. */ - Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ - GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ - int x, /* Upper left of */ - int y, /* bounding rect. */ - unsigned int width, /* Width & height. */ + Display* display, /* Display. */ + Drawable d, /* Draw on this. */ + GC gc, /* Use this GC. */ + int x, int y, /* Upper left of bounding rect. */ + unsigned int width, /* Width & height. */ unsigned int height, - int angle1, /* Staring angle of arc. */ - int angle2) /* Extent of arc. */ + int angle1, /* Staring angle of arc. */ + int angle2) /* Extent of arc. */ { MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) d; CGrafPtr saveWorld; @@ -1322,9 +1330,7 @@ XFillArc( u += NON_AA_CG_OFFSET; } TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext(macWin, destPort, gc, &outContext); - rect = CGRectMake( - macWin->xOff + x + o, - macWin->yOff + y + o, + rect = CGRectMake(macWin->xOff + x + o, macWin->yOff + y + o, width - u, height - u); #if MAC_OS_X_VERSION_MAX_ALLOWED >= 1040 @@ -1364,9 +1370,9 @@ XFillArc( double vertex[2], center1[2], center2[2]; TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); - theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + x + o); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + y + o); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + width + lw); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + x + o); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + y + o); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + width + lw); theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + height + lw); start = (short) (90 - (angle1/64)); extent = (short) (-(angle2/64)); @@ -1388,7 +1394,7 @@ XFillArc( polygon = OpenPoly(); MoveTo((short) ((theRect.left + theRect.right)/2), - (short) ((theRect.top + theRect.bottom)/2)); + (short) ((theRect.top + theRect.bottom)/2)); LineTo((short) (center1[0] + .5), (short) (center1[1] + .5)); LineTo((short) (center2[0] + .5), (short) (center2[1] + .5)); ClosePoly(); @@ -1413,16 +1419,17 @@ XFillArc( * * XFillArcs -- * - * Draw a filled arc. + * Draw a filled arc. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Draws a filled arc for each array element on the specified drawable. + * Draws a filled arc for each array element on the specified drawable. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void XFillArcs( Display *display, @@ -1435,7 +1442,7 @@ XFillArcs( CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; GWorldPtr destPort; - XArc * arcPtr; + XArc *arcPtr; int i, lw = gc->line_width; destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); @@ -1459,8 +1466,7 @@ XFillArcs( || arcPtr->angle2 == 0) { continue; } - rect = CGRectMake( - macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o, + rect = CGRectMake(macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o, macWin->yOff + arcPtr->y + o, arcPtr->width - u, arcPtr->height - u); @@ -1474,13 +1480,13 @@ XFillArcs( CGMutablePathRef p = CGPathCreateMutable(); CGAffineTransform t = CGAffineTransformIdentity; CGPoint c = CGPointMake(CGRectGetMidX(rect), - CGRectGetMidY(rect)); + CGRectGetMidY(rect)); float w = CGRectGetWidth(rect); if (arcPtr->width != arcPtr->height) { t = CGAffineTransformMakeScale(1, CGRectGetHeight(rect)/w); c = CGPointApplyAffineTransform(c, - CGAffineTransformInvert(t)); + CGAffineTransformInvert(t)); } if (gc->arc_mode == ArcPieSlice) { CGPathMoveToPoint(p, &t, c.x, c.y); @@ -1507,9 +1513,9 @@ XFillArcs( TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); for (i = 0, arcPtr = arcArr;ixOff + arcPtr->x + o); - theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + arcPtr->y + o); - theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + arcPtr->width + lw); + theRect.left = (short) (macWin->xOff + arcPtr->x + o); + theRect.top = (short) (macWin->yOff + arcPtr->y + o); + theRect.right = (short) (theRect.left + arcPtr->width + lw); theRect.bottom = (short) (theRect.top + arcPtr->height + lw); start = (short) (90 - (arcPtr->angle1/64)); extent = (short) (- (arcPtr->angle2/64)); @@ -1532,7 +1538,7 @@ XFillArcs( polygon = OpenPoly(); MoveTo((short) ((theRect.left + theRect.right)/2), - (short) ((theRect.top + theRect.bottom)/2)); + (short) ((theRect.top + theRect.bottom)/2)); LineTo((short) (center1[0] + .5), (short) (center1[1] + .5)); LineTo((short) (center2[0] + .5), (short) (center2[1] + .5)); ClosePoly(); @@ -1561,8 +1567,10 @@ XFillArcs( * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + long -XMaxRequestSize(Display *display) +XMaxRequestSize( + Display *display) { return (SHRT_MAX / 4); } @@ -1573,31 +1581,28 @@ XMaxRequestSize(Display *display) * * TkScrollWindow -- * - * Scroll a rectangle of the specified window and accumulate - * a damage region. + * Scroll a rectangle of the specified window and accumulate a damage + * region. * * Results: - * Returns 0 if the scroll genereated no additional damage. - * Otherwise, sets the region that needs to be repainted after - * scrolling and returns 1. + * Returns 0 if the scroll genereated no additional damage. Otherwise, + * sets the region that needs to be repainted after scrolling and returns + * 1. * * Side effects: - * Scrolls the bits in the window. + * Scrolls the bits in the window. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int TkScrollWindow( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* The window to be scrolled. */ - GC gc, /* GC for window to be scrolled. */ - int x, /* Position rectangle to be scrolled. */ - int y, - int width, - int height, - int dx, /* Distance rectangle should be moved. */ - int dy, - TkRegion damageRgn) /* Region to accumulate damage in. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* The window to be scrolled. */ + GC gc, /* GC for window to be scrolled. */ + int x, int y, /* Position rectangle to be scrolled. */ + int width, int height, + int dx, int dy, /* Distance rectangle should be moved. */ + TkRegion damageRgn) /* Region to accumulate damage in. */ { MacDrawable *destDraw = (MacDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); RgnHandle rgn = (RgnHandle) damageRgn; @@ -1613,13 +1618,12 @@ TkScrollWindow( TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); /* - * Due to the implementation below the behavior may be differnt - * than X in certain cases that should never occur in Tk. The - * scrollRect is the source rect extended by the offset (the union - * of the source rect and the offset rect). Everything - * in the extended scrollRect is scrolled. On X, it's possible - * to "skip" over an area if the offset makes the source and - * destination rects disjoint and non-aligned. + * Due to the implementation below the behavior may be differnt than X in + * certain cases that should never occur in Tk. The scrollRect is the + * source rect extended by the offset (the union of the source rect and + * the offset rect). Everything in the extended scrollRect is scrolled. On + * X, it's possible to "skip" over an area if the offset makes the source + * and destination rects disjoint and non-aligned. */ SetRect(&srcRect, (short) (destDraw->xOff + x), @@ -1639,9 +1643,10 @@ TkScrollWindow( } /* - * Adjust clip region so that we don't copy any windows - * that may overlap us. + * Adjust clip region so that we don't copy any windows that may overlap + * us. */ + visRgn = NewRgn(); clipRgn = NewRgn(); RectRgn(rgn, &srcRect); @@ -1654,14 +1659,14 @@ TkScrollWindow( SetEmptyRgn(rgn); /* - * When a menu is up, the Mac does not expect drawing to occur and - * does not clip out the menu. We have to do it ourselves. This - * is pretty gross. + * When a menu is up, the Mac does not expect drawing to occur and does + * not clip out the menu. We have to do it ourselves. This is pretty + * gross. */ if (tkUseMenuCascadeRgn == 1) { - Point scratch = {0, 0}; - MacDrawable *macDraw = (MacDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); + Point scratch = {0, 0}; + MacDrawable *macDraw = (MacDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); LocalToGlobal(&scratch); CopyRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, rgn); @@ -1678,17 +1683,14 @@ TkScrollWindow( DisposeRgn(clipRgn); DisposeRgn(visRgn); + /* - * Fortunantly, the region returned by ScrollRect is symanticlly - * the same as what we need to return in this function. If the - * region is empty we return zero to denote that no damage was - * created. + * Fortunantly, the region returned by ScrollRect is symanticlly the same + * as what we need to return in this function. If the region is empty we + * return zero to denote that no damage was created. */ - if (EmptyRgn(rgn)) { - return 0; - } else { - return 1; - } + + return !EmptyRgn(rgn); } /* @@ -1696,13 +1698,13 @@ TkScrollWindow( * * TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort -- * - * Set up the graphics port from the given GC. + * Set up the graphics port from the given GC. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The current port is adjusted. + * The current port is adjusted. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1710,7 +1712,7 @@ TkScrollWindow( void TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort( GC gc, - GWorldPtr destPort) /* GC to apply to current port. */ + GWorldPtr destPort) /* GC to apply to current port. */ { RGBColor macColor; @@ -1719,12 +1721,15 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort( } if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &macColor) == true) { - /* TODO: cache RGBPats for preformace - measure gains... */ + /* + * TODO: cache RGBPats for preformace - measure gains... + */ + MakeRGBPat(gPenPat, &macColor); } PenNormal(); - if(gc->function == GXxor) { + if (gc->function == GXxor) { PenMode(patXor); } if (gc->line_width > 1) { @@ -1732,26 +1737,26 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort( } if (gc->line_style != LineSolid) { /* - * Here the dash pattern should be set in the drawing, - * environment, but I don't know how to do that for the Mac. + * Here the dash pattern should be set in the drawing environment, but + * I don't know how to do that for the Mac. * - * p[] is an array of unsigned chars containing the dash list. - * A '\0' indicates the end of this list. + * p[] is an array of unsigned chars containing the dash list. A '\0' + * indicates the end of this list. * - * Someone knows how to implement this? If you have a more - * complete implementation of SetUpGraphicsPort() for - * the Mac (or for Windows), please let me know. + * Someone knows how to implement this? If you have a more complete + * implementation of SetUpGraphicsPort() for the Mac (or for Windows), + * please let me know. * - * Jan Nijtmans - * CMG Arnhem, B.V. - * email: j.nijtmans@chello.nl (private) - * jan.nijtmans@cmg.nl (work) - * url: http://purl.oclc.org/net/nijtmans/ + * Jan Nijtmans + * CMG Arnhem, B.V. + * email: j.nijtmans@chello.nl (private) + * jan.nijtmans@cmg.nl (work) + * url: http://purl.oclc.org/net/nijtmans/ * * FIXME: - * This is not possible with QuickDraw line drawing. As of - * Tk 8.4.7 we have a complete set of drawing routines using - * CG, so there is no reason to support this here. + * This is not possible with QuickDraw line drawing. As of Tk 8.4.7 we + * have a complete set of drawing routines using CG, so there is no + * reason to support this here. */ } } @@ -1761,13 +1766,13 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort( * * TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext -- * - * Set up a CGContext for the given graphics port. + * Set up a CGContext for the given graphics port. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1791,13 +1796,13 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext( outContext = *contextPtr; /* - * Now clip the CG Context to the port. Note, we have already - * set up the port with our clip region, so we can just get - * the clip back out of there. If we use the macWin->clipRgn - * directly at this point, we get some odd drawing effects. + * Now clip the CG Context to the port. Note, we have already set up the + * port with our clip region, so we can just get the clip back out of + * there. If we use the macWin->clipRgn directly at this point, we get + * some odd drawing effects. * - * We also have to intersect our clip region with the port - * visible region so we don't overwrite the window decoration. + * We also have to intersect our clip region with the port visible region + * so we don't overwrite the window decoration. */ if (!clipRgn) { @@ -1813,8 +1818,8 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext( SetEmptyRgn(clipRgn); /* - * Note: You have to call SyncCGContextOriginWithPort - * AFTER all the clip region manipulations. + * Note: You have to call SyncCGContextOriginWithPort AFTER all the clip + * region manipulations. */ SyncCGContextOriginWithPort(outContext, destPort); @@ -1823,28 +1828,32 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext( boundsRect.bottom - boundsRect.top); CGContextConcatCTM(outContext, coordsTransform); - /* Now offset the CTM to the subwindow offset */ + /* + * Now offset the CTM to the subwindow offset. + */ if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &macColor) == true) { - CGContextSetRGBFillColor(outContext, - RGBFLOATRED(macColor), - RGBFLOATGREEN(macColor), - RGBFLOATBLUE(macColor), - 1); - CGContextSetRGBStrokeColor(outContext, - RGBFLOATRED(macColor), - RGBFLOATGREEN(macColor), - RGBFLOATBLUE(macColor), - 1); + CGContextSetRGBFillColor(outContext, RGBFLOATRED(macColor), + RGBFLOATGREEN(macColor), RGBFLOATBLUE(macColor), 1); + CGContextSetRGBStrokeColor(outContext, RGBFLOATRED(macColor), + RGBFLOATGREEN(macColor), RGBFLOATBLUE(macColor), 1); } - if(gc->function == GXxor) { + if (gc->function == GXxor) { + /* empty */ } w = gc->line_width; - /* When should we antialias? */ + + /* + * When should we antialias? + */ + if (notAA(gc->line_width)) { - /* Make non-antialiased CG drawing look more like X11 */ + /* + * Make non-antialiased CG drawing look more like X11. + */ + w -= (gc->line_width ? NON_AA_CG_OFFSET : 0); CGContextSetShouldAntialias(outContext, 0); } else { @@ -1867,7 +1876,7 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext( if (gc->cap_style == CapButt) { /* - * What about CapNotLast, CapProjecting? + * What about CapNotLast, CapProjecting? */ CGContextSetLineCap(outContext, kCGLineCapButt); @@ -1891,22 +1900,22 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpCGContext( * * TkMacOSXReleaseCGContext -- * - * Release the CGContext for the given graphics port. + * Release the CGContext for the given graphics port. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void TkMacOSXReleaseCGContext( - MacDrawable *macWin, - CGrafPtr destPort, - CGContextRef *outContext) + MacDrawable *macWin, + CGrafPtr destPort, + CGContextRef *outContext) { CGContextSynchronize(*outContext); QDEndCGContext(destPort, outContext); @@ -1917,21 +1926,21 @@ TkMacOSXReleaseCGContext( * * TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn -- * - * Set up the clipping region so that drawing only occurs on the - * specified X subwindow. + * Set up the clipping region so that drawing only occurs on the + * specified X subwindow. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The clipping region in the current port is changed. + * The clipping region in the current port is changed. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn( - Drawable drawable) /* Drawable to update. */ + Drawable drawable) /* Drawable to update. */ { MacDrawable *macDraw = (MacDrawable *) drawable; @@ -1942,40 +1951,44 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn( #if defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG) && defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG_DRAWING) TkMacOSXInitNamedDebugSymbol(HIToolbox, int, QDDebugFlashRegion, - CGrafPtr port, RgnHandle region); + CGrafPtr port, RgnHandle region); if (QDDebugFlashRegion) { CGrafPtr grafPtr = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(drawable); - /* Carbon-internal region flashing SPI (c.f. Technote 2124) */ + + /* + * Carbon-internal region flashing SPI (c.f. Technote 2124) + */ + QDDebugFlashRegion(grafPtr, macDraw->clipRgn); } #endif /* TK_MAC_DEBUG_DRAWING */ /* * When a menu is up, the Mac does not expect drawing to occur and - * does not clip out the menu. We have to do it ourselves. This - * is pretty gross. + * does not clip out the menu. We have to do it ourselves. This is + * pretty gross. */ if (macDraw->clipRgn != NULL) { if (tkUseMenuCascadeRgn == 1) { - Point scratch = {0, 0}; - GDHandle saveDevice; - GWorldPtr saveWorld; - - GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); - SetGWorld(TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(drawable), NULL); - LocalToGlobal(&scratch); - SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); - if (tmpRgn == NULL) { - tmpRgn = NewRgn(); - } - CopyRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, tmpRgn); - OffsetRgn(tmpRgn, -scratch.h, -scratch.v); - DiffRgn(macDraw->clipRgn, tmpRgn, tmpRgn); - SetClip(tmpRgn); - macDraw->toplevel->flags |= TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU; + Point scratch = {0, 0}; + GDHandle saveDevice; + GWorldPtr saveWorld; + + GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); + SetGWorld(TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(drawable), NULL); + LocalToGlobal(&scratch); + SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); + if (tmpRgn == NULL) { + tmpRgn = NewRgn(); + } + CopyRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, tmpRgn); + OffsetRgn(tmpRgn, -scratch.h, -scratch.v); + DiffRgn(macDraw->clipRgn, tmpRgn, tmpRgn); + SetClip(tmpRgn); + macDraw->toplevel->flags |= TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU; } else { - SetClip(macDraw->clipRgn); + SetClip(macDraw->clipRgn); } } } @@ -1986,31 +1999,29 @@ TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn( * * TkMacOSXMakeStippleMap -- * - * Given a drawable and a stipple pattern this function draws the - * pattern repeatedly over the drawable. The drawable can then - * be used as a mask for bit-bliting a stipple pattern over an - * object. + * Given a drawable and a stipple pattern this function draws the pattern + * repeatedly over the drawable. The drawable can then be used as a mask + * for bit-bliting a stipple pattern over an object. * * Results: - * A BitMap data structure. + * A BitMap data structure. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ BitMapPtr TkMacOSXMakeStippleMap( - Drawable drawable, /* Window to apply stipple. */ - Drawable stipple) /* The stipple pattern. */ + Drawable drawable, /* Window to apply stipple. */ + Drawable stipple) /* The stipple pattern. */ { GWorldPtr destPort; BitMapPtr bitmapPtr; - Rect portRect; - int width, height, stippleHeight, stippleWidth; - int i, j; - char * data; + Rect portRect; + int width, height, stippleHeight, stippleWidth, i, j; + char *data; Rect bounds; destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(drawable); @@ -2039,7 +2050,7 @@ TkMacOSXMakeStippleMap( bounds.bottom = i + stippleHeight; CopyBits(GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(destPort), bitmapPtr, - &portRect, &bounds, srcCopy, NULL); + &portRect, &bounds, srcCopy, NULL); } } return bitmapPtr; @@ -2050,20 +2061,20 @@ TkMacOSXMakeStippleMap( * * InvertByte -- * - * This function reverses the bits in the passed in Byte of data. + * This function reverses the bits in the passed in Byte of data. * * Results: - * The incoming byte in reverse bit order. + * The incoming byte in reverse bit order. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static unsigned char InvertByte( - unsigned char data) /* Byte of data. */ + unsigned char data) /* Byte of data. */ { unsigned char i; unsigned char mask = 1, result = 0; @@ -2082,32 +2093,32 @@ InvertByte( * * TkpDrawHighlightBorder -- * - * This procedure draws a rectangular ring around the outside of - * a widget to indicate that it has received the input focus. + * This procedure draws a rectangular ring around the outside of a widget + * to indicate that it has received the input focus. * - * On the Macintosh, this puts a 1 pixel border in the bgGC color - * between the widget and the focus ring, except in the case where - * highlightWidth is 1, in which case the border is left out. + * On the Macintosh, this puts a 1 pixel border in the bgGC color between + * the widget and the focus ring, except in the case where highlightWidth + * is 1, in which case the border is left out. * - * For proper Mac L&F, use highlightWidth of 3. + * For proper Mac L&F, use highlightWidth of 3. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * A rectangle "width" pixels wide is drawn in "drawable", - * corresponding to the outer area of "tkwin". + * A rectangle "width" pixels wide is drawn in "drawable", corresponding + * to the outer area of "tkwin". * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpDrawHighlightBorder ( - Tk_Window tkwin, - GC fgGC, - GC bgGC, - int highlightWidth, - Drawable drawable) + Tk_Window tkwin, + GC fgGC, + GC bgGC, + int highlightWidth, + Drawable drawable) { if (highlightWidth == 1) { TkDrawInsetFocusHighlight (tkwin, fgGC, highlightWidth, drawable, 0); @@ -2125,8 +2136,8 @@ TkpDrawHighlightBorder ( * * TkpDrawFrame -- * - * This procedure draws the rectangular frame area. If the user - * has request themeing, it draws with a the background theme. + * This procedure draws the rectangular frame area. If the user has + * request themeing, it draws with a the background theme. * * Results: * None. @@ -2138,15 +2149,20 @@ TkpDrawHighlightBorder ( */ void -TkpDrawFrame (Tk_Window tkwin, Tk_3DBorder border, - int highlightWidth, int borderWidth, int relief) +TkpDrawFrame( + Tk_Window tkwin, + Tk_3DBorder border, + int highlightWidth, + int borderWidth, + int relief) { if (useThemedToplevel && Tk_IsTopLevel(tkwin)) { /* - * Currently only support themed toplevels, until we can better - * factor this to handle individual windows (blanket theming of - * frames will work for very few UIs). + * Currently only support themed toplevels, until we can better factor + * this to handle individual windows (blanket theming of frames will + * work for very few UIs). */ + Rect bounds; Point origin; CGrafPtr saveWorld; @@ -2175,15 +2191,21 @@ TkpDrawFrame (Tk_Window tkwin, Tk_3DBorder border, EraseRect(&bounds); SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); - XCopyArea(display, pixmap, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), - gc, 0, 0, bounds.right, bounds.bottom, 0, 0); + XCopyArea(display, pixmap, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), gc, 0, 0, bounds.right, + bounds.bottom, 0, 0); Tk_FreePixmap(display, pixmap); Tk_FreeGC(display, gc); } else { - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), - border, highlightWidth, highlightWidth, - Tk_Width(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, - Tk_Height(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, - borderWidth, relief); + Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), border, highlightWidth, + highlightWidth, Tk_Width(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, + Tk_Height(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, borderWidth, relief); } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXEvent.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXEvent.c index 82a4ad0..dd90d6e 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXEvent.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXEvent.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXEvent.c -- * * This file contains the basic Mac OS X Event handling routines. @@ -7,23 +7,23 @@ * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2005-2006 Daniel A. Steffen * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXEvent.c,v 1.12 2006/10/31 22:33:34 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXEvent.c,v 1.13 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" #include "tkMacOSXEvent.h" #include "tkMacOSXDebug.h" - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXFlushWindows -- * - * This routine flushes all the Carbon windows of the application. It - * is called by the setup procedure for the Tcl/Carbon event source. + * This routine flushes all the Carbon windows of the application. It is + * called by the setup procedure for the Tcl/Carbon event source. * * Results: * None. @@ -35,10 +35,10 @@ */ MODULE_SCOPE void -TkMacOSXFlushWindows () +TkMacOSXFlushWindows(void) { WindowRef wRef = GetWindowList(); - + while (wRef) { CGrafPtr portPtr = GetWindowPort(wRef); if (QDIsPortBuffered(portPtr)) { @@ -48,62 +48,61 @@ TkMacOSXFlushWindows () } } -/* +/* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- - * + * * TkMacOSXProcessEvent -- - * + * * This dispatches a filtered Carbon event to the appropriate handler * * Note on MacEventStatus.stopProcessing: Please be conservative in the - * individual handlers and don't assume the event is fully handled - * unless you *really* need to ensure that other handlers don't see the - * event anymore. Some OS manager or library might be interested in - * events even after they are already handled on the Tk level. + * individual handlers and don't assume the event is fully handled unless + * you *really* need to ensure that other handlers don't see the event + * anymore. Some OS manager or library might be interested in events even + * after they are already handled on the Tk level. * - * Results: + * Results: * 0 on success * -1 on failure * * Side effects: * Converts a Carbon event to a Tk event - * + * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -MODULE_SCOPE int -TkMacOSXProcessEvent(TkMacOSXEvent * eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) +MODULE_SCOPE int +TkMacOSXProcessEvent( + TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, + MacEventStatus *statusPtr) { switch (eventPtr->eClass) { - case kEventClassMouse: - TkMacOSXProcessMouseEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); - break; - case kEventClassWindow: - TkMacOSXProcessWindowEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); - break; - case kEventClassKeyboard: - TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); - break; - case kEventClassApplication: - TkMacOSXProcessApplicationEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); - break; - case kEventClassMenu: - TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); - break; - case kEventClassCommand: - TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); - break; - default: -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - { - char buf [256]; - fprintf(stderr, - "Unrecognised event : %s\n", - TkMacOSXCarbonEventToAscii(eventPtr->eventRef, buf)); - } -#endif - break; - } + case kEventClassMouse: + TkMacOSXProcessMouseEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); + break; + case kEventClassWindow: + TkMacOSXProcessWindowEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); + break; + case kEventClassKeyboard: + TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); + break; + case kEventClassApplication: + TkMacOSXProcessApplicationEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); + break; + case kEventClassMenu: + TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); + break; + case kEventClassCommand: + TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent(eventPtr, statusPtr); + break; + default: { + char buf[256]; + + LOG_MSG("Unrecognised event : %s\n", + TkMacOSXCarbonEventToAscii(eventPtr->eventRef, buf)); + break; + } + } return 0; } @@ -112,8 +111,8 @@ TkMacOSXProcessEvent(TkMacOSXEvent * eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) * * TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent -- * - * This routine processes the event in eventPtr, and - * generates the appropriate Tk events from it. + * This routine processes the event in eventPtr, and generates the + * appropriate Tk events from it. * * Results: * True if event(s) are generated - false otherwise. @@ -125,37 +124,37 @@ TkMacOSXProcessEvent(TkMacOSXEvent * eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) */ MODULE_SCOPE int -TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) +TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent( + TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, + MacEventStatus *statusPtr) { - int menuContext; - OSStatus status; + int menuContext; + OSStatus status; switch (eventPtr->eKind) { - case kEventMenuBeginTracking: - case kEventMenuEndTracking: - break; - default: - return 0; - break; + case kEventMenuBeginTracking: + case kEventMenuEndTracking: + break; + default: + return 0; + break; } - status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, - kEventParamMenuContext, - typeUInt32, NULL, - sizeof(menuContext), NULL, - &menuContext); + status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, kEventParamMenuContext, + typeUInt32, NULL, sizeof(menuContext), NULL, &menuContext); if (status == noErr && (menuContext & kMenuContextMenuBar)) { static int oldMode = TCL_SERVICE_ALL; + if (eventPtr->eKind == kEventMenuBeginTracking) { oldMode = Tcl_SetServiceMode(TCL_SERVICE_ALL); TkMacOSXClearMenubarActive(); - + /* * Handle -postcommand */ - + TkMacOSXPreprocessMenu(); } else { - Tcl_SetServiceMode(oldMode); + Tcl_SetServiceMode(oldMode); } } return 0; @@ -166,8 +165,8 @@ TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) * * TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent -- * - * This routine processes the event in eventPtr, and - * generates the appropriate Tk events from it. + * This routine processes the event in eventPtr, and generates the + * appropriate Tk events from it. * * Results: * True if event(s) are generated - false otherwise. @@ -179,32 +178,29 @@ TkMacOSXProcessMenuEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) */ MODULE_SCOPE int -TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) +TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent( + TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, + MacEventStatus *statusPtr) { - HICommand command; - int menuContext; - OSStatus status; + HICommand command; + int menuContext; + OSStatus status; switch (eventPtr->eKind) { - case kEventCommandProcess: - case kEventCommandUpdateStatus: - break; - default: - return 0; - break; + case kEventCommandProcess: + case kEventCommandUpdateStatus: + break; + default: + return 0; + break; } - status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, - kEventParamDirectObject, - typeHICommand, NULL, - sizeof(command), NULL, - &command); + status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, kEventParamDirectObject, + typeHICommand, NULL, sizeof(command), NULL, &command); if (status == noErr && (command.attributes & kHICommandFromMenu)) { if (eventPtr->eKind == kEventCommandProcess) { - status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, - kEventParamMenuContext, - typeUInt32, NULL, - sizeof(menuContext), NULL, - &menuContext); + status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, + kEventParamMenuContext, typeUInt32, NULL, + sizeof(menuContext), NULL, &menuContext); if (status == noErr && (menuContext & kMenuContextMenuBar) && (menuContext & kMenuContextMenuBarTracking)) { TkMacOSXHandleMenuSelect(GetMenuID(command.menu.menuRef), @@ -212,26 +208,26 @@ TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) GetCurrentEventKeyModifiers() & optionKey); return 1; } - } else { + } else if (command.commandID == kHICommandPreferences + && eventPtr->interp) { Tcl_CmdInfo dummy; - if (command.commandID == kHICommandPreferences && eventPtr->interp) { - if (Tcl_GetCommandInfo(eventPtr->interp, - "::tk::mac::ShowPreferences", &dummy)) { - if (!IsMenuItemEnabled(command.menu.menuRef, - command.menu.menuItemIndex)) { - EnableMenuItem(command.menu.menuRef, - command.menu.menuItemIndex); - } - } else { - if (IsMenuItemEnabled(command.menu.menuRef, - command.menu.menuItemIndex)) { - DisableMenuItem(command.menu.menuRef, - command.menu.menuItemIndex); - } + + if (Tcl_GetCommandInfo(eventPtr->interp, + "::tk::mac::ShowPreferences", &dummy)) { + if (!IsMenuItemEnabled(command.menu.menuRef, + command.menu.menuItemIndex)) { + EnableMenuItem(command.menu.menuRef, + command.menu.menuItemIndex); + } + } else { + if (IsMenuItemEnabled(command.menu.menuRef, + command.menu.menuItemIndex)) { + DisableMenuItem(command.menu.menuRef, + command.menu.menuItemIndex); } - statusPtr->stopProcessing = 1; - return 1; } + statusPtr->stopProcessing = 1; + return 1; } } return 0; @@ -256,17 +252,17 @@ TkMacOSXProcessCommandEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) */ MODULE_SCOPE OSStatus -TkMacOSXReceiveAndProcessEvent() +TkMacOSXReceiveAndProcessEvent(void) { static EventTargetRef targetRef = NULL; EventRef eventRef; OSStatus err; /* - * This is a poll, since we have already counted the events coming - * into this routine, and are guaranteed to have one waiting. + * This is a poll, since we have already counted the events coming into + * this routine, and are guaranteed to have one waiting. */ - + err = ReceiveNextEvent(0, NULL, kEventDurationNoWait, true, &eventRef); if (err == noErr) { if (!targetRef) { @@ -277,11 +273,10 @@ TkMacOSXReceiveAndProcessEvent() TkMacOSXStopTclEventLoopCarbonTimer(); #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG if (err != noErr && err != eventLoopTimedOutErr - && err != eventNotHandledErr - ) { - char buf [256]; - fprintf(stderr, - "RCNE SendEventToEventTarget (%s) failed, %d\n", + && err != eventNotHandledErr) { + char buf[256]; + + ERR_MSG("RCNE SendEventToEventTarget (%s) failed, %d", TkMacOSXCarbonEventToAscii(eventRef, buf), (int)err); } #endif @@ -289,3 +284,11 @@ TkMacOSXReceiveAndProcessEvent() } return err; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXFont.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXFont.c index 87d4c9c..00e88ac 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXFont.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXFont.c @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ /* * tkMacOSXFont.c -- * - * Contains the Macintosh implementation of the platform-independant - * font package interface. This version uses ATSU instead of Quickdraw. + * Contains the Macintosh implementation of the platform-independant font + * package interface. This version uses ATSU instead of Quickdraw. * * Copyright 2002-2004 Benjamin Riefenstahl, Benjamin.Riefenstahl@epost.de * @@ -16,7 +16,6 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * * Todos: * * - Get away from Font Manager and Quickdraw functions as much as possible, @@ -26,16 +25,16 @@ * instead of just assuming that they are the same. * * - Get a second font register going for fonts that are not assigned to a - * font family by the OS. On my system I have 27 fonts of that type, - * Hebrew, Arabic and Hindi fonts that actually come with the system. + * font family by the OS. On my system I have 27 fonts of that type, Hebrew, + * Arabic and Hindi fonts that actually come with the system. * FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont() returns -981 (kFMInvalidFontFamilyErr) - * for these and they are not listed when enumerating families, but they - * are when enumerating fonts directly. The problem that the OS sees may - * be that at least some of them do not contain any Latin characters. Note - * that such fonts can not be used for controls, because controls - * definitely require a family id (this assertion needs testing). + * for these and they are not listed when enumerating families, but they are + * when enumerating fonts directly. The problem that the OS sees may be that + * at least some of them do not contain any Latin characters. Note that such + * fonts can not be used for controls, because controls definitely require a + * family id (this assertion needs testing). * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXFont.c,v 1.21 2006/12/30 23:15:22 cc_benny Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXFont.c,v 1.22 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -46,40 +45,47 @@ #define TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS #endif */ +#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS +#define FDBG DBG_MSG +#else +#define LOG_ON_ERR(...) /* nothing */ +#define FDBG(...) /* nothing */ +#endif /* Define macros only available on Mac OS X 10.3 or later */ #ifndef FixedToInt -#define FixedToInt(a) ((short)(((Fixed)(a) + fixed1/2) >> 16)) +#define FixedToInt(a) ((short)(((Fixed)(a) + fixed1/2) >> 16)) #endif #ifndef IntToFixed -#define IntToFixed(a) ((Fixed)(a) << 16) +#define IntToFixed(a) ((Fixed)(a) << 16) #endif /* - * Problem: The sum of two parts is not the same as the whole. In particular + * Problem: The sum of two parts is not the same as the whole. In particular * the width of two separately measured strings will usually be larger than - * the width of them pasted together. Tk has a design bug here, because it - * generally assumes that this kind of arithmetic works. - * To workaround this, #define TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE to 1 below, we then avoid - * lines that tremble and shiver while the cursor passes through them by - * undercutting the system and behind the scenes pasting strings together that - * look like they are on the same line and adjacent and that are drawn with - * the same font. To do this we need some global data. + * the width of them pasted together. Tk has a design bug here, because it + * generally assumes that this kind of arithmetic works. To workaround this, + * #define TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE to 1 below, we then avoid lines that tremble + * and shiver while the cursor passes through them by undercutting the system + * and behind the scenes pasting strings together that look like they are on + * the same line and adjacent and that are drawn with the same font. To do + * this we need some global data. */ + #define TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE 0 typedef TkMacOSXFont MacFont; typedef TkMacOSXFontDrawingContext DrawingContext; /* - * Information about font families, initialized at startup time. Font - * families are described by a mapping from UTF-8 names to MacOS font family - * IDs. The whole list is kept as the sorted array "familyList", allocated - * with ckrealloc(). + * Information about font families, initialized at startup time. Font families + * are described by a mapping from UTF-8 names to MacOS font family IDs. The + * whole list is kept as the sorted array "familyList", allocated with + * ckrealloc(). * * Note: This would have been easier, if we could just have used Tcl hash - * arrays. Unfortunately there seems to be no pre-packaged - * non-case-sensitive version of that available. + * arrays. Unfortunately there seems to be no pre-packaged non-case-sensitive + * version of that available. */ typedef struct { @@ -89,43 +95,42 @@ typedef struct { static MacFontFamily * familyList = NULL; static int - familyListNextFree = 0, /* The next free slot in familyList. */ - familyListMaxValid = 0, /* The top of the sorted area. */ - familyListSize = 0; /* The size of the whole array. */ + familyListNextFree = 0, /* The next free slot in familyList. */ + familyListMaxValid = 0, /* The top of the sorted area. */ + familyListSize = 0; /* The size of the whole array. */ /* * A simple one-shot sub-allocator for fast and efficient allocation of - * strings. Used by the familyList array for the names. These strings are - * only allocated once at startup and never freed. If you ever need to + * strings. Used by the familyList array for the names. These strings are only + * allocated once at startup and never freed. If you ever need to * re-initialize this, you can just ckfree() all the StringBlocks in the list * and start over. */ -#define STRING_BLOCK_MAX (1024-8) /* Make sizeof(StringBlock) == - * 1024. */ +#define STRING_BLOCK_MAX (1024-8) /* Make sizeof(StringBlock) == + * 1024. */ typedef struct StringBlock { - struct StringBlock * next; /* Starting from "stringMemory" these - * blocks form a linked list. */ - int nextFree; /* Top of the used area in the - * "strings" member. */ - char strings[STRING_BLOCK_MAX]; /* The actual memory managed here. */ + struct StringBlock *next; /* Starting from "stringMemory" these + * blocks form a linked list. */ + int nextFree; /* Top of the used area in the + * "strings" member. */ + char strings[STRING_BLOCK_MAX]; /* The actual memory managed here. */ } StringBlock; -static StringBlock * stringMemory = NULL; - +static StringBlock *stringMemory = NULL; #if TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE -static Tcl_DString currentLine; /* The current line as seen so far. This - * contains a Tcl_UniChar DString. */ +static Tcl_DString currentLine; /* The current line as seen so far. This + * contains a Tcl_UniChar DString. */ static int - currentY = -1, /* The Y position (row in pixels) of the - * current line. */ - currentLeft = -1, /* The left edge (pixels) of the current - * line. */ - currentRight = -1; /* The right edge (pixels) of the current - * line. */ -static const MacFont * currentFontPtr = NULL; - /* The font of the current line. */ + currentY = -1, /* The Y position (row in pixels) of the + * current line. */ + currentLeft = -1, /* The left edge (pixels) of the current + * line. */ + currentRight = -1; /* The right edge (pixels) of the current + * line. */ +static const MacFont *currentFontPtr = NULL; + /* The font of the current line. */ #endif /* TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE */ static int antialiasedTextEnabled; @@ -135,7 +140,7 @@ static int antialiasedTextEnabled; */ #define SYSTEMFONT_NAME "system" -#define APPLFONT_NAME "application" +#define APPLFONT_NAME "application" /* * Procedures used only in this file. @@ -145,104 +150,88 @@ static int antialiasedTextEnabled; * The actual workers. */ -static void MacFontDrawText( - const MacFont * fontPtr, - const char * source, int numBytes, - int rangeStart, int rangeLength, - int x, int y); -static int MeasureStringWidth( - const MacFont * fontPtr, - int start, int end); - +static void MacFontDrawText(const MacFont *fontPtr, + const char * source, int numBytes, int rangeStart, + int rangeLength, int x, int y); +static int MeasureStringWidth(const MacFont *fontPtr, + int start, int end); #if TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE -static const Tcl_UniChar * UpdateLineBuffer( - const MacFont * fontPtr, - const DrawingContext * drawingContextPtr, - const char * source, int numBytes, - int x, int y, - int * offset); +static const Tcl_UniChar* UpdateLineBuffer(const MacFont * fontPtr, + const DrawingContext *drawingContextPtr, + const char *source, int numBytes, int x, int y, + int *offset); #endif /* TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE */ /* * Initialization and setup of a font data structure. */ -static void InitFont( - Tk_Window tkwin, - FMFontFamily familyId, const char * familyName, - int size, int qdStyle, MacFont * fontPtr); -static void InitATSUObjects( - FMFontFamily familyId, - short qdsize, short qdStyle, - ATSUFontID * fontIdPtr, - ATSUTextLayout * layoutPtr, ATSUStyle * stylePtr); -static void InitATSUStyle( - ATSUFontID fontId, short ptSize, short qdStyle, - ATSUStyle style); -static void SetFontFeatures( - ATSUFontID fontId, int fixed, - ATSUStyle style); -static void AdjustFontHeight( - MacFont * fontPtr); -static void InitATSULayout( - const DrawingContext * drawingContextPtr, - ATSUTextLayout layout, int fixed); -static void ReleaseFont( - MacFont * fontPtr); +static void InitFont(Tk_Window tkwin, FMFontFamily familyId, + const char * familyName, int size, int qdStyle, + MacFont * fontPtr); +static void InitATSUObjects(FMFontFamily familyId, short qdsize, + short qdStyle, ATSUFontID * fontIdPtr, + ATSUTextLayout *layoutPtr, ATSUStyle *stylePtr); +static void InitATSUStyle(ATSUFontID fontId, short ptSize, + short qdStyle, ATSUStyle style); +static void SetFontFeatures(ATSUFontID fontId, int fixed, + ATSUStyle style); +static void AdjustFontHeight(MacFont *fontPtr); +static void InitATSULayout(const DrawingContext*drawingContextPtr, + ATSUTextLayout layout, int fixed); +static void ReleaseFont(MacFont *fontPtr); /* * Finding fonts by name. */ -static const MacFontFamily * FindFontFamilyOrAlias( - const char * name); -static const MacFontFamily * FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback( - const char * name); +static const MacFontFamily* FindFontFamilyOrAlias(const char *name); +static const MacFontFamily* FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback(const char*name); /* * Doing interesting things with font families and fonts. */ -static void InitFontFamilies(void); -static OSStatus GetFontFamilyName( - FMFontFamily fontFamily, char * name, int numBytes); +static void InitFontFamilies(void); +static OSStatus GetFontFamilyName(FMFontFamily fontFamily, char *name, + int numBytes); /* * Accessor functions and internal utilities for the font family list. */ -static const MacFontFamily * AddFontFamily( - const char * name, FMFontFamily familyId); +static const MacFontFamily * AddFontFamily(const char *name, + FMFontFamily familyId); static const MacFontFamily * FindFontFamily(const char * name); -static Tcl_Obj * EnumFontFamilies(void); - -static OSStatus FontFamilyEnumCallback(ATSFontFamilyRef family, void *refCon); -static void SortFontFamilies(void); -static int CompareFontFamilies(const void * vp1, const void * vp2); -static const char * AddString(const char * in); +static Tcl_Obj * EnumFontFamilies(void); +static OSStatus FontFamilyEnumCallback(ATSFontFamilyRef family, + void *refCon); +static void SortFontFamilies(void); +static int CompareFontFamilies(const void *vp1, const void *vp2); +static const char * AddString(const char *in); /* *------------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpFontPkgInit -- * - * This procedure is called when an application is created. It - * initializes all the structures that are used by the - * platform-dependant code on a per application basis. + * This procedure is called when an application is created. It + * initializes all the structures that are used by the platform-dependant + * code on a per application basis. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Initialization of variables local to this file. + * Initialization of variables local to this file. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpFontPkgInit( - TkMainInfo * mainPtr) /* The application being created. */ + TkMainInfo *mainPtr) /* The application being created. */ { InitFontFamilies(); @@ -250,10 +239,7 @@ TkpFontPkgInit( Tcl_DStringInit(¤tLine); #endif -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "tkMacOSXFont.c (ATSU version) intialized " - "(" __TIME__ ")\n"); -#endif + FDBG("tkMacOSXFont.c (ATSU version) intialized (" __TIME__ ")"); } /* @@ -261,41 +247,41 @@ TkpFontPkgInit( * * TkpGetNativeFont -- * - * Map a platform-specific native font name to a TkFont. + * Map a platform-specific native font name to a TkFont. * * Results: - * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the - * native font. If a native font by the given name could not be - * found, the return value is NULL. + * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the native + * font. If a native font by the given name could not be found, the + * return value is NULL. * - * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, even - * if the name has already been seen before. The caller should call - * TkpDeleteFont() when the font is no longer needed. + * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, even if + * the name has already been seen before. The caller should call + * TkpDeleteFont() when the font is no longer needed. * - * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated - * with the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing - * the contents of the generics TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). + * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated with + * the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing the + * contents of the generics TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ TkFont * TkpGetNativeFont( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ - const char * name) /* Platform-specific font name. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ + const char * name) /* Platform-specific font name. */ { FMFontFamily familyId; MacFont * fontPtr; if (strcmp(name, SYSTEMFONT_NAME) == 0) { - familyId = GetSysFont(); + familyId = GetSysFont(); } else if (strcmp(name, APPLFONT_NAME) == 0) { - familyId = GetAppFont(); + familyId = GetAppFont(); } else { - return NULL; + return NULL; } fontPtr = (MacFont *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacFont)); @@ -309,74 +295,74 @@ TkpGetNativeFont( * * TkpGetFontFromAttributes -- * - * Given a desired set of attributes for a font, find a font with the - * closest matching attributes. + * Given a desired set of attributes for a font, find a font with the + * closest matching attributes. * * Results: - * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the font - * with the desired attributes. If a font with the desired attributes - * could not be constructed, some other font will be substituted - * automatically. + * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the font + * with the desired attributes. If a font with the desired attributes + * could not be constructed, some other font will be substituted + * automatically. * - * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, even - * if the specified attributes have already been seen before. The - * caller should call TkpDeleteFont() to free the platform- specific - * data when the font is no longer needed. + * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, even if + * the specified attributes have already been seen before. The caller + * should call TkpDeleteFont() to free the platform-specific data when + * the font is no longer needed. * - * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated - * with the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing - * the contents of the generic TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). + * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated with + * the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing the + * contents of the generic TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ TkFont * TkpGetFontFromAttributes( - TkFont * tkFontPtr, /* If non-NULL, store the information in this - * existing TkFont structure, rather than - * allocating a new structure to hold the font; - * the existing contents of the font will be - * released. If NULL, a new TkFont structure is - * allocated. */ - Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ - const TkFontAttributes * faPtr) - /* Set of attributes to match. */ + TkFont *tkFontPtr, /* If non-NULL, store the information in this + * existing TkFont structure, rather than + * allocating a new structure to hold the + * font; the existing contents of the font + * will be released. If NULL, a new TkFont + * structure is allocated. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ + const TkFontAttributes *faPtr) + /* Set of attributes to match. */ { short qdStyle; FMFontFamily familyId; - const char * name; - const MacFontFamily * familyPtr; - MacFont * fontPtr; + const char *name; + const MacFontFamily *familyPtr; + MacFont *fontPtr; familyId = GetAppFont(); name = NULL; qdStyle = 0; if (faPtr->family != NULL) { - familyPtr = FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback(faPtr->family); - if (familyPtr != NULL) { - name = familyPtr->name; - familyId = familyPtr->familyId; - } + familyPtr = FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback(faPtr->family); + if (familyPtr != NULL) { + name = familyPtr->name; + familyId = familyPtr->familyId; + } } if (faPtr->weight != TK_FW_NORMAL) { - qdStyle |= bold; + qdStyle |= bold; } if (faPtr->slant != TK_FS_ROMAN) { - qdStyle |= italic; + qdStyle |= italic; } if (faPtr->underline) { - qdStyle |= underline; + qdStyle |= underline; } if (tkFontPtr == NULL) { - fontPtr = (MacFont *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacFont)); + fontPtr = (MacFont *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacFont)); } else { - fontPtr = (MacFont *) tkFontPtr; - ReleaseFont(fontPtr); + fontPtr = (MacFont *) tkFontPtr; + ReleaseFont(fontPtr); } InitFont(tkwin, familyId, name, faPtr->size, qdStyle, fontPtr); @@ -388,23 +374,23 @@ TkpGetFontFromAttributes( * * TkpDeleteFont -- * - * Called to release a font allocated by TkpGetNativeFont() or - * TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). The caller should have already - * released the fields of the TkFont that are used exclusively by the - * generic TkFont code. + * Called to release a font allocated by TkpGetNativeFont() or + * TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). The caller should have already released + * the fields of the TkFont that are used exclusively by the generic + * TkFont code. * * Results: - * TkFont is deallocated. + * TkFont is deallocated. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpDeleteFont( - TkFont * tkFontPtr) /* Token of font to be deleted. */ + TkFont *tkFontPtr) /* Token of font to be deleted. */ { ReleaseFont((MacFont *) tkFontPtr); } @@ -414,23 +400,23 @@ TkpDeleteFont( * * TkpGetFontFamilies -- * - * Return information about the font families that are available on - * the display of the given window. + * Return information about the font families that are available on the + * display of the given window. * * Results: - * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list of all the available - * font families. + * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list of all the available + * font families. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpGetFontFamilies( - Tcl_Interp * interp, /* Interp to hold result. */ - Tk_Window tkwin) /* For display to query. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interp to hold result. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* For display to query. */ { Tcl_SetObjResult(interp,EnumFontFamilies()); } @@ -440,28 +426,30 @@ TkpGetFontFamilies( * * TkpGetSubFonts -- * - * A function used by the testing package for querying the actual - * screen fonts that make up a font object. + * A function used by the testing package for querying the actual screen + * fonts that make up a font object. * * Results: - * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list containing the names - * of the screen fonts that make up the given font object. + * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list containing the names of + * the screen fonts that make up the given font object. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpGetSubFonts( - Tcl_Interp * interp, /* Interp to hold result. */ - Tk_Font tkfont) /* Font object to query. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interp to hold result. */ + Tk_Font tkfont) /* Font object to query. */ { - /* We don't know much about our fallback fonts, ATSU does all that for - * us. We could use ATSUMatchFont to implement this function. But as - * the information is only used for testing, such an effort seems not - * very useful. */ + /* + * We don't know much about our fallback fonts, ATSU does all that for us. + * We could use ATSUMatchFont to implement this function. But as the + * information is only used for testing, such an effort seems not very + * useful. + */ } /* @@ -469,24 +457,24 @@ TkpGetSubFonts( * * TkpGetFontAttrsForChar -- * - * Retrieve the font attributes of the actual font used to render a - * given character. + * Retrieve the font attributes of the actual font used to render a given + * character. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The font attributes are stored in *faPtr. + * The font attributes are stored in *faPtr. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpGetFontAttrsForChar( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window on the font's display */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font to query */ - Tcl_UniChar c, /* Character of interest */ - TkFontAttributes* faPtr) /* Output: Font attributes */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window on the font's display */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font to query */ + Tcl_UniChar c, /* Character of interest */ + TkFontAttributes* faPtr) /* Output: Font attributes */ { TkMacOSXFont* fontPtr = (TkMacOSXFont*) tkfont; UniChar uchar = c; @@ -497,8 +485,8 @@ TkpGetFontAttrsForChar( UniCharCount changedLength; /* - * Most of the attributes are just copied from the base font. This - * assumes that all fonts can have all attributes. + * Most of the attributes are just copied from the base font. This assumes + * that all fonts can have all attributes. */ *faPtr = fontPtr->font.fa; @@ -515,57 +503,46 @@ TkpGetFontAttrsForChar( TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, &uchar, 1); fontId = fontPtr->atsuFontId; - err = ATSUMatchFontsToText( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, 0, 1, - &fontId, &changedOffset, &changedLength); + err = ATSUMatchFontsToText(fontPtr->atsuLayout, 0, 1, + &fontId, &changedOffset, &changedLength); #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS if (err != kATSUFontsMatched && err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "TkpGetFontAttrsForChar: " - "Can't match \\u%04X\n", - (unsigned) c); + FDBG("TkpGetFontAttrsForChar: Can't match \\u%04X", (unsigned) c); } #endif if (err == kATSUFontsMatched) { - - /* - * A fallback was used and the actual font is in fontId. Determine - * the name. - */ - - FMFontFamily fontFamilyId; - FMFontStyle fontStyle; - int i; - - err = FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont( - fontId, &fontFamilyId, &fontStyle); + /* + * A fallback was used and the actual font is in fontId. Determine the + * name. + */ + + FMFontFamily fontFamilyId; + FMFontStyle fontStyle; + int i; + + err = FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont(fontId, &fontFamilyId, + &fontStyle); + LOG_ON_ERR(FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont); + + if (err == noErr) { + /* + * Find the canonical name in our global list. + */ + + for (i=0; ifamily = familyList[i].name; + break; + } + } #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont: Error %d\n", - (int) err); - } + if (i >= familyListMaxValid) { + FDBG("TkpGetFontAttrsForChar: Can't find font %d for \\u%04X", + (int) fontFamilyId, (unsigned) c); + } #endif - - if (err == noErr) { - - /* - * Find the canonical name in our global list. - */ - - for (i=0; ifamily = familyList[i].name; - break; - } - } -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (i >= familyListMaxValid) { - fprintf(stderr, "TkpGetFontAttrsForChar: " - "Can't find font %d for \\u%04X\n", - (int) fontFamilyId, (unsigned) c); - } -#endif - } + } } #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ @@ -576,133 +553,124 @@ TkpGetFontAttrsForChar( /* *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * Tk_MeasureChars -- + * Tk_MeasureChars -- * - * Determine the number of characters from the string that will fit in - * the given horizontal span. The measurement is done under the - * assumption that Tk_DrawChars() will be used to actually display the - * characters. + * Determine the number of characters from the string that will fit in + * the given horizontal span. The measurement is done under the + * assumption that Tk_DrawChars() will be used to actually display the + * characters. * - * With ATSUI we need the line context to do this right, so we have the - * actual implementation in TkpMeasureCharsInContext(). + * With ATSUI we need the line context to do this right, so we have the + * actual implementation in TkpMeasureCharsInContext(). * * Results: - * - * The return value is the number of bytes from source that fit into the - * span that extends from 0 to maxLength. *lengthPtr is filled with the - * x-coordinate of the right edge of the last character that did fit. + * The return value is the number of bytes from source that fit into the + * span that extends from 0 to maxLength. *lengthPtr is filled with the + * x-coordinate of the right edge of the last character that did fit. * * Side effects: - * - * None. + * None. * * Todo: - * - * Effects of the "flags" parameter are untested. + * Effects of the "flags" parameter are untested. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int Tk_MeasureChars( - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn. */ - const char * source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be - * '\0' terminated. */ - int numBytes, /* Maximum number of bytes to consider from - * source string. */ - int maxLength, /* If >= 0, maxLength specifies the longest - * permissible line length; don't consider any - * character that would cross this x-position. - * If < 0, then line length is unbounded and the - * flags argument is ignored. */ - int flags, /* Various flag bits OR-ed together: - * TK_PARTIAL_OK means include the last char - * which only partially fit on this line. - * TK_WHOLE_WORDS means stop on a word boundary, - * if possible. TK_AT_LEAST_ONE means return at - * least one character even if no characters - * fit. */ - int * lengthPtr) /* Filled with x-location just after the - * terminating character. */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn. */ + const char *source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be + * '\0' terminated. */ + int numBytes, /* Maximum number of bytes to consider from + * source string. */ + int maxLength, /* If >= 0, maxLength specifies the longest + * permissible line length; don't consider any + * character that would cross this x-position. + * If < 0, then line length is unbounded and + * the flags argument is ignored. */ + int flags, /* Various flag bits OR-ed together: + * TK_PARTIAL_OK means include the last char + * which only partially fit on this line. + * TK_WHOLE_WORDS means stop on a word + * boundary, if possible. TK_AT_LEAST_ONE + * means return at least one character even if + * no characters fit. */ + int *lengthPtr) /* Filled with x-location just after the + * terminating character. */ { - return TkpMeasureCharsInContext( - tkfont, source, numBytes, 0, numBytes, maxLength, flags, lengthPtr); + return TkpMeasureCharsInContext(tkfont, source, numBytes, 0, numBytes, + maxLength, flags, lengthPtr); } /* *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * TkpMeasureCharsInContext -- + * TkpMeasureCharsInContext -- * - * Determine the number of bytes from the string that will fit in the - * given horizontal span. The measurement is done under the assumption - * that TkpDrawCharsInContext() will be used to actually display the - * characters. + * Determine the number of bytes from the string that will fit in the + * given horizontal span. The measurement is done under the assumption + * that TkpDrawCharsInContext() will be used to actually display the + * characters. * - * This one is almost the same as Tk_MeasureChars(), but with access to - * all the characters on the line for context. + * This one is almost the same as Tk_MeasureChars(), but with access to + * all the characters on the line for context. * * Results: - * The return value is the number of bytes from source that - * fit into the span that extends from 0 to maxLength. *lengthPtr is - * filled with the x-coordinate of the right edge of the last - * character that did fit. + * The return value is the number of bytes from source that fit into the + * span that extends from 0 to maxLength. *lengthPtr is filled with the + * x-coordinate of the right edge of the last character that did fit. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int TkpMeasureCharsInContext( - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn. */ - const char * source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be - * '\0' terminated. */ - int numBytes, /* Maximum number of bytes to consider from - * source string in all. */ - int rangeStart, /* Index of first byte to measure. */ - int rangeLength, /* Length of range to measure in bytes. */ - int maxLength, /* If >= 0, maxLength specifies the longest - * permissible line length; don't consider any - * character that would cross this x-position. - * If < 0, then line length is unbounded and the - * flags argument is ignored. */ - int flags, /* Various flag bits OR-ed together: - * TK_PARTIAL_OK means include the last char - * which only partially fits on this line. - * TK_WHOLE_WORDS means stop on a word boundary, - * if possible. - * TK_AT_LEAST_ONE means return at least one - * character (or at least the first partial word - * in case TK_WHOLE_WORDS is also set) even if no - * characters (words) fit. - * TK_ISOLATE_END means that the last character - * should not be considered in context with the - * rest of the string (used for breaking - * lines). */ - int * lengthPtr) /* Filled with x-location just after the - * terminating character. */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn. */ + const char * source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be + * '\0' terminated. */ + int numBytes, /* Maximum number of bytes to consider from + * source string in all. */ + int rangeStart, /* Index of first byte to measure. */ + int rangeLength, /* Length of range to measure in bytes. */ + int maxLength, /* If >= 0, maxLength specifies the longest + * permissible line length; don't consider any + * character that would cross this x-position. + * If < 0, then line length is unbounded and + * the flags argument is ignored. */ + int flags, /* Various flag bits OR-ed together: + * TK_PARTIAL_OK means include the last char + * which only partially fits on this line. + * TK_WHOLE_WORDS means stop on a word + * boundary, if possible. TK_AT_LEAST_ONE + * means return at least one character (or at + * least the first partial word in case + * TK_WHOLE_WORDS is also set) even if no + * characters (words) fit. TK_ISOLATE_END + * means that the last character should not be + * considered in context with the rest of the + * string (used for breaking lines). */ + int *lengthPtr) /* Filled with x-location just after the + * terminating character. */ { - const MacFont * fontPtr = (const MacFont *) tkfont; - int curX = -1; - int curByte = 0; - UniChar * uchars; + const MacFont *fontPtr = (const MacFont *) tkfont; + int curX = -1, curByte = 0; + UniChar *uchars; int ulen, urstart, urlen, urend; Tcl_DString ucharBuffer; DrawingContext drawingContext; - /* * Sanity checks. */ if ((rangeStart < 0) || ((rangeStart+rangeLength) > numBytes)) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "MeasureChars: bad parameters\n"); -#endif - *lengthPtr = 0; - return 0; + FDBG("MeasureChars: bad parameters"); + *lengthPtr = 0; + return 0; } /* @@ -711,13 +679,11 @@ TkpMeasureCharsInContext( if (rangeLength == 0 || (maxLength == 0 && !(flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE))) { #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fflush(stdout); - fprintf(stderr, "measure: '%.*s', empty\n", - rangeLength, source+rangeStart); - fflush(stderr); + fflush(stdout); #endif - *lengthPtr = 0; - return 0; + FDBG("measure: '%.*s', empty", rangeLength, source+rangeStart); + *lengthPtr = 0; + return 0; } #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ @@ -734,242 +700,217 @@ TkpMeasureCharsInContext( urend = urstart + urlen; if (maxLength < 0) { - - curX = MeasureStringWidth(fontPtr, urstart, urend); - curByte = rangeLength; - + curX = MeasureStringWidth(fontPtr, urstart, urend); + curByte = rangeLength; } else { - - UniCharArrayOffset offset = 0; - OSStatus err; - - /* - * Have some upper limit on the size actually used. - */ - - if (maxLength > 32767) { - maxLength = 32767; - } - - offset = urstart; - err = noErr; - - if (maxLength > 1) { - - /* - * Let the system do some work by calculating a line break. - * - * Somehow ATSUBreakLine seems to assume that it needs at least - * one pixel padding. So we add one to the limit. Note also - * that ATSUBreakLine sometimes runs into an endless loop when - * the third parameter is equal or less than IntToFixed(2), so we - * need at least IntToFixed(3) (at least that's the current state - * of my knowledge). - */ - - err = ATSUBreakLine( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, - urstart, - IntToFixed(maxLength+1), - false, /* !iUseAsSoftLineBreak */ - &offset); - - /* - * There is no way to signal an error from this routine, so we - * use predefined offset=urstart and otherwise ignore the - * possibility. - */ + UniCharArrayOffset offset = 0; + OSStatus err; + + /* + * Have some upper limit on the size actually used. + */ + + if (maxLength > 32767) { + maxLength = 32767; + } + + offset = urstart; + err = noErr; + + if (maxLength > 1) { + /* + * Let the system do some work by calculating a line break. + * + * Somehow ATSUBreakLine seems to assume that it needs at least + * one pixel padding. So we add one to the limit. Note also that + * ATSUBreakLine sometimes runs into an endless loop when the + * third parameter is equal or less than IntToFixed(2), so we need + * at least IntToFixed(3) (at least that's the current state of my + * knowledge). + */ + + err = ATSUBreakLine(fontPtr->atsuLayout, urstart, + IntToFixed(maxLength+1), false, /* !iUseAsSoftLineBreak */ + &offset); + + /* + * There is no way to signal an error from this routine, so we use + * predefined offset=urstart and otherwise ignore the possibility. + */ #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if ((err != noErr) && (err != kATSULineBreakInWord)) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUBreakLine(): Error %d for '%.*s'\n", - (int) err, rangeLength, source+rangeStart); - } + if ((err != noErr) && (err != kATSULineBreakInWord)) { + FDBG("ATSUBreakLine(): Error %d for '%.*s'", + (int) err, rangeLength, source+rangeStart); + } #endif -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "measure: '%.*s', break offset=%d, errcode=%d\n", - rangeLength, source+rangeStart, (int) offset, (int) err); -#endif - - /* - * ATSUBreakLine includes the whitespace that separates words, - * but we don't want that. Besides, ATSUBreakLine thinks that - * spaces don't occupy pixels at the end of the break, which is - * also something we like to decide for ourself. - */ - - while ((offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) && (uchars[offset-1] == ' ')) { - offset--; - } - - /* - * Fix up left-overs for the TK_WHOLE_WORDS case. - */ - - if (flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS) { - if(flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) { - - /* - * If we are the the start of the range, we need to look - * forward. If we are not at the end of a word, we must - * be in the middle of the first word, so we also look - * forward. - */ - - if ((offset == (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) || (uchars[offset] != ' ')) { - while ((offset < (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) - && (uchars[offset] != ' ')) { - offset++; - } - } - } else { - - /* - * If we are not at the end of a word, we need to look - * backward. - */ - - if ((offset != (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) && (uchars[offset] != ' ')) { - while ((offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) - && (uchars[offset-1] != ' ')) { - offset--; - } - while ((offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) - && (uchars[offset-1] == ' ')) { - offset--; - } - } - } - } - } - - if (offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) { - offset = urend; - } - - /* - * If "flags" says that we don't actually want a word break, we need - * to find the next character break ourself, as ATSUBreakLine() will - * only give us word breaks. Do a simple linear search. - */ - - if ((err != kATSULineBreakInWord) - && !(flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS) - && (offset <= (UniCharArrayOffset)urend)) { - - UniCharArrayOffset lastOffset = offset; - UniCharArrayOffset nextoffset; - int lastX = -1; - int wantonemorechar = -1; /* undecided */ - - while (offset <= (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) { - - if (flags & TK_ISOLATE_END) { - TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, - uchars, offset); - } - curX = MeasureStringWidth(fontPtr, urstart, offset); - -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "measure: '%.*s', try until=%d, width=%d\n", - rangeLength, source+rangeStart, (int) offset, curX); -#endif - - if (curX > maxLength) { - - /* - * Even if we are over the limit, we may want another - * character in some situations. Than we keep looking - * for one more character. - */ - - if (wantonemorechar == -1) { - wantonemorechar = - ((flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) - && (lastOffset == (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart)) - || - ((flags & TK_PARTIAL_OK) - && (lastX != maxLength)) - ; - if (!wantonemorechar) { - break; - } - lastX = curX; - } - - /* - * There may belong combining marks to this character. - * Wait for a new curX to collect them all. - */ - - if (lastX != curX) { - break; - } - } - - /* - * Save this position, so we can come back to it. - */ - - lastX = curX; - lastOffset = offset; - - /* - * Increment offset by one character, taking combining marks - * into account. - */ - - if (offset >= (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) { - break; - } - nextoffset = 0; - if (flags & TK_ISOLATE_END) { - TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, - uchars, ulen); - } - err = ATSUNextCursorPosition( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, - offset, - kATSUByCluster, - &nextoffset); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUNextCursorPosition(): " - "Error %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - break; - } - if (nextoffset <= offset) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUNextCursorPosition(): " - "Can't move further " - "(shouldn't happen, bad data?)\n"); -#endif - break; - } - - offset = nextoffset; - } - - /* - * We have overshot one character, so backup one position. - */ - - curX = lastX; - offset = lastOffset; - } - - if (curX < 0) { - if (flags & TK_ISOLATE_END) { - TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, - uchars, offset); - } - curX = MeasureStringWidth(fontPtr, urstart, offset); - } - - curByte = Tcl_UtfAtIndex(source, offset) - source; - curByte -= rangeStart; + FDBG("measure: '%.*s', break offset=%d, errcode=%d", + rangeLength, source+rangeStart, (int) offset, (int) err); + + /* + * ATSUBreakLine includes the whitespace that separates words, but + * we don't want that. Besides, ATSUBreakLine thinks that spaces + * don't occupy pixels at the end of the break, which is also + * something we like to decide for ourself. + */ + + while ((offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) + && (uchars[offset-1] == ' ')) { + offset--; + } + + /* + * Fix up left-overs for the TK_WHOLE_WORDS case. + */ + + if (flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS) { + if (flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) { + /* + * If we are the the start of the range, we need to look + * forward. If we are not at the end of a word, we must be + * in the middle of the first word, so we also look + * forward. + */ + + if ((offset == (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) + || (uchars[offset] != ' ')) { + while ((offset < (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) + && (uchars[offset] != ' ')) { + offset++; + } + } + } else { + /* + * If we are not at the end of a word, we need to look + * backward. + */ + + if ((offset != (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) + && (uchars[offset] != ' ')) { + while ((offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) + && (uchars[offset-1] != ' ')) { + offset--; + } + while ((offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart) + && (uchars[offset-1] == ' ')) { + offset--; + } + } + } + } + } + + if (offset > (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) { + offset = urend; + } + + /* + * If "flags" says that we don't actually want a word break, we need + * to find the next character break ourself, as ATSUBreakLine() will + * only give us word breaks. Do a simple linear search. + */ + + if ((err != kATSULineBreakInWord) + && !(flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS) + && (offset <= (UniCharArrayOffset)urend)) { + UniCharArrayOffset lastOffset = offset; + UniCharArrayOffset nextoffset; + int lastX = -1; + int wantonemorechar = -1; /* undecided */ + + while (offset <= (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) { + if (flags & TK_ISOLATE_END) { + TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, + uchars, offset); + } + curX = MeasureStringWidth(fontPtr, urstart, offset); + + FDBG("measure: '%.*s', try until=%d, width=%d", + rangeLength, source+rangeStart, (int) offset, curX); + + if (curX > maxLength) { + /* + * Even if we are over the limit, we may want another + * character in some situations. Than we keep looking for + * one more character. + */ + + if (wantonemorechar == -1) { + wantonemorechar = + ((flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) + && (lastOffset == (UniCharArrayOffset)urstart)) + || ((flags & TK_PARTIAL_OK) + && (lastX != maxLength)); + if (!wantonemorechar) { + break; + } + lastX = curX; + } + + /* + * There may belong combining marks to this character. + * Wait for a new curX to collect them all. + */ + + if (lastX != curX) { + break; + } + } + + /* + * Save this position, so we can come back to it. + */ + + lastX = curX; + lastOffset = offset; + + /* + * Increment offset by one character, taking combining marks + * into account. + */ + + if (offset >= (UniCharArrayOffset)urend) { + break; + } + nextoffset = 0; + if (flags & TK_ISOLATE_END) { + TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, + uchars, ulen); + } + err = ATSUNextCursorPosition(fontPtr->atsuLayout, offset, + kATSUByCluster, &nextoffset); + if (err != noErr) { + FDBG("ATSUNextCursorPosition(): Error %d", (int) err); + break; + } + if (nextoffset <= offset) { + FDBG("ATSUNextCursorPosition(): Can't move further " + "(shouldn't happen, bad data?)"); + break; + } + + offset = nextoffset; + } + + /* + * We have overshot one character, so backup one position. + */ + + curX = lastX; + offset = lastOffset; + } + + if (curX < 0) { + if (flags & TK_ISOLATE_END) { + TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, + uchars, offset); + } + curX = MeasureStringWidth(fontPtr, urstart, offset); + } + + curByte = Tcl_UtfAtIndex(source, offset) - source; + curByte -= rangeStart; } Tcl_DStringFree(&ucharBuffer); @@ -980,13 +921,12 @@ TkpMeasureCharsInContext( #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS fflush(stdout); - fprintf(stderr, "measure: '%.*s', maxpix=%d, -> width=%d, bytes=%d, " - "flags=%s%s%s%s\n", - rangeLength, source+rangeStart, maxLength, curX, curByte, - flags & TK_PARTIAL_OK ? "partialOk " : "", - flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS ? "wholeWords " : "", - flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE ? "atLeastOne " : "", - flags & TK_ISOLATE_END ? "isolateEnd " : ""); + FDBG("measure: '%.*s', maxpix=%d, -> width=%d, bytes=%d, flags=%s%s%s%s", + rangeLength, source+rangeStart, maxLength, curX, curByte, + flags & TK_PARTIAL_OK ? "partialOk " : "", + flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS ? "wholeWords " : "", + flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE ? "atLeastOne " : "", + flags & TK_ISOLATE_END ? "isolateEnd " : ""); fflush(stderr); #endif @@ -999,42 +939,40 @@ TkpMeasureCharsInContext( * * Tk_DrawChars -- * - * Draw a string of characters on the screen. + * Draw a string of characters on the screen. * - * With ATSUI we need the line context to do this right, so we have the - * actual implementation in TkpDrawCharsInContext(). + * With ATSUI we need the line context to do this right, so we have the + * actual implementation in TkpDrawCharsInContext(). * * Results: - * - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * - * Information gets drawn on the screen. + * Information gets drawn on the screen. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void Tk_DrawChars( - Display * display, /* Display on which to draw. */ - Drawable drawable, /* Window or pixmap in which to draw. */ - GC gc, /* Graphics context for drawing characters. */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn; must - * be the same as font used in GC. */ - const char * source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be - * '\0' terminated. All Tk meta-characters - * (tabs, control characters, and newlines) - * should be stripped out of the string that is - * passed to this function. If they are not - * stripped out, they will be displayed as - * regular printing characters. */ - int numBytes, /* Number of bytes in string. */ - int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of the - * string when drawing. */ + Display *display, /* Display on which to draw. */ + Drawable drawable, /* Window or pixmap in which to draw. */ + GC gc, /* Graphics context for drawing characters. */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn; must + * be the same as font used in GC. */ + const char *source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be + * '\0' terminated. All Tk meta-characters + * (tabs, control characters, and newlines) + * should be stripped out of the string that + * is passed to this function. If they are not + * stripped out, they will be displayed as + * regular printing characters. */ + int numBytes, /* Number of bytes in string. */ + int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of the + * string when drawing. */ { TkpDrawCharsInContext(display, drawable, gc, tkfont, source, numBytes, - 0, numBytes, x, y); + 0, numBytes, x, y); } @@ -1043,46 +981,45 @@ Tk_DrawChars( * * TkpDrawCharsInContext -- * - * Draw a string of characters on the screen like Tk_DrawChars(), with - * access to all the characters on the line for context. + * Draw a string of characters on the screen like Tk_DrawChars(), with + * access to all the characters on the line for context. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Information gets drawn on the screen. + * Information gets drawn on the screen. * * Todo: + * We could try to implement a correct stipple algorithm. * - * We could try to implement a correct stipple algorithm. - * - * The fiddling with QD GraphPorts can be replaced with just working - * with the Quarz CGContext (see TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw()), once we - * decide to stick to Quarz and really forget about QD drawing in here. + * The fiddling with QD GraphPorts can be replaced with just working with + * the Quarz CGContext (see TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw()), once we decide to + * stick to Quarz and really forget about QD drawing in here. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpDrawCharsInContext( - Display * display, /* Display on which to draw. */ - Drawable drawable, /* Window or pixmap in which to draw. */ - GC gc, /* Graphics context for drawing characters. */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn; must - * be the same as font used in GC. */ - const char * source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be - * '\0' terminated. All Tk meta-characters - * (tabs, control characters, and newlines) - * should be stripped out of the string that is - * passed to this function. If they are not - * stripped out, they will be displayed as - * regular printing characters. */ - int numBytes, /* Number of bytes in string. */ - int rangeStart, /* Index of first byte to draw. */ - int rangeLength, /* Length of range to draw in bytes. */ - int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of the - * whole (not just the range) string when - * drawing. */ + Display *display, /* Display on which to draw. */ + Drawable drawable, /* Window or pixmap in which to draw. */ + GC gc, /* Graphics context for drawing characters. */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn; must + * be the same as font used in GC. */ + const char * source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be + * '\0' terminated. All Tk meta-characters + * (tabs, control characters, and newlines) + * should be stripped out of the string that + * is passed to this function. If they are not + * stripped out, they will be displayed as + * regular printing characters. */ + int numBytes, /* Number of bytes in string. */ + int rangeStart, /* Index of first byte to draw. */ + int rangeLength, /* Length of range to draw in bytes. */ + int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of the + * whole (not just the range) string when + * drawing. */ { const MacFont * fontPtr; MacDrawable * macWin; @@ -1107,54 +1044,52 @@ TkpDrawCharsInContext( GetForeColor(&origColor); if ((gc->fill_style == FillStippled - || gc->fill_style == FillOpaqueStippled) - && gc->stipple != None) { - - Pixmap pixmap; - GWorldPtr bufferPort; - Pattern white; - - stippleMap = TkMacOSXMakeStippleMap(drawable, gc->stipple); - - pixmap = Tk_GetPixmap(display, drawable, - stippleMap->bounds.right, stippleMap->bounds.bottom, 0); - - bufferPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(pixmap); - SetGWorld(bufferPort, NULL); - - if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &macColor)) { - RGBForeColor(&macColor); - } - GetQDGlobalsWhite(&white); - ShowPen(); - FillRect(&stippleMap->bounds, &white); - MacFontDrawText(fontPtr, source, numBytes, rangeStart, rangeLength, - 0, 0); - HidePen(); - - SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); - - CopyDeepMask(GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(bufferPort), stippleMap, - GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(destPort), &stippleMap->bounds, - &stippleMap->bounds, &portRect, - srcOr, NULL); - - /* - * TODO: this doesn't work quite right - it does a blend. you can't - * draw white text when you have a stipple. - */ - - Tk_FreePixmap(display, pixmap); - ckfree(stippleMap->baseAddr); - ckfree((char *)stippleMap); + || gc->fill_style == FillOpaqueStippled) + && gc->stipple != None) { + Pixmap pixmap; + GWorldPtr bufferPort; + Pattern white; + + stippleMap = TkMacOSXMakeStippleMap(drawable, gc->stipple); + + pixmap = Tk_GetPixmap(display, drawable, + stippleMap->bounds.right, stippleMap->bounds.bottom, 0); + + bufferPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(pixmap); + SetGWorld(bufferPort, NULL); + + if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &macColor)) { + RGBForeColor(&macColor); + } + GetQDGlobalsWhite(&white); + ShowPen(); + FillRect(&stippleMap->bounds, &white); + MacFontDrawText(fontPtr, source, numBytes, rangeStart, rangeLength, + 0, 0); + HidePen(); + + SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); + + CopyDeepMask(GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(bufferPort), stippleMap, + GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(destPort), &stippleMap->bounds, + &stippleMap->bounds, &portRect, srcOr, NULL); + + /* + * TODO: this doesn't work quite right - it does a blend. You can't + * draw white text when you have a stipple. + */ + + Tk_FreePixmap(display, pixmap); + ckfree(stippleMap->baseAddr); + ckfree((char *)stippleMap); } else { - if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &macColor)) { - RGBForeColor(&macColor); - } - ShowPen(); - MacFontDrawText(fontPtr, source, numBytes, rangeStart, rangeLength, - macWin->xOff + x, macWin->yOff + y); - HidePen(); + if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &macColor)) { + RGBForeColor(&macColor); + } + ShowPen(); + MacFontDrawText(fontPtr, source, numBytes, rangeStart, rangeLength, + macWin->xOff + x, macWin->yOff + y); + HidePen(); } RGBForeColor(&origColor); @@ -1171,34 +1106,31 @@ TkpDrawCharsInContext( * * TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw -- * - * Setup a Quarz CGContext from the current QD GraphPort for use in - * drawing or measuring. + * Setup a Quarz CGContext from the current QD GraphPort for use in + * drawing or measuring. * * Results: - * - * A CGContext is allocated, configured and returned in - * drawingContextPtr. Also drawingContextPtr->portRect is filled in. + * A CGContext is allocated, configured and returned in + * drawingContextPtr. Also drawingContextPtr->portRect is filled in. * * Side effects: - * - * None. + * None. * * Assumptions: - * - * The current QD GraphPort contains all the data necessary. This is - * clearly the case for the actual drawing, but not so clear for - * measuring. OTOH for measuring the specific parameters are not really - * interesting and the GraphPort is not changed either. The - * availability of a CGContext may be important for the measuring - * process though. + * The current QD GraphPort contains all the data necessary. This is + * clearly the case for the actual drawing, but not so clear for + * measuring. OTOH for measuring the specific parameters are not really + * interesting and the GraphPort is not changed either. The availability + * of a CGContext may be important for the measuring process though. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw( - DrawingContext * drawingContextPtr) /* Quarz context data filled in - * by this function. */ + DrawingContext *drawingContextPtr) + /* Quarz context data filled in by this + * function. */ { GDHandle currentDevice; CGrafPtr destPort; @@ -1213,53 +1145,47 @@ TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw( err = QDBeginCGContext(destPort, &outContext); if (err == noErr && outContext) { - /* - * Now clip the CG Context to the port. We also have to intersect our clip - * region with the port visible region so we don't overwrite the window - * decoration. - */ - - if (!clipRgn) { - clipRgn = NewRgn(); - } - - GetPortBounds(destPort, &boundsRect); - - RectRgn(clipRgn, &boundsRect); - SectRegionWithPortClipRegion(destPort, clipRgn); - SectRegionWithPortVisibleRegion(destPort, clipRgn); - ClipCGContextToRegion(outContext, &boundsRect, clipRgn); - SetEmptyRgn(clipRgn); - - /* - * Note: You have to call SyncCGContextOriginWithPort - * AFTER all the clip region manipulations. - */ - - SyncCGContextOriginWithPort(outContext, destPort); - - /* - * Scale the color values, as QD uses UInt16 with the range [0..2^16-1] - * while Quarz uses float with [0..1]. NB: Only - * CGContextSetRGBFillColor() seems to be actually used by ATSU. - */ - - GetForeColor(&macColor); - CGContextSetRGBFillColor(outContext, - RGBFLOATRED(macColor), - RGBFLOATGREEN(macColor), - RGBFLOATBLUE(macColor), - 1.0f); - #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS + /* + * Now clip the CG Context to the port. We also have to intersect our + * clip region with the port visible region so we don't overwrite the + * window decoration. + */ + + if (!clipRgn) { + clipRgn = NewRgn(); + } + + GetPortBounds(destPort, &boundsRect); + + RectRgn(clipRgn, &boundsRect); + SectRegionWithPortClipRegion(destPort, clipRgn); + SectRegionWithPortVisibleRegion(destPort, clipRgn); + ClipCGContextToRegion(outContext, &boundsRect, clipRgn); + SetEmptyRgn(clipRgn); + + /* + * Note: You have to call SyncCGContextOriginWithPort AFTER all the + * clip region manipulations. + */ + + SyncCGContextOriginWithPort(outContext, destPort); + + /* + * Scale the color values, as QD uses UInt16 with the range + * [0..2^16-1] while Quarz uses float with [0..1]. NB: Only + * CGContextSetRGBFillColor() seems to be actually used by ATSU. + */ + + GetForeColor(&macColor); + CGContextSetRGBFillColor(outContext, RGBFLOATRED(macColor), + RGBFLOATGREEN(macColor), RGBFLOATBLUE(macColor), 1.0f); } else { - fprintf(stderr, "QDBeginCGContext(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - #endif + FDBG("QDBeginCGContext(): Error %d", (int) err); } drawingContextPtr->graphPort = destPort; drawingContextPtr->cgContext = outContext; drawingContextPtr->portRect = boundsRect; - } /* @@ -1267,16 +1193,16 @@ TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw( * * TkMacOSXQuarzEndDraw -- * - * Free the Quarz CGContext in drawingContextPtr. + * Free the Quarz CGContext in drawingContextPtr. * * Results: * - * The CGContext is de-allocated. drawingContextPtr->cgContext will be - * invalid after this. + * The CGContext is de-allocated. drawingContextPtr->cgContext will be + * invalid after this. * * Side effects: * - * None. + * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1287,8 +1213,8 @@ TkMacOSXQuarzEndDraw( { if (drawingContextPtr->cgContext) { QDEndCGContext( - drawingContextPtr->graphPort, - &drawingContextPtr->cgContext); + drawingContextPtr->graphPort, + &drawingContextPtr->cgContext); } } #endif /* TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ */ @@ -1298,28 +1224,28 @@ TkMacOSXQuarzEndDraw( * * MacFontDrawText -- * - * Helper function for Tk_DrawChars. Draws characters, using the - * screen font in fontPtr to draw multilingual characters. + * Helper function for Tk_DrawChars. Draws characters, using the screen + * font in fontPtr to draw multilingual characters. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Information gets drawn on the screen. + * Information gets drawn on the screen. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void MacFontDrawText( - const MacFont * fontPtr, /* Contains font to use when drawing - * following string. */ - const char * source, /* Potentially multilingual UTF-8 string. */ - int numBytes, /* Length of string in bytes. */ - int rangeStart, /* Index of first byte to draw. */ - int rangeLength, /* Length of range to draw in bytes. */ - int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of - * string when drawing. */ + const MacFont *fontPtr, /* Contains font to use when drawing + * following string. */ + const char *source, /* Potentially multilingual UTF-8 string. */ + int numBytes, /* Length of string in bytes. */ + int rangeStart, /* Index of first byte to draw. */ + int rangeLength, /* Length of range to draw in bytes. */ + int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of + * string when drawing. */ { Fixed fx, fy; int ulen, urstart, urlen; @@ -1332,12 +1258,11 @@ MacFontDrawText( Tcl_DString runString; #endif - #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw(&drawingContext); /* - * Turn the y coordinate upside-down for Quarz drawing. We would have + * Turn the y coordinate upside-down for Quarz drawing. We would have * liked to just use a CTM transform in the CGContext, but than we get * upside-down text, so doing it that way gets more painfull than to just * hack around the problem right here. @@ -1349,10 +1274,9 @@ MacFontDrawText( fy = IntToFixed(y); #endif - #if TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE - UpdateLineBuffer( - fontPtr, &drawingContext, source, numBytes, x, y, &lineOffset); + UpdateLineBuffer(fontPtr, &drawingContext, source, numBytes, x, y, + &lineOffset); fx = IntToFixed(currentLeft); @@ -1372,15 +1296,8 @@ MacFontDrawText( urstart = Tcl_NumUtfChars(source, rangeStart); urlen = Tcl_NumUtfChars(source+rangeStart,rangeLength); - err = ATSUDrawText( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, - lineOffset+urstart, urlen, - fx, fy); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUDrawText(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + err = ATSUDrawText(fontPtr->atsuLayout, lineOffset+urstart, urlen, fx,fy); + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUDrawText); #if !TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); @@ -1390,46 +1307,42 @@ MacFontDrawText( TkMacOSXQuarzEndDraw(&drawingContext); #endif } - /* *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- * * MeasureStringWidth -- * - * Low-level measuring of strings. + * Low-level measuring of strings. * * Results: - * - * The width of the string in pixels. + * The width of the string in pixels. * * Side effects: - * - * None. + * None. * * Assumptions: - * - * fontPtr->atsuLayout is setup with the actual string data to measure. + * fontPtr->atsuLayout is setup with the actual string data to measure. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int MeasureStringWidth( - const MacFont * fontPtr, /* Contains font, ATSU layout and string data - * to measure. */ - int start, int end) /* Start and end positions to measure in that - * string. */ + const MacFont *fontPtr, /* Contains font, ATSU layout and string data + * to measure. */ + int start, int end) /* Start and end positions to measure in that + * string. */ { /* * This implementation of measuring via ATSUGetGlyphBounds() does not * quite conform with the specification given for [font measure]: * - * The return value is the total width in pixels of text, not - * including the extra pixels used by highly exagerrated characters - * such as cursive "f". + * The return value is the total width in pixels of text, not + * including the extra pixels used by highly exagerrated characters + * such as cursive "f". * - * Instead the result of ATSUGetGlyphBounds() *does* include these - * "extra pixels". + * Instead the result of ATSUGetGlyphBounds() *does* include these "extra + * pixels". */ ATSTrapezoid bounds; @@ -1437,23 +1350,19 @@ MeasureStringWidth( OSStatus err; if (end <= start) { - return 0; + return 0; } bounds.upperRight.x = bounds.upperLeft.x = 0; - err = ATSUGetGlyphBounds( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, - 0, 0, - start, end-start, - kATSUseFractionalOrigins, - 1, &bounds, &numBounds); + err = ATSUGetGlyphBounds(fontPtr->atsuLayout, 0, 0, start, end-start, + kATSUseFractionalOrigins, 1, &bounds, &numBounds); #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUGetGlyphBounds(): Error %d\n", (int) err); + FDBG("ATSUGetGlyphBounds(): Error %d", (int) err); } else if (numBounds < 1) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUGetGlyphBounds(): No output\n"); + FDBG("ATSUGetGlyphBounds(): No output"); } else if (numBounds > 1) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUGetGlyphBounds(): More output\n"); + FDBG("ATSUGetGlyphBounds(): More output"); } #endif @@ -1466,52 +1375,50 @@ MeasureStringWidth( * * UpdateLineBuffer -- * - * See the general dicussion of TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE on the header - * pages. This function maintains the data for this feature. + * See the general dicussion of TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE on the header pages. + * This function maintains the data for this feature. * * Results: - * - * The Tcl_UniChar string of the whole line as seen so far. + * The Tcl_UniChar string of the whole line as seen so far. * * Side effects: + * "*offset" is filled with the index of the first new character in + * "currentLine". The globals currentLine, currentY, currentLeft, + * currentRight and currentFontPtr are updated as necessary. * - * "*offset" is filled with the index of the first new character in - * "currentLine". The globals currentLine, currentY, currentLeft, - * currentRight and currentFontPtr are updated as necessary. - * - * The currentLine string is set as the current text in - * fontPtr->atsuLayout (see TkMacOSXLayoutSetString()). + * The currentLine string is set as the current text in + * fontPtr->atsuLayout (see TkMacOSXLayoutSetString()). * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static const Tcl_UniChar * UpdateLineBuffer( - const MacFont * fontPtr,/* The font to be used for the new piece of - * text. */ - const DrawingContext * drawingContextPtr, - /* The Quarz drawing parameters. Needed for - * measuring the new piece. */ - const char * source, /* A new piece of line to be added. */ - int numBytes, /* Length of the new piece. */ - int x, int y, /* Position of the new piece in the window. */ - int * offset) /* Filled with the offset of the new piece in - * currentLine. */ + const MacFont *fontPtr, /* The font to be used for the new piece of + * text. */ + const DrawingContext *drawingContextPtr, + /* The Quarz drawing parameters. Needed for + * measuring the new piece. */ + const char *source, /* A new piece of line to be added. */ + int numBytes, /* Length of the new piece. */ + int x, int y, /* Position of the new piece in the window. */ + int *offset) /* Filled with the offset of the new piece in + * currentLine. */ { const Tcl_UniChar * uchars; int ulen; if (y != currentY - || x < currentRight-1 || x > currentRight+2 - || currentFontPtr != fontPtr) { - Tcl_DStringFree(¤tLine); - Tcl_DStringInit(¤tLine); - currentY = y; - currentLeft = x; - currentFontPtr = fontPtr; - *offset = 0; + || x < currentRight-1 || x > currentRight+2 + || currentFontPtr != fontPtr) { + Tcl_DStringFree(¤tLine); + Tcl_DStringInit(¤tLine); + currentY = y; + currentLeft = x; + currentFontPtr = fontPtr; + *offset = 0; } else { - *offset = Tcl_DStringLength(¤tLine) / 2; + *offset = Tcl_DStringLength(¤tLine) / 2; } Tcl_UtfToUniCharDString(source, numBytes, ¤tLine); @@ -1529,33 +1436,33 @@ UpdateLineBuffer( * * InitFont -- * - * Helper for TkpGetNativeFont() and TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). - * Initializes the memory for a MacFont that wraps the - * platform-specific data. + * Helper for TkpGetNativeFont() and TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). + * Initializes the memory for a MacFont that wraps the platform-specific + * data. * - * The caller is responsible for initializing the fields of the TkFont - * that are used exclusively by the generic TkFont code, and for - * releasing those fields before calling TkpDeleteFont(). + * The caller is responsible for initializing the fields of the TkFont + * that are used exclusively by the generic TkFont code, and for + * releasing those fields before calling TkpDeleteFont(). * * Results: - * Fills the MacFont structure. + * Fills the MacFont structure. * * Side effects: - * Memory allocated. + * Memory allocated. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void InitFont( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ - FMFontFamily familyId, /* The font family to initialize for. */ - const char * familyName,/* The font family name, if known. Otherwise - * this can be NULL. */ - int size, /* Point size for the font. */ - int qdStyle, /* QuickDraw style bits. */ - MacFont * fontPtr) /* Filled with information constructed from the - * above arguments. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ + FMFontFamily familyId, /* The font family to initialize for. */ + const char * familyName, /* The font family name, if known. Otherwise + * this can be NULL. */ + int size, /* Point size for the font. */ + int qdStyle, /* QuickDraw style bits. */ + MacFont * fontPtr) /* Filled with information constructed from the + * above arguments. */ { OSStatus err; FontInfo fi; @@ -1565,38 +1472,31 @@ InitFont( int periodWidth, wWidth; if (size == 0) { - size = GetDefFontSize(); + size = GetDefFontSize(); } points = (short) TkFontGetPoints(tkwin, size); err = FetchFontInfo(familyId, points, qdStyle, &fi); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "FetchFontInfo(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(FetchFontInfo); if (familyName == NULL) { - char name[256] = ""; - const MacFontFamily * familyPtr; - - err = GetFontFamilyName(familyId, name, sizeof(name)); - if (err == noErr) { - - /* - * We find the canonical font name, so we can avoid unnecessary - * memory management. - */ - - familyPtr = FindFontFamily(name); - if (familyPtr != NULL) { - familyName = familyPtr->name; - } else { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "Font family '%s': Not found\n", name); -#endif - } - } + char name[256] = ""; + const MacFontFamily * familyPtr; + + err = GetFontFamilyName(familyId, name, sizeof(name)); + if (err == noErr) { + /* + * We find the canonical font name, so we can avoid unnecessary + * memory management. + */ + + familyPtr = FindFontFamily(name); + if (familyPtr != NULL) { + familyName = familyPtr->name; + } else { + FDBG("Font family '%s': Not found", name); + } + } } fontPtr->font.fid = (Font) fontPtr; @@ -1612,11 +1512,11 @@ InitFont( fmPtr = &fontPtr->font.fm; /* - * Note: Macs measure the line height as ascent + descent + - * leading. Leading as a separate entity does not exist in X11 - * and Tk. We add it to the ascent at the moment, because adding - * it to the descent, as the Mac docs would indicate, would change - * the position of self-drawn underlines. + * Note: Macs measure the line height as ascent + descent + leading. + * Leading as a separate entity does not exist in X11 and Tk. We add it to + * the ascent at the moment, because adding it to the descent, as the Mac + * docs would indicate, would change the position of self-drawn + * underlines. */ fmPtr->ascent = fi.ascent + fi.leading; @@ -1627,9 +1527,8 @@ InitFont( fontPtr->qdSize = points; fontPtr->qdStyle = (short) qdStyle; - InitATSUObjects( - familyId, points, qdStyle, - &fontPtr->atsuFontId, &fontPtr->atsuLayout, &fontPtr->atsuStyle); + InitATSUObjects(familyId, points, qdStyle, + &fontPtr->atsuFontId, &fontPtr->atsuLayout, &fontPtr->atsuStyle); Tk_MeasureChars((Tk_Font)fontPtr, ".", 1, -1, 0, &periodWidth); Tk_MeasureChars((Tk_Font)fontPtr, "W", 1, -1, 0, &wWidth); @@ -1645,29 +1544,28 @@ InitFont( * * InitATSUObjects -- * - * Helper for InitFont(). Initializes the ATSU data handles for a - * MacFont. + * Helper for InitFont(). Initializes the ATSU data handles for a + * MacFont. * * Results: - * - * Sets up all we know and can do at this point in time in fontIdPtr, - * layoutPtr and stylePtr. + * Sets up all we know and can do at this point in time in fontIdPtr, + * layoutPtr and stylePtr. * * Side effects: - * - * Allocates data structures inside of ATSU. + * Allocates data structures inside of ATSU. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void InitATSUObjects( - FMFontFamily familyId, /* The font family to use. */ - short ptSize, short qdStyles, /* The additional font parameters. */ - ATSUFontID * fontIdPtr, /* Filled with the font id. */ - ATSUTextLayout * layoutPtr, /* Filled with the ATSU layout handle. */ - ATSUStyle * stylePtr) /* Filled with the ATSU style handle, - * configured with all parameters. */ + FMFontFamily familyId, /* The font family to use. */ + short ptSize, short qdStyles, + /* The additional font parameters. */ + ATSUFontID *fontIdPtr, /* Filled with the font id. */ + ATSUTextLayout *layoutPtr, /* Filled with the ATSU layout handle. */ + ATSUStyle *stylePtr) /* Filled with the ATSU style handle, + * configured with all parameters. */ { OSStatus err; FMFontStyle stylesDone, stylesLeft; @@ -1684,18 +1582,13 @@ InitATSUObjects( * Generate a font id from family id and QD style bits. */ - err = FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance( - familyId, qdStyles, fontIdPtr, &stylesDone); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(): Error %d\n", - (int) err); - } -#endif + err = FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(familyId, qdStyles, fontIdPtr, + &stylesDone); + LOG_ON_ERR(FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance); /* - * We see what style bits are left and tell ATSU to synthesize what's - * left like QD does it. + * We see what style bits are left and tell ATSU to synthesize what's left + * like QD does it. */ stylesLeft = qdStyles & ~(unsigned)stylesDone; @@ -1705,24 +1598,16 @@ InitATSUObjects( */ err = ATSUCreateStyle(stylePtr); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUCreateStyle(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUCreateStyle); InitATSUStyle(*fontIdPtr, ptSize, stylesLeft, *stylePtr); /* - * Create the layout. Note: We can't set the layout attributes here, + * Create the layout. Note: We can't set the layout attributes here, * because the text and the style must be set first. */ err = ATSUCreateTextLayout(layoutPtr); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUCreateTextLayout(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUCreateTextLayout); /*InitATSULayout(*layoutPtr);*/ } @@ -1731,25 +1616,24 @@ InitATSUObjects( * * InitATSUStyle -- * - * Helper for InitATSUObjects(). Initializes the ATSU style for a - * MacFont. + * Helper for InitATSUObjects(). Initializes the ATSU style for a + * MacFont. * * Results: - * - * Sets up all parameters needed for an ATSU style. + * Sets up all parameters needed for an ATSU style. * * Side effects: - * - * Allocates data structures for the style inside of ATSU. + * Allocates data structures for the style inside of ATSU. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void InitATSUStyle( - ATSUFontID fontId, /* The font id to use. */ - short ptSize, short qdStyles, /* Additional font parameters. */ - ATSUStyle style) /* The style handle to configure. */ + ATSUFontID fontId, /* The font id to use. */ + short ptSize, short qdStyles, + /* Additional font parameters. */ + ATSUStyle style) /* The style handle to configure. */ { /* * Attributes for the style. @@ -1757,69 +1641,59 @@ InitATSUStyle( Fixed fsize = IntToFixed(ptSize); Boolean - isBold = (qdStyles&bold) != 0, - isUnderline = (qdStyles&underline) != 0, - isItalic = (qdStyles&italic) != 0; + isBold = (qdStyles&bold) != 0, + isUnderline = (qdStyles&underline) != 0, + isItalic = (qdStyles&italic) != 0; ATSStyleRenderingOptions options = - antialiasedTextEnabled == -1 ? kATSStyleNoOptions : - antialiasedTextEnabled == 0 ? kATSStyleNoAntiAliasing : - kATSStyleApplyAntiAliasing; + antialiasedTextEnabled == -1 ? kATSStyleNoOptions : + antialiasedTextEnabled == 0 ? kATSStyleNoAntiAliasing : + kATSStyleApplyAntiAliasing; static const ATSUAttributeTag styleTags[] = { - kATSUFontTag, kATSUSizeTag, - kATSUQDBoldfaceTag, kATSUQDItalicTag, kATSUQDUnderlineTag, - kATSUStyleRenderingOptionsTag, + kATSUFontTag, kATSUSizeTag, + kATSUQDBoldfaceTag, kATSUQDItalicTag, kATSUQDUnderlineTag, + kATSUStyleRenderingOptionsTag, }; static const ByteCount styleSizes[] = { - sizeof(ATSUFontID), sizeof(Fixed), - sizeof(Boolean), sizeof(Boolean), sizeof(Boolean), - sizeof(ATSStyleRenderingOptions), + sizeof(ATSUFontID), sizeof(Fixed), + sizeof(Boolean), sizeof(Boolean), sizeof(Boolean), + sizeof(ATSStyleRenderingOptions), }; const ATSUAttributeValuePtr styleValues[] = { - &fontId, &fsize, - &isBold, &isItalic, &isUnderline, - &options, + &fontId, &fsize, + &isBold, &isItalic, &isUnderline, + &options, }; - OSStatus err; - - err = ATSUSetAttributes( - style, - sizeof(styleTags)/sizeof(styleTags[0]), - styleTags, styleSizes, styleValues); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUSetAttributes(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + OSStatus err = ATSUSetAttributes(style, + sizeof(styleTags)/sizeof(styleTags[0]), + styleTags, styleSizes, styleValues); + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUSetAttributes); } - /* *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- * * SetFontFeatures -- * - * Helper for InitFont(). Request specific font features of the ATSU - * style object for a MacFont. + * Helper for InitFont(). Request specific font features of the ATSU + * style object for a MacFont. * * Results: - * - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * - * Specific font features are enabled on the ATSU style object. + * Specific font features are enabled on the ATSU style object. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void SetFontFeatures( - ATSUFontID fontId, /* The font id to use. */ - int fixed, /* Is this a fixed font? */ - ATSUStyle style) /* The style handle to configure. */ + ATSUFontID fontId, /* The font id to use. */ + int fixed, /* Is this a fixed font? */ + ATSUStyle style) /* The style handle to configure. */ { /* * Don't use the standard latin ligatures, if this is determined to be a @@ -1827,24 +1701,19 @@ SetFontFeatures( */ static const ATSUFontFeatureType fixed_featureTypes[] = { - kLigaturesType, kLigaturesType + kLigaturesType, kLigaturesType }; static const ATSUFontFeatureSelector fixed_featureSelectors[] = { - kCommonLigaturesOffSelector, kRareLigaturesOffSelector + kCommonLigaturesOffSelector, kRareLigaturesOffSelector }; OSStatus err; if (fixed) { - err = ATSUSetFontFeatures( - style, - sizeof(fixed_featureTypes)/sizeof(fixed_featureTypes[0]), - fixed_featureTypes, fixed_featureSelectors); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUSetFontFeatures(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + err = ATSUSetFontFeatures(style, + sizeof(fixed_featureTypes)/sizeof(fixed_featureTypes[0]), + fixed_featureTypes, fixed_featureSelectors); + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUSetFontFeatures); } } @@ -1853,17 +1722,15 @@ SetFontFeatures( * * AdjustFontHeight -- * - * Helper for InitFont(). Check font height against some real world - * examples. + * Helper for InitFont(). Check font height against some real world + * examples. * * Results: - * - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * - * The metrics in fontPtr->font.fm are adjusted so that typical combined - * characters fit into ascent+descent. + * The metrics in fontPtr->font.fm are adjusted so that typical combined + * characters fit into ascent+descent. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1875,7 +1742,7 @@ AdjustFontHeight( /* * The standard values for ascent, descent and leading as determined in * InitFont do not take composition into account, they are designed for - * plain ASCII characters. This code measures the actual size of some + * plain ASCII characters. This code measures the actual size of some * typical composed characters from the Latin-1 range and corrects these * factors, especially the ascent. * @@ -1883,20 +1750,18 @@ AdjustFontHeight( * than requested. * * An alternative would be to instruct ATSU to shrink oversized combined - * characters. I think I have seen that feature somewhere, but I can't + * characters. I think I have seen that feature somewhere, but I can't * find it now [BR]. */ static const UniChar chars[] - /* Auml, Aacute, Acirc, Atilde, Ccedilla */ - = {0x00C4, 0x00C1, 0x00C2, 0x00C3, 0x00C7}; + /* Auml, Aacute, Acirc, Atilde, Ccedilla */ + = {0x00C4, 0x00C1, 0x00C2, 0x00C3, 0x00C7}; static const int charslen = sizeof(chars) / sizeof(chars[0]); - DrawingContext drawingContext; Rect size; OSStatus err; - #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ TkMacOSXQuarzStartDraw(&drawingContext); #endif @@ -1904,100 +1769,90 @@ AdjustFontHeight( TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(fontPtr, &drawingContext, chars, charslen); size.top = size.bottom = 0; - err = ATSUMeasureTextImage( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, - 0, charslen, - 0, 0, - &size); + err = ATSUMeasureTextImage(fontPtr->atsuLayout, 0, charslen, 0, 0, &size); #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ TkMacOSXQuarzEndDraw(&drawingContext); #endif if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUMeasureTextImage(): Error %d\n", (int) err); -#endif + FDBG("ATSUMeasureTextImage(): Error %d", (int) err); } else { - TkFontMetrics * fmPtr = &fontPtr->font.fm; - int ascent = -size.top; - int descent = size.bottom; - - if (ascent > fmPtr->ascent) { - fmPtr->ascent = ascent; - } - if (descent > fmPtr->descent) { - fmPtr->descent = descent; - } + TkFontMetrics * fmPtr = &fontPtr->font.fm; + int ascent = -size.top; + int descent = size.bottom; + + if (ascent > fmPtr->ascent) { + fmPtr->ascent = ascent; + } + if (descent > fmPtr->descent) { + fmPtr->descent = descent; + } } } - /* *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- * * InitATSULayout -- * - * Helper for TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(). Initializes the ATSU layout - * object for a MacFont and a specific string. + * Helper for TkMacOSXLayoutSetString(). Initializes the ATSU layout + * object for a MacFont and a specific string. * * Results: - * - * Sets up all parameters needed for an ATSU layout object. + * Sets up all parameters needed for an ATSU layout object. * * Side effects: - * - * Allocates data structures for the layout object inside of ATSU. + * Allocates data structures for the layout object inside of ATSU. * * Assumptions: - * - * The actual string data and style information is already set by - * ATSUSetTextPointerLocation() and ATSUSetRunStyle() (see - * TkMacOSXLayoutSetString()). + * The actual string data and style information is already set by + * ATSUSetTextPointerLocation() and ATSUSetRunStyle() (see + * TkMacOSXLayoutSetString()). * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void InitATSULayout( - const DrawingContext * drawingContextPtr, - /* Specifies the CGContext to use. */ - ATSUTextLayout layout, /* The layout object to configure. */ - int fixed) /* Is this a fixed font? */ + const DrawingContext *drawingContextPtr, + /* Specifies the CGContext to use. */ + ATSUTextLayout layout, /* The layout object to configure. */ + int fixed) /* Is this a fixed font? */ { /* * Attributes for the layout. */ ATSLineLayoutOptions layoutOptions = - 0 + 0 #if TK_MAC_COALESCE_LINE /* * Options to use unconditionally, when we try to do coalescing in here. */ - | kATSLineDisableAllLayoutOperations - | kATSLineFractDisable - | kATSLineUseDeviceMetrics + | kATSLineDisableAllLayoutOperations + | kATSLineFractDisable + | kATSLineUseDeviceMetrics #endif - ; + ; static const ATSUAttributeTag layoutTags[] = { #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ - kATSUCGContextTag, + kATSUCGContextTag, #endif - kATSULineLayoutOptionsTag, + kATSULineLayoutOptionsTag, }; static const ByteCount layoutSizes[] = { #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ - sizeof(CGContextRef), + sizeof(CGContextRef), #endif - sizeof(ATSLineLayoutOptions), + sizeof(ATSLineLayoutOptions), }; const ATSUAttributeValuePtr layoutValues[] = { #if TK_MAC_USE_QUARZ - (void*)&drawingContextPtr->cgContext, + (void*)&drawingContextPtr->cgContext, #endif - &layoutOptions, + &layoutOptions, }; OSStatus err; @@ -2007,29 +1862,16 @@ InitATSULayout( */ if (fixed) { - layoutOptions |= - kATSLineFractDisable - | kATSLineUseDeviceMetrics - ; + layoutOptions |= kATSLineFractDisable | kATSLineUseDeviceMetrics; } - err = ATSUSetLayoutControls( - layout, - sizeof(layoutTags)/sizeof(layoutTags[0]), - layoutTags, layoutSizes, layoutValues); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUSetLayoutControls(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + err = ATSUSetLayoutControls(layout, + sizeof(layoutTags)/sizeof(layoutTags[0]), + layoutTags, layoutSizes, layoutValues); + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUSetLayoutControls); err = ATSUSetTransientFontMatching(layout, true); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUSetTransientFontMatching(): Error %d\n", - (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUSetTransientFontMatching); } /* @@ -2037,83 +1879,68 @@ InitATSULayout( * * TkMacOSXLayoutSetString -- * - * Setup the MacFont for a specific string. + * Setup the MacFont for a specific string. * * Results: - * - * Sets up all parameters so that ATSU can work with the objects in - * MacFont. + * Sets up all parameters so that ATSU can work with the objects in + * MacFont. * * Side effects: - * - * Sets parameters on the layout object fontPtr->atsuLayout. + * Sets parameters on the layout object fontPtr->atsuLayout. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkMacOSXLayoutSetString( - const MacFont * fontPtr, /* The fontPtr to configure. */ + const MacFont *fontPtr, /* The fontPtr to configure. */ const DrawingContext * drawingContextPtr, - /* For the CGContext to be used.*/ - const UniChar * uchars, int ulen) /* The UniChar string to set into - * fontPtr->atsuLayout. */ + /* For the CGContext to be used.*/ + const UniChar *uchars, int ulen) + /* The UniChar string to set into + * fontPtr->atsuLayout. */ { OSStatus err; - err = ATSUSetTextPointerLocation( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, - uchars, kATSUFromTextBeginning, ulen, - ulen); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUSetTextPointerLocation(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + err = ATSUSetTextPointerLocation(fontPtr->atsuLayout, + uchars, kATSUFromTextBeginning, ulen, ulen); + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUSetTextPointerLocation); /* * Styles can only be set after the text is set. */ - err = ATSUSetRunStyle( - fontPtr->atsuLayout, fontPtr->atsuStyle, - kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSUSetRunStyle(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + err = ATSUSetRunStyle(fontPtr->atsuLayout, fontPtr->atsuStyle, + kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd); + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSUSetRunStyle); /* * Layout attributes can only be set after the styles are set. */ - InitATSULayout( - drawingContextPtr, fontPtr->atsuLayout, - fontPtr->font.fm.fixed); + InitATSULayout(drawingContextPtr, fontPtr->atsuLayout, + fontPtr->font.fm.fixed); } - /* *------------------------------------------------------------------------- * * ReleaseFont -- * - * Called to release the Macintosh-specific contents of a TkFont. The - * caller is responsible for freeing the memory used by the font - * itself. + * Called to release the Macintosh-specific contents of a TkFont. The + * caller is responsible for freeing the memory used by the font itself. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Memory is freed. + * Memory is freed. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void ReleaseFont( - MacFont * fontPtr) /* The font to delete. */ + MacFont *fontPtr) /* The font to delete. */ { ATSUDisposeTextLayout(fontPtr->atsuLayout); ATSUDisposeStyle(fontPtr->atsuStyle); @@ -2124,40 +1951,40 @@ ReleaseFont( * * FindFontFamilyOrAlias, FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback -- * - * Determine if any physical screen font exists on the system with The - * given family name. If the family exists, then it should be possible - * to construct some physical screen font with that family name. + * Determine if any physical screen font exists on the system with the + * given family name. If the family exists, then it should be possible to + * construct some physical screen font with that family name. * - * FindFontFamilyOrAlias also considers font aliases as determined by - * TkFontGetAliasList(). + * FindFontFamilyOrAlias also considers font aliases as determined by + * TkFontGetAliasList(). * - * FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback also considers font aliases as - * determined by TkFontGetFallbacks(). + * FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback also considers font aliases as + * determined by TkFontGetFallbacks(). * - * The overall algorithm to get the closest font to the one requested is - * this: + * The overall algorithm to get the closest font to the one requested is + * this: * - * try fontname - * try all aliases for fontname - * foreach fallback for fontname - * try the fallback - * try all aliases for the fallback + * try fontname + * try all aliases for fontname + * foreach fallback for fontname + * try the fallback + * try all aliases for the fallback * * Results: * - * The return value is NULL if the specified font family does not exist, - * a valid MacFontFamily* otherwise. + * The return value is NULL if the specified font family does not exist, + * a valid MacFontFamily* otherwise. * * Side effects: * - * None. + * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static const MacFontFamily * FindFontFamilyOrAlias( - const char * name) /* Name or alias name of the font to find. */ + const char * name) /* Name or alias name of the font to find. */ { const MacFontFamily * familyPtr; char ** aliases; @@ -2165,24 +1992,24 @@ FindFontFamilyOrAlias( familyPtr = FindFontFamily(name); if (familyPtr != NULL) { - return familyPtr; + return familyPtr; } aliases = TkFontGetAliasList(name); if (aliases != NULL) { - for (i = 0; aliases[i] != NULL; i++) { - familyPtr = FindFontFamily(aliases[i]); - if (familyPtr != NULL) { - return familyPtr; - } - } + for (i = 0; aliases[i] != NULL; i++) { + familyPtr = FindFontFamily(aliases[i]); + if (familyPtr != NULL) { + return familyPtr; + } + } } return NULL; } - + static const MacFontFamily * FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback( - const char * name) /* Name or alias name of the font to find. */ + const char * name) /* Name or alias name of the font to find. */ { const MacFontFamily * familyPtr; const char * fallback; @@ -2191,38 +2018,34 @@ FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback( familyPtr = FindFontFamilyOrAlias(name); if (familyPtr != NULL) { - return familyPtr; + return familyPtr; } fallbacks = TkFontGetFallbacks(); for (i = 0; fallbacks[i] != NULL; i++) { - for (j = 0; (fallback = fallbacks[i][j]) != NULL; j++) { - if (strcasecmp(name, fallback) == 0) { - for (j = 0; (fallback = fallbacks[i][j]) != NULL; j++) { - familyPtr = FindFontFamilyOrAlias(fallback); - if (familyPtr != NULL) { - return familyPtr; - } - } - } - break; /* benny: This "break" is a carry-over from - * tkMacOSXFont.c, but what is actually its purpose - * ???? */ - } + for (j = 0; (fallback = fallbacks[i][j]) != NULL; j++) { + if (strcasecmp(name, fallback) == 0) { + for (j = 0; (fallback = fallbacks[i][j]) != NULL; j++) { + familyPtr = FindFontFamilyOrAlias(fallback); + if (familyPtr != NULL) { + return familyPtr; + } + } + } + break; /* benny: This "break" is a carry-over from + * tkMacOSXFont.c, but what is actually its purpose + * ???? */ + } } - /* - * FIXME: We would have liked to recover by re-enumerating fonts. But - * that doesn't work, because Carbon seems to cache the inital list of - * fonts. Fonts newly installed don't show up with - * FMCreateFontFamilyIterator()/FMGetNextFontFamily() without a restart - * of the app. Similar problem with fonts removed. + * FIXME: We would have liked to recover by re-enumerating fonts. But that + * doesn't work, because Carbon seems to cache the inital list of fonts. + * Fonts newly installed don't show up with + * FMCreateFontFamilyIterator()/FMGetNextFontFamily() without a restart of + * the app. Similar problem with fonts removed. */ -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "Font family '%s': Not found\n", name); -#endif - + FDBG("Font family '%s': Not found", name); return NULL; } @@ -2231,16 +2054,16 @@ FindFontFamilyOrAliasOrFallback( * * InitFontFamilies -- * - * Helper to TkpFontPkgInit. Use the Font Manager to fill in the - * familyList global array. + * Helper to TkpFontPkgInit. Use the Font Manager to fill in the + * familyList global array. * * Results: * - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: * - * Allocates memory. + * Allocates memory. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -2255,15 +2078,11 @@ InitFontFamilies(void) */ if (familyListNextFree > 0) { - return; + return; } err = ATSFontFamilyApplyFunction(FontFamilyEnumCallback,NULL); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "ATSFontFamilyApplyFunction(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(ATSFontFamilyApplyFunction); AddFontFamily(APPLFONT_NAME, GetAppFont()); AddFontFamily(SYSTEMFONT_NAME, GetSysFont()); @@ -2273,7 +2092,7 @@ InitFontFamilies(void) static OSStatus FontFamilyEnumCallback( - ATSFontFamilyRef family, + ATSFontFamilyRef family, void *refCon) { OSStatus err; @@ -2283,7 +2102,7 @@ FontFamilyEnumCallback( err = GetFontFamilyName(family, name, sizeof(name)); if (err == noErr) { - AddFontFamily(name, family); + AddFontFamily(name, family); } return noErr; @@ -2295,28 +2114,28 @@ FontFamilyEnumCallback( * * GetFontFamilyName -- * - * Use the Font Manager to get the name of a given FMFontfamily. This - * currently gets the standard, non-localized QuickDraw name. Other - * names would be possible, see docs for ATSUFindFontName for a - * selection. The MacOSX font selector seems to use the localized - * family name given by ATSUFindFontName(kFontFamilyName), but that API - * doesn't give us a name at all for some fonts. + * Use the Font Manager to get the name of a given FMFontfamily. This + * currently gets the standard, non-localized QuickDraw name. Other names + * would be possible, see docs for ATSUFindFontName for a selection. The + * MacOSX font selector seems to use the localized family name given by + * ATSUFindFontName(kFontFamilyName), but that API doesn't give us a name + * at all for some fonts. * * Results: - * An OS error code, noErr on success. name is filled with the - * resulting name. + * An OS error code, noErr on success. name is filled with the resulting + * name. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static OSStatus GetFontFamilyName( - FMFontFamily fontFamily, /* The font family for which to find the - * name. */ - char * name, int numBytes) /* Filled with the result. */ + FMFontFamily fontFamily, /* The font family for which to find the + * name. */ + char * name, int numBytes) /* Filled with the result. */ { OSStatus err; Str255 nativeName; @@ -2328,11 +2147,9 @@ GetFontFamilyName( name[0] = 0; err = FMGetFontFamilyName(fontFamily, nativeName); + LOG_ON_ERR(FMGetFontFamilyName); if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - fprintf(stderr, "FMGetFontFamilyName(): Error %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - return err; + return err; } /* @@ -2342,35 +2159,26 @@ GetFontFamilyName( encoding = kTextEncodingMacRoman; err = FMGetFontFamilyTextEncoding(fontFamily, &encoding); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "FMGetFontFamilyTextEncoding(): Error %d\n", (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(FMGetFontFamilyTextEncoding); nameencoding = encoding; err = RevertTextEncodingToScriptInfo(encoding, &nameencoding, NULL, NULL); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_FONTS - if (err != noErr) { - fprintf(stderr, "RevertTextEncodingToScriptInfo(): Error %d\n", - (int) err); - } -#endif + LOG_ON_ERR(RevertTextEncodingToScriptInfo); /* - * Note: We could use Tcl facilities to do the re-encoding here. We'd - * have to maintain tables to map OS encoding codes to Tcl encoding names - * like tkMacOSXFont.c did. Using native re-encoding directly instead is - * a lot easier and future-proof than that. There is one snag, though: I - * have seen CFStringGetCString() crash with invalid encoding ids. But - * than if that happens it would be a bug in - * FMGetFontFamilyTextEncoding() or RevertTextEncodingToScriptInfo(). + * Note: We could use Tcl facilities to do the re-encoding here. We'd have + * to maintain tables to map OS encoding codes to Tcl encoding names like + * tkMacOSXFont.c did. Using native re-encoding directly instead is a lot + * easier and future-proof than that. There is one snag, though: I have + * seen CFStringGetCString() crash with invalid encoding ids. But than if + * that happens it would be a bug in FMGetFontFamilyTextEncoding() or + * RevertTextEncodingToScriptInfo(). */ cfString = CFStringCreateWithPascalStringNoCopy( - NULL, nativeName, nameencoding, kCFAllocatorNull); + NULL, nativeName, nameencoding, kCFAllocatorNull); CFStringGetCString( - cfString, name, numBytes, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + cfString, name, numBytes, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); CFRelease(cfString); return noErr; @@ -2381,41 +2189,39 @@ GetFontFamilyName( * * FindFontFamily -- * - * Find the font family with the given name in the global familyList. - * Uses bsearch() for convenient access. Comparision is done - * non-case-sensitively with CompareFontFamilies() which see. + * Find the font family with the given name in the global familyList. + * Uses bsearch() for convenient access. Comparision is done + * non-case-sensitively with CompareFontFamilies() which see. * * Results: * - * MacFontFamily: A pair of family id and the actual name registered for - * the font. + * MacFontFamily: A pair of family id and the actual name registered for + * the font. * * Side effects: * - * None. + * None. * * Assumption: * - * Requires the familyList array to be sorted. + * Requires the familyList array to be sorted. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static const MacFontFamily * FindFontFamily( - const char * name) /* The family name. Note: Names are compared - * non-case-sensitive. */ + const char *name) /* The family name. Note: Names are compared + * non-case-sensitive. */ { const MacFontFamily key = {name,-1}; if(familyListMaxValid <= 0) { - return NULL; + return NULL; } - return bsearch( - &key, - familyList, familyListMaxValid, sizeof(*familyList), - CompareFontFamilies); + return bsearch(&key, familyList, familyListMaxValid, sizeof(*familyList), + CompareFontFamilies); } /* @@ -2423,15 +2229,13 @@ FindFontFamily( * * EnumFontFamilies -- * - * Create a Tcl list with the registered names in the global familyList. + * Create a Tcl list with the registered names in the global familyList. * * Results: - * - * A Tcl list of names. + * A Tcl list of names. * * Side effects: - * - * None. + * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -2444,8 +2248,8 @@ EnumFontFamilies(void) tclList = Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); for (i=0; i= familyListSize) { - familyListSize += 100; - familyList = (MacFontFamily *) ckrealloc( - (void*) familyList, - familyListSize * sizeof(*familyList)); + familyListSize += 100; + familyList = (MacFontFamily *) ckrealloc((void*) familyList, + familyListSize * sizeof(*familyList)); } familyPtr = familyList + familyListNextFree; @@ -2499,18 +2302,18 @@ AddFontFamily( * * SortFontFamilies -- * - * Sort the entries in familyList. Only after calling - * SortFontFamilies(), the new families registered with AddFontFamily() - * are actually available for FindFontFamily(), because FindFontFamily() - * requires the array to be sorted. + * Sort the entries in familyList. Only after calling SortFontFamilies(), + * the new families registered with AddFontFamily() are actually + * available for FindFontFamily(), because FindFontFamily() requires the + * array to be sorted. * * Results: * - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: * - * familyList is sorted and familyListMaxValid is updated. + * familyList is sorted and familyListMaxValid is updated. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -2519,8 +2322,8 @@ static void SortFontFamilies(void) { if (familyListNextFree > 0) { - qsort( familyList, familyListNextFree, sizeof(*familyList), - CompareFontFamilies); + qsort(familyList, familyListNextFree, sizeof(*familyList), + CompareFontFamilies); } familyListMaxValid = familyListNextFree; } @@ -2530,21 +2333,19 @@ SortFontFamilies(void) * * CompareFontFamilies -- * - * Comparison function used by SortFontFamilies() and FindFontFamily(). + * Comparison function used by SortFontFamilies() and FindFontFamily(). * * Results: + * Result as required to generate a stable sort order for bsearch() and + * qsort(). The ordering is not case-sensitive as far as + * Tcl_UtfNcasecmp() (which see) can provide that. * - * Result as required to generate a stable sort order for bsearch() and - * qsort(). The ordering is not case-sensitive as far as - * Tcl_UtfNcasecmp() (which see) can provide that. - * - * Note: It would be faster to compare first the length and the actual - * strings only as a tie-breaker, but than the ordering wouldn't look so - * pretty in [font families] ;-). + * Note: It would be faster to compare first the length and the actual + * strings only as a tie-breaker, but than the ordering wouldn't look so + * pretty in [font families] ;-). * * Side effects: - * - * None. + * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -2556,9 +2357,7 @@ CompareFontFamilies( { const char * name1; const char * name2; - int len1; - int len2; - int diff; + int len1, len2, diff; name1 = ((const MacFontFamily *) vp1)->name; name2 = ((const MacFontFamily *) vp2)->name; @@ -2576,43 +2375,39 @@ CompareFontFamilies( * * AddString -- * - * Helper for AddFontFamily(). Allocates a string in the one-shot - * allocator. + * Helper for AddFontFamily(). Allocates a string in the one-shot + * allocator. * * Results: - * - * A duplicated string in the one-shot allocator. + * A duplicated string in the one-shot allocator. * * Side effects: - * - * May allocate a new memory block. + * May allocate a new memory block. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static const char * AddString( - const char * in) /* String to add, zero-terminated. */ + const char *in) /* String to add, zero-terminated. */ { int len; - char * result; - + char *result; + len = strlen(in) +1; if (stringMemory == NULL - || (stringMemory->nextFree+len) > STRING_BLOCK_MAX ) { - StringBlock * newblock = - (StringBlock *) ckalloc(sizeof(StringBlock)); - newblock->next = stringMemory; - newblock->nextFree = 0; - stringMemory = newblock; + || (stringMemory->nextFree+len) > STRING_BLOCK_MAX) { + StringBlock * newblock = (StringBlock *) ckalloc(sizeof(StringBlock)); + newblock->next = stringMemory; + newblock->nextFree = 0; + stringMemory = newblock; } result = stringMemory->strings + stringMemory->nextFree; stringMemory->nextFree += len; memcpy(result, in, len); - return result; } @@ -2621,29 +2416,29 @@ AddString( * * TkMacOSXIsCharacterMissing -- * - * Given a tkFont and a character determine whether the character has - * a glyph defined in the font or not. + * Given a tkFont and a character determine whether the character has a + * glyph defined in the font or not. * * Results: - * Returns a 1 if the character is missing, a 0 if it is not. + * Returns a 1 if the character is missing, a 0 if it is not. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int TkMacOSXIsCharacterMissing( - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The font we are looking in. */ - unsigned int searchChar) /* The character we are looking for. */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The font we are looking in. */ + unsigned int searchChar) /* The character we are looking for. */ { /* Background: This function is private and only used in * tkMacOSXMenu.c:FindMarkCharacter(). * - * We could use ATSUMatchFont() to implement. We'd have to change the - * definition of the encoding of the parameter searchChar from MacRoman - * to UniChar for that. + * We could use ATSUMatchFont() to implement. We'd have to change the + * definition of the encoding of the parameter searchChar from MacRoman to + * UniChar for that. * * The system uses font fallback for controls, so we don't really need * this. */ @@ -2656,30 +2451,27 @@ TkMacOSXIsCharacterMissing( * * TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle -- * - * This procedure sets up the appropriate ControlFontStyleRec - * for a Mac control. + * This procedure sets up the appropriate ControlFontStyleRec + * for a Mac control. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle( - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Tk font object to use for the control. */ - ControlFontStylePtr fsPtr) /* The style object to configure. */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Tk font object to use for the control. */ + ControlFontStylePtr fsPtr) /* The style object to configure. */ { - const MacFont * fontPtr; - fontPtr = (MacFont *) tkfont; - fsPtr->flags = - kControlUseFontMask| - kControlUseSizeMask| - kControlUseFaceMask| - kControlUseJustMask; + const MacFont * fontPtr = (MacFont *) tkfont; + + fsPtr->flags = kControlUseFontMask | + kControlUseSizeMask | kControlUseFaceMask | kControlUseJustMask; fsPtr->font = fontPtr->qdFont; fsPtr->size = fontPtr->qdSize; fsPtr->style = fontPtr->qdStyle; @@ -2691,47 +2483,53 @@ TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle( * * TkMacOSXUseAntialiasedText -- * - * Enables or disables application-wide use of antialiased text (where - * available). Sets up a linked Tcl global variable to allow - * disabling of antialiased text from tcl. - * The possible values for this variable are: + * Enables or disables application-wide use of antialiased text (where + * available). Sets up a linked Tcl global variable to allow disabling of + * antialiased text from tcl. The possible values for this variable are: * - * -1 - Use system default as configurable in "System Preferences" -> - * "General". - * 0 - Unconditionally disable antialiasing. - * 1 - Unconditionally enable antialiasing. + * -1 - Use system default as configurable in "System Preferences" -> + * "General". + * 0 - Unconditionally disable antialiasing. + * 1 - Unconditionally enable antialiasing. * * Results: * - * TCL_OK. + * TCL_OK. * * Side effects: * - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXUseAntialiasedText( - Tcl_Interp * interp, /* The Tcl interpreter to receive the - * variable .*/ - int enable) /* Initial value. */ + Tcl_Interp * interp, /* The Tcl interpreter to receive the variable .*/ + int enable) /* Initial value. */ { static Boolean initialized = FALSE; - if(!initialized) { - initialized = TRUE; - - if (Tcl_CreateNamespace(interp, "::tk::mac", NULL, NULL) == NULL) { - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - } - if (Tcl_LinkVar(interp, "::tk::mac::antialiasedtext", - (char *) &antialiasedTextEnabled, - TCL_LINK_INT) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - } + if (!initialized) { + initialized = TRUE; + + if (Tcl_CreateNamespace(interp, "::tk::mac", NULL, NULL) == NULL) { + Tcl_ResetResult(interp); + } + if (Tcl_LinkVar(interp, "::tk::mac::antialiasedtext", + (char *) &antialiasedTextEnabled, + TCL_LINK_INT) != TCL_OK) { + Tcl_ResetResult(interp); + } } antialiasedTextEnabled = enable; return TCL_OK; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXInit.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXInit.c index d3492c4..6059708 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXInit.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXInit.c @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXInit.c,v 1.25 2006/11/24 19:03:50 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXInit.c,v 1.26 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -198,22 +198,29 @@ TkpInit(interp) FSRef ref; SInt16 refNum; - /* Write resource data to temporary file and open it */ + /* + * Write resource data to temporary file and open it. + */ + strcpy(fileName, P_tmpdir); if (fileName[strlen(fileName) - 1] != '/') { strcat(fileName, "/"); } strcat(fileName, "tkMacOSX_XXXXXX"); fd = mkstemp(fileName); - if (fd == -1) break; + if (fd == -1) { + break; + } fcntl(fd, F_SETFD, FD_CLOEXEC); - if (write(fd, data, size) == -1) break; + if (write(fd, data, size) == -1) { + break; + } err = FSPathMakeRef((unsigned char*)fileName, &ref, NULL); - if (err != noErr) break; + if (err != noErr) { + break; + } err = FSOpenResourceFile(&ref, 0, NULL, fsRdPerm, &refNum); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - if (err != noErr) fprintf(stderr,"FSOpenResourceFile error %ld\n",err); -#endif + LOG_ON_ERROR(FSOpenResourceFile); break; } if (fd != -1) { @@ -225,12 +232,11 @@ TkpInit(interp) } /* REMOVE ME: Close stdin & stdout for remote debugging otherwise we - * will fight with gdb for stdin & stdout - */ + * will fight with gdb for stdin & stdout */ - if (getenv ("XCNOSTDIN") != NULL) { - close (0); - close (1); + if (getenv("XCNOSTDIN") != NULL) { + close(0); + close(1); } /* @@ -241,18 +247,22 @@ TkpInit(interp) if (!isatty(0)) { struct stat st; + if (fstat(0, &st) || (S_ISCHR(st.st_mode) && st.st_blocks == 0)) { Tk_InitConsoleChannels(interp); Tcl_RegisterChannel(interp, Tcl_GetStdChannel(TCL_STDIN)); Tcl_RegisterChannel(interp, Tcl_GetStdChannel(TCL_STDOUT)); Tcl_RegisterChannel(interp, Tcl_GetStdChannel(TCL_STDERR)); + /* - * Only show the console if we don't have a startup script - * and tcl_interactive hasn't been set already. + * Only show the console if we don't have a startup script and + * tcl_interactive hasn't been set already. */ + if (Tcl_GetStartupScript(NULL) == NULL) { - CONST char *intvar = - Tcl_GetVar(interp, "tcl_interactive", TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); + CONST char *intvar = Tcl_GetVar(interp, + "tcl_interactive", TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); + if (intvar == NULL) { Tcl_SetVar(interp, "tcl_interactive", "1", TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXInt.h b/macosx/tkMacOSXInt.h index f3bb504..289f47b 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXInt.h +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXInt.h @@ -6,10 +6,10 @@ * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXInt.h,v 1.20 2006/10/31 22:33:34 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXInt.h,v 1.21 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #ifndef _TKMACINT @@ -32,64 +32,63 @@ #endif struct TkWindowPrivate { - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Ptr to tk window or NULL if Pixmap */ - CGrafPtr grafPtr; + TkWindow *winPtr; /* Ptr to tk window or NULL if Pixmap */ + CGrafPtr grafPtr; ControlRef rootControl; - int xOff; /* X offset from toplevel window */ - int yOff; /* Y offset from toplevel window */ + int xOff; /* X offset from toplevel window */ + int yOff; /* Y offset from toplevel window */ RgnHandle clipRgn; /* Visible region of window */ RgnHandle aboveClipRgn; /* Visible region of window & it's children */ int referenceCount; /* Don't delete toplevel until children are * gone. */ - struct TkWindowPrivate *toplevel; /* Pointer to the toplevel - * datastruct. */ + struct TkWindowPrivate *toplevel; + /* Pointer to the toplevel datastruct. */ int flags; /* Various state see defines below. */ }; typedef struct TkWindowPrivate MacDrawable; /* - * This list is used to keep track of toplevel windows that have a Mac - * window attached. This is useful for several things, not the least - * of which is maintaining floating windows. + * This list is used to keep track of toplevel windows that have a Mac window + * attached. This is useful for several things, not the least of which is + * maintaining floating windows. */ typedef struct TkMacOSXWindowList { - struct TkMacOSXWindowList *nextPtr; /* The next window in the list. */ - TkWindow *winPtr; /* This window */ + struct TkMacOSXWindowList *nextPtr; + /* The next window in the list. */ + TkWindow *winPtr; /* This window */ } TkMacOSXWindowList; /* * Defines use for the flags field of the MacDrawable data structure. */ - + #define TK_SCROLLBAR_GROW 1 #define TK_CLIP_INVALID 2 #define TK_HOST_EXISTS 4 #define TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU 8 /* - * I am reserving TK_EMBEDDED = 0x100 in the MacDrawable flags - * This is defined in tk.h. We need to duplicate the TK_EMBEDDED flag in the - * TkWindow structure for the window, but in the MacWin. This way we can - * still tell what the correct port is after the TKWindow structure has been - * freed. This actually happens when you bind destroy of a toplevel to - * Destroy of a child. + * I am reserving TK_EMBEDDED = 0x100 in the MacDrawable flags. This is + * defined in tk.h. We need to duplicate the TK_EMBEDDED flag in the TkWindow + * structure for the window, but in the MacWin. This way we can still tell + * what the correct port is after the TKWindow structure has been freed. This + * actually happens when you bind destroy of a toplevel to Destroy of a child. */ /* - * This structure is for handling Netscape-type in process - * embedding where Tk does not control the top-level. It contains - * various functions that are needed by Mac specific routines, like - * TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort. The definitions of the function types - * are in tkMacOSX.h. + * This structure is for handling Netscape-type in process embedding where Tk + * does not control the top-level. It contains various functions that are + * needed by Mac specific routines, like TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort. The + * definitions of the function types are in tkMacOSX.h. */ typedef struct { - Tk_MacOSXEmbedRegisterWinProc *registerWinProc; - Tk_MacOSXEmbedGetGrafPortProc *getPortProc; - Tk_MacOSXEmbedMakeContainerExistProc *containerExistProc; - Tk_MacOSXEmbedGetClipProc *getClipProc; - Tk_MacOSXEmbedGetOffsetInParentProc *getOffsetProc; + Tk_MacOSXEmbedRegisterWinProc *registerWinProc; + Tk_MacOSXEmbedGetGrafPortProc *getPortProc; + Tk_MacOSXEmbedMakeContainerExistProc *containerExistProc; + Tk_MacOSXEmbedGetClipProc *getClipProc; + Tk_MacOSXEmbedGetOffsetInParentProc *getOffsetProc; } TkMacOSXEmbedHandler; MODULE_SCOPE TkMacOSXEmbedHandler *tkMacOSXEmbedHandler; @@ -97,7 +96,7 @@ MODULE_SCOPE TkMacOSXEmbedHandler *tkMacOSXEmbedHandler; /* * Defines used for TkMacOSXInvalidateWindow */ - + #define TK_WINDOW_ONLY 0 #define TK_PARENT_WINDOW 1 @@ -120,65 +119,104 @@ MODULE_SCOPE TkMacOSXEmbedHandler *tkMacOSXEmbedHandler; * Defines for tkTextDisp.c */ -#define TK_LAYOUT_WITH_BASE_CHUNKS 1 -#define TK_DRAW_IN_CONTEXT 1 +#define TK_LAYOUT_WITH_BASE_CHUNKS 1 +#define TK_DRAW_IN_CONTEXT 1 /* - * Variables shared among various Mac Tk modules but are not - * exported to the outside world. + * Variables shared among various Mac Tk modules but are not exported to the + * outside world. */ /* * Globals shared among Macintosh Tk */ -MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkCurrentAppleMenu; /* Handle to current Apple Menu */ -MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkAppleMenu; /* Handle to default Apple Menu */ -MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkFileMenu; /* Handles to menus */ -MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkEditMenu; /* Handles to menus */ -MODULE_SCOPE RgnHandle tkMenuCascadeRgn;/* A region to clip with. */ -MODULE_SCOPE int tkUseMenuCascadeRgn; /* If this is 1, clipping code - * should intersect tkMenuCascadeRgn - * before drawing occurs. - * tkMenuCascadeRgn will only - * be valid when the value of this - * variable is 1. */ -MODULE_SCOPE int tkPictureIsOpen; /* If this is 1, we are drawing to a - * picture The clipping should then be - * done relative to the bounds of the - * picture rather than the window. As - * of OS X.0.4, something is seriously - * wrong: The clipping bounds only - * seem to work if the top,left values - * are 0,0 The destination rectangle - * for CopyBits should also have - * top,left values of 0,0 - */ +MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkCurrentAppleMenu; + /* Handle to current Apple Menu */ +MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkAppleMenu; + /* Handle to default Apple Menu */ +MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkFileMenu; + /* Handles to menus */ +MODULE_SCOPE MenuHandle tkEditMenu; + /* Handles to menus */ +MODULE_SCOPE RgnHandle tkMenuCascadeRgn; + /* A region to clip with. */ +MODULE_SCOPE int tkUseMenuCascadeRgn; + /* If this is 1, clipping code should + * intersect tkMenuCascadeRgn before drawing + * occurs. tkMenuCascadeRgn will only be valid + * when the value of this variable is 1. */ +MODULE_SCOPE int tkPictureIsOpen; + /* If this is 1, we are drawing to a picture + * The clipping should then be done relative + * to the bounds of the picture rather than + * the window. As of OS X.0.4, something is + * seriously wrong: The clipping bounds only + * seem to work if the top,left values are 0,0 + * The destination rectangle for CopyBits + * should also have top,left values of 0,0 */ MODULE_SCOPE TkMacOSXWindowList *tkMacOSXWindowListPtr; - /* The list of toplevels */ + /* The list of toplevels */ MODULE_SCOPE Tcl_Encoding TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding; -MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXDisplayChanged(Display *display); -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXUseAntialiasedText(Tcl_Interp *interp, int enable); -MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXInitCarbonEvents(Tcl_Interp *interp); -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing(Tcl_Interp *interp, int enable, int antiAlias); -MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXInitKeyboard(Tcl_Interp *interp); -MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXDefaultStartupScript(void); -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXGenerateFocusEvent( Window window, int activeFlag); +MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXDisplayChanged(Display *display); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXUseAntialiasedText(Tcl_Interp *interp, + int enable); +MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXInitCarbonEvents(Tcl_Interp *interp); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXInitCGDrawing(Tcl_Interp *interp, int enable, + int antiAlias); +MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXInitKeyboard(Tcl_Interp *interp); +MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXDefaultStartupScript(void); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXGenerateFocusEvent(Window window, + int activeFlag); MODULE_SCOPE WindowClass TkMacOSXWindowClass(TkWindow *winPtr); -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed(TkWindow *winPtr); -MODULE_SCOPE int TkGenerateButtonEventForXPointer(Window window); -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXCompareColors(unsigned long c1, unsigned long c2); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed(TkWindow *winPtr); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkGenerateButtonEventForXPointer(Window window); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXCompareColors(unsigned long c1, + unsigned long c2); +MODULE_SCOPE void * TkMacOSXGetNamedSymbol(const char *module, + const char *symbol); + +/* + * Macro to abstract common use of TkMacOSXGetNamedSymbol to initialize named + * symbols. + */ -MODULE_SCOPE void* TkMacOSXGetNamedSymbol(const char* module, const char* symbol); -/* Macro to abstract common use of TkMacOSXGetNamedSymbol to initialize named symbols */ #define TkMacOSXInitNamedSymbol(module, ret, symbol, ...) \ static ret (* symbol)(__VA_ARGS__) = (void*)(-1L); \ if (symbol == (void*)(-1L)) { \ symbol = TkMacOSXGetNamedSymbol(STRINGIFY(module), STRINGIFY(_##symbol));\ } +/* + * Macro to make handling failed events a little bit less verbose. Assumes + * that error values are always in the (local) variable 'err'. + */ + +#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG +#define LOG_MSG(msg, ...) fprintf(stderr, msg "\n", __VA_ARGS__) +#define LOG_ON_ERROR(msg) \ + if (err != noErr) { \ + fprintf(stderr, ##msg " failed, %d\n", (int) err); \ + } +#else +#define LOG_MSG(msg, ...) /* do nothing */ +#define LOG_ON_ERROR(msg) /* do nothing */ +#endif + +/* + * Include the stubbed internal platform-specific API. + */ + #include "tkIntPlatDecls.h" #endif /* _TKMACINT */ + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c index 3a6551b..27d6c7b 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ /* * tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c -- * - * This file implements functions that decode & handle keyboard events - * on MacOS X. + * This file implements functions that decode & handle keyboard events + * on MacOS X. * * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2006 Daniel A. Steffen @@ -10,51 +10,49 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * The following terms apply to all files originating from Apple - * Computer, Inc. ("Apple") and associated with the software - * unless explicitly disclaimed in individual files. - * - * - * Apple hereby grants permission to use, copy, modify, - * distribute, and license this software and its documentation - * for any purpose, provided that existing copyright notices are - * retained in all copies and that this notice is included - * verbatim in any distributions. No written agreement, license, - * or royalty fee is required for any of the authorized - * uses. Modifications to this software may be copyrighted by - * their authors and need not follow the licensing terms - * described here, provided that the new terms are clearly - * indicated on the first page of each file where they apply. - * - * - * IN NO EVENT SHALL APPLE, THE AUTHORS OR DISTRIBUTORS OF THE - * SOFTWARE BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY FOR DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, - * INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF - * THIS SOFTWARE, ITS DOCUMENTATION, OR ANY DERIVATIVES THEREOF, - * EVEN IF APPLE OR THE AUTHORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE - * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. APPLE, THE AUTHORS AND - * DISTRIBUTORS SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, - * BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, - * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. THIS - * SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, AND APPLE,THE - * AUTHORS AND DISTRIBUTORS HAVE NO OBLIGATION TO PROVIDE - * MAINTENANCE, SUPPORT, UPDATES, ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS. - * - * GOVERNMENT USE: If you are acquiring this software on behalf - * of the U.S. government, the Government shall have only - * "Restricted Rights" in the software and related documentation - * as defined in the Federal Acquisition Regulations (FARs) in - * Clause 52.227.19 (c) (2). If you are acquiring the software - * on behalf of the Department of Defense, the software shall be - * classified as "Commercial Computer Software" and the - * Government shall have only "Restricted Rights" as defined in - * Clause 252.227-7013 (c) (1) of DFARs. Notwithstanding the - * foregoing, the authors grant the U.S. Government and others - * acting in its behalf permission to use and distribute the - * software in accordance with the terms specified in this - * license. - * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c,v 1.18 2006/09/11 14:41:04 das Exp $ + * The following terms apply to all files originating from Apple + * Computer, Inc. ("Apple") and associated with the software + * unless explicitly disclaimed in individual files. + * + * Apple hereby grants permission to use, copy, modify, + * distribute, and license this software and its documentation + * for any purpose, provided that existing copyright notices are + * retained in all copies and that this notice is included + * verbatim in any distributions. No written agreement, license, + * or royalty fee is required for any of the authorized + * uses. Modifications to this software may be copyrighted by + * their authors and need not follow the licensing terms + * described here, provided that the new terms are clearly + * indicated on the first page of each file where they apply. + * + * IN NO EVENT SHALL APPLE, THE AUTHORS OR DISTRIBUTORS OF THE + * SOFTWARE BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY FOR DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, + * INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF + * THIS SOFTWARE, ITS DOCUMENTATION, OR ANY DERIVATIVES THEREOF, + * EVEN IF APPLE OR THE AUTHORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE + * POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. APPLE, THE AUTHORS AND + * DISTRIBUTORS SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, + * BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, + * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. THIS + * SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, AND APPLE,THE + * AUTHORS AND DISTRIBUTORS HAVE NO OBLIGATION TO PROVIDE + * MAINTENANCE, SUPPORT, UPDATES, ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS. + * + * GOVERNMENT USE: If you are acquiring this software on behalf + * of the U.S. government, the Government shall have only + * "Restricted Rights" in the software and related documentation + * as defined in the Federal Acquisition Regulations (FARs) in + * Clause 52.227.19 (c) (2). If you are acquiring the software + * on behalf of the Department of Defense, the software shall be + * classified as "Commercial Computer Software" and the + * Government shall have only "Restricted Rights" as defined in + * Clause 252.227-7013 (c) (1) of DFARs. Notwithstanding the + * foregoing, the authors grant the U.S. Government and others + * acting in its behalf permission to use and distribute the + * software in accordance with the terms specified in this + * license. + * + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXKeyEvent.c,v 1.19 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -65,252 +63,225 @@ #define TK_MAC_DEBUG_KEYBOARD #endif */ +#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_KEYBOARD +#define KDBG DBG_MSG +#else +#define KDBG(...) /* nothing */ +#endif typedef struct { - WindowRef whichWindow; - int global_x, global_y; - int local_x, local_y; + WindowRef whichWindow; + int global_x, global_y; + int local_x, local_y; unsigned int state; unsigned char ch; - UInt32 keyCode; - UInt32 keyModifiers; - UInt32 message; + UInt32 keyCode; + UInt32 keyModifiers; + UInt32 message; } KeyEventData; -static Tk_Window gGrabWinPtr = NULL; /* Current grab window, - * NULL if no grab. */ -static Tk_Window gKeyboardWinPtr = NULL; /* Current keyboard grab window. */ - -static UInt32 deadKeyStateUp = 0; /* The deadkey state for the current - * sequence of keyup events or 0 if - * not in a deadkey sequence */ -static UInt32 deadKeyStateDown = 0; /* Ditto for keydown */ +static Tk_Window gGrabWinPtr = NULL; + /* Current grab window, NULL if no grab. */ +static Tk_Window gKeyboardWinPtr = NULL; + /* Current keyboard grab window. */ +static UInt32 deadKeyStateUp = 0; + /* The deadkey state for the current sequence + * of keyup events or 0 if not in a deadkey + * sequence */ +static UInt32 deadKeyStateDown = 0; + /* Ditto for keydown */ /* * Declarations for functions used only in this file. */ - -static int InitKeyData( - KeyEventData * keyEventDataPtr); - -static int InitKeyEvent( - XEvent * eventPtr, - KeyEventData * e, - UInt32 savedKeyCode, - UInt32 savedModifiers); - -static int GenerateKeyEvent ( - UInt32 eKind, - KeyEventData * e, - UInt32 savedKeyCode, - UInt32 savedModifiers, - const UniChar * chars, int numChars); - -static int GetKeyboardLayout ( - Ptr * resourcePtr, TextEncoding * encodingPtr); -static TextEncoding GetKCHREncoding( - ScriptCode script, SInt32 layoutid); - -static int KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource( - UniChar * uniChars, int maxChars, - Ptr uchr, - EventKind eKind, - UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, - UInt32 * deadKeyStatePtr); - -static int KeycodeToUnicodeViaKCHRResource( - UniChar * uniChars, int maxChars, - Ptr kchr, TextEncoding encoding, - EventKind eKind, - UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, - UInt32 * deadKeyStatePtr); + +static int InitKeyData(KeyEventData *keyEventDataPtr); +static int InitKeyEvent(XEvent *eventPtr, KeyEventData *e, + UInt32 savedKeyCode, UInt32 savedModifiers); +static int GenerateKeyEvent(UInt32 eKind, KeyEventData *e, + UInt32 savedKeyCode, UInt32 savedModifiers, + const UniChar *chars, int numChars); +static int GetKeyboardLayout(Ptr *resourcePtr, + TextEncoding *encodingPtr); +static TextEncoding GetKCHREncoding(ScriptCode script, SInt32 layoutid); +static int KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource(UniChar *uniChars, + int maxChars, Ptr uchr, EventKind eKind, + UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, + UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr); +static int KeycodeToUnicodeViaKCHRResource(UniChar *uniChars, + int maxChars, Ptr kchr, TextEncoding encoding, + EventKind eKind, UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, + UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent -- * - * This routine processes the event in eventPtr, and - * generates the appropriate Tk events from it. + * This routine processes the event in eventPtr, and generates the + * appropriate Tk events from it. * * Results: - * True if event(s) are generated - false otherwise. + * True if event(s) are generated - false otherwise. * * Side effects: - * Additional events may be place on the Tk event queue. + * Additional events may be place on the Tk event queue. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent( - TkMacOSXEvent * eventPtr, - MacEventStatus * statusPtr) + TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, + MacEventStatus *statusPtr) { static UInt32 savedKeyCode = 0; static UInt32 savedModifiers = 0; static UniChar savedChar = 0; - OSStatus status; + OSStatus status; KeyEventData keyEventData; - MenuRef menuRef; + MenuRef menuRef; MenuItemIndex menuItemIndex; int eventGenerated; UniChar uniChars[5]; /* make this larger, if needed */ UInt32 uniCharsLen = 0; if (!InitKeyData(&keyEventData)) { - statusPtr->err = 1; - return false; + statusPtr->err = 1; + return false; } - + /* * Because of the way that Tk operates, we can't in general funnel menu - * accelerators through IsMenuKeyEvent. Tk treats accelerators as mere + * accelerators through IsMenuKeyEvent. Tk treats accelerators as mere * decoration, and the user has to install bindings to get them to fire. * - * However, the only way to trigger the Hide & Hide Others functions - * is by invoking the Menu command for Hide. So there is no nice way to - * provide a Tk command to hide the app which would be available for a - * binding. So I am going to hijack Command-H and Command-Shift-H - * here, and run the menu commands. Since the HI Guidelines explicitly - * reserve these for Hide, this isn't such a bad thing. Also, if you do - * rebind Command-H to another menu item, Hide will lose its binding. - * - * Note that I don't really do anything at this point, - * I just mark stopProcessing as 0 and return, and then the - * RecieveAndProcessEvent code will dispatch the event to the default - * handler. + * However, the only way to trigger the Hide & Hide Others functions is by + * invoking the Menu command for Hide. So there is no nice way to provide + * a Tk command to hide the app which would be available for a binding. So + * I am going to hijack Command-H and Command-Shift-H here, and run the + * menu commands. Since the HI Guidelines explicitly reserve these for + * Hide, this isn't such a bad thing. Also, if you do rebind Command-H to + * another menu item, Hide will lose its binding. + * + * Note that I don't really do anything at this point, I just mark + * stopProcessing as 0 and return, and then the RecieveAndProcessEvent + * code will dispatch the event to the default handler. */ - if ((eventPtr->eKind == kEventRawKeyDown + if ((eventPtr->eKind == kEventRawKeyDown || eventPtr->eKind == kEventRawKeyRepeat) - && IsMenuKeyEvent(tkCurrentAppleMenu, eventPtr->eventRef, + && IsMenuKeyEvent(tkCurrentAppleMenu, eventPtr->eventRef, kMenuEventQueryOnly, &menuRef, &menuItemIndex)) { MenuCommand menuCmd; GetMenuItemCommandID (menuRef, menuItemIndex, &menuCmd); switch (menuCmd) { - case kHICommandHide: - case kHICommandHideOthers: - case kHICommandShowAll: - case kHICommandPreferences: - case kHICommandQuit: - statusPtr->stopProcessing = 0; - return 0; /* TODO: may not be on event on queue. */ - break; - default: - break; + case kHICommandHide: + case kHICommandHideOthers: + case kHICommandShowAll: + case kHICommandPreferences: + case kHICommandQuit: + statusPtr->stopProcessing = 0; + return 0; /* TODO: may not be on event on queue. */ + break; + default: + break; } } - status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, - kEventParamKeyMacCharCodes, - typeChar, NULL, - sizeof(keyEventData.ch), NULL, - &keyEventData.ch); + status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, + kEventParamKeyMacCharCodes, typeChar, NULL, + sizeof(keyEventData.ch), NULL, &keyEventData.ch); if (status != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr, "Failed to retrieve KeyMacCharCodes\n"); -#endif - statusPtr->err = 1; - return false; - } - status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, - kEventParamKeyCode, - typeUInt32, NULL, - sizeof(keyEventData.keyCode), NULL, - &keyEventData.keyCode); + LOG_MSG("Failed to retrieve KeyMacCharCodes"); + statusPtr->err = 1; + return false; + } + status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, kEventParamKeyCode, + typeUInt32, NULL, sizeof(keyEventData.keyCode), NULL, + &keyEventData.keyCode); if (status != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr, "Failed to retrieve KeyCode\n"); -#endif - statusPtr->err = 1; - return false; + LOG_MSG("Failed to retrieve KeyCode"); + statusPtr->err = 1; + return false; } - status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, - kEventParamKeyModifiers, - typeUInt32, NULL, - sizeof(keyEventData.keyModifiers), NULL, - &keyEventData.keyModifiers); + status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, kEventParamKeyModifiers, + typeUInt32, NULL, sizeof(keyEventData.keyModifiers), NULL, + &keyEventData.keyModifiers); if (status != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr, "Failed to retrieve KeyModifiers\n"); -#endif - statusPtr->err = 1; - return false; + LOG_MSG("Failed to retrieve KeyModifiers"); + statusPtr->err = 1; + return false; } switch (eventPtr->eKind) { - case kEventRawKeyUp: - case kEventRawKeyDown: - case kEventRawKeyRepeat: - { - UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr; - - if (kEventRawKeyDown == eventPtr->eKind) { - deadKeyStatePtr = &deadKeyStateDown; - } else { - deadKeyStatePtr = &deadKeyStateUp; - } - - uniCharsLen = TkMacOSXKeycodeToUnicode( - uniChars, sizeof(uniChars)/sizeof(*uniChars), - eventPtr->eKind, - keyEventData.keyCode, keyEventData.keyModifiers, - deadKeyStatePtr); - } + case kEventRawKeyUp: + case kEventRawKeyDown: + case kEventRawKeyRepeat: { + UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr; + + if (kEventRawKeyDown == eventPtr->eKind) { + deadKeyStatePtr = &deadKeyStateDown; + } else { + deadKeyStatePtr = &deadKeyStateUp; + } + + uniCharsLen = TkMacOSXKeycodeToUnicode(uniChars, + sizeof(uniChars)/sizeof(*uniChars), eventPtr->eKind, + keyEventData.keyCode, keyEventData.keyModifiers, + deadKeyStatePtr); + } } if (kEventRawKeyUp == eventPtr->eKind) { - /* - * For some reason the deadkey processing for KeyUp doesn't work - * sometimes, so we fudge and use the last detected KeyDown. - */ - - if((0 == uniCharsLen) && (0 != savedChar)) { - uniChars[0] = savedChar; - uniCharsLen = 1; - } - - /* - * Suppress keyup events while we have a deadkey sequence on keydown. - * We still *do* want to collect deadkey state in this situation if - * the system provides it, that's why we do this only after - * TkMacOSXKeycodeToUnicode(). - */ - - if (0 != deadKeyStateDown) { - uniCharsLen = 0; - } + /* + * For some reason the deadkey processing for KeyUp doesn't work + * sometimes, so we fudge and use the last detected KeyDown. + */ + + if ((0 == uniCharsLen) && (0 != savedChar)) { + uniChars[0] = savedChar; + uniCharsLen = 1; + } + + /* + * Suppress keyup events while we have a deadkey sequence on keydown. + * We still *do* want to collect deadkey state in this situation if + * the system provides it, that's why we do this only after + * TkMacOSXKeycodeToUnicode(). + */ + + if (0 != deadKeyStateDown) { + uniCharsLen = 0; + } } keyEventData.message = keyEventData.ch|(keyEventData.keyCode << 8); - eventGenerated = GenerateKeyEvent( - eventPtr->eKind, &keyEventData, - savedKeyCode, savedModifiers, - uniChars, uniCharsLen); + eventGenerated = GenerateKeyEvent(eventPtr->eKind, &keyEventData, + savedKeyCode, savedModifiers, uniChars, uniCharsLen); savedModifiers = keyEventData.keyModifiers; if ((kEventRawKeyDown == eventPtr->eKind) && (uniCharsLen > 0)) { - savedChar = uniChars[0]; + savedChar = uniChars[0]; } else { - savedChar = 0; + savedChar = 0; } - + statusPtr->stopProcessing = 1; if (eventGenerated == 0) { - savedKeyCode = keyEventData.message; - return false; + savedKeyCode = keyEventData.message; + return false; } else if (eventGenerated == -1) { - savedKeyCode = 0; - statusPtr->stopProcessing = 0; - return false; + savedKeyCode = 0; + statusPtr->stopProcessing = 0; + return false; } else { - savedKeyCode = 0; - return true; + savedKeyCode = 0; + return true; } } @@ -319,107 +290,102 @@ TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent( * * GenerateKeyEvent -- * - * Given Macintosh keyUp, keyDown & autoKey events (in their "raw" - * form) and a list of unicode characters this function generates the - * appropriate X key events. + * Given Macintosh keyUp, keyDown & autoKey events (in their "raw" form) + * and a list of unicode characters this function generates the + * appropriate X key events. * - * Parameter eKind is a raw keyboard event. e contains the data sent - * with the event. savedKeyCode and savedModifiers contain the values - * from the last event that came before (see - * TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent()). chars/numChars has the Unicode - * characters for which we want to create events. + * Parameter eKind is a raw keyboard event. e contains the data sent with + * the event. savedKeyCode and savedModifiers contain the values from the + * last event that came before (see TkMacOSXProcessKeyboardEvent()). + * chars/numChars has the Unicode characters for which we want to create + * events. * * Results: - * 1 if an event was generated, -1 for any error. + * 1 if an event was generated, -1 for any error. * * Side effects: - * Additional events may be place on the Tk event queue. + * Additional events may be place on the Tk event queue. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int GenerateKeyEvent( - UInt32 eKind, - KeyEventData * e, - UInt32 savedKeyCode, - UInt32 savedModifiers, - const UniChar * chars, int numChars) + UInt32 eKind, + KeyEventData * e, + UInt32 savedKeyCode, + UInt32 savedModifiers, + const UniChar * chars, + int numChars) { XEvent event; int i; - + if (-1 == InitKeyEvent(&event, e, savedKeyCode, savedModifiers)) { - return -1; + return -1; } if (kEventRawKeyModifiersChanged == eKind) { + if (savedModifiers > e->keyModifiers) { + event.xany.type = KeyRelease; + } else { + event.xany.type = KeyPress; + } - if (savedModifiers > e->keyModifiers) { - event.xany.type = KeyRelease; - } else { - event.xany.type = KeyPress; - } - - /* - * Use special '-1' to signify a special keycode to our - * platform specific code in tkMacOSXKeyboard.c. This is - * rather like what happens on Windows. - */ - - event.xany.send_event = -1; - - /* - * Set keycode (which was zero) to the changed modifier - */ - - event.xkey.keycode = (e->keyModifiers ^ savedModifiers); - Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + /* + * Use special '-1' to signify a special keycode to our + * platform specific code in tkMacOSXKeyboard.c. This is + * rather like what happens on Windows. + */ - } else { + event.xany.send_event = -1; - for (i = 0; i < numChars; ++i) { - - /* - * Encode one char in the trans_chars array that was already - * introduced for MS Windows. Don't encode the string, if it is - * a control character but was not generated with a real control - * modifier. Such control characters get generated by KeyTrans() - * for special keys, but we rather want to identify those by - * their KeySyms. - */ - - event.xkey.trans_chars[0] = 0; - if ((controlKey & e->keyModifiers) || (chars[i] >= ' ')) { - int done; - done = Tcl_UniCharToUtf(chars[i],event.xkey.trans_chars); - event.xkey.trans_chars[done] = 0; - } - - switch(eKind) { - case kEventRawKeyDown: - event.xany.type = KeyPress; - Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); - break; - case kEventRawKeyUp: - event.xany.type = KeyRelease; - Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); - break; - case kEventRawKeyRepeat: - event.xany.type = KeyRelease; - Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); - event.xany.type = KeyPress; - Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); - break; - default: -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr, - "GenerateKeyEvent(): Invalid parameter eKind %d\n", - (int) eKind); -#endif - return -1; - } - } + /* + * Set keycode (which was zero) to the changed modifier + */ + + event.xkey.keycode = (e->keyModifiers ^ savedModifiers); + Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + + } else { + for (i = 0; i < numChars; ++i) { + /* + * Encode one char in the trans_chars array that was already + * introduced for MS Windows. Don't encode the string, if it is a + * control character but was not generated with a real control + * modifier. Such control characters get generated by KeyTrans() + * for special keys, but we rather want to identify those by their + * KeySyms. + */ + + event.xkey.trans_chars[0] = 0; + if ((controlKey & e->keyModifiers) || (chars[i] >= ' ')) { + int done; + done = Tcl_UniCharToUtf(chars[i],event.xkey.trans_chars); + event.xkey.trans_chars[done] = 0; + } + + switch(eKind) { + case kEventRawKeyDown: + event.xany.type = KeyPress; + Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + break; + case kEventRawKeyUp: + event.xany.type = KeyRelease; + Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + break; + case kEventRawKeyRepeat: + event.xany.type = KeyRelease; + Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + event.xany.type = KeyPress; + Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + break; + default: + LOG_MSG("GenerateKeyEvent(): Invalid parameter eKind %d", + (int) eKind); + return -1; + } + } } return 1; @@ -430,33 +396,33 @@ GenerateKeyEvent( * * InitKeyData -- * - * This routine initializes a KeyEventData structure by asking the OS - * and Tk for all the global information needed here. + * This routine initializes a KeyEventData structure by asking the OS and + * Tk for all the global information needed here. * * Results: - * True if the current front window can be found in Tk data structures - * - false otherwise. + * True if the current front window can be found in Tk data structures - + * false otherwise. * * Side Effects: - * None + * None * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static int -InitKeyData(KeyEventData * keyEventDataPtr) + +static int +InitKeyData( + KeyEventData *keyEventDataPtr) { - memset (keyEventDataPtr, 0, sizeof(*keyEventDataPtr)); + memset(keyEventDataPtr, 0, sizeof(*keyEventDataPtr)); keyEventDataPtr->whichWindow = ActiveNonFloatingWindow(); if (keyEventDataPtr->whichWindow == NULL) { - return false; + return false; } XQueryPointer(NULL, None, NULL, NULL, - &keyEventDataPtr->global_x, - &keyEventDataPtr->global_y, - &keyEventDataPtr->local_x, - &keyEventDataPtr->local_y, - &keyEventDataPtr->state); + &keyEventDataPtr->global_x, &keyEventDataPtr->global_y, + &keyEventDataPtr->local_x, &keyEventDataPtr->local_y, + &keyEventDataPtr->state); return true; } @@ -466,75 +432,70 @@ InitKeyData(KeyEventData * keyEventDataPtr) * * InitKeyEvent -- * - * Initialize an XEvent structure by asking Tk for global information. - * Also uses a KeyEventData structure and other current state. + * Initialize an XEvent structure by asking Tk for global information. + * Also uses a KeyEventData structure and other current state. * * Results: - * 1 on success, -1 for any error. + * 1 on success, -1 for any error. * * Side effects: - * Additional events may be place on the Tk event queue. + * Additional events may be place on the Tk event queue. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -/* - * We have a general problem here. How do we handle 'Option-char' - * keypresses? The problem is that we might want to bind to some of these - * (e.g. Cmd-Opt-d is 'uncomment' in Alpha). OTOH Option-d actually produces - * a real character on MacOS, namely a mathematical delta. +/* + * We have a general problem here. How do we handle 'Option-char' keypresses? + * The problem is that we might want to bind to some of these (e.g. Cmd-Opt-d + * is 'uncomment' in Alpha). OTOH Option-d actually produces a real character + * on MacOS, namely a mathematical delta. * * The current behaviour is that a binding goes by the combinations of - * modifiers and base keysym, that is Option-d. The string value of the - * event is the mathematical delta character, so if no binding calls - * [break], the text widget will insert that character. + * modifiers and base keysym, that is Option-d. The string value of the event + * is the mathematical delta character, so if no binding calls [break], the + * text widget will insert that character. * - * Note that this is similar to control combinations on all platforms. They + * Note that this is similar to control combinations on all platforms. They * also generate events that have the base character as keysym and a real - * control character as character value. So Ctrl+C gets us the keysym XK_C, + * control character as character value. So Ctrl+C gets us the keysym XK_C, * the modifier Control (so you can bind ) and a string value as * "\u0003". - * + * * For a different solutions we may want for the event to contain keysyms for - * *both* the 'Opt-d' side of things and the mathematical delta. Then a + * *both* the 'Opt-d' side of things and the mathematical delta. Then a * binding on Opt-d will trigger, but a binding on mathematical delta would - * also trigger. This would require changes in the core, though. + * also trigger. This would require changes in the core, though. */ static int InitKeyEvent( - XEvent * eventPtr, - KeyEventData * e, - UInt32 savedKeyCode, - UInt32 savedModifiers) + XEvent * eventPtr, + KeyEventData * e, + UInt32 savedKeyCode, + UInt32 savedModifiers) { Window window; Tk_Window tkwin; TkDisplay *dispPtr; - + /* - * The focus must be in the FrontWindow on the Macintosh. - * We then query Tk to determine the exact Tk window - * that owns the focus. + * The focus must be in the FrontWindow on the Macintosh. We then query Tk + * to determine the exact Tk window that owns the focus. */ window = TkMacOSXGetXWindow(e->whichWindow); dispPtr = TkGetDisplayList(); tkwin = Tk_IdToWindow(dispPtr->display, window); - + if (tkwin == NULL) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"tkwin == NULL, %d\n", __LINE__); -#endif - return -1; + LOG_MSG("tkwin == NULL, %d", __LINE__); + return -1; } - + tkwin = (Tk_Window) ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->dispPtr->focusPtr; if (tkwin == NULL) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"tkwin == NULL, %d\n", __LINE__); -#endif - return -1; + LOG_MSG("tkwin == NULL, %d", __LINE__); + return -1; } eventPtr->xany.send_event = false; @@ -551,17 +512,15 @@ InitKeyEvent( eventPtr->xkey.state = e->state; eventPtr->xkey.trans_chars[0] = 0; - Tk_TopCoordsToWindow( - tkwin, e->local_x, e->local_y, - &eventPtr->xkey.x, &eventPtr->xkey.y); + Tk_TopCoordsToWindow(tkwin, e->local_x, e->local_y, + &eventPtr->xkey.x, &eventPtr->xkey.y); eventPtr->xkey.keycode = e->ch | - ((savedKeyCode & charCodeMask) << 8) | - ((e->message&keyCodeMask) << 8); + ((savedKeyCode & charCodeMask) << 8) | + ((e->message&keyCodeMask) << 8); return 1; } - /* * If we have old headers, we need to define these types and constants @@ -583,25 +542,27 @@ InitKeyEvent( * * GetKeyboardLayout -- * - * Queries the OS for a pointer to a keyboard resource. + * Queries the OS for a pointer to a keyboard resource. * - * This function works with the keyboard layout switch menu. It uses - * Keyboard Layout Services, where available. + * This function works with the keyboard layout switch menu. It uses + * Keyboard Layout Services, where available. * * Results: - * 1 if there is returned a Unicode 'uchr' resource in *resourcePtr, 0 - * if it is a classic 'KCHR' resource. A pointer to the actual resource - * data goes into *resourcePtr. If the resource is a 'KCHR' resource, - * the corresponding Mac encoding goes into *encodingPtr. + * 1 if there is returned a Unicode 'uchr' resource in *resourcePtr, 0 if + * it is a classic 'KCHR' resource. A pointer to the actual resource data + * goes into *resourcePtr. If the resource is a 'KCHR' resource, the + * corresponding Mac encoding goes into *encodingPtr. * * Side effects: - * Sets some internal static variables. + * Sets some internal static variables. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int -GetKeyboardLayout (Ptr * resourcePtr, TextEncoding * encodingPtr) +GetKeyboardLayout( + Ptr *resourcePtr, + TextEncoding *encodingPtr) { static KeyboardLayoutRef lastLayout = NULL; static SInt32 lastLayoutId; @@ -622,279 +583,260 @@ GetKeyboardLayout (Ptr * resourcePtr, TextEncoding * encodingPtr) currentKeyScript = GetScriptManagerVariable(smKeyScript); TkMacOSXInitNamedSymbol(HIToolbox, OSStatus, KLGetCurrentKeyboardLayout, - KeyboardLayoutRef*); + KeyboardLayoutRef*); TkMacOSXInitNamedSymbol(HIToolbox, OSStatus, KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty, - KeyboardLayoutRef, KeyboardLayoutPropertyTag, const void**); + KeyboardLayoutRef, KeyboardLayoutPropertyTag, const void**); if (KLGetCurrentKeyboardLayout && KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty) { - - /* - * Use the Keyboard Layout Services (these functions only exist since - * 10.2). - */ - - KLGetCurrentKeyboardLayout(¤tLayout); - - if (currentLayout != NULL) { - - /* - * The layout pointer could in theory be the same for different - * layouts, only the id gives us the information that the - * keyboard has actually changed. OTOH the layout object can - * also change and it could still be the same layoutid. - */ - - KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty(currentLayout, kKLIdentifier, - (const void**)¤tLayoutId); - - if ((lastLayout != currentLayout) - || (lastLayoutId != currentLayoutId)) { - -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_KEYBOARD - fprintf (stderr, "GetKeyboardLayout(): Use KLS\n"); -#endif - - hasLayoutChanged = true; - - /* - * Reinitialize all relevant variables. - */ - - lastLayout = currentLayout; - lastLayoutId = currentLayoutId; - uchr = NULL; - KCHR = NULL; - - if ((KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty(currentLayout, - kKLuchrData, (const void**)&uchr) - == noErr) - && (uchr != NULL)) { - /* done */ - } else if ((KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty(currentLayout, - kKLKCHRData, (const void**)&KCHR) - == noErr) - && (KCHR != NULL)) { - /* done */ - } - } - } - + /* + * Use the Keyboard Layout Services (these functions only exist since + * 10.2). + */ + + KLGetCurrentKeyboardLayout(¤tLayout); + + if (currentLayout != NULL) { + /* + * The layout pointer could in theory be the same for different + * layouts, only the id gives us the information that the keyboard + * has actually changed. OTOH the layout object can also change + * and it could still be the same layoutid. + */ + + KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty(currentLayout, kKLIdentifier, + (const void**)¤tLayoutId); + + if ((lastLayout != currentLayout) + || (lastLayoutId != currentLayoutId)) { + KDBG("GetKeyboardLayout(): Use KLS"); + hasLayoutChanged = true; + + /* + * Reinitialize all relevant variables. + */ + + lastLayout = currentLayout; + lastLayoutId = currentLayoutId; + uchr = NULL; + KCHR = NULL; + + if ((KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty(currentLayout, kKLuchrData, + (const void**)&uchr) == noErr) && (uchr != NULL)) { + /* done */ + } else if ((KLGetKeyboardLayoutProperty(currentLayout, + kKLKCHRData, (const void**)&KCHR) == noErr) + && (KCHR != NULL)) { + /* done */ + } + } + } } else { - - /* - * Use the classic approach as shown in Apple code samples, loading - * the keyboard resources directly. This is broken for 10.3 and - * possibly already in 10.2. - */ - - currentLayoutId = GetScriptVariable(currentKeyScript,smScriptKeys); - - if ((lastLayout == NULL) || (lastLayoutId != currentLayoutId)) { - -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_KEYBOARD - fprintf (stderr, "GetKeyboardLayout(): Use GetResource()\n"); -#endif - - hasLayoutChanged = true; - - /* - * Reinitialize all relevant variables. - */ - - lastLayout = (KeyboardLayoutRef)-1; - lastLayoutId = currentLayoutId; - uchr = NULL; - KCHR = NULL; - - /* - * Get the new layout resource in the classic way. - */ - - if (handle != NULL) { - HUnlock(handle); - } - - if ((handle = GetResource('uchr',currentLayoutId)) != NULL) { - HLock(handle); - uchr = *handle; - } else if ((handle = GetResource('KCHR',currentLayoutId)) != NULL) { - HLock(handle); - KCHR = *handle; - } - } + /* + * Use the classic approach as shown in Apple code samples, loading + * the keyboard resources directly. This is broken for 10.3 and + * possibly already in 10.2. + */ + + currentLayoutId = GetScriptVariable(currentKeyScript,smScriptKeys); + + if ((lastLayout == NULL) || (lastLayoutId != currentLayoutId)) { + KDBG("GetKeyboardLayout(): Use GetResource()"); + + hasLayoutChanged = true; + + /* + * Reinitialize all relevant variables. + */ + + lastLayout = (KeyboardLayoutRef)-1; + lastLayoutId = currentLayoutId; + uchr = NULL; + KCHR = NULL; + + /* + * Get the new layout resource in the classic way. + */ + + if (handle != NULL) { + HUnlock(handle); + } + + if ((handle = GetResource('uchr',currentLayoutId)) != NULL) { + HLock(handle); + uchr = *handle; + } else if ((handle = GetResource('KCHR',currentLayoutId)) != NULL) { + HLock(handle); + KCHR = *handle; + } + } } if (hasLayoutChanged) { - #ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_KEYBOARD - if (KCHR != NULL) { - fprintf (stderr, "GetKeyboardLayout(): New 'KCHR' layout %d\n", - (int) (short) currentLayoutId); - } else if (uchr != NULL) { - fprintf (stderr, "GetKeyboardLayout(): New 'uchr' layout %d\n", - (int) (short) currentLayoutId); - } else { - fprintf (stderr, "GetKeyboardLayout(): Use cached layout " - "(should have been %d)\n", - (int) (short) currentLayoutId); - } + if (KCHR != NULL) { + KDBG("GetKeyboardLayout(): New 'KCHR' layout %d", + (int) (short) currentLayoutId); + } else if (uchr != NULL) { + KDBG("GetKeyboardLayout(): New 'uchr' layout %d", + (int) (short) currentLayoutId); + } else { + KDBG("GetKeyboardLayout(): Use cached layout " + "(should have been %d)", (int) (short) currentLayoutId); + } #endif - deadKeyStateUp = deadKeyStateDown = 0; - - /* - * If we did get a new 'KCHR', compute its encoding and put it into - * lastEncoding. - * - * If we didn't get a new 'KCHR' and if we have no 'uchr' either, get - * some 'KCHR' from the OS cache and leave lastEncoding at its - * current value. This should better not happen, it doesn't really - * work. - */ - - if (KCHR != NULL) { - lastEncoding = GetKCHREncoding(currentKeyScript, currentLayoutId); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG_KEYBOARD - fprintf (stderr, "GetKeyboardLayout(): New 'KCHR' encoding %lu " - "(%lu + 0x%lX)\n", - lastEncoding, lastEncoding & 0xFFFFL, - lastEncoding & ~0xFFFFL); -#endif - } else if (uchr == NULL) { - KCHR = (Ptr) GetScriptManagerVariable(smKCHRCache); - } + deadKeyStateUp = deadKeyStateDown = 0; + + /* + * If we did get a new 'KCHR', compute its encoding and put it into + * lastEncoding. + * + * If we didn't get a new 'KCHR' and if we have no 'uchr' either, get + * some 'KCHR' from the OS cache and leave lastEncoding at its + * current value. This should better not happen, it doesn't really + * work. + */ + + if (KCHR != NULL) { + lastEncoding = GetKCHREncoding(currentKeyScript, currentLayoutId); + KDBG("GetKeyboardLayout(): New 'KCHR' encoding %lu (%lu + 0x%lX)", + lastEncoding, lastEncoding & 0xFFFFL, + lastEncoding & ~0xFFFFL); + } else if (uchr == NULL) { + KCHR = (Ptr) GetScriptManagerVariable(smKCHRCache); + } } if (uchr != NULL) { - *resourcePtr = uchr; - return 1; + *resourcePtr = uchr; + return 1; } else { - *resourcePtr = KCHR; - *encodingPtr = lastEncoding; - return 0; + *resourcePtr = KCHR; + *encodingPtr = lastEncoding; + return 0; } } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * GetKCHREncoding -- * - * Upgrade a WorldScript code to a TEC encoding based on the keyboard - * layout id. + * Upgrade a WorldScript code to a TEC encoding based on the keyboard + * layout id. * * Results: - * The TEC code that corresponds best to the combination of WorldScript - * code and 'KCHR' id. + * The TEC code that corresponds best to the combination of WorldScript + * code and 'KCHR' id. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * * Rationale and Notes: - * WorldScript codes are sometimes not unique encodings. E.g. Icelandic - * uses script smRoman (0), but the actual encoding is - * kTextEncodingMacIcelandic (37). ftp://ftp.unicode.org/Public - * /MAPPINGS/VENDORS/APPLE/README.TXT has a good summary of these - * variants. So we need to upgrade the script to an encoding with - * GetTextEncodingFromScriptInfo(). + * WorldScript codes are sometimes not unique encodings. E.g. Icelandic + * uses script smRoman (0), but the actual encoding is + * kTextEncodingMacIcelandic (37). ftp://ftp.unicode.org/Public + * /MAPPINGS/VENDORS/APPLE/README.TXT has a good summary of these + * variants. So we need to upgrade the script to an encoding with + * GetTextEncodingFromScriptInfo(). * - * 'KCHR' ids are usually region codes (see the comments in Script.h). - * Where they are not, we get a paramErr from the OS function and have - * appropriate fallbacks. + * 'KCHR' ids are usually region codes (see the comments in Script.h). + * Where they are not, we get a paramErr from the OS function and have + * appropriate fallbacks. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static TextEncoding -GetKCHREncoding(ScriptCode script, SInt32 layoutid) +GetKCHREncoding( + ScriptCode script, + SInt32 layoutid) { RegionCode region = layoutid; TextEncoding encoding = script; if (GetTextEncodingFromScriptInfo(script, kTextLanguageDontCare, region, - &encoding) == noErr) { - return encoding; + &encoding) == noErr) { + return encoding; } /* - * GetTextEncodingFromScriptInfo() doesn't know about more exotic - * layouts. This provides a fallback for good measure. In an ideal - * world, exotic layouts would always provide a 'uchr' resource anyway, - * so we wouldn't need this. + * GetTextEncodingFromScriptInfo() doesn't know about more exotic layouts. + * This provides a fallback for good measure. In an ideal world, exotic + * layouts would always provide a 'uchr' resource anyway, so we wouldn't + * need this. * - * We can add more keyboard layouts, if we get actual complaints. Farsi - * or other Celtic/Gaelic layouts would be candidates. + * We can add more keyboard layouts, if we get actual complaints. Farsi or + * other Celtic/Gaelic layouts would be candidates. */ switch (layoutid) { - - /* - * Icelandic and Faroese (planned). These layouts are sold by Apple - * Iceland for legacy applications. - */ - - case 1800: case 1821: - return kTextEncodingMacIcelandic; - - /* - * Irish and Welsh. These layouts are mentioned in . - * - * FIXME: This may have to be kTextEncodingMacGaelic instead, but I - * can't locate layouts of this type for testing. - */ - - case 581: case 779: - return kTextEncodingMacCeltic; + /* + * Icelandic and Faroese (planned). These layouts are sold by Apple + * Iceland for legacy applications. + */ + + case 1800: case 1821: + return kTextEncodingMacIcelandic; + + /* + * Irish and Welsh. These layouts are mentioned in . + * + * FIXME: This may have to be kTextEncodingMacGaelic instead, but I + * can't locate layouts of this type for testing. + */ + + case 581: case 779: + return kTextEncodingMacCeltic; } - + /* - * The valid script codes are also the valid default encoding codes, so - * if nothing else helps, fall back on those. + * The valid script codes are also the valid default encoding codes, so if + * nothing else helps, fall back on those. */ return script; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource -- * - * Given MacOS key event data this function generates the Unicode - * characters. It does this using a 'uchr' and the UCKeyTranslate - * API. + * Given MacOS key event data this function generates the Unicode + * characters. It does this using a 'uchr' and the UCKeyTranslate API. * - * The parameter deadKeyStatePtr can be NULL, if no deadkey handling - * is needed. + * The parameter deadKeyStatePtr can be NULL, if no deadkey handling is + * needed. * - * Tested and known to work with US, Hebrew, Greek and Russian layouts - * as well as "Unicode Hex Input". + * Tested and known to work with US, Hebrew, Greek and Russian layouts as + * well as "Unicode Hex Input". * * Results: - * The number of characters generated if any, 0 if we are waiting for - * another byte of a dead-key sequence. Fills in the uniChars array - * with a Unicode string. + * The number of characters generated if any, 0 if we are waiting for + * another byte of a dead-key sequence. Fills in the uniChars array with + * a Unicode string. * * Side Effects: - * None + * None * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource( - UniChar * uniChars, int maxChars, - Ptr uchr, - EventKind eKind, - UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, - UInt32 * deadKeyStatePtr) + UniChar *uniChars, + int maxChars, + Ptr uchr, + EventKind eKind, + UInt32 keycode, + UInt32 modifiers, + UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr) { int action; unsigned long keyboardType; OptionBits options = 0; UInt32 dummy_state; - UniCharCount actuallength; + UniCharCount actuallength; OSStatus status; keycode &= 0xFF; @@ -902,260 +844,242 @@ KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource( keyboardType = LMGetKbdType(); if (NULL==deadKeyStatePtr) { - options = kUCKeyTranslateNoDeadKeysMask; - dummy_state = 0; - deadKeyStatePtr = &dummy_state; + options = kUCKeyTranslateNoDeadKeysMask; + dummy_state = 0; + deadKeyStatePtr = &dummy_state; } - switch(eKind) { - case kEventRawKeyDown: - action = kUCKeyActionDown; - break; - case kEventRawKeyUp: - action = kUCKeyActionUp; - break; - case kEventRawKeyRepeat: - action = kUCKeyActionAutoKey; - break; - default: -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr, - "KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource(): " - "Invalid parameter eKind %d\n", - (int) eKind); -#endif - return 0; + switch(eKind) { + case kEventRawKeyDown: + action = kUCKeyActionDown; + break; + case kEventRawKeyUp: + action = kUCKeyActionUp; + break; + case kEventRawKeyRepeat: + action = kUCKeyActionAutoKey; + break; + default: + LOG_MSG("KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource(): " + "Invalid parameter eKind %d", (int) eKind); + return 0; } - status = UCKeyTranslate( - (const UCKeyboardLayout *) uchr, - keycode, action, modifiers, keyboardType, - options, deadKeyStatePtr, - maxChars, &actuallength, uniChars); + status = UCKeyTranslate((const UCKeyboardLayout *) uchr, keycode, action, + modifiers, keyboardType, options, deadKeyStatePtr, maxChars, + &actuallength, uniChars); if ((0 == actuallength) && (0 != *deadKeyStatePtr)) { - /* - * More data later - */ - - return 0; + /* + * More data later + */ + + return 0; } - + /* * some IMEs leave residue :-( */ - - *deadKeyStatePtr = 0; + + *deadKeyStatePtr = 0; if (noErr != status) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"UCKeyTranslate failed: %d", (int) status); -#endif - actuallength = 0; + LOG_MSG("UCKeyTranslate failed: %d", (int) status); + actuallength = 0; } return actuallength; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * KeycodeToUnicodeViaKCHRResource -- * - * Given MacOS key event data this function generates the Unicode - * characters. It does this using a 'KCHR' and the KeyTranslate API. + * Given MacOS key event data this function generates the Unicode + * characters. It does this using a 'KCHR' and the KeyTranslate API. * - * The parameter deadKeyStatePtr can be NULL, if no deadkey handling - * is needed. + * The parameter deadKeyStatePtr can be NULL, if no deadkey handling is + * needed. * * Results: - * The number of characters generated if any, 0 if we are waiting for - * another byte of a dead-key sequence. Fills in the uniChars array - * with a Unicode string. + * The number of characters generated if any, 0 if we are waiting for + * another byte of a dead-key sequence. Fills in the uniChars array with + * a Unicode string. * * Side Effects: - * None + * None * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int KeycodeToUnicodeViaKCHRResource( - UniChar * uniChars, int maxChars, - Ptr kchr, TextEncoding encoding, - EventKind eKind, - UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, - UInt32 * deadKeyStatePtr) + UniChar *uniChars, + int maxChars, + Ptr kchr, + TextEncoding encoding, + EventKind eKind, + UInt32 keycode, + UInt32 modifiers, + UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr) { UInt32 result; char macBuff[3]; - char * macStr; + char *macStr; int macStrLen; UInt32 dummy_state = 0; - if (NULL == deadKeyStatePtr) { - deadKeyStatePtr = &dummy_state; + deadKeyStatePtr = &dummy_state; } keycode |= modifiers; result = KeyTranslate(kchr, keycode, deadKeyStatePtr); if ((0 == result) && (0 != dummy_state)) { - /* - * 'dummy_state' gets only filled if the caller did not want deadkey - * processing (deadKeyStatePtr was NULL originally), but we still - * have a deadkey. We just push the keycode for the space bar to get - * the real key value. - */ - - result = KeyTranslate(kchr, 0x31, deadKeyStatePtr); - *deadKeyStatePtr = 0; + /* + * 'dummy_state' gets only filled if the caller did not want deadkey + * processing (deadKeyStatePtr was NULL originally), but we still + * have a deadkey. We just push the keycode for the space bar to get + * the real key value. + */ + + result = KeyTranslate(kchr, 0x31, deadKeyStatePtr); + *deadKeyStatePtr = 0; } if ((0 == result) && (0 != *deadKeyStatePtr)) { - /* - * More data later - */ - - return 0; + /* + * More data later + */ + + return 0; } macBuff[0] = (char) (result >> 16); - macBuff[1] = (char) result; + macBuff[1] = (char) result; macBuff[2] = 0; if (0 != macBuff[0]) { - /* - * If the first byte is valid, the second is too - */ - - macStr = macBuff; - macStrLen = 2; + /* + * If the first byte is valid, the second is too + */ + + macStr = macBuff; + macStrLen = 2; } else if (0 != macBuff[1]) { - /* - * Only the second is valid - */ - - macStr = macBuff+1; - macStrLen = 1; + /* + * Only the second is valid + */ + + macStr = macBuff+1; + macStrLen = 1; } else { - /* - * No valid bytes at all -- shouldn't happen - */ - - macStr = NULL; - macStrLen = 0; + /* + * No valid bytes at all -- shouldn't happen + */ + + macStr = NULL; + macStrLen = 0; } if (macStrLen <= 0) { - return 0; + return 0; } else { + /* + * Use the CFString conversion routines. This is the easiest and most + * compatible way to get from an 8-bit string and a MacOS script code + * to a Unicode string. + * + * FIXME: The system ships with an Irish 'KCHR' but without the + * corresponding macCeltic encoding, which triggers the error below. + * Tcl doesn't have the macCeltic encoding either right now, so until + * we get that, we can just as well stick to this code. The right fix + * would be to use the Tcl encodings and add macCeltic and probably + * others there. Suitable Unicode data files for the missing encodings + * are available from www.evertype.com. + */ + + CFStringRef cfString; + int uniStrLen; + + cfString = CFStringCreateWithCStringNoCopy(NULL, macStr, encoding, + kCFAllocatorNull); + if (cfString == NULL) { + LOG_MSG("CFString: Can't convert with encoding %d", + (int) encoding); + return 0; + } - /* - * Use the CFString conversion routines. This is the easiest and - * most compatible way to get from an 8-bit string and a MacOS script - * code to a Unicode string. - * - * FIXME: The system ships with an Irish 'KCHR' but without the - * corresponding macCeltic encoding, which triggers the error below. - * Tcl doesn't have the macCeltic encoding either right now, so until - * we get that, we can just as well stick to this code. The right - * fix would be to use the Tcl encodings and add macCeltic and - * probably others there. Suitable Unicode data files for the - * missing encodings are available from www.evertype.com. - */ - - CFStringRef cfString; - int uniStrLen; - - cfString = CFStringCreateWithCStringNoCopy( - NULL, macStr, encoding, kCFAllocatorNull); - if (cfString == NULL) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "CFString: Can't convert with encoding %d\n", - (int) encoding); -#endif - return 0; - } - - uniStrLen = CFStringGetLength(cfString); - if (uniStrLen > maxChars) { - uniStrLen = maxChars; - } - CFStringGetCharacters(cfString, CFRangeMake(0,uniStrLen), uniChars); - CFRelease(cfString); + uniStrLen = CFStringGetLength(cfString); + if (uniStrLen > maxChars) { + uniStrLen = maxChars; + } + CFStringGetCharacters(cfString, CFRangeMake(0,uniStrLen), uniChars); + CFRelease(cfString); - return uniStrLen; + return uniStrLen; } } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXKeycodeToUnicode -- * - * Given MacOS key event data this function generates the Unicode - * characters. It does this using OS resources and APIs. + * Given MacOS key event data this function generates the Unicode + * characters. It does this using OS resources and APIs. * - * The parameter deadKeyStatePtr can be NULL, if no deadkey handling - * is needed. + * The parameter deadKeyStatePtr can be NULL, if no deadkey handling is + * needed. * - * This function is called from XKeycodeToKeysym() in - * tkMacOSKeyboard.c. + * This function is called from XKeycodeToKeysym() in tkMacOSKeyboard.c. * * Results: - * The number of characters generated if any, 0 if we are waiting for - * another byte of a dead-key sequence. Fills in the uniChars array - * with a Unicode string. + * The number of characters generated if any, 0 if we are waiting for + * another byte of a dead-key sequence. Fills in the uniChars array with + * a Unicode string. * * Side Effects: - * None + * None * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXKeycodeToUnicode( - UniChar * uniChars, int maxChars, - EventKind eKind, - UInt32 keycode, UInt32 modifiers, - UInt32 * deadKeyStatePtr) + UniChar *uniChars, + int maxChars, + EventKind eKind, + UInt32 keycode, + UInt32 modifiers, + UInt32 *deadKeyStatePtr) { Ptr resource = NULL; TextEncoding encoding; - int len; - - if (GetKeyboardLayout(&resource,&encoding)) { - len = KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource( - uniChars, maxChars, resource, eKind, - keycode, modifiers, deadKeyStatePtr); + if (GetKeyboardLayout(&resource, &encoding)) { + return KeycodeToUnicodeViaUnicodeResource(uniChars, maxChars, + resource, eKind, keycode, modifiers, deadKeyStatePtr); } else { - len = KeycodeToUnicodeViaKCHRResource( - uniChars, maxChars, resource, encoding, eKind, - keycode, modifiers, deadKeyStatePtr); + return KeycodeToUnicodeViaKCHRResource(uniChars, maxChars, resource, + encoding, eKind, keycode, modifiers, deadKeyStatePtr); } - - return len; } - - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * XGrabKeyboard -- * - * Simulates a keyboard grab by setting the focus. + * Simulates a keyboard grab by setting the focus. * * Results: - * Always returns GrabSuccess. + * Always returns GrabSuccess. * * Side effects: - * Sets the keyboard focus to the specified window. + * Sets the keyboard focus to the specified window. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1178,13 +1102,13 @@ XGrabKeyboard( * * XUngrabKeyboard -- * - * Releases the simulated keyboard grab. + * Releases the simulated keyboard grab. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Sets the keyboard focus back to the value before the grab. + * Sets the keyboard focus back to the value before the grab. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1203,13 +1127,14 @@ XUngrabKeyboard( * TkMacOSXGetCapture -- * * Results: - * Returns the current grab window + * Returns the current grab window * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * */ + Tk_Window -TkMacOSXGetCapture() +TkMacOSXGetCapture(void) { return gGrabWinPtr; } @@ -1219,26 +1144,25 @@ TkMacOSXGetCapture() * * TkpSetCapture -- * - * This function captures the mouse so that all future events - * will be reported to this window, even if the mouse is outside - * the window. If the specified window is NULL, then the mouse - * is released. + * This function captures the mouse so that all future events will be + * reported to this window, even if the mouse is outside the window. If + * the specified window is NULL, then the mouse is released. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Sets the capture flag and captures the mouse. + * Sets the capture flag and captures the mouse. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpSetCapture( - TkWindow *winPtr) /* Capture window, or NULL. */ + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Capture window, or NULL. */ { while ((winPtr != NULL) && !Tk_IsTopLevel(winPtr)) { - winPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; + winPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; } gGrabWinPtr = (Tk_Window) winPtr; } @@ -1248,25 +1172,25 @@ TkpSetCapture( * * Tk_SetCaretPos -- * - * This enables correct placement of the XIM caret. This is called - * by widgets to indicate their cursor placement, and the caret - * location is used by TkpGetString to place the XIM caret. + * This enables correct placement of the XIM caret. This is called by + * widgets to indicate their cursor placement, and the caret location is + * used by TkpGetString to place the XIM caret. * * Results: - * None + * None * * Side effects: - * None + * None * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -Tk_SetCaretPos(tkwin, x, y, height) - Tk_Window tkwin; - int x; - int y; - int height; +Tk_SetCaretPos( + Tk_Window tkwin, + int x, + int y, + int height) { } @@ -1275,23 +1199,31 @@ Tk_SetCaretPos(tkwin, x, y, height) * * TkMacOSXInitKeyboard -- * - * This procedure initializes the keyboard layout. + * This procedure initializes the keyboard layout. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ MODULE_SCOPE void -TkMacOSXInitKeyboard ( - Tcl_Interp *interp) +TkMacOSXInitKeyboard( + Tcl_Interp *interp) { Ptr resource; TextEncoding encoding; - - GetKeyboardLayout(&resource,&encoding); + + GetKeyboardLayout(&resource, &encoding); } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXMenu.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXMenu.c index 6a6d8f3..f4d1acf 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXMenu.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXMenu.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXMenu.c -- * * This module implements the Mac-platform specific features of menus. @@ -7,10 +7,10 @@ * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2005-2006 Daniel A. Steffen * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXMenu.c,v 1.34 2006/10/31 22:26:06 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXMenu.c,v 1.35 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -36,10 +36,9 @@ typedef struct MacMenu { MenuRef menuHdl; /* The Menu Manager data structure. */ Rect menuRect; /* The rectangle as calculated in the - * MDEF. This is used to figure ou the - * clipping rgn before we push - * the <> virtual binding - * through. */ + * MDEF. This is used to figure out the + * clipping rgn before we push the + * <> virtual binding through. */ } MacMenu; typedef struct MenuEntryUserData { @@ -105,15 +104,14 @@ typedef struct MenuEntryUserData { */ typedef struct EntryGeometry { - int accelTextStart; /* Offset into the accel string where - * the text starts. Everything before - * this is modifier key descriptions. - */ + int accelTextStart; /* Offset into the accel string where the text + * starts. Everything before this is modifier + * key descriptions. */ int modifierWidth; /* Width of modifier symbols. */ - int accelTextWidth; /* Width of the text after the modifier + int accelTextWidth; /* Width of the text after the modifier * keys. */ - int nonAccelMargin; /* The width of the margin for entries - * without accelerators. */ + int nonAccelMargin; /* The width of the margin for entries without + * accelerators. */ } EntryGeometry; /* @@ -146,15 +144,14 @@ typedef struct TopLevelMenubarList { #define MENU_HELP_MENU MENU_PLATFORM_FLAG2 #define MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING MENU_PLATFORM_FLAG3 -#define CASCADE_CMD (0x1b) - /* The special command char for cascade - * menus. */ +#define CASCADE_CMD (0x1b) /* The special command char for cascade + * menus. */ #define MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING 1 #define SCREEN_MARGIN 5 static int gNoTkMenus = 0; /* This is used by Tk_MacOSXTurnOffMenus as the - * flag that Tk is not to draw any menus. */ - + * flag that Tk is not to draw any menus. */ + RgnHandle tkMenuCascadeRgn = NULL; /* The region to clip drawing to when the * MDEF is up. */ @@ -183,7 +180,7 @@ static char *currentMenuBarName; static Tk_Window currentMenuBarOwner; /* Which window owns the current menu bar. */ static char elipsisString[TCL_UTF_MAX + 1]; - /* The UTF representation of the elipsis (...) + /* The UTF representation of the elipsis (...) * character. */ static int inPostMenu; /* We cannot be re-entrant like X * windows. */ @@ -197,7 +194,7 @@ static MacDrawable macMDEFDrawable; static int MDEFScrollFlag = 0; /* Used so that popups don't scroll too soon. */ static int menuBarFlags; /* Used for whether the menu bar needs * redrawing or not. */ - + static struct TearoffSelect { TkMenu *menuPtr; /* The menu that is torn off */ Point point; /* The point to place the new menu */ @@ -206,8 +203,8 @@ static struct TearoffSelect { } tearoffStruct; struct MenuCommandHandlerData { /* This is the ClientData we pass to */ - TkMenu *menuPtr; /* Tcl_DoWhenIdle to move handling */ - int index; /* menu commands to the event loop. */ + TkMenu *menuPtr; /* Tcl_DoWhenIdle to move handling */ + int index; /* menu commands to the event loop. */ }; static RgnHandle totalMenuRgn = NULL; @@ -218,7 +215,7 @@ static RgnHandle utilRgn = NULL;/* Used when creating the region that is to static TopLevelMenubarList *windowListPtr; /* A list of windows that have menubars set. */ -static MenuItemDrawingUPP tkThemeMenuItemDrawingUPP; +static MenuItemDrawingUPP tkThemeMenuItemDrawingUPP; /* Points to the UPP for theme Item drawing. */ static Tcl_Obj *useMDEFVar; @@ -228,125 +225,94 @@ MenuRef tkCurrentAppleMenu = NULL; * Forward declarations for procedures defined later in this file: */ -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp, - TkMenu *menuInstPtr, - int cascade, - short *menuIDPtr)); -MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXFreeMenuID _ANSI_ARGS_((short menuID)); - -static void CompleteIdlers _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr)); -static void DrawMenuBarWhenIdle _ANSI_ARGS_(( - ClientData clientData)); -static void DrawMenuBackground _ANSI_ARGS_(( - Rect *menuRectPtr, Drawable d, ThemeMenuType type)); -static void DrawMenuEntryAccelerator _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, - Drawable d, GC gc, Tk_Font tkfont, - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, int x, int y, - int width, int height, int drawArrow)); -static void DrawMenuEntryBackground _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, - Drawable d, Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, - Tk_3DBorder bgBorder, int x, int y, - int width, int heigth)); -static void DrawMenuEntryIndicator _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, - Drawable d, GC gc, GC indicatorGC, - Tk_Font tkfont, +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(Tcl_Interp *interp, + TkMenu *menuInstPtr, int cascade, + short *menuIDPtr); +MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXFreeMenuID(short menuID); + +static void CompleteIdlers(TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void DrawMenuBarWhenIdle(ClientData clientData); +static void DrawMenuBackground(Rect *menuRectPtr, Drawable d, + ThemeMenuType type); +static void DrawMenuEntryAccelerator(TkMenu *menuPtr, + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Drawable d, GC gc, + Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, + Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, int x, int y, int width, + int height, int drawArrow); +static void DrawMenuEntryBackground(TkMenu *menuPtr, + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Drawable d, + Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, Tk_3DBorder bgBorder, + int x, int y, int width, int heigth); +static void DrawMenuEntryIndicator(TkMenu *menuPtr, + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Drawable d, GC gc, + GC indicatorGC, Tk_Font tkfont, + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, int x, int y, + int width, int height); +static void DrawMenuEntryLabel(TkMenu *menuPtr,TkMenuEntry *mePtr, + Drawable d, GC gc, Tk_Font tkfont, + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, int x, int y, + int width, int height); +static void DrawMenuSeparator(TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, + Drawable d, GC gc, Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, int x, int y, - int width, int height)); -static void DrawMenuEntryLabel _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu * menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Drawable d, - GC gc, Tk_Font tkfont, + int width, int height); +static void DrawTearoffEntry(TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, + Drawable d, GC gc, Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, int x, int y, - int width, int height)); -static void DrawMenuSeparator _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr, - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Drawable d, GC gc, - Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - int x, int y, int width, int height)); -static void DrawTearoffEntry _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr, - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Drawable d, GC gc, - Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - int x, int y, int width, int height)); -static void EventuallyInvokeMenu (ClientData data); -static void GetEntryText _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenuEntry *mePtr, - Tcl_DString *dStringPtr)); -static void GetMenuAccelGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr, + int width, int height); +static void EventuallyInvokeMenu(ClientData data); +static void GetEntryText(TkMenuEntry *mePtr, + Tcl_DString *dStringPtr); +static void GetMenuAccelGeometry(TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, int *modWidthPtr, - int *textWidthPtr, int *heightPtr)); -static void GetMenuLabelGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenuEntry *mePtr, + int *textWidthPtr, int *heightPtr); +static void GetMenuLabelGeometry(TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr)); -static void GetMenuIndicatorGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, - Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr)); -static void GetMenuSeparatorGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_(( + int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr); +static void GetMenuIndicatorGeometry(TkMenu *menuPtr, + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Tk_Font tkfont, + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, + int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr); +static void GetMenuSeparatorGeometry( TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr)); -static void GetTearoffEntryGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr, + int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr); +static void GetTearoffEntryGeometry(TkMenu *menuPtr, TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Tk_Font tkfont, CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, int *widthPtr, - int *heightPtr)); -static char FindMarkCharacter _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenuEntry *mePtr)); -static void InvalidateMDEFRgns _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); - -static void MenuDefProc _ANSI_ARGS_((short message, - MenuHandle menu, Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, short *whichItem )); -static void HandleMenuHiliteMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr); -static void HandleMenuDrawMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr); -static void HandleMenuFindItemsMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr); -static void HandleMenuPopUpMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr); -static void HandleMenuCalcItemMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr); - -static void MenuSelectEvent _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr)); -static void ReconfigureIndividualMenu _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr, MenuHandle macMenuHdl, - int base)); -static void ReconfigureMacintoshMenu _ANSI_ARGS_ (( - ClientData clientData)); -static void RecursivelyClearActiveMenu _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr)); -static void RecursivelyDeleteMenu _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr)); -static void RecursivelyInsertMenu _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkMenu *menuPtr)); -static void SetDefaultMenubar _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); -static int SetMenuCascade _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenu *menuPtr)); -static void mySetMenuTitle _ANSI_ARGS_((MenuHandle menuHdl, - Tcl_Obj *titlePtr)); -static void AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenuEntry *mePtr, - Rect * menuRectPtr, MenuTrackingData *mtdPtr, + int *heightPtr); +static char FindMarkCharacter(TkMenuEntry *mePtr); +static void InvalidateMDEFRgns(void); +static void MenuDefProc(short message, MenuHandle menu, + Rect *menuRectPtr, Point hitPt, short *whichItem); +static void HandleMenuHiliteMsg(MenuRef menu, Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, SInt16 *whichItem, TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void HandleMenuDrawMsg(MenuRef menu, Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, SInt16 *whichItem, TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void HandleMenuFindItemsMsg(MenuRef menu, Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, SInt16 *whichItem, TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void HandleMenuPopUpMsg(MenuRef menu, Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, SInt16 *whichItem, TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void HandleMenuCalcItemMsg(MenuRef menu, Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, SInt16 *whichItem, TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void MenuSelectEvent(TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void ReconfigureIndividualMenu(TkMenu *menuPtr, + MenuHandle macMenuHdl, int base); +static void ReconfigureMacintoshMenu(ClientData clientData); +static void RecursivelyClearActiveMenu(TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void RecursivelyDeleteMenu(TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void RecursivelyInsertMenu(TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void SetDefaultMenubar(void); +static int SetMenuCascade(TkMenu *menuPtr); +static void mySetMenuTitle(MenuHandle menuHdl, Tcl_Obj *titlePtr); +static void AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(TkMenuEntry *mePtr, + Rect *menuRectPtr, MenuTrackingData *mtdPtr, Drawable d, Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, Tk_Font tkfont, - int x, int y, int width, int height)); -static pascal void ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc _ANSI_ARGS_ ((const Rect *inBounds, - SInt16 inDepth, Boolean inIsColorDevice, - SInt32 inUserData)); - + int x, int y, int width, int height); +static pascal void ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc(const Rect *inBounds, + SInt16 inDepth, Boolean inIsColorDevice, + SInt32 inUserData); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -375,16 +341,15 @@ TkMacOSXUseMenuID( Tcl_HashEntry *commandEntryPtr; int newEntry; int iMacID = macID; /* Do this to remove compiler warning */ - + TkMenuInit(); commandEntryPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) iMacID, - &newEntry); - if (newEntry == 1) { - Tcl_SetHashValue(commandEntryPtr, NULL); - return TCL_OK; - } else { - return TCL_ERROR; + &newEntry); + if (!newEntry) { + return TCL_ERROR; } + Tcl_SetHashValue(commandEntryPtr, NULL); + return TCL_OK; } /* @@ -392,27 +357,27 @@ TkMacOSXUseMenuID( * * TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID -- * - * Allocates a new menu id and marks it in use. Each menu on the - * mac must be designated by a unique id, which is a short. In - * addition, some ids are reserved by the system. Since Tk uses - * mostly dynamic menus, we must allocate and free these ids on - * the fly. We use the id as a key into a hash table; if there - * is no hash entry, we know that we can use the id. + * Allocates a new menu id and marks it in use. Each menu on the mac must + * be designated by a unique id, which is a short. In addition, some ids + * are reserved by the system. Since Tk uses mostly dynamic menus, we + * must allocate and free these ids on the fly. We use the id as a key + * into a hash table; if there is no hash entry, we know that we can use + * the id. * - * Carbon allows a much larger number of menus than the old APIs. - * I believe this is 32768, but am not sure. This code just uses - * 2000 as the upper limit. Unfortunately tk leaks menus when - * cloning, under some circumstances (see bug on sourceforge). + * Carbon allows a much larger number of menus than the old APIs. I + * believe this is 32768, but am not sure. This code just uses 2000 as + * the upper limit. Unfortunately Tk leaks menus when cloning, under some + * circumstances (see bug on sourceforge). * * Results: - * Returns TCL_OK if succesful; TCL_ERROR if there are no more - * ids of the appropriate type to allocate. menuIDPtr contains - * the new id if succesful. + * Returns TCL_OK if succesful; TCL_ERROR if there are no more ids of the + * appropriate type to allocate. menuIDPtr contains the new id if + * succesful. * * Side effects: - * An entry is created for the menu in the command hash table, - * and the hash entry is stored in the appropriate field in the - * menu data structure. + * An entry is created for the menu in the command hash table, and the + * hash entry is stored in the appropriate field in the menu data + * structure. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -421,7 +386,7 @@ int Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Used for error reporting */ TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are working with */ int cascade, /* 0 if we are working with a normal menu; - 1 if we are working with a cascade */ + * 1 if we are working with a cascade */ short *menuIDPtr) /* The resulting id */ { int found = 0; @@ -430,25 +395,27 @@ int short returnID = *menuIDPtr; /* - * The following code relies on shorts and unsigned chars wrapping - * when the highest value is incremented. Also, the values between - * 236 and 255 inclusive are reserved for DA's by the Mac OS. + * The following code relies on shorts and unsigned chars wrapping when + * the highest value is incremented. Also, the values between 236 and 255 + * inclusive are reserved for DA's by the Mac OS. */ - + if (!cascade) { short curID = lastMenuID + 1; - if (curID == 236) { + + if (curID == 236) { curID = 256; } while (curID != lastMenuID) { - int iCurID = curID; + int iCurID = curID; + commandEntryPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) iCurID, &newEntry); if (newEntry == 1) { - found = 1; - lastMenuID = returnID = curID; - break; + found = 1; + lastMenuID = returnID = curID; + break; } curID++; if (curID == 236) { @@ -456,19 +423,19 @@ int } } } else { - /* - * Cascade ids must be between 0 and 235 only, so they must be - * dealt with separately. + * Cascade ids must be between 0 and 235 only, so they must be dealt + * with separately. */ - + short curID = lastCascadeID + 1; - if (curID == 2000) { + if (curID == 2000) { curID = 0; } - + while (curID != lastCascadeID) { - int iCurID = curID; + int iCurID = curID; + commandEntryPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) iCurID, &newEntry); if (newEntry == 1) { @@ -483,16 +450,15 @@ int } } - if (found) { - Tcl_SetHashValue(commandEntryPtr, (char *) menuPtr); - *menuIDPtr = returnID; - return TCL_OK; - } else { + if (!found) { Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "No more menus can be allocated.", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "No more menus can be allocated.", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } + + Tcl_SetHashValue(commandEntryPtr, (char *) menuPtr); + *menuIDPtr = returnID; + return TCL_OK; } /* @@ -517,7 +483,7 @@ TkMacOSXFreeMenuID( { Tcl_HashEntry *entryPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) ((int)menuID)); - + if (entryPtr != NULL) { Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(entryPtr); } @@ -541,8 +507,8 @@ TkMacOSXFreeMenuID( * Returns a standard TCL error. * * Side effects: - * Allocates a Macintosh menu handle and puts in the platformData - * field of the menuPtr. + * Allocates a Macintosh menu handle and puts in the platformData field + * of the menuPtr. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -560,49 +526,45 @@ TkpNewMenu( int error = TCL_OK; OSStatus err; CFStringRef cfStr; - + error = TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(menuPtr->interp, menuPtr, 0, &menuID); if (error != TCL_OK) { return error; } err = CreateNewMenu(menuID, kMenuAttrDoNotUseUserCommandKeys, &macMenuHdl); if (err != noErr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(menuPtr->interp, "CreateNewMenu failed.", - (char *) NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; + Tcl_AppendResult(menuPtr->interp, "CreateNewMenu failed.", NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; } cfStr = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin), - kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); if (!cfStr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(menuPtr->interp, "CFStringCreateWithCString failed.", - (char *) NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; + Tcl_AppendResult(menuPtr->interp, "CFStringCreateWithCString failed.", + NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; } err = SetMenuTitleWithCFString(macMenuHdl, cfStr); CFRelease(cfStr); if (err != noErr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(menuPtr->interp, "SetMenuTitleWithCFString failed.", - (char *) NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; + Tcl_AppendResult(menuPtr->interp, "SetMenuTitleWithCFString failed.", + NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; } - + /* - * Check whether we want to use the custom mdef or not. For now - * the default is to use it unless the variable is explicitly - * set to no. + * Check whether we want to use the custom mdef or not. For now the + * default is to use it unless the variable is explicitly set to no. */ - - useMDEFObjPtr = Tcl_ObjGetVar2(menuPtr->interp, useMDEFVar, NULL, TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); - if (useMDEFObjPtr == NULL - || Tcl_GetBooleanFromObj(NULL, useMDEFObjPtr, &useMDEF) == TCL_ERROR - || useMDEF) { - menuDefSpec.defType = kMenuDefProcPtr; - menuDefSpec.u.defProc = MenuDefProc; - if ((err = SetMenuDefinition(macMenuHdl, &menuDefSpec)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "SetMenuDefinition failed %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - } + + useMDEFObjPtr = Tcl_ObjGetVar2(menuPtr->interp, useMDEFVar, NULL, + TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); + if (useMDEFObjPtr == NULL || + Tcl_GetBooleanFromObj(NULL, useMDEFObjPtr, &useMDEF) == TCL_ERROR + || useMDEF) { + menuDefSpec.defType = kMenuDefProcPtr; + menuDefSpec.u.defProc = MenuDefProc; + err = SetMenuDefinition(macMenuHdl, &menuDefSpec); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetMenuDefinition); } menuPtr->platformData = (TkMenuPlatformData) ckalloc(sizeof(MacMenu)); ((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl = macMenuHdl; @@ -611,7 +573,7 @@ TkpNewMenu( if ((currentMenuBarInterp == menuPtr->interp) && (currentMenuBarName != NULL)) { Tk_Window parentWin = Tk_Parent(menuPtr->tkwin); - + if (strcmp(currentMenuBarName, Tk_PathName(parentWin)) == 0) { if ((strcmp(Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin) + strlen(Tk_PathName(parentWin)), ".apple") == 0) @@ -621,10 +583,10 @@ TkpNewMenu( Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); menuBarFlags |= MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; } - } + } } } - + menuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) menuPtr); return TCL_OK; @@ -658,12 +620,12 @@ TkpDestroyMenu( } if (GetMenuID(macMenuHdl) == currentHelpMenuID) { MenuRef helpMenuHdl; - MenuItemIndex helpIndex; - - if ((HMGetHelpMenu(&helpMenuHdl,&helpIndex) == noErr) + MenuItemIndex helpIndex; + + if ((HMGetHelpMenu(&helpMenuHdl,&helpIndex) == noErr) && (helpMenuHdl != NULL)) { int i, count = CountMenuItems(helpMenuHdl); - + for (i = helpIndex; i <= count; i++) { DeleteMenuItem(helpMenuHdl, helpIndex); } @@ -671,12 +633,12 @@ TkpDestroyMenu( currentHelpMenuID = 0; } if (menuPtr->platformData != NULL) { - MenuID menuID; - menuID = GetMenuID(macMenuHdl); - DeleteMenu(menuID); - TkMacOSXFreeMenuID(menuID); - DisposeMenu(macMenuHdl); - ckfree((char *) menuPtr->platformData); + MenuID menuID = GetMenuID(macMenuHdl); + + DeleteMenu(menuID); + TkMacOSXFreeMenuID(menuID); + DisposeMenu(macMenuHdl); + ckfree((char *) menuPtr->platformData); menuPtr->platformData = NULL; } } @@ -706,6 +668,7 @@ SetMenuCascade( MenuHandle macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; MenuID newMenuID, menuID = GetMenuID(macMenuHdl); int error = TCL_OK; + if (menuID >= 256) { error = TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(menuPtr->interp, menuPtr, 1, &newMenuID); if (error == TCL_OK) { @@ -734,13 +697,12 @@ SetMenuCascade( void TkpDestroyMenuEntry( - TkMenuEntry *mePtr) /* The common structure for the menu - * entry. */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr) /* The common structure for the menu entry. */ { - TkMenu *menuPtr = mePtr->menuPtr; - + TkMenu *menuPtr = mePtr->menuPtr; + ckfree((char *) mePtr->platformEntryData); - if ((menuPtr->platformData != NULL) + if ((menuPtr->platformData != NULL) && !(menuPtr->menuFlags & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { menuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) menuPtr); @@ -753,9 +715,9 @@ TkpDestroyMenuEntry( * GetEntryText -- * * Given a menu entry, gives back the text that should go in it. - * Separators should be done by the caller, as they have to be - * handled specially. This is primarily used to do a substitution - * between "..." and the ellipsis character which looks nicer. + * Separators should be done by the caller, as they have to be handled + * specially. This is primarily used to do a substitution between "..." + * and the ellipsis character which looks nicer. * * Results: * itemText points to the new text for the item. @@ -769,8 +731,8 @@ TkpDestroyMenuEntry( static void GetEntryText( TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* A pointer to the menu entry. */ - Tcl_DString *dStringPtr) /* The DString to put the text into. This - * will be initialized by this routine. */ + Tcl_DString *dStringPtr) /* The DString to put the text into. This will + * be initialized by this routine. */ { Tcl_DStringInit(dStringPtr); if (mePtr->type == TEAROFF_ENTRY) { @@ -813,12 +775,12 @@ GetEntryText( * * FindMarkCharacter -- * - * Finds the Macintosh mark character based on the font of the - * item. We calculate a good mark character based on the font - * that this item is rendered in. + * Finds the Macintosh mark character based on the font of the item. We + * calculate a good mark character based on the font that this item is + * rendered in. * - * We try the following special mac characters. If none of them - * are present, just use the check mark. + * We try the following special mac characters. If none of them are + * present, just use the check mark. * '' - Check mark character (\022) * 'Â¥' - Mac Bullet character (\245) * '' - Filled diamond (\023) @@ -846,7 +808,7 @@ FindMarkCharacter( tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(mePtr->menuPtr->tkwin, (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) ? mePtr->menuPtr->fontPtr : mePtr->fontPtr); - + if (!TkMacOSXIsCharacterMissing(tkfont, '\022')) { markChar = '\022'; /* Check mark */ } else if (!TkMacOSXIsCharacterMissing(tkfont, '\245')) { @@ -871,8 +833,8 @@ FindMarkCharacter( * SetMenuTitle -- * * Sets title of menu so that the text displays correctly in menubar. - * This code directly manipulates menu handle data. This code - * was originally part of an ancient Apple Developer Response mail. + * This code directly manipulates menu handle data. This code was + * originally part of an ancient Apple Developer Response mail. * * Results: * None. @@ -887,18 +849,20 @@ FindMarkCharacter( static void mySetMenuTitle( MenuRef menuHdl, /* The menu we are setting the title of. */ - Tcl_Obj *titlePtr) /* The C string to set the title to. */ + Tcl_Obj *titlePtr) /* The C string to set the title to. */ { - char *title = (titlePtr == NULL) ? "" - : Tcl_GetStringFromObj(titlePtr, NULL); - CFStringRef cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, - title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + char *title = (titlePtr == NULL) ? "" : Tcl_GetString(titlePtr); + CFStringRef cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, title, + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); SetMenuTitleWithCFString(menuHdl, cf); CFRelease(cf); } - -static int ParseAccelerators(char **accelStringPtr) { + +static int +ParseAccelerators( + char **accelStringPtr) +{ char *accelString = *accelStringPtr; int flags = 0; while (1) { @@ -954,95 +918,91 @@ static int ParseAccelerators(char **accelStringPtr) { * Processes configurations for menu entries. * * Results: - * Returns standard TCL result. If TCL_ERROR is returned, then - * the interp's result contains an error message. + * Returns standard TCL result. If TCL_ERROR is returned, then the + * interp's result contains an error message. * * Side effects: - * Configuration information get set for mePtr; old resources - * get freed, if any need it. + * Configuration information get set for mePtr; old resources get freed, + * if any need it. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int TkpConfigureMenuEntry( - TkMenuEntry *mePtr) /* Information about menu entry; may - * or may not already have values for - * some fields. */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr) /* Information about menu entry; may or may + * not already have values for some fields. */ { TkMenu *menuPtr = mePtr->menuPtr; -#if 0 /* Unused */ +#if 0 /* Unused */ int index = mePtr->index; MenuHandle macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; MenuHandle helpMenuHdl = NULL; #endif /* - * Cascade menus have to have menu IDs of less than 256. So - * we need to change the child menu if this has been configured - * for a cascade item. + * Cascade menus have to have menu IDs of less than 256. So we need to + * change the child menu if this has been configured for a cascade item. */ - + if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { if ((mePtr->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) && (mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { MenuHandle childMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) mePtr ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; - + if (childMenuHdl != NULL) { int error = SetMenuCascade(mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr); - + if (error != TCL_OK) { return error; } - + if (menuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { mySetMenuTitle(childMenuHdl, mePtr->labelPtr); } } } } - + /* - * We need to parse the accelerator string. If it has the strings - * for Command, Control, Shift or Option, we need to flag it - * so we can draw the symbols for it. We also need to precalcuate - * the position of the first real character we are drawing. + * We need to parse the accelerator string. If it has the strings for + * Command, Control, Shift or Option, we need to flag it so we can draw + * the symbols for it. We also need to precalcuate the position of the + * first real character we are drawing. */ - + if (0 == mePtr->accelLength) { ((EntryGeometry *)mePtr->platformEntryData)->accelTextStart = -1; } else { char *accelString = (mePtr->accelPtr == NULL) ? "" - : Tcl_GetStringFromObj(mePtr->accelPtr, NULL); + : Tcl_GetString(mePtr->accelPtr); char *accel = accelString; mePtr->entryFlags &= ~ENTRY_ACCEL_MASK; - + mePtr->entryFlags |= ParseAccelerators(&accelString); - - ((EntryGeometry *)mePtr->platformEntryData)->accelTextStart + + ((EntryGeometry *)mePtr->platformEntryData)->accelTextStart = ((long) accelString - (long) accel); } - + if (!(menuPtr->menuFlags & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { menuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) menuPtr); } - + return TCL_OK; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * ReconfigureIndividualMenu -- * - * This routine redoes the guts of the menu. It works from - * a base item and offset, so that a regular menu will - * just have all of its items added, but the help menu will - * have all of its items appended after the apple-defined - * items. + * This routine redoes the guts of the menu. It works from a base item + * and offset, so that a regular menu will just have all of its items + * added, but the help menu will have all of its items appended after the + * apple-defined items. * * Results: * None. @@ -1056,14 +1016,12 @@ TkpConfigureMenuEntry( static void ReconfigureIndividualMenu( TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are affecting. */ - MenuHandle macMenuHdl, /* The macintosh menu we are affecting. - * Will not necessarily be - * menuPtr->platformData because this could - * be the help menu. */ + MenuHandle macMenuHdl, /* The macintosh menu we are affecting. Will + * not necessarily be menuPtr->platformData + * because this could be the help menu. */ int base) /* The last index that we do not want - * touched. 0 for normal menus; - * # of system help menu items - * for help menus. */ + * touched. 0 for normal menus; # of system + * help menu items * for help menus. */ { int count; int index; @@ -1072,17 +1030,17 @@ ReconfigureIndividualMenu( #if defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG) && defined(TK_MAC_DEBUG_MENUS) /* Carbon-internal menu debugging (c.f. Technote 2124) */ - TkMacOSXInitNamedDebugSymbol(HIToolbox, void, DebugPrintMenu, MenuRef menu); + TkMacOSXInitNamedDebugSymbol(HIToolbox,void,DebugPrintMenu,MenuRef menu); if (DebugPrintMenu) { - DebugPrintMenu(macMenuHdl); + DebugPrintMenu(macMenuHdl); } #endif for (mePtr = menuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; mePtr != NULL; mePtr = mePtr->nextCascadePtr) { char *name = (mePtr->namePtr == NULL) ? "" - : Tcl_GetStringFromObj(mePtr->namePtr, NULL); - + : Tcl_GetString(mePtr->namePtr); + if (strcmp(Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin), name) == 0) { if (mePtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { parentDisabled = 1; @@ -1090,45 +1048,45 @@ ReconfigureIndividualMenu( break; } } - + /* * First, we get rid of all of the old items. */ - + count = CountMenuItems(macMenuHdl); for (index = base; index < count; index++) { DeleteMenuItem(macMenuHdl, base + 1); } count = menuPtr->numEntries; - + for (index = 1; index <= count; index++) { mePtr = menuPtr->entries[index - 1]; - + /* - * We have to do separators separately because SetMenuItemText - * does not parse meta-characters. + * We have to do separators separately because SetMenuItemText does + * not parse meta-characters. */ - + if (mePtr->type == SEPARATOR_ENTRY) { - AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString (macMenuHdl, NULL, - kMenuItemAttrSeparator | kMenuItemAttrDisabled, - 0, NULL); + AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString (macMenuHdl, NULL, + kMenuItemAttrSeparator | kMenuItemAttrDisabled, 0, NULL); } else { Tcl_DString itemTextDString; - CFStringRef cf; + CFStringRef cf; + GetEntryText(mePtr, &itemTextDString); - cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, - Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, + Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString),kCFStringEncodingUTF8); if (cf != NULL) { - AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString (macMenuHdl, cf, 0, 0, NULL); - CFRelease(cf); + AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString (macMenuHdl, cf, 0, 0, NULL); + CFRelease(cf); } else { - cf = CFSTR (""); - AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString (macMenuHdl, cf, 0, 0, NULL); + cf = CFSTR (""); + AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString (macMenuHdl, cf, 0, 0, NULL); } Tcl_DStringFree(&itemTextDString); - + /* * Set enabling and disabling correctly. */ @@ -1138,61 +1096,60 @@ ReconfigureIndividualMenu( } else { EnableMenuItem(macMenuHdl, base + index); } - + /* * Set the check mark for check entries and radio entries. */ - - SetItemMark(macMenuHdl, base + index, 0); + + SetItemMark(macMenuHdl, base + index, 0); if ((mePtr->type == CHECK_BUTTON_ENTRY) || (mePtr->type == RADIO_BUTTON_ENTRY)) { - CheckMenuItem(macMenuHdl, base + index, (mePtr->entryFlags - & ENTRY_SELECTED) && mePtr->indicatorOn); + CheckMenuItem(macMenuHdl, base + index, mePtr->indicatorOn + && (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SELECTED)); if (mePtr->indicatorOn && (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SELECTED)) { SetItemMark(macMenuHdl, base + index, FindMarkCharacter(mePtr)); } } - + if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - if ((mePtr->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) + if ((mePtr->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) && (mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { - MenuHandle childMenuHdl = + MenuHandle childMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) mePtr->childMenuRefPtr ->menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; if (childMenuHdl != NULL) { - { - SetMenuItemHierarchicalID(macMenuHdl, base + index, - GetMenuID(childMenuHdl)); - } + SetMenuItemHierarchicalID(macMenuHdl, base + index, + GetMenuID(childMenuHdl)); } + /* * If we changed the highligthing of this menu, its - * children all have to be reconfigured so that - * their state will be reflected in the menubar. + * children all have to be reconfigured so that their + * state will be reflected in the menubar. */ - - if (!(mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr->menuFlags + + if (!(mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr->menuFlags & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr); } } } - + if ((mePtr->type != CASCADE_ENTRY) && (mePtr->accelPtr != NULL)) { - int accelLen; - int modifiers = 0; - int hasCmd = 0; - int offset = ((EntryGeometry *)mePtr->platformEntryData)->accelTextStart; - char *accel = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(mePtr->accelPtr, &accelLen); - accelLen -= offset; + int accelLen, modifiers = 0, hasCmd = 0; + int offset = ((EntryGeometry *) + mePtr->platformEntryData)->accelTextStart; + char *accel = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(mePtr->accelPtr,&accelLen); + + accelLen -= offset; accel+= offset; - + if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_OPTION_ACCEL) { modifiers |= kMenuOptionModifier; } @@ -1205,71 +1162,75 @@ ReconfigureIndividualMenu( if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_COMMAND_ACCEL) { hasCmd = 1; } - if (accelLen == 1) { - if (hasCmd || (modifiers != 0 && modifiers != kMenuShiftModifier)) { - SetItemCmd(macMenuHdl, base + index, accel[0]); + if (accelLen == 1) { + if (hasCmd || (modifiers != 0 + && modifiers != kMenuShiftModifier)) { + SetItemCmd(macMenuHdl, base + index, accel[0]); if (!hasCmd) { modifiers |= kMenuNoCommandModifier; } } - } else { - /* - * Now we need to convert from various textual names - * to Carbon codes + } else { + /* + * Now we need to convert from various textual names to + * Carbon codes. */ + char glyph = 0x0; - char first = UCHAR(accel[0]); + char first = UCHAR(accel[0]); + if (first == 'F' && (accel[1] > '0' && accel[1] <= '9')) { int fkey = accel[1] - '0'; + if (accel[2] > '0' && accel[2] <= '9') { fkey = 10*fkey + (accel[2] - '0'); } if (fkey > 0 && fkey < 16) { glyph = kMenuF1Glyph + fkey - 1; } - } else if (first == 'P' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"pageup")) { - glyph = kMenuPageUpGlyph; - } else if (first == 'P' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"pagedown")) { - glyph = kMenuPageDownGlyph; - } else if (first == 'L' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"left")) { - glyph = kMenuLeftArrowGlyph; - } else if (first == 'R' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"right")) { - glyph = kMenuRightArrowGlyph; - } else if (first == 'U' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"up")) { - glyph = kMenuUpArrowGlyph; - } else if (first == 'D' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"down")) { - glyph = kMenuDownArrowGlyph; - } else if (first == 'E' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"escape")) { - glyph = kMenuEscapeGlyph; - } else if (first == 'C' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"clear")) { - glyph = kMenuClearGlyph; - } else if (first == 'E' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"enter")) { - glyph = kMenuEnterGlyph; - } else if (first == 'D' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"backspace")) { - glyph = kMenuDeleteLeftGlyph; - } else if (first == 'S' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"space")) { - glyph = kMenuSpaceGlyph; - } else if (first == 'T' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"tab")) { - glyph = kMenuTabRightGlyph; - } else if (first == 'F' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"delete")) { - glyph = kMenuDeleteRightGlyph; - } else if (first == 'H' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"home")) { - glyph = kMenuNorthwestArrowGlyph; - } else if (first == 'R' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"return")) { - glyph = kMenuReturnGlyph; - } else if (first == 'H' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"help")) { - glyph = kMenuHelpGlyph; - } else if (first == 'P' && 0 ==strcasecmp(accel,"power")) { - glyph = kMenuPowerGlyph; - } + } else if (first == 'P' && !strcasecmp(accel,"pageup")) { + glyph = kMenuPageUpGlyph; + } else if (first == 'P' && !strcasecmp(accel,"pagedown")) { + glyph = kMenuPageDownGlyph; + } else if (first == 'L' && !strcasecmp(accel,"left")) { + glyph = kMenuLeftArrowGlyph; + } else if (first == 'R' && !strcasecmp(accel,"right")) { + glyph = kMenuRightArrowGlyph; + } else if (first == 'U' && !strcasecmp(accel,"up")) { + glyph = kMenuUpArrowGlyph; + } else if (first == 'D' && !strcasecmp(accel,"down")) { + glyph = kMenuDownArrowGlyph; + } else if (first == 'E' && !strcasecmp(accel,"escape")) { + glyph = kMenuEscapeGlyph; + } else if (first == 'C' && !strcasecmp(accel,"clear")) { + glyph = kMenuClearGlyph; + } else if (first == 'E' && !strcasecmp(accel,"enter")) { + glyph = kMenuEnterGlyph; + } else if (first == 'D' && !strcasecmp(accel,"backspace")){ + glyph = kMenuDeleteLeftGlyph; + } else if (first == 'S' && !strcasecmp(accel,"space")) { + glyph = kMenuSpaceGlyph; + } else if (first == 'T' && !strcasecmp(accel,"tab")) { + glyph = kMenuTabRightGlyph; + } else if (first == 'F' && !strcasecmp(accel,"delete")) { + glyph = kMenuDeleteRightGlyph; + } else if (first == 'H' && !strcasecmp(accel,"home")) { + glyph = kMenuNorthwestArrowGlyph; + } else if (first == 'R' && !strcasecmp(accel,"return")) { + glyph = kMenuReturnGlyph; + } else if (first == 'H' && !strcasecmp(accel,"help")) { + glyph = kMenuHelpGlyph; + } else if (first == 'P' && !strcasecmp(accel,"power")) { + glyph = kMenuPowerGlyph; + } if (glyph != 0x0) { SetMenuItemKeyGlyph(macMenuHdl, base + index, glyph); if (!hasCmd) { modifiers |= kMenuNoCommandModifier; } } - } - + } + SetMenuItemModifiers(macMenuHdl, base + index, modifiers); } } @@ -1281,25 +1242,24 @@ ReconfigureIndividualMenu( * * ReconfigureMacintoshMenu -- * - * Rebuilds the Macintosh MenuHandle items from the menu. Called - * usually as an idle handler, but can be called synchronously - * if the menu is about to be posted. + * Rebuilds the Macintosh MenuHandle items from the menu. Called usually + * as an idle handler, but can be called synchronously if the menu is + * about to be posted. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Configuration information get set for mePtr; old resources - * get freed, if any need it. + * Configuration information get set for mePtr; old resources get freed, + * if any need it. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void ReconfigureMacintoshMenu( - ClientData clientData) /* Information about menu entry; may - * or may not already have values for - * some fields. */ + ClientData clientData) /* Information about menu entry; may or may + * not already have values for some fields. */ { TkMenu *menuPtr = (TkMenu *) clientData; MenuHandle macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; @@ -1319,16 +1279,16 @@ ReconfigureMacintoshMenu( } */ if (GetMenuID(macMenuHdl) == currentHelpMenuID) { - MenuItemIndex helpIndex; - HMGetHelpMenu(&helpMenuHdl,&helpIndex); + MenuItemIndex helpIndex; + + HMGetHelpMenu(&helpMenuHdl, &helpIndex); if (helpMenuHdl != NULL) { - ReconfigureIndividualMenu(menuPtr, helpMenuHdl, - helpIndex - 1); + ReconfigureIndividualMenu(menuPtr, helpMenuHdl, helpIndex - 1); } } if (menuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { - if (!(menuBarFlags & MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING)) { + if (!(menuBarFlags & MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING)) { Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); menuBarFlags |= MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; } @@ -1340,8 +1300,8 @@ ReconfigureMacintoshMenu( * * CompleteIdlers -- * - * Completes all idle handling so that the menus are in sync when - * the user invokes them with the mouse. + * Completes all idle handling so that the menus are in sync when the + * user invokes them with the mouse. * * Results: * None. @@ -1354,7 +1314,7 @@ ReconfigureMacintoshMenu( static void CompleteIdlers( - TkMenu *menuPtr) /* The menu we are completing. */ + TkMenu *menuPtr) /* The menu we are completing. */ { int i; @@ -1362,16 +1322,13 @@ CompleteIdlers( Tcl_CancelIdleCall(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) menuPtr); ReconfigureMacintoshMenu((ClientData) menuPtr); } - + for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - if (menuPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - if ((menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && (menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - != NULL)) { - CompleteIdlers(menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr - ->menuPtr); - } - } + if ((menuPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) && + (menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) && + (menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + CompleteIdlers(menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr); + } } } @@ -1402,22 +1359,20 @@ TkpPostMenu( { MenuHandle macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; long popUpResult; - int result; - int oldMode; + int result, oldMode; if (inPostMenu) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "Cannot call post menu while already posting menu", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, + "Cannot call post menu while already posting menu", NULL); result = TCL_ERROR; } else { short menuID; Window window; int oldWidth = menuPtr->totalWidth; Tk_Window parentWindow = Tk_Parent(menuPtr->tkwin); - + inPostMenu++; - + result = TkPreprocessMenu(menuPtr); if (result != TCL_OK) { inPostMenu--; @@ -1425,10 +1380,10 @@ TkpPostMenu( } /* - * The post commands could have deleted the menu, which means - * we are dead and should go away. + * The post commands could have deleted the menu, which means we are + * dead and should go away. */ - + if (menuPtr->tkwin == NULL) { inPostMenu--; return TCL_OK; @@ -1438,15 +1393,15 @@ TkpPostMenu( if (menuBarFlags & MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING) { Tcl_CancelIdleCall(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); DrawMenuBarWhenIdle((ClientData *) NULL); - } - + } + if (NULL == parentWindow) { tearoffStruct.excludeRect.top = tearoffStruct.excludeRect.left = tearoffStruct.excludeRect.bottom = tearoffStruct.excludeRect.right = SHRT_MAX; } else { int left, top; - + Tk_GetRootCoords(parentWindow, &left, &top); tearoffStruct.excludeRect.left = left; tearoffStruct.excludeRect.top = top; @@ -1454,19 +1409,20 @@ TkpPostMenu( tearoffStruct.excludeRect.bottom = top + Tk_Height(parentWindow); if (Tk_Class(parentWindow) == Tk_GetUid("Menubutton")) { TkWindow *parentWinPtr = (TkWindow *) parentWindow; - TkMenuButton *mbPtr = - (TkMenuButton *) parentWinPtr->instanceData; + TkMenuButton *mbPtr = (TkMenuButton *) + parentWinPtr->instanceData; int menuButtonWidth = Tk_Width(parentWindow) - 2 * (mbPtr->highlightWidth + mbPtr->borderWidth + 1); + menuPtr->totalWidth = menuButtonWidth > menuPtr->totalWidth ? menuButtonWidth : menuPtr->totalWidth; } } - + InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, -1); RecursivelyInsertMenu(menuPtr); CountMenuItems(macMenuHdl); - + oldMode = Tcl_SetServiceMode(TCL_SERVICE_ALL); popUpResult = PopUpMenuSelect(macMenuHdl, y, x, menuPtr->active); Tcl_SetServiceMode(oldMode); @@ -1474,18 +1430,18 @@ TkpPostMenu( menuPtr->totalWidth = oldWidth; RecursivelyDeleteMenu(menuPtr); DeleteMenu(GetMenuID(macMenuHdl)); - + /* * Simulate the mouse up. */ - + window = Tk_WindowId(menuPtr->tkwin); TkGenerateButtonEventForXPointer(window); - + /* * Dispatch the command. */ - + menuID = HiWord(popUpResult); if (menuID != 0) { result = TkMacOSXDispatchMenuEvent(menuID, LoWord(popUpResult)); @@ -1494,15 +1450,15 @@ TkpPostMenu( result = TCL_OK; } - /* - * Be careful, here. The command executed in handling the menu event - * could destroy the window. Don't try to do anything with it then. - */ - - if (menuPtr->tkwin) { + /* + * Be careful, here. The command executed in handling the menu event + * could destroy the window. Don't try to do anything with it then. + */ + + if (menuPtr->tkwin) { InvalidateMDEFRgns(); RecursivelyClearActiveMenu(menuPtr); - } + } inPostMenu--; } return result; @@ -1514,9 +1470,8 @@ TkpPostMenu( * TkpMenuNewEntry -- * * Adds a pointer to a new menu entry structure with the platform- - * specific fields filled in. The Macintosh uses the - * platformEntryData field of the TkMenuEntry record to store - * geometry information. + * specific fields filled in. The Macintosh uses the platformEntryData + * field of the TkMenuEntry record to store geometry information. * * Results: * Standard TCL error. @@ -1535,7 +1490,7 @@ TkpMenuNewEntry( EntryGeometry *geometryPtr = (EntryGeometry *) ckalloc(sizeof(EntryGeometry)); TkMenu *menuPtr = mePtr->menuPtr; - + geometryPtr->accelTextStart = 0; geometryPtr->accelTextWidth = 0; geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = 0; @@ -1551,12 +1506,11 @@ TkpMenuNewEntry( /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * * Tk_MacOSXTurnOffMenus -- * - * Turns off all the menu drawing code. This is more than just disabling - * the "menu" command, this means that Tk will NEVER touch the menubar. - * It is needed in the Plugin, where Tk does not own the menubar. + * Turns off all the menu drawing code. This is more than just disabling + * the "menu" command, this means that Tk will NEVER touch the menubar. + * It is needed in the Plugin, where Tk does not own the menubar. * * Results: * None. @@ -1568,7 +1522,7 @@ TkpMenuNewEntry( */ void -Tk_MacOSXTurnOffMenus() +Tk_MacOSXTurnOffMenus(void) { gNoTkMenus = 1; } @@ -1576,7 +1530,6 @@ Tk_MacOSXTurnOffMenus() /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * * DrawMenuBarWhenIdle -- * * Update the menu bar next time there is an idle event. @@ -1598,19 +1551,19 @@ DrawMenuBarWhenIdle( TkMenu *appleMenuPtr, *helpMenuPtr; MenuHandle macMenuHdl; Tcl_HashEntry *hashEntryPtr; - + /* * If we have been turned off, exit. */ - + if (gNoTkMenus) { - return; + return; } - + /* * We need to clear the apple and help menus of any extra items. */ - + if (currentAppleMenuID != 0) { hashEntryPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) ((int)currentAppleMenuID)); @@ -1619,8 +1572,7 @@ DrawMenuBarWhenIdle( TkpNewMenu(appleMenuPtr); appleMenuPtr->menuFlags &= ~MENU_APPLE_MENU; appleMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, - (ClientData) appleMenuPtr); + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) appleMenuPtr); } if (currentHelpMenuID != 0) { @@ -1634,12 +1586,11 @@ DrawMenuBarWhenIdle( Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, (ClientData) helpMenuPtr); } - + /* - * We need to find the clone of this menu that is the menubar. - * Once we do that, for every cascade in the menu, we need to - * insert the Mac menu in the Mac menubar. Finally, we need - * to redraw the menubar. + * We need to find the clone of this menu that is the menubar. Once we do + * that, for every cascade in the menu, we need to insert the Mac menu in + * the Mac menubar. Finally, we need to redraw the menubar. */ menuRefPtr = NULL; @@ -1650,188 +1601,163 @@ DrawMenuBarWhenIdle( if (menuRefPtr != NULL) { TkMenu *menuPtr, *menuBarPtr; TkMenu *cascadeMenuPtr; - char *appleMenuName, *helpMenuName; - int appleIndex = -1, helpIndex = -1; - int i; - - menuPtr = menuRefPtr->menuPtr; - if (menuPtr != NULL) { - TkMenuReferences *specialMenuRefPtr; - TkMenuEntry *specialEntryPtr; - - appleMenuName = ckalloc(strlen(currentMenuBarName) - + 1 + strlen(".apple") + 1); - sprintf(appleMenuName, "%s.apple", - Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)); - specialMenuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, - appleMenuName); - if ((specialMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && (specialMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { - for (specialEntryPtr - = specialMenuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; - specialEntryPtr != NULL; - specialEntryPtr - = specialEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { + char *appleMenuName, *helpMenuName; + int appleIndex = -1, helpIndex = -1, i; + + menuPtr = menuRefPtr->menuPtr; + if (menuPtr != NULL) { + TkMenuReferences *specialMenuRefPtr; + TkMenuEntry *specialEntryPtr; + + appleMenuName = ckalloc( + strlen(currentMenuBarName) + 1 + strlen(".apple") + 1); + sprintf(appleMenuName, "%s.apple", Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)); + specialMenuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, + appleMenuName); + if ((specialMenuRefPtr != NULL) + && (specialMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + for (specialEntryPtr = specialMenuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; + specialEntryPtr != NULL; + specialEntryPtr = specialEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { if (specialEntryPtr->menuPtr == menuPtr) { appleIndex = specialEntryPtr->index; break; } } - } - ckfree(appleMenuName); - - helpMenuName = ckalloc(strlen(currentMenuBarName) - + 1 + strlen(".help") + 1); - sprintf(helpMenuName, "%s.help", - Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)); - specialMenuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, - helpMenuName); - if ((specialMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && (specialMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { - for (specialEntryPtr - = specialMenuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; - specialEntryPtr != NULL; - specialEntryPtr - = specialEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { + } + ckfree(appleMenuName); + + helpMenuName = ckalloc( + strlen(currentMenuBarName) + 1 + strlen(".help") + 1); + sprintf(helpMenuName, "%s.help", Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)); + specialMenuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, + helpMenuName); + if ((specialMenuRefPtr != NULL) + && (specialMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + for (specialEntryPtr = specialMenuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; + specialEntryPtr != NULL; + specialEntryPtr = specialEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { if (specialEntryPtr->menuPtr == menuPtr) { helpIndex = specialEntryPtr->index; break; } } } - ckfree(helpMenuName); - - } - - for (menuBarPtr = menuPtr; - (menuBarPtr != NULL) - && (menuBarPtr->menuType != MENUBAR); - menuBarPtr = menuBarPtr->nextInstancePtr) { - - /* - * Null loop body. - */ - - } - - if (menuBarPtr == NULL) { - SetDefaultMenubar(); - } else { - if (menuBarPtr->tearoff != menuPtr->tearoff) { - if (menuBarPtr->tearoff) { - appleIndex = (-1 == appleIndex) ? appleIndex - : appleIndex + 1; - helpIndex = (-1 == helpIndex) ? helpIndex - : helpIndex + 1; - } else { - appleIndex = (-1 == appleIndex) ? appleIndex - : appleIndex - 1; - helpIndex = (-1 == helpIndex) ? helpIndex - : helpIndex - 1; - } - } - ClearMenuBar(); - - if (appleIndex == -1) { - InsertMenu(tkAppleMenu, 0); - currentAppleMenuID = 0; - tkCurrentAppleMenu = tkAppleMenu; + ckfree(helpMenuName); + } + + for (menuBarPtr = menuPtr; + (menuBarPtr != NULL) && (menuBarPtr->menuType != MENUBAR); + menuBarPtr = menuBarPtr->nextInstancePtr) { + /* + * Null loop body. + */ + } + + if (menuBarPtr == NULL) { + goto setDefault; + } + + if (menuBarPtr->tearoff != menuPtr->tearoff) { + if (menuBarPtr->tearoff) { + appleIndex = (-1 == appleIndex) ? appleIndex : appleIndex + 1; + helpIndex = (-1 == helpIndex) ? helpIndex : helpIndex + 1; } else { - short appleID; - appleMenuPtr = menuBarPtr->entries[appleIndex] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; - TkpDestroyMenu(appleMenuPtr); - TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(appleMenuPtr->interp, appleMenuPtr, 0, - &appleID); - macMenuHdl = NewMenu(appleID, "\p\024"); - appleMenuPtr->platformData = - (TkMenuPlatformData) ckalloc(sizeof(MacMenu)); - ((MacMenu *)appleMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl - = macMenuHdl; - SetRect(&((MacMenu *) appleMenuPtr->platformData)->menuRect, - 0, 0, 0, 0); - appleMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_APPLE_MENU; - if (!(appleMenuPtr->menuFlags - & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { - appleMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, - (ClientData) appleMenuPtr); - } - InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, 0); - RecursivelyInsertMenu(appleMenuPtr); - currentAppleMenuID = appleID; - tkCurrentAppleMenu = macMenuHdl; + appleIndex = (-1 == appleIndex) ? appleIndex : appleIndex - 1; + helpIndex = (-1 == helpIndex) ? helpIndex : helpIndex - 1; } - if (helpIndex == -1) { - currentHelpMenuID = 0; + } + ClearMenuBar(); + + if (appleIndex == -1) { + InsertMenu(tkAppleMenu, 0); + currentAppleMenuID = 0; + tkCurrentAppleMenu = tkAppleMenu; + } else { + short appleID; + appleMenuPtr = menuBarPtr->entries[appleIndex] + ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; + TkpDestroyMenu(appleMenuPtr); + TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(appleMenuPtr->interp, appleMenuPtr, 0, + &appleID); + macMenuHdl = NewMenu(appleID, "\p\024"); + appleMenuPtr->platformData = (TkMenuPlatformData) + ckalloc(sizeof(MacMenu)); + ((MacMenu *)appleMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl = macMenuHdl; + SetRect(&((MacMenu *) appleMenuPtr->platformData)->menuRect, 0, 0, + 0, 0); + appleMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_APPLE_MENU; + if (!(appleMenuPtr->menuFlags & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { + appleMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, + (ClientData) appleMenuPtr); } - - for (i = 0; i < menuBarPtr->numEntries; i++) { - if (i == appleIndex) { - if (menuBarPtr->entries[i]->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { - DisableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - ->platformData)->menuHdl, - 0); - } else { - EnableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - ->platformData)->menuHdl, - 0); + InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, 0); + RecursivelyInsertMenu(appleMenuPtr); + currentAppleMenuID = appleID; + tkCurrentAppleMenu = macMenuHdl; + } + if (helpIndex == -1) { + currentHelpMenuID = 0; + } + + for (i = 0; i < menuBarPtr->numEntries; i++) { + if (i == appleIndex) { + if (menuBarPtr->entries[i]->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { + DisableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i]-> + childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl, + 0); + } else { + EnableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i]-> + childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl, + 0); + } + continue; + } else if (i == helpIndex) { + TkMenu *helpMenuPtr = menuBarPtr->entries[i] + ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; + + if (helpMenuPtr == NULL) { + continue; + } + helpMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_HELP_MENU; + if (!(helpMenuPtr->menuFlags + & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { + helpMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, + (ClientData) helpMenuPtr); + } + macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) helpMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; + currentHelpMenuID = GetMenuID(macMenuHdl); + } else if (menuBarPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { + if ((menuBarPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) && + menuBarPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr) { + cascadeMenuPtr = menuBarPtr->entries[i] + ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; + macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) cascadeMenuPtr + ->platformData)->menuHdl; + DeleteMenu(GetMenuID(macMenuHdl)); + InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, 0); + RecursivelyInsertMenu(cascadeMenuPtr); + if (menuBarPtr->entries[i]->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { + DisableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i] + ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr + ->platformData)->menuHdl, 0); + } else { + EnableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i] + ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr + ->platformData)->menuHdl, 0); } - continue; - } else if (i == helpIndex) { - TkMenu *helpMenuPtr = menuBarPtr->entries[i] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; - - if (helpMenuPtr == NULL) { - continue; - } - helpMenuPtr->menuFlags |= MENU_HELP_MENU; - if (!(helpMenuPtr->menuFlags - & MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING)) { - helpMenuPtr->menuFlags - |= MENU_RECONFIGURE_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(ReconfigureMacintoshMenu, - (ClientData) helpMenuPtr); - } - macMenuHdl = - ((MacMenu *) helpMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; - currentHelpMenuID = GetMenuID(macMenuHdl); - } else if (menuBarPtr->entries[i]->type - == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - if ((menuBarPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && menuBarPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr - ->menuPtr != NULL) { - cascadeMenuPtr = menuBarPtr->entries[i] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; - macMenuHdl = ((MacMenu *) cascadeMenuPtr - ->platformData)->menuHdl; - DeleteMenu(GetMenuID(macMenuHdl)); - InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, 0); - RecursivelyInsertMenu(cascadeMenuPtr); - if (menuBarPtr->entries[i]->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { - DisableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - ->platformData)->menuHdl, - 0); - } else { - EnableMenuItem(((MacMenu *) menuBarPtr->entries[i] - ->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - ->platformData)->menuHdl, - 0); - } - } - } + } } } } else { + setDefault: SetDefaultMenubar(); } DrawMenuBar(); menuBarFlags &= ~MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -1852,25 +1778,24 @@ DrawMenuBarWhenIdle( static void RecursivelyInsertMenu( - TkMenu *menuPtr) /* All of the cascade items in this menu - * will be inserted into the mac menubar. */ + TkMenu *menuPtr) /* All of the cascade items in this menu will + * be inserted into the mac menubar. */ { int i; TkMenu *cascadeMenuPtr; MenuHandle macMenuHdl; - + for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - if (menuPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - if ((menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && (menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - != NULL)) { - cascadeMenuPtr = menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; - macMenuHdl = - ((MacMenu *) cascadeMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; - InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, -1); - RecursivelyInsertMenu(cascadeMenuPtr); + if (menuPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { + if ((menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) + && menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL) { + cascadeMenuPtr = menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; + macMenuHdl = + ((MacMenu *) cascadeMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; + InsertMenu(macMenuHdl, -1); + RecursivelyInsertMenu(cascadeMenuPtr); } - } + } } } @@ -1882,7 +1807,6 @@ RecursivelyInsertMenu( * Takes all of the cascades of this menu out of the Mac hierarchical * list. * - * * Results: * None. * @@ -1894,25 +1818,24 @@ RecursivelyInsertMenu( static void RecursivelyDeleteMenu( - TkMenu *menuPtr) /* All of the cascade items in this menu - * will be inserted into the mac menubar. */ + TkMenu *menuPtr) /* All of the cascade items in this menu will + * be inserted into the mac menubar. */ { int i; TkMenu *cascadeMenuPtr; MenuHandle macMenuHdl; - + for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - if (menuPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - if ((menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && (menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr - != NULL)) { - cascadeMenuPtr = menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; - macMenuHdl = - ((MacMenu *) cascadeMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; - DeleteMenu(GetMenuID(macMenuHdl)); - RecursivelyInsertMenu(cascadeMenuPtr); + if (menuPtr->entries[i]->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { + if ((menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) && + (menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + cascadeMenuPtr = menuPtr->entries[i]->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr; + macMenuHdl = + ((MacMenu *) cascadeMenuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl; + DeleteMenu(GetMenuID(macMenuHdl)); + RecursivelyInsertMenu(cascadeMenuPtr); } - } + } } } @@ -1933,11 +1856,11 @@ RecursivelyDeleteMenu( */ static void -SetDefaultMenubar() +SetDefaultMenubar(void) { if (currentMenuBarName != NULL) { - ckfree(currentMenuBarName); - currentMenuBarName = NULL; + ckfree(currentMenuBarName); + currentMenuBarName = NULL; } currentMenuBarOwner = NULL; ClearMenuBar(); @@ -1945,8 +1868,8 @@ SetDefaultMenubar() InsertMenu(tkFileMenu, 0); InsertMenu(tkEditMenu, 0); if (!(menuBarFlags & MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING)) { - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); - menuBarFlags |= MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, NULL); + menuBarFlags |= MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; } } @@ -1955,8 +1878,8 @@ SetDefaultMenubar() * * TkpSetMainMenubar -- * - * Puts the menu associated with a window into the menubar. Should - * only be called when the window is in front. + * Puts the menu associated with a window into the menubar. Should only + * be called when the window is in front. * * Results: * None. @@ -1971,81 +1894,77 @@ void TkpSetMainMenubar( Tcl_Interp *interp, /* The interpreter of the application */ Tk_Window tkwin, /* The frame we are setting up */ - char *menuName) /* The name of the menu to put in front. - * If NULL, use the default menu bar. - */ + char *menuName) /* The name of the menu to put in front. If + * NULL, use the default menu bar. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; - CGrafPtr winPort; + CGrafPtr winPort; WindowRef macWindowPtr; WindowRef frontNonFloating; winPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(winPtr->window); if (!winPort) { - return; + return; } macWindowPtr = GetWindowFromPort(winPort); - - frontNonFloating = ActiveNonFloatingWindow(); + + frontNonFloating = ActiveNonFloatingWindow(); if ((macWindowPtr == NULL) || (macWindowPtr != frontNonFloating)) { - return; + return; } - if ((currentMenuBarInterp != interp) - || (currentMenuBarOwner != tkwin) - || (currentMenuBarName == NULL) - || (menuName == NULL) - || (strcmp(menuName, currentMenuBarName) != 0)) { + if ((currentMenuBarInterp != interp) || (currentMenuBarOwner != tkwin) + || (currentMenuBarName == NULL) || (menuName == NULL) + || (strcmp(menuName, currentMenuBarName) != 0)) { Tk_Window searchWindow; - TopLevelMenubarList *listPtr; - - if (currentMenuBarName != NULL) { - ckfree(currentMenuBarName); - } + TopLevelMenubarList *listPtr; + + if (currentMenuBarName != NULL) { + ckfree(currentMenuBarName); + } if (menuName == NULL) { searchWindow = tkwin; if (strcmp(Tk_Class(searchWindow), "Menu") == 0) { - TkMenuReferences *menuRefPtr; - - menuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(interp, Tk_PathName(tkwin)); - if (menuRefPtr != NULL) { - TkMenu *menuPtr = menuRefPtr->menuPtr; - if (menuPtr != NULL) { - menuPtr = menuPtr->masterMenuPtr; - searchWindow = menuPtr->tkwin; - } - } - } + TkMenuReferences *menuRefPtr; + + menuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(interp, Tk_PathName(tkwin)); + if (menuRefPtr != NULL) { + TkMenu *menuPtr = menuRefPtr->menuPtr; + + if (menuPtr != NULL) { + searchWindow = menuPtr->masterMenuPtr->tkwin; + } + } + } for (; searchWindow != NULL; searchWindow = Tk_Parent(searchWindow)) { - - for (listPtr = windowListPtr; listPtr != NULL; - listPtr = listPtr->nextPtr) { - if (listPtr->tkwin == searchWindow) { - break; - } - } - if (listPtr != NULL) { - menuName = Tk_PathName(listPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr - ->tkwin); - break; - } + for (listPtr = windowListPtr; listPtr != NULL; + listPtr = listPtr->nextPtr) { + if (listPtr->tkwin == searchWindow) { + break; + } + } + if (listPtr != NULL) { + menuName = Tk_PathName( + listPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr->tkwin); + break; + } } } - + if (menuName == NULL) { currentMenuBarName = NULL; - } else { - currentMenuBarName = ckalloc(strlen(menuName) + 1); + } else { + currentMenuBarName = ckalloc(strlen(menuName) + 1); strcpy(currentMenuBarName, menuName); - } - currentMenuBarOwner = tkwin; - currentMenuBarInterp = interp; + } + currentMenuBarOwner = tkwin; + currentMenuBarInterp = interp; } if (!(menuBarFlags & MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING)) { - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); - menuBarFlags |= MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, NULL); + menuBarFlags |= MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING; } } @@ -2060,8 +1979,8 @@ TkpSetMainMenubar( * None. * * Side effects: - * On Windows and UNIX, associates the platform menu with the - * platform window. + * On Windows and UNIX, associates the platform menu with the platform + * window. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -2072,45 +1991,44 @@ TkpSetWindowMenuBar( TkMenu *menuPtr) /* The menu we are setting */ { TopLevelMenubarList *listPtr, *prevPtr; - + /* * Remove any existing reference to this window. */ - - for (prevPtr = NULL, listPtr = windowListPtr; - listPtr != NULL; - prevPtr = listPtr, listPtr = listPtr->nextPtr) { + + for (prevPtr = NULL, listPtr = windowListPtr; + listPtr != NULL; + prevPtr = listPtr, listPtr = listPtr->nextPtr) { if (listPtr->tkwin == tkwin) { break; - } + } } - + if (listPtr != NULL) { - if (prevPtr != NULL) { - prevPtr->nextPtr = listPtr->nextPtr; - } else { - windowListPtr = listPtr->nextPtr; - } - ckfree((char *) listPtr); + if (prevPtr != NULL) { + prevPtr->nextPtr = listPtr->nextPtr; + } else { + windowListPtr = listPtr->nextPtr; + } + ckfree((char *) listPtr); } - + if (menuPtr != NULL) { - listPtr = (TopLevelMenubarList *) ckalloc(sizeof(TopLevelMenubarList)); - listPtr->nextPtr = windowListPtr; - windowListPtr = listPtr; - listPtr->tkwin = tkwin; - listPtr->menuPtr = menuPtr; + listPtr = (TopLevelMenubarList *) ckalloc(sizeof(TopLevelMenubarList)); + listPtr->nextPtr = windowListPtr; + windowListPtr = listPtr; + listPtr->tkwin = tkwin; + listPtr->menuPtr = menuPtr; } } - -static void + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * EventuallyInvokeMenu -- * - * This IdleTime callback actually invokes the menu command - * scheduled in TkMacOSXDispatchMenuEvent. + * This IdleTime callback actually invokes the menu command scheduled in + * TkMacOSXDispatchMenuEvent. * * Results: * None. @@ -2121,32 +2039,33 @@ static void *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -EventuallyInvokeMenu (ClientData data) +static void +EventuallyInvokeMenu( + ClientData data) { - struct MenuCommandHandlerData *realData - = (struct MenuCommandHandlerData *) data; + struct MenuCommandHandlerData *realData = + (struct MenuCommandHandlerData *) data; int code; code = TkInvokeMenu(realData->menuPtr->interp, realData->menuPtr, - realData->index); - - if (code != TCL_OK && code != TCL_CONTINUE - && code != TCL_BREAK) { - Tcl_AddErrorInfo(realData->menuPtr->interp, "\n (menu invoke)"); - Tcl_BackgroundError(realData->menuPtr->interp); + realData->index); + + if (code != TCL_OK && code != TCL_CONTINUE && code != TCL_BREAK) { + Tcl_AddErrorInfo(realData->menuPtr->interp, "\n (menu invoke)"); + Tcl_BackgroundError(realData->menuPtr->interp); } - + Tcl_Release(realData->menuPtr->interp); Tcl_Release(realData->menuPtr); } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXDispatchMenuEvent -- * - * Given a menu id and an item, dispatches the command associated - * with it. + * Given a menu id and an item, dispatches the command associated with + * it. * * Results: * None. @@ -2159,64 +2078,71 @@ EventuallyInvokeMenu (ClientData data) int TkMacOSXDispatchMenuEvent( - int menuID, /* The menu id of the menu we are invoking */ - int index) /* The one-based index of the item that was - * selected. */ + int menuID, /* The menu id of the menu we are invoking */ + int index) /* The one-based index of the item that was + * selected. */ { int result = TCL_OK; + if (menuID != 0) { - if (menuID == kHMHelpMenuID) { - if (currentMenuBarOwner != NULL) { - TkMenuReferences *helpMenuRef; - char *helpMenuName = ckalloc(strlen(currentMenuBarName) - + strlen(".help") + 1); - sprintf(helpMenuName, "%s.help", currentMenuBarName); - helpMenuRef = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, - helpMenuName); - ckfree(helpMenuName); - if ((helpMenuRef != NULL) && (helpMenuRef->menuPtr != NULL)) { + if (menuID == kHMHelpMenuID) { + if (currentMenuBarOwner != NULL) { + TkMenuReferences *helpMenuRef; + char *helpMenuName = ckalloc(strlen(currentMenuBarName) + + strlen(".help") + 1); + + sprintf(helpMenuName, "%s.help", currentMenuBarName); + helpMenuRef = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, + helpMenuName); + ckfree(helpMenuName); + if ((helpMenuRef != NULL) && (helpMenuRef->menuPtr != NULL)) { MenuRef outHelpMenu; MenuItemIndex itemIndex; int newIndex; + HMGetHelpMenu(&outHelpMenu, &itemIndex); - newIndex = index - itemIndex; - result = TkInvokeMenu(currentMenuBarInterp, - helpMenuRef->menuPtr, newIndex); - } - } - } else { - Tcl_HashEntry *commandEntryPtr = - Tcl_FindHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) ((int)menuID)); - if (commandEntryPtr != NULL) { - TkMenu *menuPtr = (TkMenu *) Tcl_GetHashValue(commandEntryPtr); - if ((currentAppleMenuID == menuID) - && (index > menuPtr->numEntries + 1)) { - /* - * We don't need to do anything here, the standard - * Application event handler will open the built-in - * Apple menu item for us. - */ - result = TCL_OK; - } else { - struct MenuCommandHandlerData *data - = (struct MenuCommandHandlerData *) - ckalloc(sizeof(struct MenuCommandHandlerData)); - Tcl_Preserve(menuPtr->interp); - Tcl_Preserve(menuPtr); - data->menuPtr = menuPtr; - data->index = index - 1; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle (EventuallyInvokeMenu, - (ClientData) data); - /* result = TkInvokeMenu(menuPtr->interp, menuPtr, index - 1); */ - } - } else { - return TCL_ERROR; - } + newIndex = index - itemIndex; + result = TkInvokeMenu(currentMenuBarInterp, + helpMenuRef->menuPtr, newIndex); + } + } + } else { + Tcl_HashEntry *commandEntryPtr = + Tcl_FindHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) ((int)menuID)); + TkMenu *menuPtr; + + if (commandEntryPtr == NULL) { + return TCL_ERROR; + } + + menuPtr = (TkMenu *) Tcl_GetHashValue(commandEntryPtr); + + if ((currentAppleMenuID == menuID) + && (index > menuPtr->numEntries + 1)) { + /* + * We don't need to do anything here, the standard Application + * event handler will open the built-in Apple menu item for + * us. + */ + + result = TCL_OK; + } else { + struct MenuCommandHandlerData *data = + (struct MenuCommandHandlerData *) + ckalloc(sizeof(struct MenuCommandHandlerData)); + + Tcl_Preserve(menuPtr->interp); + Tcl_Preserve(menuPtr); + data->menuPtr = menuPtr; + data->index = index - 1; + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(EventuallyInvokeMenu, (ClientData) data); + /* result = TkInvokeMenu(menuPtr->interp, menuPtr, index-1); */ + } } } return result; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * @@ -2243,9 +2169,8 @@ GetMenuIndicatorGeometry ( int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ { char markChar; - + *heightPtr = fmPtr->linespace; - markChar = (char) FindMarkCharacter(mePtr); *widthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, &markChar, 1) + 4; } @@ -2268,61 +2193,64 @@ GetMenuIndicatorGeometry ( static void GetMenuAccelGeometry ( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are measuring */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are measuring */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated font metrics */ - int *modWidthPtr, /* The width of all of the key - * modifier symbols. */ - int *textWidthPtr, /* The resulting width */ - int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are measuring */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are measuring */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated font metrics */ + int *modWidthPtr, /* The width of all of the key modifier + * symbols. */ + int *textWidthPtr, /* The resulting width */ + int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ { *heightPtr = fmPtr->linespace; *modWidthPtr = 0; if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - *textWidthPtr = SICN_HEIGHT; - *modWidthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "W", 1); + *textWidthPtr = SICN_HEIGHT; + *modWidthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "W", 1); } else if (0 == mePtr->accelLength) { - *textWidthPtr = 0; + *textWidthPtr = 0; } else { - char *accel = (mePtr->accelPtr == NULL) ? "" - : Tcl_GetStringFromObj(mePtr->accelPtr, NULL); - - if (NULL == GetResource('SICN', SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER)) { - *textWidthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, accel, mePtr->accelLength); - } else { - int emWidth = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "W", 1) + 1; - if ((mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_ACCEL_MASK) == 0) { - int width = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, accel, mePtr->accelLength); - *textWidthPtr = emWidth; - if (width < emWidth) { - *modWidthPtr = 0; - } else { - *modWidthPtr = width - emWidth; - } - } else { - int length = ((EntryGeometry *)mePtr->platformEntryData) - ->accelTextStart; - if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_CONTROL_ACCEL) { - *modWidthPtr += CONTROL_ICON_WIDTH; - } - if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SHIFT_ACCEL) { - *modWidthPtr += SHIFT_ICON_WIDTH; - } - if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_OPTION_ACCEL) { - *modWidthPtr += OPTION_ICON_WIDTH; - } - if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_COMMAND_ACCEL) { - *modWidthPtr += COMMAND_ICON_WIDTH; - } - if (1 == (mePtr->accelLength - length)) { - *textWidthPtr = emWidth; - } else { - *textWidthPtr += Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, accel - + length, mePtr->accelLength - length); - } - } - } + char *accel = (mePtr->accelPtr == NULL) ? "" + : Tcl_GetString(mePtr->accelPtr); + + if (NULL == GetResource('SICN', SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER)) { + *textWidthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, accel, mePtr->accelLength); + } else { + int emWidth = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "W", 1) + 1; + + if ((mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_ACCEL_MASK) == 0) { + int width = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, accel, mePtr->accelLength); + + *textWidthPtr = emWidth; + if (width < emWidth) { + *modWidthPtr = 0; + } else { + *modWidthPtr = width - emWidth; + } + } else { + int length = ((EntryGeometry *)mePtr->platformEntryData) + ->accelTextStart; + + if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_CONTROL_ACCEL) { + *modWidthPtr += CONTROL_ICON_WIDTH; + } + if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SHIFT_ACCEL) { + *modWidthPtr += SHIFT_ICON_WIDTH; + } + if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_OPTION_ACCEL) { + *modWidthPtr += OPTION_ICON_WIDTH; + } + if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_COMMAND_ACCEL) { + *modWidthPtr += COMMAND_ICON_WIDTH; + } + if (1 == (mePtr->accelLength - length)) { + *textWidthPtr = emWidth; + } else { + *textWidthPtr += Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, accel + length, + mePtr->accelLength - length); + } + } + } } } @@ -2344,17 +2272,17 @@ GetMenuAccelGeometry ( static void GetTearoffEntryGeometry ( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are measuring */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated font metrics */ - int *widthPtr, /* The resulting width */ - int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are measuring */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated font metrics */ + int *widthPtr, /* The resulting width */ + int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ { if ((GetResource('MDEF', 591) == NULL) && (menuPtr->menuType == MASTER_MENU)) { - *heightPtr = fmPtr->linespace; - *widthPtr = 0; + *heightPtr = fmPtr->linespace; + *widthPtr = 0; } else { *widthPtr = *heightPtr = 0; } @@ -2378,18 +2306,18 @@ GetTearoffEntryGeometry ( static void GetMenuSeparatorGeometry( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are measuring */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalcualted font metrics */ - int *widthPtr, /* The resulting width */ - int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are measuring */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalcualted font metrics */ + int *widthPtr, /* The resulting width */ + int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height */ { - SInt16 outHeight; - - GetThemeMenuSeparatorHeight(&outHeight); - *widthPtr = 0; - *heightPtr = outHeight; + SInt16 outHeight; + + GetThemeMenuSeparatorHeight(&outHeight); + *widthPtr = 0; + *heightPtr = outHeight; } /* @@ -2403,54 +2331,53 @@ GetMenuSeparatorGeometry( * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void DrawMenuEntryIndicator( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ - Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing */ - GC gc, /* The GC we are drawing with */ - GC indicatorGC, /* The GC to use for the indicator */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated font metrics */ - int x, /* topleft hand corner of entry */ - int y, /* topleft hand corner of entry */ - int width, /* width of entry */ - int height) /* height of entry */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ + Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing */ + GC gc, /* The GC we are drawing with */ + GC indicatorGC, /* The GC to use for the indicator */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated font metrics */ + int x, /* topleft hand corner of entry */ + int y, /* topleft hand corner of entry */ + int width, /* width of entry */ + int height) /* height of entry */ { - if ((mePtr->type == CHECK_BUTTON_ENTRY) || - (mePtr->type == RADIO_BUTTON_ENTRY)) { - if (mePtr->indicatorOn - && (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SELECTED)) { + if ((mePtr->type == CHECK_BUTTON_ENTRY) || + (mePtr->type == RADIO_BUTTON_ENTRY)) { + if (mePtr->indicatorOn && (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SELECTED)) { int baseline; short markShort; - - baseline = y + (height + fmPtr->ascent - fmPtr->descent) / 2; - GetItemMark(((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl, - mePtr->index + 1, &markShort); - if (markShort != 0) { - char markChar; - char markCharUTF[TCL_UTF_MAX + 1]; + + baseline = y + (height + fmPtr->ascent - fmPtr->descent) / 2; + GetItemMark(((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuHdl, + mePtr->index + 1, &markShort); + if (markShort != 0) { + char markChar, markCharUTF[TCL_UTF_MAX + 1]; int dstWrote; - - markChar = (char) markShort; - /* - * Not sure if this is the correct encoding, but this function - * doesn't appear to be used at all in, since the Carbon Menus - * draw themselves - */ - Tcl_ExternalToUtf(NULL, NULL, &markChar, 1, 0, NULL, + + markChar = (char) markShort; + + /* + * Not sure if this is the correct encoding, but this function + * doesn't appear to be used at all in, since the Carbon Menus + * draw themselves + */ + + Tcl_ExternalToUtf(NULL, NULL, &markChar, 1, 0, NULL, markCharUTF, TCL_UTF_MAX + 1, NULL, &dstWrote, NULL); Tk_DrawChars(menuPtr->display, d, gc, tkfont, markCharUTF, dstWrote, x + 2, baseline); - } + } } - } + } } /* @@ -2464,17 +2391,16 @@ DrawMenuEntryIndicator( * Nothing * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static void DrawMenuBackground( - Rect *menuRectPtr, /* The menu rect */ + Rect *menuRectPtr, /* The menu rect */ Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ - ThemeMenuType type /* Type of menu */ - ) + ThemeMenuType type) /* Type of menu */ { CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; @@ -2484,9 +2410,8 @@ DrawMenuBackground( GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(d); - DrawThemeMenuBackground (menuRectPtr, type); - SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); - return; + DrawThemeMenuBackground(menuRectPtr, type); + SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); } /* @@ -2494,71 +2419,70 @@ DrawMenuBackground( * * DrawSICN -- * - * Given a resource id and an index, loads the appropriate SICN - * and draws it into a given drawable using the given gc. + * Given a resource id and an index, loads the appropriate SICN and draws + * it into a given drawable using the given gc. * * Results: * Returns 1 if the SICN was found, 0 if not found. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static int DrawSICN( - int resourceID, /* The resource # of the SICN table */ - int index, /* The index into the SICN table of the - * icon we want. */ - Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ - GC gc, /* The GC to draw with */ - int x, /* The left hand coord of the SICN */ - int y) /* The top coord of the SICN */ + int resourceID, /* The resource # of the SICN table */ + int index, /* The index into the SICN table of the icon + * we want. */ + Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ + GC gc, /* The GC to draw with */ + int x, /* The left hand coord of the SICN */ + int y) /* The top coord of the SICN */ { Handle sicnHandle = (Handle) GetResource('SICN', SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER); - + BitMap sicnBitmap; + Rect destRect; + CGrafPtr saveWorld; + GDHandle saveDevice; + GWorldPtr destPort; + const BitMap *destBitMap; + RGBColor origForeColor, origBackColor, foreColor, backColor; + if (NULL == sicnHandle) { - return 0; - } else { - BitMap sicnBitmap; - Rect destRect; - CGrafPtr saveWorld; - GDHandle saveDevice; - GWorldPtr destPort; - const BitMap *destBitMap; - RGBColor origForeColor, origBackColor, foreColor, backColor; - - HLock(sicnHandle); - destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); - GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); - SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); - TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(d); - TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); - GetForeColor(&origForeColor); - GetBackColor(&origBackColor); - - if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &foreColor)) { - RGBForeColor(&foreColor); - } - - if (TkSetMacColor(gc->background, &backColor)) { - RGBBackColor(&backColor); - } + return 0; + } + + HLock(sicnHandle); + destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); + GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); + SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); + TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(d); + TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); + GetForeColor(&origForeColor); + GetBackColor(&origBackColor); + + if (TkSetMacColor(gc->foreground, &foreColor)) { + RGBForeColor(&foreColor); + } - SetRect(&destRect, x, y, x + SICN_HEIGHT, y + SICN_HEIGHT); - sicnBitmap.baseAddr = (Ptr) (*sicnHandle) + index * SICN_HEIGHT - * SICN_ROWS; - sicnBitmap.rowBytes = SICN_ROWS; - SetRect(&sicnBitmap.bounds, 0, 0, 16, 16); - destBitMap = GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(destPort); - CopyBits(&sicnBitmap, destBitMap, &sicnBitmap.bounds, &destRect, GetPortTextMode(destPort), NULL); - HUnlock(sicnHandle); - RGBForeColor(&origForeColor); - RGBBackColor(&origBackColor); - SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); - return 1; + if (TkSetMacColor(gc->background, &backColor)) { + RGBBackColor(&backColor); } + + SetRect(&destRect, x, y, x + SICN_HEIGHT, y + SICN_HEIGHT); + sicnBitmap.baseAddr = (Ptr) (*sicnHandle) + index*SICN_HEIGHT*SICN_ROWS; + sicnBitmap.rowBytes = SICN_ROWS; + SetRect(&sicnBitmap.bounds, 0, 0, 16, 16); + destBitMap = GetPortBitMapForCopyBits(destPort); + CopyBits(&sicnBitmap, destBitMap, &sicnBitmap.bounds, &destRect, + GetPortTextMode(destPort), NULL); + HUnlock(sicnHandle); + RGBForeColor(&origForeColor); + RGBBackColor(&origBackColor); + SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); + return 1; } /* @@ -2566,93 +2490,90 @@ DrawSICN( * * DrawMenuEntryAccelerator -- * - * This procedure draws the accelerator part of a menu. We - * need to decide what to draw here. Should we replace strings - * like "Control", "Command", etc? + * This procedure draws the accelerator part of a menu. We need to decide + * what to draw here. Should we replace strings like "Control", + * "Command", etc? * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void DrawMenuEntryAccelerator( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ - Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing in */ - GC gc, /* The gc to draw into */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated font metrics */ - Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, /* border for menu background */ - int x, /* The left side of the entry */ - int y, /* The top of the entry */ - int width, /* The width of the entry */ - int height, /* The height of the entry */ - int drawArrow) /* Whether or not to draw cascade arrow */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ + Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing in */ + GC gc, /* The gc to draw into */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated font metrics */ + Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, /* border for menu background */ + int x, /* The left side of the entry */ + int y, /* The top of the entry */ + int width, /* The width of the entry */ + int height, /* The height of the entry */ + int drawArrow) /* Whether or not to draw cascade arrow */ { int activeBorderWidth; - + Tk_GetPixelsFromObj(NULL, menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->activeBorderWidthPtr, - &activeBorderWidth); + &activeBorderWidth); if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - /* - * Under Appearance, we let the Appearance Manager draw the icon - */ - + /* + * Under Appearance, we let the Appearance Manager draw the icon + */ } else if (mePtr->accelLength != 0) { - int leftEdge = x + width; - int baseline = y + (height + fmPtr->ascent - fmPtr->descent) / 2; - char *accel; - - accel = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(mePtr->accelPtr, NULL); + int leftEdge = x + width; + int baseline = y + (height + fmPtr->ascent - fmPtr->descent) / 2; + char *accel = Tcl_GetString(mePtr->accelPtr); if (NULL == GetResource('SICN', SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER)) { leftEdge -= ((EntryGeometry *) mePtr->platformEntryData) - ->accelTextWidth; + ->accelTextWidth; Tk_DrawChars(menuPtr->display, d, gc, tkfont, accel, - mePtr->accelLength, leftEdge, baseline); + mePtr->accelLength, leftEdge, baseline); } else { - EntryGeometry *geometryPtr = - (EntryGeometry *) mePtr->platformEntryData; + EntryGeometry *geometryPtr = + (EntryGeometry *) mePtr->platformEntryData; int length = mePtr->accelLength - geometryPtr->accelTextStart; - + leftEdge -= geometryPtr->accelTextWidth; if ((mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_ACCEL_MASK) == 0) { - leftEdge -= geometryPtr->modifierWidth; + leftEdge -= geometryPtr->modifierWidth; } - - Tk_DrawChars(menuPtr->display, d, gc, tkfont, accel - + geometryPtr->accelTextStart, length, leftEdge, baseline); + + Tk_DrawChars(menuPtr->display, d, gc, tkfont, + accel + geometryPtr->accelTextStart, length, leftEdge, + baseline); if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_COMMAND_ACCEL) { - leftEdge -= COMMAND_ICON_WIDTH; - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, COMMAND_ICON, d, gc, - leftEdge, (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); + leftEdge -= COMMAND_ICON_WIDTH; + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, COMMAND_ICON, d, gc, leftEdge, + (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); } if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_OPTION_ACCEL) { - leftEdge -= OPTION_ICON_WIDTH; - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, OPTION_ICON, d, gc, - leftEdge, (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); + leftEdge -= OPTION_ICON_WIDTH; + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, OPTION_ICON, d, gc, leftEdge, + (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); } if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SHIFT_ACCEL) { - leftEdge -= SHIFT_ICON_WIDTH; - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, SHIFT_ICON, d, gc, - leftEdge, (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); + leftEdge -= SHIFT_ICON_WIDTH; + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, SHIFT_ICON, d, gc, leftEdge, + (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); } if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_CONTROL_ACCEL) { - leftEdge -= CONTROL_ICON_WIDTH; - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, CONTROL_ICON, d, gc, - leftEdge, (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); + leftEdge -= CONTROL_ICON_WIDTH; + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, CONTROL_ICON, d, gc, leftEdge, + (y + (height / 2)) - (SICN_HEIGHT / 2) - 1); } - } + } } } @@ -2667,30 +2588,29 @@ DrawMenuEntryAccelerator( * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void DrawMenuSeparator( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ - Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing into */ - GC gc, /* The gc we are drawing with */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated font metrics */ - int x, /* left coordinate of entry */ - int y, /* top coordinate of entry */ - int width, /* width of entry */ - int height) /* height of entry */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ + Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing into */ + GC gc, /* The gc we are drawing with */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated font metrics */ + int x, /* left coordinate of entry */ + int y, /* top coordinate of entry */ + int width, /* width of entry */ + int height) /* height of entry */ { CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; GWorldPtr destPort; Rect r; - + destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); @@ -2699,17 +2619,17 @@ DrawMenuSeparator( r.left = x; r.bottom = y + height; r.right = x + width; - + DrawThemeMenuSeparator(&r); } /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper -- + * AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper -- * - * It routes to the Appearance Managers DrawThemeEntry, which will - * then call us back after setting up the drawing context. + * It routes to the Appearance Managers DrawThemeEntry, which will then + * call us back after setting up the drawing context. * * Results: * A menu entry is drawn @@ -2719,17 +2639,18 @@ DrawMenuSeparator( * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static void + +static void AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper( TkMenuEntry *mePtr, Rect *menuRectPtr, - MenuTrackingData *mtdPtr, + MenuTrackingData *mtdPtr, Drawable d, - Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, - Tk_Font tkfont, - int x, - int y, - int width, + Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, + Tk_Font tkfont, + int x, + int y, + int width, int height) { MenuEntryUserData meData; @@ -2746,32 +2667,30 @@ AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper( itemRect.left = x; itemRect.bottom = itemRect.top + height; itemRect.right = itemRect.left + width; - + if (mePtr->state == ENTRY_ACTIVE) { - theState = kThemeMenuSelected; + theState = kThemeMenuSelected; } else if (mePtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { - theState = kThemeMenuDisabled; + theState = kThemeMenuDisabled; } else { - theState = kThemeMenuActive; + theState = kThemeMenuActive; } - + if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - theType = kThemeMenuItemHierarchical; + theType = kThemeMenuItemHierarchical; } else { - theType = kThemeMenuItemPlain; + theType = kThemeMenuItemPlain; } - - DrawThemeMenuItem (menuRectPtr, &itemRect, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop, mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom, theState, - theType, tkThemeMenuItemDrawingUPP, - (unsigned long) &meData); - + + DrawThemeMenuItem (menuRectPtr, &itemRect, mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom, theState, theType, + tkThemeMenuItemDrawingUPP, (unsigned long) &meData); } /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc -- + * ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc -- * * This routine is called from the Appearance DrawThemeMenuEntry * @@ -2783,27 +2702,28 @@ AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper( * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static pascal void -ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc ( +ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc( const Rect *inBounds, - SInt16 inDepth, - Boolean inIsColorDevice, + SInt16 inDepth, + Boolean inIsColorDevice, SInt32 inUserData) { MenuEntryUserData *meData = (MenuEntryUserData *) inUserData; - TkpDrawMenuEntry(meData->mePtr, meData->mdefDrawable, - meData->tkfont, meData->fmPtr, inBounds->left, - inBounds->top, inBounds->right - inBounds->left, - inBounds->bottom - inBounds->top, 0, 1); + + TkpDrawMenuEntry(meData->mePtr, meData->mdefDrawable, meData->tkfont, + meData->fmPtr, inBounds->left, inBounds->top, + inBounds->right-inBounds->left,inBounds->bottom-inBounds->top,0,1); } /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * TkMacOSXHandleTearoffMenu() -- + * TkMacOSXHandleTearoffMenu -- * - * This routine sees if the MDEF has set a menu and a mouse position - * for tearing off and makes a tearoff menu if it has. + * This routine sees if the MDEF has set a menu and a mouse position for + * tearing off and makes a tearoff menu if it has. * * Results: * menuPtr->interp will have the result of the tearoff command. @@ -2818,18 +2738,17 @@ void TkMacOSXHandleTearoffMenu(void) { if (tearoffStruct.menuPtr != NULL) { - Tcl_DString tearoffCmdStr; - char intString[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; - short windowPart; - WindowRef whichWindow; - - windowPart = FindWindow(tearoffStruct.point, &whichWindow); - - if (windowPart != inMenuBar) { - Tcl_DStringInit(&tearoffCmdStr); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&tearoffCmdStr, "tkTearOffMenu"); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&tearoffCmdStr, - Tk_PathName(tearoffStruct.menuPtr->tkwin)); + WindowRef whichWindow; + short windowPart = FindWindow(tearoffStruct.point, &whichWindow); + + if (windowPart != inMenuBar) { + char intString[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; + Tcl_DString tearoffCmdStr; + + Tcl_DStringInit(&tearoffCmdStr); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&tearoffCmdStr, "tkTearOffMenu"); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&tearoffCmdStr, + Tk_PathName(tearoffStruct.menuPtr->tkwin)); sprintf(intString, "%d", tearoffStruct.point.h); Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&tearoffCmdStr, intString); sprintf(intString, "%d", tearoffStruct.point.v); @@ -2847,24 +2766,25 @@ TkMacOSXHandleTearoffMenu(void) * * TkpInitializeMenuBindings -- * - * For every interp, initializes the bindings for Windows - * menus. Does nothing on Mac or XWindows. + * For every interp, initializes the bindings for Windows menus. Does + * nothing on Mac or XWindows. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * C-level bindings are setup for the interp which will - * handle Alt-key sequences for menus without beeping - * or interfering with user-defined Alt-key bindings. + * C-level bindings are setup for the interp which will handle Alt-key + * sequences for menus without beeping or interfering with user-defined + * Alt-key bindings. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkpInitializeMenuBindings(interp, bindingTable) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* The interpreter to set. */ - Tk_BindingTable bindingTable; /* The table to add to. */ +TkpInitializeMenuBindings( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* The interpreter to set. */ + Tk_BindingTable bindingTable) + /* The table to add to. */ { /* * Nothing to do. @@ -2876,23 +2796,22 @@ TkpInitializeMenuBindings(interp, bindingTable) * * TkpComputeMenubarGeometry -- * - * This procedure is invoked to recompute the size and - * layout of a menu that is a menubar clone. + * This procedure is invoked to recompute the size and layout of a menu + * that is a menubar clone. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Fields of menu entries are changed to reflect their - * current positions, and the size of the menu window - * itself may be changed. + * Fields of menu entries are changed to reflect their current positions, + * and the size of the menu window itself may be changed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkpComputeMenubarGeometry(menuPtr) - TkMenu *menuPtr; /* Structure describing menu. */ +TkpComputeMenubarGeometry( + TkMenu *menuPtr) /* Structure describing menu. */ { TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry(menuPtr); } @@ -2908,24 +2827,23 @@ TkpComputeMenubarGeometry(menuPtr) * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void DrawTearoffEntry( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ - Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing into */ - GC gc, /* The gc we are drawing with */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The font we are drawing with */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The metrics we are drawing with */ - int x, /* Left edge of entry. */ - int y, /* Top edge of entry. */ - int width, /* Width of entry. */ - int height) /* Height of entry. */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ + Drawable d, /* The drawable we are drawing into */ + GC gc, /* The gc we are drawing with */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The font we are drawing with */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The metrics we are drawing with */ + int x, /* Left edge of entry. */ + int y, /* Top edge of entry. */ + int width, /* Width of entry. */ + int height) /* Height of entry. */ { XPoint points[2]; int margin, segmentWidth, maxX; @@ -2934,13 +2852,13 @@ DrawTearoffEntry( if (menuPtr->menuType != MASTER_MENU ) { return; } - + margin = (fmPtr->ascent + fmPtr->descent)/2; points[0].x = x; points[0].y = y + height/2; points[1].y = points[0].y; segmentWidth = 6; - maxX = width - 1; + maxX = width - 1; border = Tk_Get3DBorderFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->borderPtr); while (points[0].x < maxX) { @@ -2959,12 +2877,10 @@ DrawTearoffEntry( * * TkMacOSXSetHelpMenuItemCount -- * - * Has to be called after the first call to InsertMenu. Sets - * up the global variable for the number of items in the - * unmodified help menu. - * NB. Nobody uses this any more, since you can get the number - * of system help items from HMGetHelpMenu trivially. - * But it is in the stubs table... + * Has to be called after the first call to InsertMenu. Sets up the + * global variable for the number of items in the unmodified help menu. + * NB. Nobody uses this any more, since you can get the number of system + * help items from HMGetHelpMenu trivially. But it is in the stubs table. * * Results: * None. @@ -2975,8 +2891,8 @@ DrawTearoffEntry( *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void -TkMacOSXSetHelpMenuItemCount() +void +TkMacOSXSetHelpMenuItemCount(void) { } @@ -2997,26 +2913,26 @@ TkMacOSXSetHelpMenuItemCount() */ void -TkMacOSXMenuClick() +TkMacOSXMenuClick(void) { TkMenu *menuPtr; TkMenuReferences *menuRefPtr; - + if ((currentMenuBarInterp != NULL) && (currentMenuBarName != NULL)) { - menuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, - currentMenuBarName); - for (menuPtr = menuRefPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr; - menuPtr != NULL; menuPtr = menuPtr->nextInstancePtr) { - if (menuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { - CompleteIdlers(menuPtr); - break; - } - } + menuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, + currentMenuBarName); + for (menuPtr = menuRefPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr; + menuPtr != NULL; menuPtr = menuPtr->nextInstancePtr) { + if (menuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { + CompleteIdlers(menuPtr); + break; + } + } } - + if (menuBarFlags & MENUBAR_REDRAW_PENDING) { - Tcl_CancelIdleCall(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); - DrawMenuBarWhenIdle((ClientData *) NULL); + Tcl_CancelIdleCall(DrawMenuBarWhenIdle, (ClientData *) NULL); + DrawMenuBarWhenIdle((ClientData *) NULL); } } @@ -3039,19 +2955,19 @@ TkMacOSXMenuClick() void TkpDrawMenuEntry( - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry to draw */ - Drawable d, /* What to draw into */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* Precalculated font for menu */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry to draw */ + Drawable d, /* What to draw into */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* Precalculated font for menu */ CONST Tk_FontMetrics *menuMetricsPtr, - /* Precalculated metrics for menu */ - int x, /* X-coordinate of topleft of entry */ - int y, /* Y-coordinate of topleft of entry */ - int width, /* Width of the entry rectangle */ - int height, /* Height of the current rectangle */ - int strictMotif, /* Boolean flag */ - int drawArrow) /* Whether or not to draw the cascade - * arrow for cascade items. Only applies - * to Windows. */ + /* Precalculated metrics for menu */ + int x, /* X-coordinate of topleft of entry */ + int y, /* Y-coordinate of topleft of entry */ + int width, /* Width of the entry rectangle */ + int height, /* Height of the current rectangle */ + int strictMotif, /* Boolean flag */ + int drawArrow) /* Whether or not to draw the cascade arrow + * for cascade items. Only applies to + * Windows. */ { GC gc; TkMenu *menuPtr = mePtr->menuPtr; @@ -3064,33 +2980,33 @@ TkpDrawMenuEntry( int adjustedHeight = height - 2 * padY; /* - * Choose the gc for drawing the foreground part of the entry. - * Under Appearance, we pass a null (appearanceGC) to tell - * ourselves not to change whatever color the appearance manager has set. + * Choose the gc for drawing the foreground part of the entry. Under + * Appearance, we pass a null (appearanceGC) to tell ourselves not to + * change whatever color the appearance manager has set. */ if ((mePtr->state == ENTRY_ACTIVE) && !strictMotif) { gc = mePtr->activeGC; if (gc == NULL) { - gc = menuPtr->activeGC; + gc = menuPtr->activeGC; } } else { - TkMenuEntry *cascadeEntryPtr; - int parentDisabled = 0; - - for (cascadeEntryPtr = menuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; - cascadeEntryPtr != NULL; - cascadeEntryPtr = cascadeEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { - char *name = (cascadeEntryPtr->namePtr == NULL) ? "" - : Tcl_GetStringFromObj(cascadeEntryPtr->namePtr, NULL); - - if (strcmp(name, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)) == 0) { - if (cascadeEntryPtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { - parentDisabled = 1; - } - break; - } - } + TkMenuEntry *cascadeEntryPtr; + int parentDisabled = 0; + + for (cascadeEntryPtr = menuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; + cascadeEntryPtr != NULL; + cascadeEntryPtr = cascadeEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { + char *name = (cascadeEntryPtr->namePtr == NULL) ? "" + : Tcl_GetString(cascadeEntryPtr->namePtr); + + if (strcmp(name, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)) == 0) { + if (cascadeEntryPtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { + parentDisabled = 1; + } + break; + } + } if (((parentDisabled || (mePtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED))) && (menuPtr->disabledFgPtr != NULL)) { @@ -3103,9 +3019,9 @@ TkpDrawMenuEntry( if (gc == NULL) { gc = menuPtr->textGC; } - } + } } - + indicatorGC = mePtr->indicatorGC; if (indicatorGC == NULL) { indicatorGC = menuPtr->indicatorGC; @@ -3131,22 +3047,22 @@ TkpDrawMenuEntry( } /* - * Need to draw the entire background, including padding. On Unix, - * for menubars, we have to draw the rest of the entry taking - * into account the padding. + * Need to draw the entire background, including padding. On Unix, for + * menubars, we have to draw the rest of the entry taking into account the + * padding. */ - - DrawMenuEntryBackground(menuPtr, mePtr, d, activeBorder, - bgBorder, x, y, width, height); - + + DrawMenuEntryBackground(menuPtr, mePtr, d, activeBorder, bgBorder, x, y, + width, height); + if (mePtr->type == SEPARATOR_ENTRY) { - DrawMenuSeparator(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, tkfont, + DrawMenuSeparator(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, tkfont, fmPtr, x, adjustedY, width, adjustedHeight); } else if (mePtr->type == TEAROFF_ENTRY) { DrawTearoffEntry(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, tkfont, fmPtr, x, adjustedY, width, adjustedHeight); } else { - DrawMenuEntryLabel(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, tkfont, fmPtr, x, + DrawMenuEntryLabel(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, tkfont, fmPtr, x, adjustedY, width, adjustedHeight); DrawMenuEntryAccelerator(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, tkfont, fmPtr, activeBorder, x, adjustedY, width, adjustedHeight, drawArrow); @@ -3154,7 +3070,6 @@ TkpDrawMenuEntry( DrawMenuEntryIndicator(menuPtr, mePtr, d, gc, indicatorGC, tkfont, fmPtr, x, adjustedY, width, adjustedHeight); } - } } @@ -3163,16 +3078,15 @@ TkpDrawMenuEntry( * * TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry -- * - * This procedure is invoked to recompute the size and - * layout of a menu that is not a menubar clone. + * This procedure is invoked to recompute the size and layout of a menu + * that is not a menubar clone. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Fields of menu entries are changed to reflect their - * current positions, and the size of the menu window - * itself may be changed. + * Fields of menu entries are changed to reflect their current positions, + * and the size of the menu window itself may be changed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -3190,15 +3104,15 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( int entryWidth, maxIndicatorSpace, borderWidth, activeBorderWidth; TkMenuEntry *mePtr, *columnEntryPtr; EntryGeometry *geometryPtr; - + if (menuPtr->tkwin == NULL) { return; } Tk_GetPixelsFromObj(NULL, menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->borderWidthPtr, - &borderWidth); + &borderWidth); Tk_GetPixelsFromObj(NULL, menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->activeBorderWidthPtr, - &activeBorderWidth); + &activeBorderWidth); x = y = borderWidth; indicatorSpace = labelWidth = accelWidth = maxAccelTextWidth = 0; windowHeight = windowWidth = maxWidth = lastColumnBreak = 0; @@ -3207,14 +3121,13 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( maxIndicatorSpace = 0; /* - * On the Mac especially, getting font metrics can be quite slow, - * so we want to do it intelligently. We are going to precalculate - * them and pass them down to all of the measuring and drawing - * routines. We will measure the font metrics of the menu once. - * If an entry does not have its own font set, then we give - * the geometry/drawing routines the menu's font and metrics. - * If an entry has its own font, we will measure that font and - * give all of the geometry/drawing the entry's font and metrics. + * On the Mac especially, getting font metrics can be quite slow, so we + * want to do it intelligently. We are going to precalculate them and pass + * them down to all of the measuring and drawing routines. We will measure + * the font metrics of the menu once. If an entry does not have its own + * font set, then we give the geometry/drawing routines the menu's font + * and metrics. If an entry has its own font, we will measure that font + * and give all of the geometry/drawing the entry's font and metrics. */ menuFont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); @@ -3225,23 +3138,23 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { tkfont = menuFont; fmPtr = &menuMetrics; - } else { + } else { tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); - Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &entryMetrics); - fmPtr = &entryMetrics; - } - + Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &entryMetrics); + fmPtr = &entryMetrics; + } + if ((i > 0) && mePtr->columnBreak) { if (maxIndicatorSpace != 0) { maxIndicatorSpace += 2; } for (j = lastColumnBreak; j < i; j++) { - columnEntryPtr = menuPtr->entries[j]; - geometryPtr = - (EntryGeometry *) columnEntryPtr->platformEntryData; - - columnEntryPtr->indicatorSpace = maxIndicatorSpace; - columnEntryPtr->width = maxIndicatorSpace + maxWidth + columnEntryPtr = menuPtr->entries[j]; + geometryPtr = (EntryGeometry *) + columnEntryPtr->platformEntryData; + + columnEntryPtr->indicatorSpace = maxIndicatorSpace; + columnEntryPtr->width = maxIndicatorSpace + maxWidth + 2 * activeBorderWidth; geometryPtr->accelTextWidth = maxAccelTextWidth; geometryPtr->modifierWidth = maxModifierWidth; @@ -3249,14 +3162,15 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( columnEntryPtr->entryFlags &= ~ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN; if (maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth > maxEntryWithAccelWidth) { geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth - - maxEntryWithAccelWidth; + - maxEntryWithAccelWidth; if (geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin > maxNonAccelMargin) { - geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = maxNonAccelMargin; + geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = maxNonAccelMargin; } } else { geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = 0; - } + } } + x += maxIndicatorSpace + maxWidth + 2 * borderWidth; windowWidth = x; maxWidth = maxIndicatorSpace = maxAccelTextWidth = 0; @@ -3268,88 +3182,86 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( if (mePtr->type == SEPARATOR_ENTRY) { GetMenuSeparatorGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, - fmPtr, &entryWidth, &height); + fmPtr, &entryWidth, &height); mePtr->height = height; } else if (mePtr->type == TEAROFF_ENTRY) { - GetTearoffEntryGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, - fmPtr, &entryWidth, &height); + GetTearoffEntryGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, + fmPtr, &entryWidth, &height); mePtr->height = height; } else { /* - * For each entry, compute the height required by that - * particular entry, plus three widths: the width of the - * label, the width to allow for an indicator to be displayed - * to the left of the label (if any), and the width of the - * accelerator to be displayed to the right of the label - * (if any). These sizes depend, of course, on the type - * of the entry. + * For each entry, compute the height required by that particular + * entry, plus three widths: the width of the label, the width to + * allow for an indicator to be displayed to the left of the label + * (if any), and the width of the accelerator to be displayed to + * the right of the label (if any). These sizes depend, of course, + * on the type of the entry. */ - - GetMenuLabelGeometry(mePtr, tkfont, fmPtr, &labelWidth, - &height); + + GetMenuLabelGeometry(mePtr, tkfont, fmPtr, &labelWidth, &height); mePtr->height = height; - + if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - GetMenuAccelGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, fmPtr, - &modifierWidth, &accelWidth, &height); - nonAccelMargin = 0; + GetMenuAccelGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, fmPtr, + &modifierWidth, &accelWidth, &height); + nonAccelMargin = 0; } else if (mePtr->accelLength == 0) { - nonAccelMargin = mePtr->hideMargin ? 0 - : Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "m", 1); - accelWidth = modifierWidth = 0; + nonAccelMargin = mePtr->hideMargin ? 0 + : Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "m", 1); + accelWidth = modifierWidth = 0; } else { - labelWidth += Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "m", 1); - GetMenuAccelGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, - fmPtr, &modifierWidth, &accelWidth, &height); - if (height > mePtr->height) { - mePtr->height = height; - } - nonAccelMargin = 0; + labelWidth += Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, "m", 1); + GetMenuAccelGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, fmPtr, + &modifierWidth, &accelWidth, &height); + if (height > mePtr->height) { + mePtr->height = height; + } + nonAccelMargin = 0; } if (!(mePtr->hideMargin)) { - GetMenuIndicatorGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, - fmPtr, &indicatorSpace, &height); - if (height > mePtr->height) { - mePtr->height = height; - } + GetMenuIndicatorGeometry(menuPtr, mePtr, tkfont, fmPtr, + &indicatorSpace, &height); + if (height > mePtr->height) { + mePtr->height = height; + } } else { - indicatorSpace = 0; + indicatorSpace = 0; } if (nonAccelMargin > maxNonAccelMargin) { - maxNonAccelMargin = nonAccelMargin; + maxNonAccelMargin = nonAccelMargin; } if (accelWidth > maxAccelTextWidth) { - maxAccelTextWidth = accelWidth; + maxAccelTextWidth = accelWidth; } if (modifierWidth > maxModifierWidth) { - maxModifierWidth = modifierWidth; + maxModifierWidth = modifierWidth; } if (indicatorSpace > maxIndicatorSpace) { - maxIndicatorSpace = indicatorSpace; + maxIndicatorSpace = indicatorSpace; } entryWidth = labelWidth + modifierWidth + accelWidth + nonAccelMargin; if (entryWidth > maxWidth) { - maxWidth = entryWidth; + maxWidth = entryWidth; } - + if (mePtr->accelLength > 0) { - if (entryWidth > maxEntryWithAccelWidth) { - maxEntryWithAccelWidth = entryWidth; - } + if (entryWidth > maxEntryWithAccelWidth) { + maxEntryWithAccelWidth = entryWidth; + } } else { - if (entryWidth > maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth) { - maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth = entryWidth; - } + if (entryWidth > maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth) { + maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth = entryWidth; + } } - + mePtr->height += 2 * activeBorderWidth; - } - mePtr->y = y; + } + mePtr->y = y; y += menuPtr->entries[i]->height + borderWidth; if (y > windowHeight) { windowHeight = y; @@ -3357,11 +3269,11 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( } for (j = lastColumnBreak; j < menuPtr->numEntries; j++) { - columnEntryPtr = menuPtr->entries[j]; - geometryPtr = (EntryGeometry *) columnEntryPtr->platformEntryData; - - columnEntryPtr->indicatorSpace = maxIndicatorSpace; - columnEntryPtr->width = maxIndicatorSpace + maxWidth + columnEntryPtr = menuPtr->entries[j]; + geometryPtr = (EntryGeometry *) columnEntryPtr->platformEntryData; + + columnEntryPtr->indicatorSpace = maxIndicatorSpace; + columnEntryPtr->width = maxIndicatorSpace + maxWidth + 2 * activeBorderWidth; geometryPtr->accelTextWidth = maxAccelTextWidth; geometryPtr->modifierWidth = maxModifierWidth; @@ -3369,21 +3281,21 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( columnEntryPtr->entryFlags |= ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN; if (maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth > maxEntryWithAccelWidth) { geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = maxEntryWithoutAccelWidth - - maxEntryWithAccelWidth; + - maxEntryWithAccelWidth; if (geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin > maxNonAccelMargin) { - geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = maxNonAccelMargin; + geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = maxNonAccelMargin; } } else { geometryPtr->nonAccelMargin = 0; - } + } } windowWidth = x + maxIndicatorSpace + maxWidth + 2 * activeBorderWidth + borderWidth; windowHeight += borderWidth; - + /* - * The X server doesn't like zero dimensions, so round up to at least - * 1 (a zero-sized menu should never really occur, anyway). + * The X server doesn't like zero dimensions, so round up to at least 1 (a + * zero-sized menu should never really occur, anyway). */ if (windowWidth <= 0) { @@ -3415,168 +3327,153 @@ TkpComputeStandardMenuGeometry( static void DrawMenuEntryLabel( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ - Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ - GC gc, /* The gc we are drawing into */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated font metrics */ - int x, /* left edge */ - int y, /* right edge */ - int width, /* width of entry */ - int height) /* height of entry */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing */ + Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ + GC gc, /* The gc we are drawing into */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated font metrics */ + int x, /* left edge */ + int y, /* right edge */ + int width, /* width of entry */ + int height) /* height of entry */ { - int baseline; + int baseline, imageHeight, imageWidth; int indicatorSpace = mePtr->indicatorSpace; int leftEdge = x + indicatorSpace; - int imageHeight, imageWidth; - + /* * Draw label or bitmap or image for entry. */ baseline = y + (height + fmPtr->ascent - fmPtr->descent) / 2; if (mePtr->image != NULL) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(mePtr->image, &imageWidth, &imageHeight); - if ((mePtr->selectImage != NULL) - && (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SELECTED)) { - Tk_RedrawImage(mePtr->selectImage, 0, 0, - imageWidth, imageHeight, d, leftEdge, - (int) (y + (mePtr->height - imageHeight)/2)); - } else { - Tk_RedrawImage(mePtr->image, 0, 0, imageWidth, - imageHeight, d, leftEdge, - (int) (y + (mePtr->height - imageHeight)/2)); - } + Tk_SizeOfImage(mePtr->image, &imageWidth, &imageHeight); + if ((mePtr->selectImage != NULL) + && (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_SELECTED)) { + Tk_RedrawImage(mePtr->selectImage, 0, 0, imageWidth, imageHeight, + d, leftEdge, (int) (y + (mePtr->height - imageHeight)/2)); + } else { + Tk_RedrawImage(mePtr->image, 0, 0, imageWidth, imageHeight, + d, leftEdge, (int) (y + (mePtr->height - imageHeight)/2)); + } } else if (mePtr->bitmapPtr != NULL) { - int width, height; - Pixmap bitmap = Tk_GetBitmapFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->bitmapPtr); - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(menuPtr->display, - bitmap, &width, &height); - XCopyPlane(menuPtr->display, bitmap, d, gc, 0, 0, - (unsigned) width, (unsigned) height, leftEdge, - (int) (y + (mePtr->height - height)/2), 1); + int width, height; + Pixmap bitmap = Tk_GetBitmapFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->bitmapPtr); + + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(menuPtr->display, bitmap, &width, &height); + XCopyPlane(menuPtr->display, bitmap, d, gc, 0, 0, + (unsigned) width, (unsigned) height, leftEdge, + (int) (y + (mePtr->height - height)/2), 1); } else { - if (mePtr->labelLength > 0) { - Tcl_DString itemTextDString, convertedTextDString; - CGrafPtr saveWorld; - GDHandle saveDevice; - GWorldPtr destPort; + if (mePtr->labelLength > 0) { + Tcl_DString itemTextDString, convertedTextDString; + CGrafPtr saveWorld; + GDHandle saveDevice; + GWorldPtr destPort; #ifdef USE_ATSU - int xLocation; - int yLocation; - int runLengths; - CFStringRef stringRef; - ATSUTextLayout textLayout; - UniCharCount runLength; - ATSUStyle style; - int length; - int err; - Str255 fontName; - SInt16 fontSize; - Style fontStyle; - ATSUAttributeValuePtr valuePtr; - ByteCount valueSize; - Fixed fixedSize; - short iFONDNumber; - ATSUFontID fontID; - ATSUAttributeTag tag; - - GetThemeFont (kThemeMenuItemFont, smSystemScript, fontName, &fontSize, &fontStyle); - if ((err = ATSUCreateStyle(&style)) != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"ATSUCreateStyle failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - return; - } - fixedSize = fontSize<<16; - tag = kATSUSizeTag; - valueSize = sizeof(fixedSize); - valuePtr = &fixedSize; + int xLocation, yLocation, runLengths, length, err; + CFStringRef stringRef; + ATSUTextLayout textLayout; + UniCharCount runLength; + ATSUStyle style; + Str255 fontName; + SInt16 fontSize; + Style fontStyle; + ATSUAttributeValuePtr valuePtr; + ByteCount valueSize; + Fixed fixedSize; + short iFONDNumber; + ATSUFontID fontID; + ATSUAttributeTag tag; + + GetThemeFont(kThemeMenuItemFont, smSystemScript, fontName, + &fontSize, &fontStyle); + err = ATSUCreateStyle(&style); + LOG_ON_ERROR(ATSUCreateStyle); + if (err != noErr) { + return; + } + fixedSize = fontSize<<16; + tag = kATSUSizeTag; + valueSize = sizeof(fixedSize); + valuePtr = &fixedSize; err = ATSUSetAttributes(style, 1, &tag, &valueSize, &valuePtr); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"ATSUSetAttributes failed,%d\n", err ); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(ATSUSetAttributes); GetFNum(fontName, &iFONDNumber); - ATSUFONDtoFontID(iFONDNumber, NULL, &fontID); - tag = kATSUFontTag; - valueSize = sizeof(fontID); - valuePtr = &fontID; + ATSUFONDtoFontID(iFONDNumber, NULL, &fontID); + tag = kATSUFontTag; + valueSize = sizeof(fontID); + valuePtr = &fontID; err = ATSUSetAttributes(style, 1, &tag, &valueSize, &valuePtr); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"ATSUSetAttributes failed,%d\n", err ); + LOG_ON_ERROR(ATSUSetAttributes); #endif - } -#endif - - GetEntryText(mePtr, &itemTextDString); + GetEntryText(mePtr, &itemTextDString); #ifdef USE_ATSU - runLengths = 1; - length = Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString); - stringRef = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), - kCFStringEncodingUTF8); - if (!stringRef) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"CFStringCreateWithCString failed\n"); -#endif - } - err = ATSUCreateTextLayoutWithTextPtr(CFStringGetCharactersPtr(stringRef), - 0, length, length, - 1, &runLengths, &style, &textLayout) - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"ATSUCreateTextLayoutWithTextPtr failed, %d\n", err); -#endif - return; - } + runLengths = 1; + length = Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString); + stringRef = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, + Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + if (!stringRef) { + LOG_MSG("CFStringCreateWithCString failed"); + } + err = ATSUCreateTextLayoutWithTextPtr( + CFStringGetCharactersPtr(stringRef), 0, length, length, 1, + &runLengths, &style, &textLayout); + LOG_ON_ERROR(ATSUCreateTextLayoutWithTextPtr); + if (err != noErr) { + return; + } #endif - - /* Somehow DrawChars is changing the colors, it is odd, since - it works for the Apple Platinum Appearance, but not for - some Kaleidoscope Themes... Untill I can figure out what - exactly is going on, this will have to do: */ - destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); - GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); - SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); - TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); + /* + * Somehow DrawChars is changing the colors, it is odd, since it + * works for the Apple Platinum Appearance, but not for some + * Kaleidoscope Themes... Until I can figure out what exactly is + * going on, this will have to do: + */ + + destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(d); + GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); + SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); + TkMacOSXSetUpGraphicsPort(gc, destPort); MoveTo((short) leftEdge, (short) baseline); - Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding, Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString), &convertedTextDString); + Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(TkMacOSXCarbonEncoding, + Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), + Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString), + &convertedTextDString); #ifdef USE_ATSU - xLocation = leftEdge << 16; - yLocation = baseline << 16; - ATSUDrawText(textLayout,kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd, xLocation, yLocation); - ATSUDisposeTextLayout(textLayout); - CFRelease(stringRef); + xLocation = leftEdge << 16; + yLocation = baseline << 16; + ATSUDrawText(textLayout,kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd, + xLocation, yLocation); + ATSUDisposeTextLayout(textLayout); + CFRelease(stringRef); #else - DrawText(Tcl_DStringValue(&convertedTextDString), 0, - Tcl_DStringLength(&convertedTextDString)); + DrawText(Tcl_DStringValue(&convertedTextDString), 0, + Tcl_DStringLength(&convertedTextDString)); #endif - + /* Tk_DrawChars(menuPtr->display, d, gc, - tkfont, Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), + tkfont, Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString), leftEdge, baseline); */ - + Tcl_DStringFree(&convertedTextDString); Tcl_DStringFree(&itemTextDString); - } + } } if (mePtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { if (menuPtr->disabledFgPtr == NULL) { - } else if ((mePtr->image != NULL) + } else if ((mePtr->image != NULL) && (menuPtr->disabledImageGC != None)) { XFillRectangle(menuPtr->display, d, menuPtr->disabledImageGC, - leftEdge, - (int) (y + (mePtr->height - imageHeight)/2), + leftEdge, (int) (y + (mePtr->height - imageHeight)/2), (unsigned) imageWidth, (unsigned) imageHeight); } } @@ -3587,41 +3484,41 @@ DrawMenuEntryLabel( * * DrawMenuEntryBackground -- * - * This procedure draws the background part of a menu entry. - * Under Appearance, we only draw the background if the entry's - * border is set, we DO NOT inherit it from the menu... + * This procedure draws the background part of a menu entry. Under + * Appearance, we only draw the background if the entry's border is set, + * we DO NOT inherit it from the menu... * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menu in its current mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void DrawMenuEntryBackground( - TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing. */ - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing. */ - Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ - Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, /* Border for active items */ - Tk_3DBorder bgBorder, /* Border for the background */ - int x, /* left edge */ - int y, /* top edge */ - int width, /* width of rectangle to draw */ - int height) /* height of rectangle to draw */ + TkMenu *menuPtr, /* The menu we are drawing. */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are drawing. */ + Drawable d, /* What we are drawing into */ + Tk_3DBorder activeBorder, /* Border for active items */ + Tk_3DBorder bgBorder, /* Border for the background */ + int x, /* left edge */ + int y, /* top edge */ + int width, /* width of rectangle to draw */ + int height) /* height of rectangle to draw */ { if ((menuPtr->menuType == TEAROFF_MENU) - || ((mePtr->state == ENTRY_ACTIVE) - && (mePtr->activeBorderPtr != None)) - || ((mePtr->state != ENTRY_ACTIVE) && (mePtr->borderPtr != None))) { - if (mePtr->state == ENTRY_ACTIVE) { + || ((mePtr->state == ENTRY_ACTIVE) + && (mePtr->activeBorderPtr != None)) + || ((mePtr->state != ENTRY_ACTIVE) + && (mePtr->borderPtr != None))) { + if (mePtr->state == ENTRY_ACTIVE) { bgBorder = activeBorder; - } - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(menuPtr->tkwin, d, bgBorder, - x, y, width, height, 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); + } + Tk_Fill3DRectangle(menuPtr->tkwin, d, bgBorder, x, y, width, height, + 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); } } @@ -3644,35 +3541,34 @@ DrawMenuEntryBackground( static void GetMenuLabelGeometry( - TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are computing */ - Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ - CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr, /* The precalculated metrics */ - int *widthPtr, /* The resulting width of the label - * portion */ - int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height of the label - * portion */ + TkMenuEntry *mePtr, /* The entry we are computing */ + Tk_Font tkfont, /* The precalculated font */ + CONST Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr,/* The precalculated metrics */ + int *widthPtr, /* The resulting width of the label portion */ + int *heightPtr) /* The resulting height of the label + * portion. */ { TkMenu *menuPtr = mePtr->menuPtr; - + if (mePtr->image != NULL) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(mePtr->image, widthPtr, heightPtr); + Tk_SizeOfImage(mePtr->image, widthPtr, heightPtr); } else if (mePtr->bitmapPtr != NULL) { - Pixmap bitmap = Tk_GetBitmapFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->bitmapPtr); - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(menuPtr->display, bitmap, widthPtr, heightPtr); + Pixmap bitmap = Tk_GetBitmapFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->bitmapPtr); + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(menuPtr->display, bitmap, widthPtr, heightPtr); } else { - *heightPtr = fmPtr->linespace; - - if (mePtr->labelPtr != NULL) { - Tcl_DString itemTextDString; - - GetEntryText(mePtr, &itemTextDString); - *widthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, - Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString)); - Tcl_DStringFree(&itemTextDString); - } else { - *widthPtr = 0; - } + *heightPtr = fmPtr->linespace; + + if (mePtr->labelPtr != NULL) { + Tcl_DString itemTextDString; + + GetEntryText(mePtr, &itemTextDString); + *widthPtr = Tk_TextWidth(tkfont, + Tcl_DStringValue(&itemTextDString), + Tcl_DStringLength(&itemTextDString)); + Tcl_DStringFree(&itemTextDString); + } else { + *widthPtr = 0; + } } *heightPtr += 1; } @@ -3682,8 +3578,8 @@ GetMenuLabelGeometry( * * MenuSelectEvent -- * - * Generates a "MenuSelect" virtual event. This can be used to - * do context-sensitive menu help. + * Generates a "MenuSelect" virtual event. This can be used to do + * context-sensitive menu help. * * Results: * None. @@ -3699,7 +3595,7 @@ MenuSelectEvent( TkMenu *menuPtr) /* the menu we have selected. */ { XVirtualEvent event; - + bzero(&event, sizeof(XVirtualEvent)); event.type = VirtualEvent; event.serial = menuPtr->display->request; @@ -3710,9 +3606,9 @@ MenuSelectEvent( event.root = XRootWindow(menuPtr->display, 0); event.subwindow = None; event.time = TkpGetMS(); - - XQueryPointer(NULL, None, NULL, NULL, - &event.x_root, &event.y_root, NULL, NULL, &event.state); + + XQueryPointer(NULL, None, NULL, NULL, &event.x_root, &event.y_root, + NULL, NULL, &event.state); event.same_screen = true; event.name = Tk_GetUid("MenuSelect"); Tk_QueueWindowEvent((XEvent *) &event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); @@ -3740,17 +3636,17 @@ RecursivelyClearActiveMenu( { int i; TkMenuEntry *mePtr; - + TkActivateMenuEntry(menuPtr, -1); MenuSelectEvent(menuPtr); for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; - if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { - if ((mePtr->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) - && (mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { - RecursivelyClearActiveMenu(mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr); - } - } + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; + if (mePtr->type == CASCADE_ENTRY) { + if ((mePtr->childMenuRefPtr != NULL) + && (mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + RecursivelyClearActiveMenu(mePtr->childMenuRefPtr->menuPtr); + } + } } } @@ -3759,8 +3655,8 @@ RecursivelyClearActiveMenu( * * InvalidateMDEFRgns -- * - * Invalidates the regions covered by menus that did redrawing and - * might be damaged. + * Invalidates the regions covered by menus that did redrawing and might + * be damaged. * * Results: * None. @@ -3775,31 +3671,33 @@ void InvalidateMDEFRgns(void) { GDHandle saveDevice; - GWorldPtr saveWorld, destPort; - Point scratch; - MacDrawable *macDraw; + GWorldPtr saveWorld; TkMacOSXWindowList *listPtr; - + if (totalMenuRgn == NULL) { - return; + return; } - + GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); - for (listPtr = tkMacOSXWindowListPtr ; listPtr != NULL; - listPtr = listPtr->nextPtr) { - macDraw = (MacDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(listPtr->winPtr); - if (macDraw->flags & TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU) { - destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(listPtr->winPtr)); - SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); - scratch.h = scratch.v = 0; - GlobalToLocal(&scratch); - OffsetRgn(totalMenuRgn, scratch.v, scratch.h); - InvalWindowRgn(GetWindowFromPort(destPort),totalMenuRgn); - OffsetRgn(totalMenuRgn, -scratch.v, -scratch.h); - macDraw->flags &= ~TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU; - } + for (listPtr = tkMacOSXWindowListPtr ; listPtr != NULL; + listPtr = listPtr->nextPtr) { + MacDrawable *macDraw = (MacDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(listPtr->winPtr); + + if (macDraw->flags & TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU) { + GWorldPtr destPort = + TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(listPtr->winPtr)); + Point scratch; + + SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); + scratch.h = scratch.v = 0; + GlobalToLocal(&scratch); + OffsetRgn(totalMenuRgn, scratch.v, scratch.h); + InvalWindowRgn(GetWindowFromPort(destPort),totalMenuRgn); + OffsetRgn(totalMenuRgn, -scratch.v, -scratch.h); + macDraw->flags &= ~TK_DRAWN_UNDER_MENU; + } } - + SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); SetEmptyRgn(totalMenuRgn); } @@ -3824,20 +3722,20 @@ void TkMacOSXClearMenubarActive(void) { TkMenuReferences *menuBarRefPtr; - + if (currentMenuBarName != NULL) { - menuBarRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, - currentMenuBarName); - if ((menuBarRefPtr != NULL) && (menuBarRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { - TkMenu *menuPtr; - - for (menuPtr = menuBarRefPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr; menuPtr != NULL; - menuPtr = menuPtr->nextInstancePtr) { - if (menuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { - RecursivelyClearActiveMenu(menuPtr); - } - } - } + menuBarRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, + currentMenuBarName); + if ((menuBarRefPtr != NULL) && (menuBarRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + TkMenu *menuPtr; + + for (menuPtr=menuBarRefPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr; menuPtr!=NULL; + menuPtr = menuPtr->nextInstancePtr) { + if (menuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { + RecursivelyClearActiveMenu(menuPtr); + } + } + } } InvalidateMDEFRgns(); } @@ -3848,8 +3746,8 @@ TkMacOSXClearMenubarActive(void) * TkpMenuNotifyToplevelCreate -- * * This routine reconfigures the menu and the clones indicated by - * menuName becuase a toplevel has been created and any system - * menus need to be created. Only applicable to Windows. + * menuName becuase a toplevel has been created and any system menus need + * to be created. Only applicable to Windows. * * Results: * None. @@ -3862,9 +3760,8 @@ TkMacOSXClearMenubarActive(void) void TkpMenuNotifyToplevelCreate( - Tcl_Interp *interp, /* The interp the menu lives in. */ - char *menuName) /* The name of the menu to - * reconfigure. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* The interp the menu lives in. */ + char *menuName) /* The name of the menu to reconfigure. */ { /* * Nothing to do. @@ -3889,7 +3786,7 @@ TkpMenuNotifyToplevelCreate( void TkpMenuInit(void) -{ +{ lastMenuID = 256; Tcl_InitHashTable(&commandTable, TCL_ONE_WORD_KEYS); currentMenuBarOwner = NULL; @@ -3900,18 +3797,18 @@ TkpMenuInit(void) currentMenuBarName = NULL; windowListPtr = NULL; - tkThemeMenuItemDrawingUPP - = NewMenuItemDrawingUPP(ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc); - - /* - * We should just hardcode the utf-8 ellipsis character into - * 'elipsisString' here + tkThemeMenuItemDrawingUPP = + NewMenuItemDrawingUPP(ThemeMenuItemDrawingProc); + + /* + * We should just hardcode the utf-8 ellipsis character into + * 'elipsisString' here */ - Tcl_ExternalToUtf(NULL, Tcl_GetEncoding(NULL, "macRoman"), - "\311", /* ellipsis character */ - -1, 0, NULL, elipsisString, - TCL_UTF_MAX + 1, NULL, NULL, NULL); - + + Tcl_ExternalToUtf(NULL, Tcl_GetEncoding(NULL, "macRoman"), + "\311", /* ellipsis character */ + -1, 0, NULL, elipsisString, TCL_UTF_MAX + 1, NULL, NULL, NULL); + useMDEFVar = Tcl_NewStringObj("::tk::mac::useCustomMDEF", -1); } @@ -3920,8 +3817,7 @@ TkpMenuInit(void) * * TkpMenuThreadInit -- * - * Does platform-specific initialization of thread-specific - * menu state. + * Does platform-specific initialization of thread-specific menu state. * * Results: * None. @@ -3933,7 +3829,7 @@ TkpMenuInit(void) */ void -TkpMenuThreadInit() +TkpMenuThreadInit(void) { /* * Nothing to do. @@ -3945,28 +3841,28 @@ TkpMenuThreadInit() * * TkpPreprocessMacMenu -- * - * Handle preprocessing of menubar if it exists. + * Handle preprocessing of menubar if it exists. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * All post commands for the current menubar get executed. + * All post commands for the current menubar get executed. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkMacOSXPreprocessMenu() +TkMacOSXPreprocessMenu(void) { - TkMenuReferences *mbRefPtr; - int code; - if ((currentMenuBarName != NULL) && (currentMenuBarInterp != NULL)) { - mbRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp, - currentMenuBarName); - if ((mbRefPtr != NULL) && (mbRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { - Tcl_Preserve((ClientData)currentMenuBarInterp); + TkMenuReferences *mbRefPtr = + TkFindMenuReferences(currentMenuBarInterp,currentMenuBarName); + + if ((mbRefPtr != NULL) && (mbRefPtr->menuPtr != NULL)) { + int code; + + Tcl_Preserve((ClientData) currentMenuBarInterp); code = TkPreprocessMenu(mbRefPtr->menuPtr->masterMenuPtr); if ((code != TCL_OK) && (code != TCL_CONTINUE) && (code != TCL_BREAK)) { @@ -3974,8 +3870,8 @@ TkMacOSXPreprocessMenu() "\n (menu preprocess)"); Tcl_BackgroundError(currentMenuBarInterp); } - Tcl_Release((ClientData)currentMenuBarInterp); - } + Tcl_Release((ClientData) currentMenuBarInterp); + } } } @@ -3984,188 +3880,178 @@ TkMacOSXPreprocessMenu() * * MenuDefProc -- * - * This routine is the MDEF handler for Tk. It receives all messages - * for the menu and dispatches them. + * This routine is the MDEF handler for Tk. It receives all messages for + * the menu and dispatches them. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: * This routine causes menus to be drawn and will certainly allocate - * memory as a result. Also, the menu can scroll up and down, and - * various other interface actions can take place. + * memory as a result. Also, the menu can scroll up and down, and various + * other interface actions can take place. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void MenuDefProc( - SInt16 message, /* What action are we taking? */ - MenuRef menu, /* The menu we are working with */ - Rect *menuRectPtr, /* A pointer to the rect for the - * whole menu. */ - Point hitPt, /* Where the mouse was clicked for - * the appropriate messages. */ - SInt16 *whichItem) /* Output result. Which item was - * hit by the user? */ + SInt16 message, /* What action are we taking? */ + MenuRef menu, /* The menu we are working with */ + Rect *menuRectPtr, /* A pointer to the rect for the whole + * menu. */ + Point hitPt, /* Where the mouse was clicked for the + * appropriate messages. */ + SInt16 *whichItem) /* Output result. Which item was hit by the + * user? */ { TkMenu *menuPtr; Tcl_HashEntry *commandEntryPtr; int maxMenuHeight; MenuID menuID; BitMap screenBits; - + menuID = GetMenuID(menu); commandEntryPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&commandTable, (char *) ((int)menuID)); - + if (commandEntryPtr) { - menuPtr = (TkMenu *) Tcl_GetHashValue(commandEntryPtr); + menuPtr = (TkMenu *) Tcl_GetHashValue(commandEntryPtr); } else { - menuPtr = NULL; + menuPtr = NULL; } switch (message) { - case kMenuInitMsg: - *whichItem = noErr; - break; - case kMenuDisposeMsg: - break; - case kMenuHiliteItemMsg: { - HandleMenuHiliteMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); - break; - } - case kMenuCalcItemMsg: - HandleMenuCalcItemMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); - break; - case kMenuDrawItemsMsg: { - /* - * We do nothing here, because we don't support the Menu Managers - * dynamic item groups - */ - - break; - } - case kMenuThemeSavvyMsg: - *whichItem = kThemeSavvyMenuResponse; - break; - case kMenuSizeMsg: - GetQDGlobalsScreenBits(&screenBits); - maxMenuHeight = screenBits.bounds.bottom - - screenBits.bounds.top - - GetMBarHeight() - SCREEN_MARGIN; - SetMenuWidth(menu, menuPtr->totalWidth ); - SetMenuHeight(menu,maxMenuHeight < menuPtr->totalHeight ? maxMenuHeight : menuPtr->totalHeight ); - break; - case kMenuDrawMsg: - HandleMenuDrawMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); - break; - case kMenuFindItemMsg: - HandleMenuFindItemsMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); - break; - case kMenuPopUpMsg: - HandleMenuPopUpMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); - break; + case kMenuInitMsg: + *whichItem = noErr; + break; + case kMenuDisposeMsg: + break; + case kMenuHiliteItemMsg: + HandleMenuHiliteMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); + break; + case kMenuCalcItemMsg: + HandleMenuCalcItemMsg (menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); + break; + case kMenuDrawItemsMsg: + /* + * We do nothing here, because we don't support the Menu Managers + * dynamic item groups + */ + + break; + case kMenuThemeSavvyMsg: + *whichItem = kThemeSavvyMenuResponse; + break; + case kMenuSizeMsg: + GetQDGlobalsScreenBits(&screenBits); + maxMenuHeight = screenBits.bounds.bottom + - screenBits.bounds.top - GetMBarHeight() - SCREEN_MARGIN; + SetMenuWidth(menu, menuPtr->totalWidth); + SetMenuHeight(menu, maxMenuHeighttotalHeight + ? maxMenuHeight : menuPtr->totalHeight); + break; + case kMenuDrawMsg: + HandleMenuDrawMsg(menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); + break; + case kMenuFindItemMsg: + HandleMenuFindItemsMsg(menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); + break; + case kMenuPopUpMsg: + HandleMenuPopUpMsg(menu, menuRectPtr, hitPt, whichItem, menuPtr); + break; } } void -HandleMenuHiliteMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr) +HandleMenuHiliteMsg( + MenuRef menu, + Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, + SInt16 *whichItem, + TkMenu *menuPtr) { TkMenuEntry *mePtr = NULL; Tk_Font tkfont; Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics; - int oldItem; - int newItem = -1; - MDEFHiliteItemData * hidPtr = ( MDEFHiliteItemData *)whichItem; - MenuTrackingData mtd, *mtdPtr = &mtd; - int err; + int err, oldItem, newItem = -1; + MDEFHiliteItemData *hidPtr = (MDEFHiliteItemData *) whichItem; + MenuTrackingData mtd, *mtdPtr = &mtd; + oldItem = hidPtr->previousItem - 1; newItem = hidPtr->newItem - 1; - + err = GetMenuTrackingData(menu, mtdPtr); + LOG_ON_ERROR(GetMenuTrackingData); if (err !=noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"GetMenuTrackingData failed : %d\n", err ); -#endif return; } - + if (oldItem >= 0) { - Rect oldItemRect; - int width; - - mePtr = menuPtr->entries[oldItem]; - if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { - tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, - menuPtr->fontPtr); - } else { - tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, - mePtr->fontPtr); - } - Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &fontMetrics); - - width = (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) - ? menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width; - - /* - * In Aqua, have to call EraseMenuBackground when you overdraw - * a previously selected menu item, otherwise you will see the - * old select highlight under the transparency of the new menu item. - */ - - oldItemRect.left = menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x; - oldItemRect.right = oldItemRect.left +width; - oldItemRect.top = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y; - oldItemRect.bottom = oldItemRect.top + mePtr->height; - - EraseMenuBackground(menu, & oldItemRect, NULL); - - AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, &fontMetrics, tkfont, - oldItemRect.left, - oldItemRect.top, - width, - mePtr->height); + Rect oldItemRect; + int width; + + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[oldItem]; + if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { + tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); + } else { + tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); + } + Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &fontMetrics); + + width = (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) + ? menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width; + + /* + * In Aqua, have to call EraseMenuBackground when you overdraw a + * previously selected menu item, otherwise you will see the old + * select highlight under the transparency of the new menu item. + */ + + oldItemRect.left = menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x; + oldItemRect.right = oldItemRect.left +width; + oldItemRect.top = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y; + oldItemRect.bottom = oldItemRect.top + mePtr->height; + + EraseMenuBackground(menu, & oldItemRect, NULL); + + AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, &fontMetrics, tkfont, + oldItemRect.left, oldItemRect.top, width, mePtr->height); } - if (newItem != -1) { - mePtr = menuPtr->entries[newItem]; - if (mePtr->state != ENTRY_DISABLED) { - TkActivateMenuEntry(menuPtr, newItem); - } - if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { - tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); - } else { - tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); - } - Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &fontMetrics); - AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, &fontMetrics, tkfont, - menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y, - (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) ? - menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width, - mePtr->height); + if (newItem != -1) { + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[newItem]; + if (mePtr->state != ENTRY_DISABLED) { + TkActivateMenuEntry(menuPtr, newItem); + } + if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { + tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); + } else { + tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); + } + Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &fontMetrics); + AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, &fontMetrics, tkfont, + menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y, + (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) ? + menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width, + mePtr->height); } tkUseMenuCascadeRgn = 1; MenuSelectEvent(menuPtr); Tcl_ServiceAll(); tkUseMenuCascadeRgn = 0; if (newItem!=-1 && mePtr->state != ENTRY_DISABLED) { - TkActivateMenuEntry(menuPtr, -1); + TkActivateMenuEntry(menuPtr, -1); } - } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * HandleMenuDrawMsg -- + * HandleMenuDrawMsg -- * - * It handles the MenuDefProc's draw message. + * It handles the MenuDefProc's draw message. * * Results: * A menu entry is drawn @@ -4175,289 +4061,266 @@ HandleMenuHiliteMsg (MenuRef menu, * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void -HandleMenuDrawMsg(MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr) +HandleMenuDrawMsg( + MenuRef menu, + Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, + SInt16 *whichItem, + TkMenu *menuPtr) { Tk_Font tkfont, menuFont; - Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics, entryMetrics; - Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr; + Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics, entryMetrics, *fmPtr; TkMenuEntry *mePtr; int i; GDHandle device; TkMenu *searchMenuPtr; Rect menuClipRect; ThemeMenuType menuType; - MenuTrackingData * mtdPtr = (MenuTrackingData *)whichItem; + MenuTrackingData *mtdPtr = (MenuTrackingData *) whichItem; + /* - * Store away the menu rectangle so we can keep track of the - * different regions that the menu obscures. - */ - + * Store away the menu rectangle so we can keep track of the different + * regions that the menu obscures. + */ + ((MacMenu *) menuPtr->platformData)->menuRect = *menuRectPtr; if (tkMenuCascadeRgn == NULL) { - tkMenuCascadeRgn = NewRgn(); + tkMenuCascadeRgn = NewRgn(); } if (utilRgn == NULL) { - utilRgn = NewRgn(); + utilRgn = NewRgn(); } if (totalMenuRgn == NULL) { - totalMenuRgn = NewRgn(); + totalMenuRgn = NewRgn(); } SetEmptyRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn); for (searchMenuPtr = menuPtr; searchMenuPtr != NULL; ) { - RectRgn(utilRgn, - &((MacMenu *) searchMenuPtr->platformData)->menuRect); - InsetRgn(utilRgn, -1, -1); - UnionRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, utilRgn, tkMenuCascadeRgn); - OffsetRgn(utilRgn, 1, 1); - UnionRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, utilRgn, tkMenuCascadeRgn); - - if (searchMenuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr != NULL) { - searchMenuPtr = searchMenuPtr->menuRefPtr - ->parentEntryPtr->menuPtr; - } else { - break; - } - if (searchMenuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { - break; - } + RectRgn(utilRgn, + &((MacMenu *) searchMenuPtr->platformData)->menuRect); + InsetRgn(utilRgn, -1, -1); + UnionRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, utilRgn, tkMenuCascadeRgn); + OffsetRgn(utilRgn, 1, 1); + UnionRgn(tkMenuCascadeRgn, utilRgn, tkMenuCascadeRgn); + + if (searchMenuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr == NULL) { + break; + } + searchMenuPtr = searchMenuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr->menuPtr; + if (searchMenuPtr->menuType == MENUBAR) { + break; + } } UnionRgn(totalMenuRgn, tkMenuCascadeRgn, totalMenuRgn); SetEmptyRgn(utilRgn); - + /* - * Now draw the background if Appearance is present... - */ - + * Now draw the background if Appearance is present... + */ + GetGWorld(&macMDEFDrawable.grafPtr, &device); - + if (menuPtr->menuRefPtr->topLevelListPtr != NULL) { - menuType = kThemeMenuTypePullDown; + menuType = kThemeMenuTypePullDown; } else if (menuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr != NULL) { - menuType = kThemeMenuTypeHierarchical; + menuType = kThemeMenuTypeHierarchical; } else { - menuType = kThemeMenuTypePopUp; + menuType = kThemeMenuTypePopUp; } - + DrawMenuBackground(menuRectPtr, (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, menuType); - + /* - * Next, figure out scrolling information. - */ - + * Next, figure out scrolling information. + */ + menuClipRect = *menuRectPtr; - if ((menuClipRect.bottom - menuClipRect.top) - < menuPtr->totalHeight) { - if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop < menuRectPtr->top) { - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, UP_ARROW, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, - menuPtr->textGC, - menuRectPtr->left + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, - menuRectPtr->top); - menuClipRect.top += SICN_HEIGHT; - } - if ((mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + menuPtr->totalHeight) - > menuRectPtr->bottom) { - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, DOWN_ARROW, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, - menuPtr->textGC, - menuRectPtr->left + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, - menuRectPtr->bottom - SICN_HEIGHT); - menuClipRect.bottom -= SICN_HEIGHT; - } - GetClip(utilRgn); + if ((menuClipRect.bottom - menuClipRect.top) < menuPtr->totalHeight) { + if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop < menuRectPtr->top) { + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, UP_ARROW, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, menuPtr->textGC, + menuRectPtr->left + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, + menuRectPtr->top); + menuClipRect.top += SICN_HEIGHT; + } + if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop+menuPtr->totalHeight>menuRectPtr->bottom) { + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, DOWN_ARROW, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, menuPtr->textGC, + menuRectPtr->left + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, + menuRectPtr->bottom - SICN_HEIGHT); + menuClipRect.bottom -= SICN_HEIGHT; + } + GetClip(utilRgn); } - + /* - * Now, actually draw the menu. Don't draw entries that - * are higher than the top arrow, and don't draw entries - * that are lower than the bottom. - */ - + * Now, actually draw the menu. Don't draw entries that are higher than + * the top arrow, and don't draw entries that are lower than the bottom. + */ + menuFont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); - Tk_GetFontMetrics(menuFont, &fontMetrics); + Tk_GetFontMetrics(menuFont, &fontMetrics); for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; - if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y + mePtr->height - < menuClipRect.top) { - continue; - } else if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y - > menuClipRect.bottom) { - continue; - } - ClipRect(&menuClipRect); - if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { - fmPtr = &fontMetrics; - tkfont = menuFont; - } else { - tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); - Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &entryMetrics); - fmPtr = &entryMetrics; - } - AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, fmPtr, tkfont, - menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y, - (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) ? - menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width, - menuPtr->entries[i]->height); + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; + if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop+mePtr->y+mePtr->heightvirtualMenuTop + mePtr->y > menuClipRect.bottom) { + continue; + } + + ClipRect(&menuClipRect); + if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { + fmPtr = &fontMetrics; + tkfont = menuFont; + } else { + tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); + Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &entryMetrics); + fmPtr = &entryMetrics; + } + AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, fmPtr, tkfont, + menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y, + (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) ? + menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width, + menuPtr->entries[i]->height); } - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop - + menuPtr->totalHeight; + mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + menuPtr->totalHeight; if (!EmptyRgn(utilRgn)) { - SetClip(utilRgn); - SetEmptyRgn(utilRgn); + SetClip(utilRgn); + SetEmptyRgn(utilRgn); } MDEFScrollFlag = 1; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * HandleMenuFindItemsMsg -- + * HandleMenuFindItemsMsg -- * - * It handles the MenuDefProc's FindItems message. We have to - * respond by filling in the itemSelected, itemUnderMouse and - * itemRect fields. This is also the time to scroll the menu if - * it is too long to fit on the screen. + * It handles the MenuDefProc's FindItems message. We have to respond by + * filling in the itemSelected, itemUnderMouse and itemRect fields. This + * is also the time to scroll the menu if it is too long to fit on the + * screen. * * Results: - * The Menu system is informed of the selected item & the item - * under the mouse. + * The Menu system is informed of the selected item & the item under the + * mouse. * * Side effects: * The menu might get scrolled. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void -HandleMenuFindItemsMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr) +HandleMenuFindItemsMsg( + MenuRef menu, + Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, + SInt16 *whichItem, + TkMenu *menuPtr) { TkMenuEntry *parentEntryPtr; -#if 0 /* Unused */ +#if 0 /* Unused */ Tk_Font tkfont; - Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics, entryMetrics; - Tk_FontMetrics *fmPtr; + Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics, entryMetrics, *fmPtr; #endif TkMenuEntry *mePtr; - int i; - int newItem = -1; + int i, newItem = -1, hasTopScroll, hasBottomScroll, itemUnderMouse = -1; GDHandle device; - Rect itemRect; - short windowPart; + short windowPart, scrollAmt = 0; WindowRef whichWindow; - RGBColor bgColor; - RGBColor fgColor; - RGBColor origFgColor; + RGBColor bgColor, fgColor, origFgColor, origForeColor, origBackColor; PenState origPenState; - Rect dragRect; + Rect itemRect, dragRect, menuClipRect, updateRect; Rect scratchRect = {-32768, -32768, 32767, 32767}; RgnHandle oldClipRgn; TkMenuReferences *menuRefPtr; - Rect menuClipRect; - - int hasTopScroll, hasBottomScroll; - MenuTrackingData * mtdPtr = (MenuTrackingData *)whichItem; - int itemUnderMouse = -1; + MenuTrackingData *mtdPtr = (MenuTrackingData *) whichItem; enum { - DONT_SCROLL, DOWN_SCROLL, UP_SCROLL + DONT_SCROLL, DOWN_SCROLL, UP_SCROLL } scrollDirection; - Rect updateRect; - short scrollAmt = 0; - RGBColor origForeColor, origBackColor; - + /* - * Find out which item was hit. If it is the same as the old item, - * we don't need to do anything. + * Find out which item was hit. If it is the same as the old item, we + * don't need to do anything. */ if (PtInRect(hitPt, menuRectPtr)) { - for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; - itemRect.left = menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x; - itemRect.top = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y; - if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) { - itemRect.right = itemRect.left + menuPtr->totalWidth - - mePtr->x; - } else { - itemRect.right = itemRect.left + mePtr->width; - } - itemRect.bottom = itemRect.top - + mePtr->height; - if (PtInRect(hitPt, &itemRect)) { - if ((mePtr->type == SEPARATOR_ENTRY) - || (mePtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED)) { - newItem = -1; - itemUnderMouse = i; - } else { - TkMenuEntry *cascadeEntryPtr; - int parentDisabled = 0; - - for (cascadeEntryPtr - = menuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; - cascadeEntryPtr != NULL; - cascadeEntryPtr - = cascadeEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { - char *name; - - name = Tcl_GetStringFromObj( - cascadeEntryPtr->namePtr, NULL); - if (strcmp(name, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)) - == 0) { - if (cascadeEntryPtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { - parentDisabled = 1; - } - break; - } - } - - if (parentDisabled) { - newItem = -1; - itemUnderMouse = i; - } else { - newItem = i; - itemUnderMouse = i; - } - } - break; - } - } - } else { + for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; + itemRect.left = menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x; + itemRect.top = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y; + if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) { + itemRect.right = itemRect.left + menuPtr->totalWidth + - mePtr->x; + } else { + itemRect.right = itemRect.left + mePtr->width; + } + itemRect.bottom = itemRect.top + + mePtr->height; + if (PtInRect(hitPt, &itemRect)) { + if ((mePtr->type == SEPARATOR_ENTRY) + || (mePtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED)) { + newItem = -1; + itemUnderMouse = i; + } else { + TkMenuEntry *cascadeEntryPtr; + int parentDisabled = 0; + + for (cascadeEntryPtr=menuPtr->menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; + cascadeEntryPtr != NULL; + cascadeEntryPtr=cascadeEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { + char *name = Tcl_GetString(cascadeEntryPtr->namePtr); + + if (strcmp(name, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)) == 0) { + if (cascadeEntryPtr->state == ENTRY_DISABLED) { + parentDisabled = 1; + } + break; + } + } + + if (parentDisabled) { + newItem = -1; + itemUnderMouse = i; + } else { + newItem = i; + itemUnderMouse = i; + } + } + break; + } + } } /* * Now we need to take care of scrolling the menu. */ - + hasTopScroll = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop < menuRectPtr->top; hasBottomScroll = mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom > menuRectPtr->bottom; scrollDirection = DONT_SCROLL; if (hasTopScroll && (hitPt.v < menuRectPtr->top + SICN_HEIGHT)) { - newItem = -1; - scrollDirection = DOWN_SCROLL; - } else if (hasBottomScroll && (hitPt.v > (menuRectPtr->bottom - SICN_HEIGHT))) { - newItem = -1; - scrollDirection = UP_SCROLL; + newItem = -1; + scrollDirection = DOWN_SCROLL; + } else if (hasBottomScroll && (hitPt.v>menuRectPtr->bottom-SICN_HEIGHT)) { + newItem = -1; + scrollDirection = UP_SCROLL; } - + menuClipRect = *menuRectPtr; if (hasTopScroll) { - menuClipRect.top += SICN_HEIGHT; + menuClipRect.top += SICN_HEIGHT; } if (hasBottomScroll) { - menuClipRect.bottom -= SICN_HEIGHT; + menuClipRect.bottom -= SICN_HEIGHT; } if (MDEFScrollFlag) { - scrollDirection = DONT_SCROLL; - MDEFScrollFlag = 0; + scrollDirection = DONT_SCROLL; + MDEFScrollFlag = 0; } GetClip(utilRgn); ClipRect(&menuClipRect); @@ -4465,100 +4328,96 @@ HandleMenuFindItemsMsg (MenuRef menu, mtdPtr->itemSelected = newItem + 1; mtdPtr->itemUnderMouse = itemUnderMouse + 1; mtdPtr->itemRect = itemRect; - + GetGWorld(&macMDEFDrawable.grafPtr, &device); GetForeColor(&origForeColor); GetBackColor(&origBackColor); if (scrollDirection == UP_SCROLL) { - scrollAmt = menuClipRect.bottom - hitPt.v; - if (scrollAmt < menuRectPtr->bottom - - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom) { - scrollAmt = menuRectPtr->bottom - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom; - } - if (!hasTopScroll && ((mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + scrollAmt) - < menuRectPtr->top)) { - SetRect(&updateRect, menuRectPtr->left, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop, menuRectPtr->right, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + SICN_HEIGHT); - EraseRect(&updateRect); - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, UP_ARROW, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, - menuPtr->textGC, menuRectPtr->left - + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, - menuRectPtr->top); - menuClipRect.top += SICN_HEIGHT; - } + scrollAmt = menuClipRect.bottom - hitPt.v; + if (scrollAmt < menuRectPtr->bottom - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom) { + scrollAmt = menuRectPtr->bottom - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom; + } + if (!hasTopScroll && ((mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + scrollAmt) + < menuRectPtr->top)) { + SetRect(&updateRect, menuRectPtr->left, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop, menuRectPtr->right, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + SICN_HEIGHT); + EraseRect(&updateRect); + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, UP_ARROW, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, menuPtr->textGC, + menuRectPtr->left + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, + menuRectPtr->top); + menuClipRect.top += SICN_HEIGHT; + } } else if (scrollDirection == DOWN_SCROLL) { + scrollAmt = menuClipRect.top - hitPt.v; + if (scrollAmt > menuRectPtr->top - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop) { + scrollAmt = menuRectPtr->top - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop; + } - scrollAmt = menuClipRect.top - hitPt.v; - if (scrollAmt > menuRectPtr->top - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop) { - scrollAmt = menuRectPtr->top - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop; - } - - if (!hasBottomScroll && ((mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom + scrollAmt) - > menuRectPtr->bottom)) { - SetRect(&updateRect, menuRectPtr->left, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom - SICN_HEIGHT, - menuRectPtr->right, mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom); - EraseRect(&updateRect); - DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, DOWN_ARROW, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, - menuPtr->textGC, menuRectPtr->left - + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, - menuRectPtr->bottom - SICN_HEIGHT); - menuClipRect.bottom -= SICN_HEIGHT; - } + if (!hasBottomScroll && ((mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom + scrollAmt) + > menuRectPtr->bottom)) { + SetRect(&updateRect, menuRectPtr->left, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom - SICN_HEIGHT, + menuRectPtr->right, mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom); + EraseRect(&updateRect); + DrawSICN(SICN_RESOURCE_NUMBER, DOWN_ARROW, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, + menuPtr->textGC, menuRectPtr->left + + menuPtr->entries[1]->indicatorSpace, + menuRectPtr->bottom - SICN_HEIGHT); + menuClipRect.bottom -= SICN_HEIGHT; + } } - + if (scrollDirection != DONT_SCROLL) { #if 0 - Tk_Font menuFont; - RgnHandle updateRgn = NewRgn(); + Tk_Font menuFont; + RgnHandle updateRgn = NewRgn(); #endif - - ScrollMenuImage(menu, menuRectPtr, 0, scrollAmt, NULL); - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop += scrollAmt; - mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom += scrollAmt; + + ScrollMenuImage(menu, menuRectPtr, 0, scrollAmt, NULL); + mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop += scrollAmt; + mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom += scrollAmt; #if 0 - GetRegionBounds(updateRgn,&updateRect); - DisposeRgn(updateRgn); - if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop == menuRectPtr->top) { - updateRect.top -= SICN_HEIGHT; - } - if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom == menuRectPtr->bottom) { - updateRect.bottom += SICN_HEIGHT; - } - ClipRect(&updateRect); - EraseRect(&updateRect); - menuFont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); - Tk_GetFontMetrics(menuFont, &fontMetrics); - for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { - mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; - if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y + mePtr->height - < updateRect.top) { - continue; - } else if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y - > updateRect.bottom) { - continue; - } - if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { - fmPtr = &fontMetrics; - tkfont = menuFont; - } else { - tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, - mePtr->fontPtr); - Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &entryMetrics); - fmPtr = &entryMetrics; - } - AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, - (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, fmPtr, tkfont, - menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x, - mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y, - (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) ? - menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width, - menuPtr->entries[i]->height); - } + GetRegionBounds(updateRgn,&updateRect); + DisposeRgn(updateRgn); + if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop == menuRectPtr->top) { + updateRect.top -= SICN_HEIGHT; + } + if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuBottom == menuRectPtr->bottom) { + updateRect.bottom += SICN_HEIGHT; + } + ClipRect(&updateRect); + EraseRect(&updateRect); + menuFont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, menuPtr->fontPtr); + Tk_GetFontMetrics(menuFont, &fontMetrics); + for (i = 0; i < menuPtr->numEntries; i++) { + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[i]; + if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y + mePtr->height + < updateRect.top) { + continue; + } else if (mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop+mePtr->y > updateRect.bottom) { + continue; + } + + if (mePtr->fontPtr == NULL) { + fmPtr = &fontMetrics; + tkfont = menuFont; + } else { + tkfont = Tk_GetFontFromObj(menuPtr->tkwin, mePtr->fontPtr); + Tk_GetFontMetrics(tkfont, &entryMetrics); + fmPtr = &entryMetrics; + } + AppearanceEntryDrawWrapper(mePtr, menuRectPtr, mtdPtr, + (Drawable) &macMDEFDrawable, fmPtr, tkfont, + menuRectPtr->left + mePtr->x, + mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop + mePtr->y, + (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) ? + menuPtr->totalWidth - mePtr->x : mePtr->width, + menuPtr->entries[i]->height); + } #endif } @@ -4568,95 +4427,95 @@ HandleMenuFindItemsMsg (MenuRef menu, RGBBackColor(&origBackColor); /* - * If the menu is a tearoff, and the mouse is outside the menu, - * we need to draw the drag rectangle. - * - * In order for tearoffs to work properly, we need to set - * the active member of the containing menubar. - */ - + * If the menu is a tearoff, and the mouse is outside the menu, we need to + * draw the drag rectangle. + * + * In order for tearoffs to work properly, we need to set the active + * member of the containing menubar. + */ + menuRefPtr = TkFindMenuReferences(menuPtr->interp, - Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)); - + Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)); + if ((menuRefPtr != NULL) && (menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr != NULL)) { - char *name; - for (parentEntryPtr = menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; - parentEntryPtr != NULL - ; parentEntryPtr = parentEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { - name = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(parentEntryPtr->namePtr, - NULL); - if (strcmp(name, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)) != 0) { - break; - } - } - if (parentEntryPtr != NULL) { - TkActivateMenuEntry(parentEntryPtr->menuPtr, - parentEntryPtr->index); - } + for (parentEntryPtr = menuRefPtr->parentEntryPtr; + parentEntryPtr != NULL; + parentEntryPtr = parentEntryPtr->nextCascadePtr) { + char *name = Tcl_GetString(parentEntryPtr->namePtr); + + if (strcmp(name, Tk_PathName(menuPtr->tkwin)) != 0) { + break; + } + } + if (parentEntryPtr != NULL) { + TkActivateMenuEntry(parentEntryPtr->menuPtr, + parentEntryPtr->index); + } } - + if (menuPtr->tearoff) { - scratchRect = *menuRectPtr; - if (tearoffStruct.menuPtr == NULL) { - scratchRect.top -= 10; - scratchRect.bottom += 10; - scratchRect.left -= 10; - scratchRect.right += 10; - } - - windowPart = FindWindow(hitPt, &whichWindow); - if ((windowPart != inMenuBar) && (newItem == -1) - && (hitPt.v != 0) && (hitPt.h != 0) - && (!PtInRect(hitPt, &scratchRect)) - && (!PtInRect(hitPt, &tearoffStruct.excludeRect))) { - unsigned long dummy; - oldClipRgn = NewRgn(); - GetClip(oldClipRgn); - GetForeColor(&origFgColor); - GetPenState(&origPenState); - GetForeColor(&fgColor); - GetBackColor(&bgColor); - GetGray(device, &bgColor, &fgColor); - RGBForeColor(&fgColor); - SetRect(&scratchRect, -32768, -32768, 32767, 32767); - ClipRect(&scratchRect); - - dragRect = *menuRectPtr; - tearoffStruct.menuPtr = menuPtr; - - PenMode(srcXor); - dragRect = *menuRectPtr; - OffsetRect(&dragRect, -dragRect.left, -dragRect.top); - OffsetRect(&dragRect, tearoffStruct.point.h, - tearoffStruct.point.v); - if ((dragRect.top != 0) && (dragRect.left != 0)) { - FrameRect(&dragRect); - Delay(1, &dummy); - FrameRect(&dragRect); - } - tearoffStruct.point = hitPt; - - SetClip(oldClipRgn); - DisposeRgn(oldClipRgn); - RGBForeColor(&origFgColor); - SetPenState(&origPenState); - } else { - tearoffStruct.menuPtr = NULL; - tearoffStruct.point.h = tearoffStruct.point.v = 0; - } + scratchRect = *menuRectPtr; + if (tearoffStruct.menuPtr == NULL) { + scratchRect.top -= 10; + scratchRect.bottom += 10; + scratchRect.left -= 10; + scratchRect.right += 10; + } + + windowPart = FindWindow(hitPt, &whichWindow); + if ((windowPart != inMenuBar) && (newItem == -1) + && (hitPt.v != 0) && (hitPt.h != 0) + && (!PtInRect(hitPt, &scratchRect)) + && (!PtInRect(hitPt, &tearoffStruct.excludeRect))) { + unsigned long dummy; + + oldClipRgn = NewRgn(); + GetClip(oldClipRgn); + GetForeColor(&origFgColor); + GetPenState(&origPenState); + GetForeColor(&fgColor); + GetBackColor(&bgColor); + GetGray(device, &bgColor, &fgColor); + RGBForeColor(&fgColor); + SetRect(&scratchRect, -32768, -32768, 32767, 32767); + ClipRect(&scratchRect); + + dragRect = *menuRectPtr; + tearoffStruct.menuPtr = menuPtr; + + PenMode(srcXor); + dragRect = *menuRectPtr; + OffsetRect(&dragRect, -dragRect.left, -dragRect.top); + OffsetRect(&dragRect, tearoffStruct.point.h, + tearoffStruct.point.v); + if ((dragRect.top != 0) && (dragRect.left != 0)) { + FrameRect(&dragRect); + Delay(1, &dummy); + FrameRect(&dragRect); + } + tearoffStruct.point = hitPt; + + SetClip(oldClipRgn); + DisposeRgn(oldClipRgn); + RGBForeColor(&origFgColor); + SetPenState(&origPenState); + } else { + tearoffStruct.menuPtr = NULL; + tearoffStruct.point.h = tearoffStruct.point.v = 0; + } } else { - tearoffStruct.menuPtr = NULL; - tearoffStruct.point.h = tearoffStruct.point.v = 0; - } + tearoffStruct.menuPtr = NULL; + tearoffStruct.point.h = tearoffStruct.point.v = 0; + } } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * HandleMenuPopUpMsg -- + * HandleMenuPopUpMsg -- * - * It handles the MenuDefProc's PopUp message. The menu is - * posted with the selected item at the point given in hitPt. + * It handles the MenuDefProc's PopUp message. The menu is posted with + * the selected item at the point given in hitPt. * * Results: * A menu is posted. @@ -4666,118 +4525,127 @@ HandleMenuFindItemsMsg (MenuRef menu, * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void -HandleMenuPopUpMsg (MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr) +HandleMenuPopUpMsg( + MenuRef menu, + Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, + SInt16 *whichItem, + TkMenu *menuPtr) { - int maxMenuHeight; - int oldItem; + int maxMenuHeight, oldItem; Rect portRect; BitMap screenBits; /* - * Note that for some oddball reason, h and v are reversed in the - * point given to us by the MDEF. - */ + * Note that for some oddball reason, h and v are reversed in the point + * given to us by the MDEF. + */ + GetQDGlobalsScreenBits(&screenBits); oldItem = *whichItem; if (oldItem >= menuPtr->numEntries) { - oldItem = -1; + oldItem = -1; } portRect.top = 0; portRect.bottom = 1280; maxMenuHeight = screenBits.bounds.bottom - - screenBits.bounds.top - - GetMBarHeight() - SCREEN_MARGIN; + - screenBits.bounds.top - GetMBarHeight() - SCREEN_MARGIN; if (menuPtr->totalHeight > maxMenuHeight) { - menuRectPtr->top = GetMBarHeight(); + menuRectPtr->top = GetMBarHeight(); } else { - int delta; - menuRectPtr->top = hitPt.h; - if (oldItem >= 0) { - menuRectPtr->top -= menuPtr->entries[oldItem]->y; - } - - if (menuRectPtr->top < GetMBarHeight()) { - /* Displace downward if the menu would stick off the - * top of the screen. - */ - - menuRectPtr->top = GetMBarHeight() + SCREEN_MARGIN; - } else { - /* - * Or upward if the menu sticks off the - * bottom end... - */ - - delta = menuRectPtr->top + menuPtr->totalHeight - - maxMenuHeight; - if (delta > 0) { - menuRectPtr->top -= delta; - } - } + int delta; + + menuRectPtr->top = hitPt.h; + if (oldItem >= 0) { + menuRectPtr->top -= menuPtr->entries[oldItem]->y; + } + + if (menuRectPtr->top < GetMBarHeight()) { + /* + * Displace downward if the menu would stick off the top of the + * screen. + */ + + menuRectPtr->top = GetMBarHeight() + SCREEN_MARGIN; + } else { + /* + * Or upward if the menu sticks off the bottom end... + */ + + delta = menuRectPtr->top + menuPtr->totalHeight - maxMenuHeight; + if (delta > 0) { + menuRectPtr->top -= delta; + } + } } menuRectPtr->left = hitPt.v; menuRectPtr->right = menuRectPtr->left + menuPtr->totalWidth; - menuRectPtr->bottom = menuRectPtr->top + - ((maxMenuHeight < menuPtr->totalHeight) - ? maxMenuHeight : menuPtr->totalHeight); + menuRectPtr->bottom = menuRectPtr->top + + ((maxMenuHeight < menuPtr->totalHeight) + ? maxMenuHeight : menuPtr->totalHeight); if (menuRectPtr->top == GetMBarHeight()) { - *whichItem = hitPt.h; + *whichItem = hitPt.h; } else { - *whichItem = menuRectPtr->top; + *whichItem = menuRectPtr->top; } } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * HandleMenuCalcItemMsg -- + * HandleMenuCalcItemMsg -- * - * It handles the MenuDefProc's CalcItem message. It is supposed - * to calculate the Rect of the menu entry in whichItem in the - * menu, and put that in menuRectPtr. I assume this works, but I - * have never seen the MenuManager send this message. + * It handles the MenuDefProc's CalcItem message. It is supposed to + * calculate the Rect of the menu entry in whichItem in the menu, and put + * that in menuRectPtr. I assume this works, but I have never seen the + * MenuManager send this message. * * Results: - * The Menu Manager is informed of the bounding rect of a - * menu rect. + * The Menu Manager is informed of the bounding rect of a menu rect. * * Side effects: * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void -HandleMenuCalcItemMsg(MenuRef menu, - Rect *menuRectPtr, - Point hitPt, - SInt16 *whichItem, - TkMenu *menuPtr) +HandleMenuCalcItemMsg( + MenuRef menu, + Rect *menuRectPtr, + Point hitPt, + SInt16 *whichItem, + TkMenu *menuPtr) { TkMenuEntry *mePtr; - MenuTrackingData mtd, *mtdPtr = &mtd; + MenuTrackingData mtd, *mtdPtr = &mtd; int err, virtualTop; - + err = GetMenuTrackingData(menu, mtdPtr); if (err == noErr) { - virtualTop = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop; + virtualTop = mtdPtr->virtualMenuTop; } else { - virtualTop = 0; + virtualTop = 0; } - + mePtr = menuPtr->entries[*whichItem]; menuRectPtr->left = mePtr->x; menuRectPtr->top = mePtr->y - virtualTop; if (mePtr->entryFlags & ENTRY_LAST_COLUMN) { - menuRectPtr->right = menuPtr->totalWidth; + menuRectPtr->right = menuPtr->totalWidth; } else { - menuRectPtr->right = mePtr->x + mePtr->width; + menuRectPtr->right = mePtr->x + mePtr->width; } - menuRectPtr->bottom = menuRectPtr->top - + mePtr->height; + menuRectPtr->bottom = menuRectPtr->top + mePtr->height; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXMenubutton.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXMenubutton.c index 50f2ed5..65c894f 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXMenubutton.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXMenubutton.c @@ -1,16 +1,16 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXMenubutton.c -- * - * This file implements the Macintosh specific portion of the - * menubutton widget. + * This file implements the Macintosh specific portion of the menubutton + * widget. * * Copyright (c) 1996 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXMenubutton.c,v 1.11 2006/07/20 06:25:19 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXMenubutton.c,v 1.12 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -24,28 +24,30 @@ #define kMenuAttrDoNotUseUserCommandKeys (1 << 7) #endif -#define kShadowOffset (3) /* amount to offset shadow from frame */ -#define kTriangleWidth (11) /* width of the triangle */ -#define kTriangleHeight (6) /* height of the triangle */ -#define kTriangleMargin (5) /* margin around triangle */ +#define kShadowOffset (3) /* amount to offset shadow from frame */ +#define kTriangleWidth (11) /* width of the triangle */ +#define kTriangleHeight (6) /* height of the triangle */ +#define kTriangleMargin (5) /* margin around triangle */ -#define TK_POPUP_OFFSET 32 /* size of popup marker */ +#define TK_POPUP_OFFSET 32 /* size of popup marker */ -MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp, TkMenu *menuInstPtr, int cascade, short *menuIDPtr)); -MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXFreeMenuID _ANSI_ARGS_((short menuID)); +MODULE_SCOPE int TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(Tcl_Interp *interp, + TkMenu *menuInstPtr, int cascade, + short *menuIDPtr); +MODULE_SCOPE void TkMacOSXFreeMenuID(short menuID); typedef struct { SInt16 initialValue; SInt16 minValue; SInt16 maxValue; SInt16 procID; - int isBevel; + int isBevel; } MenuButtonControlParams; typedef struct { - int len; - Str255 title; - ControlFontStyleRec style; + int len; + Str255 title; + ControlFontStyleRec style; } ControlTitleParams; /* @@ -53,50 +55,49 @@ typedef struct { */ typedef struct MacMenuButton { - TkMenuButton info; /* Generic button info. */ - WindowRef windowRef; - ControlRef userPane; - ControlRef control; - MenuRef menuRef; - RGBColor userPaneBackground; - MenuButtonControlParams params; - ControlTitleParams titleParams; + TkMenuButton info; /* Generic button info. */ + WindowRef windowRef; + ControlRef userPane; + ControlRef control; + MenuRef menuRef; + RGBColor userPaneBackground; + MenuButtonControlParams params; + ControlTitleParams titleParams; ControlButtonContentInfo bevelButtonContent; - OpenCPicParams picParams; - int flags; + OpenCPicParams picParams; + int flags; } MacMenuButton; /* * Forward declarations for procedures defined later in this file: */ -static OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc(ControlRef control, - ControlUserPaneDrawProcPtr upp); -static OSErr SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc(ControlRef control, - ControlUserPaneBackgroundProcPtr upp); -static void UserPaneDraw(ControlRef control, ControlPartCode cpc); -static void UserPaneBackgroundProc(ControlHandle, - ControlBackgroundPtr info); -static int MenuButtonInitControl ( MacMenuButton *mbPtr, Rect *paneRect, Rect *cntrRect ); - -static int UpdateControlColors _ANSI_ARGS_((MacMenuButton *mbPtr )); -static void ComputeMenuButtonControlParams _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenuButton * mbPtr, MenuButtonControlParams * paramsPtr)); -static void ComputeControlTitleParams _ANSI_ARGS_((TkMenuButton * mbPtr, ControlTitleParams * paramsPtr)); -static void CompareControlTitleParams( - ControlTitleParams * p1Ptr, - ControlTitleParams * p2Ptr, - int * titleChanged, - int * styleChanged -); +static OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc(ControlRef control, + ControlUserPaneDrawProcPtr upp); +static OSErr SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc( + ControlRef control, + ControlUserPaneBackgroundProcPtr upp); +static void UserPaneDraw(ControlRef control, ControlPartCode cpc); +static void UserPaneBackgroundProc(ControlHandle, + ControlBackgroundPtr info); +static int MenuButtonInitControl(MacMenuButton *mbPtr, + Rect *paneRect, Rect *cntrRect); +static int UpdateControlColors(MacMenuButton *mbPtr); +static void ComputeMenuButtonControlParams(TkMenuButton *mbPtr, + MenuButtonControlParams *paramsPtr); +static void ComputeControlTitleParams(TkMenuButton *mbPtr, ControlTitleParams *paramsPtr); +static void CompareControlTitleParams(ControlTitleParams *p1Ptr, + ControlTitleParams *p2Ptr, int *titleChanged, + int *styleChanged); /* - * The structure below defines menubutton class behavior by means of - * procedures that can be invoked from generic window code. + * The structure below defines menubutton class behavior by means of functions + * that can be invoked from generic window code. */ Tk_ClassProcs tkpMenubuttonClass = { - sizeof(Tk_ClassProcs), /* size */ - TkMenuButtonWorldChanged, /* worldChangedProc */ + sizeof(Tk_ClassProcs), /* size */ + TkMenuButtonWorldChanged, /* worldChangedProc */ }; /* @@ -104,13 +105,13 @@ Tk_ClassProcs tkpMenubuttonClass = { * * TkpCreateMenuButton -- * - * Allocate a new TkMenuButton structure. + * Allocate a new TkMenuButton structure. * * Results: - * Returns a newly allocated TkMenuButton structure. + * Returns a newly allocated TkMenuButton structure. * * Side effects: - * Registers an event handler for the widget. + * Registers an event handler for the widget. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -120,6 +121,7 @@ TkpCreateMenuButton( Tk_Window tkwin) { MacMenuButton *mbPtr = (MacMenuButton *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacMenuButton)); + mbPtr->userPaneBackground.red = 0; mbPtr->userPaneBackground.green = 0; mbPtr->userPaneBackground.blue = ~0; @@ -146,42 +148,39 @@ TkpCreateMenuButton( * * TkpDisplayMenuButton -- * - * This procedure is invoked to display a menubutton widget. + * This procedure is invoked to display a menubutton widget. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Commands are output to X to display the menubutton in its - * current mode. + * Commands are output to X to display the menubutton in its current + * mode. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpDisplayMenuButton( - ClientData clientData) /* Information about widget. */ + ClientData clientData) /* Information about widget. */ { TkMenuButton *butPtr = (TkMenuButton *) clientData; Tk_Window tkwin = butPtr->tkwin; - TkWindow * winPtr; - Pixmap pixmap; - MacMenuButton * mbPtr = (MacMenuButton *) butPtr; + TkWindow *winPtr; + Pixmap pixmap; + MacMenuButton *mbPtr = (MacMenuButton *) butPtr; GWorldPtr dstPort; CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; - int hasImageOrBitmap = 0; - int width, height; - int err; + int hasImageOrBitmap = 0, width, height, err; ControlButtonGraphicAlignment theAlignment; - Rect paneRect, cntrRect; butPtr->flags &= ~REDRAW_PENDING; if ((butPtr->tkwin == NULL) || !Tk_IsMapped(tkwin)) { - return; + return; } - pixmap = ( Pixmap )Tk_WindowId(tkwin); + pixmap = (Pixmap) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); dstPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); SetGWorld(dstPort, NULL); @@ -192,170 +191,167 @@ TkpDisplayMenuButton( paneRect.top = winPtr->privatePtr->yOff; paneRect.right = paneRect.left+Tk_Width(butPtr->tkwin)-1; paneRect.bottom = paneRect.top+Tk_Height(butPtr->tkwin)-1; - + cntrRect = paneRect; - + cntrRect.left += butPtr->inset; cntrRect.top += butPtr->inset; cntrRect.right -= butPtr->inset; cntrRect.bottom -= butPtr->inset; if (mbPtr->userPane) { - MenuButtonControlParams params; - bzero(¶ms, sizeof(params)); - ComputeMenuButtonControlParams(butPtr, ¶ms ); - if (bcmp(¶ms,&mbPtr->params,sizeof(params))) { - if (mbPtr->userPane) { - DisposeControl(mbPtr->userPane); - mbPtr->userPane = NULL; - mbPtr->control = NULL; - } - } - } - if (!mbPtr->userPane) { - if (MenuButtonInitControl(mbPtr,&paneRect,&cntrRect ) ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Init Control failed\n" ); -#endif - return; - } - } + MenuButtonControlParams params; + bzero(¶ms, sizeof(params)); + ComputeMenuButtonControlParams(butPtr, ¶ms ); + if (bcmp(¶ms,&mbPtr->params,sizeof(params))) { + if (mbPtr->userPane) { + DisposeControl(mbPtr->userPane); + mbPtr->userPane = NULL; + mbPtr->control = NULL; + } + } + } + if (!mbPtr->userPane) { + if (MenuButtonInitControl(mbPtr,&paneRect,&cntrRect)) { + ERR_MSG("Init Control failed"); + return; + } + } SetControlBounds(mbPtr->userPane,&paneRect); - SetControlBounds(mbPtr->control,&cntrRect); + SetControlBounds(mbPtr->control,&cntrRect); /* * We need to cache the title and its style */ - if (!(mbPtr->flags&2)) { - ControlTitleParams titleParams; - int titleChanged; - int styleChanged; - ComputeControlTitleParams(butPtr,&titleParams); - CompareControlTitleParams(&titleParams,&mbPtr->titleParams, - &titleChanged,&styleChanged); - if (titleChanged) { - CFStringRef cf; - cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, - (char*) titleParams.title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); - if (hasImageOrBitmap) { - SetControlTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->control, cf); - } else { - SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(mbPtr->menuRef, 1, cf); - } - CFRelease(cf); - bcopy(titleParams.title,mbPtr->titleParams.title,titleParams.len+1); - mbPtr->titleParams.len = titleParams.len; - } - if ((titleChanged||styleChanged) && titleParams .len) { - if (hasImageOrBitmap) { - err = SetControlFontStyle(mbPtr->control,&titleParams.style); - if (err !=noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetControlFontStyle failed %d\n", err); -#endif - return; - } - } - bcopy(&titleParams.style,&mbPtr->titleParams.style,sizeof(titleParams.style)); - } + + if (!(mbPtr->flags & 2)) { + ControlTitleParams titleParams; + int titleChanged; + int styleChanged; + + ComputeControlTitleParams(butPtr,&titleParams); + CompareControlTitleParams(&titleParams,&mbPtr->titleParams, + &titleChanged,&styleChanged); + if (titleChanged) { + CFStringRef cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, + (char*) titleParams.title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + + if (hasImageOrBitmap) { + SetControlTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->control, cf); + } else { + SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(mbPtr->menuRef, 1, cf); + } + CFRelease(cf); + bcopy(titleParams.title, mbPtr->titleParams.title, + titleParams.len + 1); + mbPtr->titleParams.len = titleParams.len; + } + if ((titleChanged||styleChanged) && titleParams .len) { + if (hasImageOrBitmap) { + err = SetControlFontStyle(mbPtr->control,&titleParams.style); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlFontStyle); + if (err != noErr) { + return; + } + } + bcopy(&titleParams.style, &mbPtr->titleParams.style, + sizeof(titleParams.style)); + } } if (butPtr->image != None) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); - hasImageOrBitmap = 1; + Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &width, &height); + hasImageOrBitmap = 1; } else if (butPtr->bitmap != None) { - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); - hasImageOrBitmap = 1; + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); + hasImageOrBitmap = 1; } if (hasImageOrBitmap) { - mbPtr->picParams.srcRect.right = width; - mbPtr->picParams.srcRect.bottom = height; - /* Set the flag to circumvent clipping and bounds problems with OS 10.0.4 */ - tkPictureIsOpen = 1; - if (!(mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture = OpenCPicture(&mbPtr->picParams)) ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"OpenCPicture failed\n"); -#endif - } - /* - * TO DO - There is one case where XCopyPlane calls CopyDeepMask, - * which does not get recorded in the picture. So the bitmap code - * will fail in that case. - */ - if (butPtr->image != NULL) { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, - height, pixmap, 0, 0); - } else { - XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, NULL, 0, 0, - (unsigned int) width, (unsigned int) height, 0, 0, 1); - } - ClosePicture(); - - tkPictureIsOpen = 0; + mbPtr->picParams.srcRect.right = width; + mbPtr->picParams.srcRect.bottom = height; + + /* + * Set the flag to circumvent clipping and bounds problems with OS + * 10.0.4 + */ + + tkPictureIsOpen = 1; + mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture = OpenCPicture(&mbPtr->picParams); + if (!mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture) { + ERR_MSG("OpenCPicture failed"); + } + + /* + * TO DO - There is one case where XCopyPlane calls CopyDeepMask, + * which does not get recorded in the picture. So the bitmap code will + * fail in that case. + */ + + if (butPtr->image != NULL) { + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, 0, 0); + } else { + XCopyPlane(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, pixmap, NULL, 0, 0, + (unsigned int) width, (unsigned int) height, 0, 0, 1); + } + ClosePicture(); + + tkPictureIsOpen = 0; err = SetControlData(mbPtr->control, kControlButtonPart, - kControlBevelButtonContentTag, - sizeof(ControlButtonContentInfo), - (char *) &mbPtr->bevelButtonContent); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetControlData BevelButtonContent failed, %d\n", err ); -#endif - } - switch (butPtr->anchor) { - case TK_ANCHOR_N: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTop; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_NE: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopRight; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_E: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignRight; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SE: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomRight; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_S: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottom; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SW: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomLeft; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_W: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignLeft; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_NW: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopLeft; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_CENTER: - theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignCenter; - break; - } - + kControlBevelButtonContentTag, + sizeof(ControlButtonContentInfo), + (char *) &mbPtr->bevelButtonContent); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlData_BevelButtonContent); + switch (butPtr->anchor) { + case TK_ANCHOR_N: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTop; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_NE: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopRight; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_E: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignRight; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_SE: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomRight; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_S: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottom; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_SW: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignBottomLeft; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_W: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignLeft; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_NW: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignTopLeft; + break; + case TK_ANCHOR_CENTER: + theAlignment = kControlBevelButtonAlignCenter; + break; + } + err = SetControlData(mbPtr->control, kControlButtonPart, - kControlBevelButtonGraphicAlignTag, - sizeof(ControlButtonGraphicAlignment), + kControlBevelButtonGraphicAlignTag, + sizeof(ControlButtonGraphicAlignment), (char *) &theAlignment); - if (err != noErr ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetControlData BevelButtonGraphicAlign failed, %d\n", err ); -#endif - } + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlData_BevelButtonGraphicAlign); } if (butPtr->flags & GOT_FOCUS) { - HiliteControl(mbPtr->control,kControlButtonPart); + HiliteControl(mbPtr->control,kControlButtonPart); } else { - HiliteControl(mbPtr->control,kControlNoPart); + HiliteControl(mbPtr->control,kControlNoPart); } UpdateControlColors(mbPtr); if (mbPtr->flags&2) { - ShowControl(mbPtr->control); - ShowControl(mbPtr->userPane); - mbPtr->flags ^= 2; + ShowControl(mbPtr->control); + ShowControl(mbPtr->userPane); + mbPtr->flags ^= 2; } else { - Draw1Control(mbPtr->userPane); - SetControlVisibility(mbPtr->control, true, true); + Draw1Control(mbPtr->userPane); + SetControlVisibility(mbPtr->control, true, true); } if (hasImageOrBitmap) { - KillPicture(mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture); + KillPicture(mbPtr->bevelButtonContent.u.picture); } SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); } @@ -365,13 +361,13 @@ TkpDisplayMenuButton( * * TkpDestroyMenuButton -- * - * Free data structures associated with the menubutton control. + * Free data structures associated with the menubutton control. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Restores the default control state. + * Restores the default control state. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -380,17 +376,18 @@ void TkpDestroyMenuButton( TkMenuButton *mbPtr) { - MacMenuButton * macMbPtr = (MacMenuButton *)mbPtr; + MacMenuButton *macMbPtr = (MacMenuButton *) mbPtr; + if (macMbPtr->userPane) { - DisposeControl(macMbPtr->userPane); - macMbPtr->userPane = NULL; + DisposeControl(macMbPtr->userPane); + macMbPtr->userPane = NULL; } if (macMbPtr->menuRef) { - short menuID; - menuID = GetMenuID(macMbPtr->menuRef); - TkMacOSXFreeMenuID(menuID); - DisposeMenu(macMbPtr->menuRef); - macMbPtr->menuRef = NULL; + short menuID = GetMenuID(macMbPtr->menuRef); + + TkMacOSXFreeMenuID(menuID); + DisposeMenu(macMbPtr->menuRef); + macMbPtr->menuRef = NULL; } } @@ -399,82 +396,82 @@ TkpDestroyMenuButton( * * TkpComputeMenuButtonGeometry -- * - * After changes in a menu button's text or bitmap, this procedure - * recomputes the menu button's geometry and passes this information - * along to the geometry manager for the window. + * After changes in a menu button's text or bitmap, this procedure + * recomputes the menu button's geometry and passes this information + * along to the geometry manager for the window. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The menu button's window may change size. + * The menu button's window may change size. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkpComputeMenuButtonGeometry(mbPtr) - register TkMenuButton *mbPtr; /* Widget record for menu button. */ + register TkMenuButton *mbPtr; /* Widget record for menu button. */ { int width, height, mm, pixels; int hasImageOrBitmap = 0; mbPtr->inset = mbPtr->highlightWidth + mbPtr->borderWidth; if (mbPtr->image != None) { - Tk_SizeOfImage(mbPtr->image, &width, &height); - if (mbPtr->width > 0) { - width = mbPtr->width; - } - if (mbPtr->height > 0) { - height = mbPtr->height; - } - hasImageOrBitmap = 1; + Tk_SizeOfImage(mbPtr->image, &width, &height); + if (mbPtr->width > 0) { + width = mbPtr->width; + } + if (mbPtr->height > 0) { + height = mbPtr->height; + } + hasImageOrBitmap = 1; } else if (mbPtr->bitmap != None) { - Tk_SizeOfBitmap(mbPtr->display, mbPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); - if (mbPtr->width > 0) { - width = mbPtr->width; - } - if (mbPtr->height > 0) { - height = mbPtr->height; - } - hasImageOrBitmap = 1; + Tk_SizeOfBitmap(mbPtr->display, mbPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); + if (mbPtr->width > 0) { + width = mbPtr->width; + } + if (mbPtr->height > 0) { + height = mbPtr->height; + } + hasImageOrBitmap = 1; } else { - hasImageOrBitmap = 0; - Tk_FreeTextLayout(mbPtr->textLayout); - mbPtr->textLayout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(mbPtr->tkfont, mbPtr->text, - -1, mbPtr->wrapLength, mbPtr->justify, 0, &mbPtr->textWidth, - &mbPtr->textHeight); - width = mbPtr->textWidth; - height = mbPtr->textHeight; - if (mbPtr->width > 0) { - width = mbPtr->width * Tk_TextWidth(mbPtr->tkfont, "0", 1); - } - if (mbPtr->height > 0) { - Tk_FontMetrics fm; - - Tk_GetFontMetrics(mbPtr->tkfont, &fm); - height = mbPtr->height * fm.linespace; - } - width += 2*mbPtr->padX; - height += 2*mbPtr->padY; + hasImageOrBitmap = 0; + Tk_FreeTextLayout(mbPtr->textLayout); + mbPtr->textLayout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(mbPtr->tkfont, mbPtr->text, + -1, mbPtr->wrapLength, mbPtr->justify, 0, &mbPtr->textWidth, + &mbPtr->textHeight); + width = mbPtr->textWidth; + height = mbPtr->textHeight; + if (mbPtr->width > 0) { + width = mbPtr->width * Tk_TextWidth(mbPtr->tkfont, "0", 1); + } + if (mbPtr->height > 0) { + Tk_FontMetrics fm; + + Tk_GetFontMetrics(mbPtr->tkfont, &fm); + height = mbPtr->height * fm.linespace; + } + width += 2*mbPtr->padX; + height += 2*mbPtr->padY; } if (mbPtr->indicatorOn) { - mm = WidthMMOfScreen(Tk_Screen(mbPtr->tkwin)); - pixels = WidthOfScreen(Tk_Screen(mbPtr->tkwin)); - mbPtr->indicatorHeight = kTriangleHeight; - mbPtr->indicatorWidth = kTriangleWidth + kTriangleMargin; - width += mbPtr->indicatorWidth; + mm = WidthMMOfScreen(Tk_Screen(mbPtr->tkwin)); + pixels = WidthOfScreen(Tk_Screen(mbPtr->tkwin)); + mbPtr->indicatorHeight = kTriangleHeight; + mbPtr->indicatorWidth = kTriangleWidth + kTriangleMargin; + width += mbPtr->indicatorWidth; } else { - mbPtr->indicatorHeight = 0; - mbPtr->indicatorWidth = 0; + mbPtr->indicatorHeight = 0; + mbPtr->indicatorWidth = 0; } if (!hasImageOrBitmap) { - width += TK_POPUP_OFFSET; + width += TK_POPUP_OFFSET; } Tk_GeometryRequest(mbPtr->tkwin, (int) (width + 2*mbPtr->inset), - (int) (height + 2*mbPtr->inset)); + (int) (height + 2*mbPtr->inset)); Tk_SetInternalBorder(mbPtr->tkwin, mbPtr->inset); } @@ -483,55 +480,56 @@ TkpComputeMenuButtonGeometry(mbPtr) * * ComputeMenuButtonControlParams -- * - * This procedure computes the various parameters used - * when creating a Carbon control (NewControl) - * These are determined by the various tk menu button parameters + * This procedure computes the various parameters used when creating a + * Carbon control (NewControl). These are determined by the various tk + * menu button parameters * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * Sets the control initialisation parameters + * Sets the control initialisation parameters * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -ComputeMenuButtonControlParams(TkMenuButton * mbPtr, - MenuButtonControlParams * paramsPtr ) +ComputeMenuButtonControlParams( + TkMenuButton *mbPtr, + MenuButtonControlParams *paramsPtr) { int fakeMenuID = 256; - /* + /* * Determine ProcID based on button type and dimensions * - * We need to set minValue to some non-zero value, - * Otherwise, the markers do not show up + * We need to set minValue to some non-zero value. Otherwise, the markers + * do not show up */ paramsPtr->minValue = kControlBehaviorMultiValueMenu; paramsPtr->maxValue = 0; if (mbPtr->image || mbPtr->bitmap) { - paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; - if (mbPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; - } else if (mbPtr->borderWidth == 3) { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; - } else { - paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; - } - if (mbPtr->indicatorOn) { - paramsPtr->initialValue = fakeMenuID; - } else { - paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; - } + paramsPtr->isBevel = 1; + if (mbPtr->borderWidth <= 2) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonSmallBevelProc; + } else if (mbPtr->borderWidth == 3) { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonNormalBevelProc; + } else { + paramsPtr->procID = kControlBevelButtonLargeBevelProc; + } + if (mbPtr->indicatorOn) { + paramsPtr->initialValue = fakeMenuID; + } else { + paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; + } } else { - paramsPtr->isBevel = 0; - paramsPtr->procID = kControlPopupButtonProc - + kControlPopupVariableWidthVariant; - paramsPtr->minValue = -12345; - paramsPtr->maxValue = -1; - paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; + paramsPtr->isBevel = 0; + paramsPtr->procID = kControlPopupButtonProc + + kControlPopupVariableWidthVariant; + paramsPtr->minValue = -12345; + paramsPtr->maxValue = -1; + paramsPtr->initialValue = 0; } } @@ -541,199 +539,184 @@ ComputeMenuButtonControlParams(TkMenuButton * mbPtr, * returns 0 if same, 1 otherwise *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static void -CompareControlTitleParams( - ControlTitleParams * p1Ptr, - ControlTitleParams * p2Ptr, - int * titleChanged, - int * styleChanged -) +CompareControlTitleParams( + ControlTitleParams *p1Ptr, + ControlTitleParams *p2Ptr, + int *titleChanged, + int *styleChanged) { if (p1Ptr->len != p2Ptr->len) { - *titleChanged = 1; + *titleChanged = 1; + } else if (bcmp(p1Ptr->title,p2Ptr->title,p1Ptr->len)) { + *titleChanged = 1; } else { - if (bcmp(p1Ptr->title,p2Ptr->title,p1Ptr->len)) { - *titleChanged = 1; - } else { - *titleChanged = 0; - } + *titleChanged = 0; } + if (p1Ptr->len && p2Ptr->len) { - *styleChanged = bcmp(&p1Ptr->style, &p2Ptr->style, sizeof(p2Ptr->style)); + *styleChanged = bcmp(&p1Ptr->style, &p2Ptr->style, + sizeof(p2Ptr->style)); } else { - *styleChanged = p1Ptr->len||p2Ptr->len; + *styleChanged = p1Ptr->len||p2Ptr->len; } } - + static void -ComputeControlTitleParams(TkMenuButton * butPtr, ControlTitleParams * paramsPtr ) +ComputeControlTitleParams( + TkMenuButton *butPtr, + ControlTitleParams *paramsPtr) { Tk_Font font; - paramsPtr->len =TkFontGetFirstTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout,&font, (char*) paramsPtr->title); - paramsPtr->title [paramsPtr->len] = 0; + + paramsPtr->len = TkFontGetFirstTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout, &font, + (char*) paramsPtr->title); + paramsPtr->title[paramsPtr->len] = 0; if (paramsPtr->len) { - TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle(font,¶msPtr->style); + TkMacOSXInitControlFontStyle(font,¶msPtr->style); } } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * MenuButtonInitControl -- * - * This procedure initialises a Carbon control + * This procedure initialises a Carbon control * * Results: - * 0 on success, 1 on failure. + * 0 on success, 1 on failure. * * Side effects: - * A background pane control and the control itself is created - * The contol is embedded in the background control - * The background control is embedded in the root control - * of the containing window - * The creation parameters for the control are also computed + * A background pane control and the control itself is created. The + * contol is embedded in the background control. The background control + * is embedded in the root control of the containing window. The creation + * parameters for the control are also computed * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + int -MenuButtonInitControl ( - MacMenuButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ - Rect *paneRect, - Rect *cntrRect -) +MenuButtonInitControl( + MacMenuButton *mbPtr, /* Mac button. */ + Rect *paneRect, + Rect *cntrRect) { - OSStatus err; - TkMenuButton * butPtr = ( TkMenuButton * )mbPtr; - ControlRef rootControl; - SInt16 procID; - Boolean initiallyVisible; - SInt16 initialValue; - SInt16 minValue; - SInt16 maxValue; - SInt32 controlReference; - short menuID; - - rootControl = TkMacOSXGetRootControl(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin)); - mbPtr->windowRef = GetWindowFromPort(TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin))); - /* + OSStatus err; + TkMenuButton *butPtr = (TkMenuButton *) mbPtr; + SInt16 procID, initialValue, minValue, maxValue; + Boolean initiallyVisible; + SInt32 controlReference; + short menuID; + ControlRef rootControl = + TkMacOSXGetRootControl(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin)); + + mbPtr->windowRef = GetWindowFromPort( + TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(butPtr->tkwin))); + + /* * Set up the user pane */ + initiallyVisible = false; - initialValue = kControlSupportsEmbedding| - kControlHasSpecialBackground; + initialValue = kControlSupportsEmbedding|kControlHasSpecialBackground; minValue = 0; maxValue = 1; procID = kControlUserPaneProc; controlReference = (SInt32)mbPtr; - mbPtr->userPane = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, - paneRect, "\p", - initiallyVisible, - initialValue, - minValue, - maxValue, - procID, - controlReference ); + mbPtr->userPane = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, paneRect, "\p", + initiallyVisible, initialValue, minValue, maxValue, procID, + controlReference); if (!mbPtr->userPane) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Failed to create user pane control\n"); -#endif - return 1; + ERR_MSG("Failed to create user pane control"); + return 1; } err = EmbedControl(mbPtr->userPane,rootControl); + LOG_ON_ERROR(EmbedControl); if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Failed to embed user pane control %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - return 1; + return 1; } SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc(mbPtr->userPane, - UserPaneBackgroundProc); + UserPaneBackgroundProc); SetUserPaneDrawProc(mbPtr->userPane,UserPaneDraw); initiallyVisible = false; ComputeMenuButtonControlParams(butPtr,&mbPtr->params); - /* Do this only if we are using bevel buttons */ + + /* + * Do this only if we are using bevel buttons. + */ + ComputeControlTitleParams(butPtr,&mbPtr->titleParams); mbPtr->control = NewControl(mbPtr->windowRef, - cntrRect, "\p", //mbPtr->titleParams.title, - initiallyVisible, - mbPtr->params.initialValue, - mbPtr->params.minValue, - mbPtr->params.maxValue, - mbPtr->params.procID, - controlReference ); + cntrRect, "\p", /*mbPtr->titleParams.title,*/ + initiallyVisible, mbPtr->params.initialValue, + mbPtr->params.minValue, mbPtr->params.maxValue, + mbPtr->params.procID, controlReference); + if (!mbPtr->control) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"failed to create control of type %d : line %d\n",mbPtr->params.procID, __LINE__); -#endif - return 1; + ERR_MSG("failed to create control of type %d : line %d", + mbPtr->params.procID, __LINE__); + return 1; } - err = EmbedControl(mbPtr->control,mbPtr->userPane); - if (err != noErr ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"failed to embed control of type %d,%d\n",procID, (int) err); -#endif - return 1; + err = EmbedControl(mbPtr->control, mbPtr->userPane); + if (err != noErr) { + ERR_MSG("failed to embed control of type %d,%d\n", procID, (int) err); + return 1; } if (mbPtr->params.isBevel) { - CFStringRef cf; - cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, - (char*) mbPtr->titleParams.title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); - SetControlTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->control, cf); - CFRelease(cf); - if (mbPtr->titleParams.len) { - err = SetControlFontStyle(mbPtr->control,&mbPtr->titleParams.style); - if (err !=noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetControlFontStyle failed %d\n", (int) err); -#endif - return 1; - } - } + CFStringRef cf = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, + (char*) mbPtr->titleParams.title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + + SetControlTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->control, cf); + CFRelease(cf); + if (mbPtr->titleParams.len) { + err = SetControlFontStyle(mbPtr->control, + &mbPtr->titleParams.style); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetControlFontStyle); + if (err != noErr) { + return 1; + } + } } else { - CFStringRef cfStr; - err = TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(mbPtr->info.interp, (TkMenu *)mbPtr, 0, &menuID); - if (err != TCL_OK) { - return 1; - } - err = CreateNewMenu(menuID, kMenuAttrDoNotUseUserCommandKeys, - &(mbPtr->menuRef)); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"CreateNewMenu failed, %d.\n", (int) err); -#endif - return 1; - } - cfStr = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, Tk_PathName(mbPtr->info.tkwin), - kCFStringEncodingUTF8); - if (!cfStr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"CFStringCreateWithCString failed.\n"); -#endif - return 1; - } - err = SetMenuTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->menuRef, cfStr); - CFRelease(cfStr); - if (err != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetMenuTitleWithCFString failed, %d.\n", (int) err); -#endif - return 1; - } - cfStr = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, - (char*) mbPtr->titleParams.title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); - AppendMenuItemText(mbPtr->menuRef, "\px"); - if (cfStr) { - SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(mbPtr->menuRef, 1, cfStr); - CFRelease(cfStr); - } - err = SetControlData(mbPtr->control, - kControlNoPart, - kControlPopupButtonMenuRefTag, - sizeof(mbPtr->menuRef), &mbPtr->menuRef); - SetControlMinimum(mbPtr->control, 1); - SetControlMaximum(mbPtr->control, 1); - SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 1); + CFStringRef cfStr; + + err = TkMacOSXGetNewMenuID(mbPtr->info.interp, (TkMenu *) mbPtr, 0, + &menuID); + if (err != TCL_OK) { + return 1; + } + err = CreateNewMenu(menuID, kMenuAttrDoNotUseUserCommandKeys, + &(mbPtr->menuRef)); + LOG_ON_ERROR(CreateNewMenu); + if (err != noErr) { + return 1; + } + cfStr = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, Tk_PathName(mbPtr->info.tkwin), + kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + if (!cfStr) { + ERR_MSG("CFStringCreateWithCString failed"); + return 1; + } + err = SetMenuTitleWithCFString(mbPtr->menuRef, cfStr); + LOG_ON_ERROR(SetMenuTitleWithCFString); + CFRelease(cfStr); + if (err != noErr) { + return 1; + } + cfStr = CFStringCreateWithCString(NULL, + (char*) mbPtr->titleParams.title, kCFStringEncodingUTF8); + AppendMenuItemText(mbPtr->menuRef, "\px"); + if (cfStr) { + SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(mbPtr->menuRef, 1, cfStr); + CFRelease(cfStr); + } + err = SetControlData(mbPtr->control, kControlNoPart, + kControlPopupButtonMenuRefTag, + sizeof(mbPtr->menuRef), &mbPtr->menuRef); + SetControlMinimum(mbPtr->control, 1); + SetControlMaximum(mbPtr->control, 1); + SetControlValue(mbPtr->control, 1); } mbPtr->flags |= 2; return 0; @@ -744,15 +727,14 @@ MenuButtonInitControl ( * * SetUserPane * - * Utility function to add a UserPaneDrawProc - * to a userPane control. From MoreControls code - * from Apple DTS. + * Utility function to add a UserPaneDrawProc to a userPane control. From + * MoreControls code from Apple DTS. * * Results: - * MacOS system error. + * MacOS system error. * * Side effects: - * The user pane gets a new UserPaneDrawProc. + * The user pane gets a new UserPaneDrawProc. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -760,12 +742,11 @@ OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc ( ControlRef control, ControlUserPaneDrawProcPtr upp) { - ControlUserPaneDrawUPP myControlUserPaneDrawUPP; - myControlUserPaneDrawUPP = NewControlUserPaneDrawUPP(upp); - return SetControlData (control, - kControlNoPart, kControlUserPaneDrawProcTag, - sizeof(myControlUserPaneDrawUPP), - (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneDrawUPP); + ControlUserPaneDrawUPP myControlUserPaneDrawUPP = + NewControlUserPaneDrawUPP(upp); + + return SetControlData(control, kControlNoPart,kControlUserPaneDrawProcTag, + sizeof(myControlUserPaneDrawUPP), (Ptr)&myControlUserPaneDrawUPP); } /* @@ -773,28 +754,29 @@ OSErr SetUserPaneDrawProc ( * * SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc -- * - * Utility function to add a UserPaneBackgroundProc - * to a userPane control + * Utility function to add a UserPaneBackgroundProc to a userPane control * * Results: - * MacOS system error. + * MacOS system error. * * Side effects: - * The user pane gets a new UserPaneBackgroundProc. + * The user pane gets a new UserPaneBackgroundProc. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ + OSErr SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc( - ControlRef control, + ControlRef control, ControlUserPaneBackgroundProcPtr upp) { - ControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP; - myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP = NewControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP(upp); - return SetControlData (control, kControlNoPart, - kControlUserPaneBackgroundProcTag, - sizeof(myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP), - (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP); + ControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP = + NewControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP(upp); + + return SetControlData(control, kControlNoPart, + kControlUserPaneBackgroundProcTag, + sizeof(myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP), + (Ptr) &myControlUserPaneBackgroundUPP); } /* @@ -802,28 +784,29 @@ SetUserPaneSetUpSpecialBackgroundProc( * * UserPaneDraw -- * - * This function draws the background of the user pane that will - * lie under checkboxes and radiobuttons. + * This function draws the background of the user pane that will lie + * under checkboxes and radiobuttons. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The user pane gets updated to the current color. + * The user pane gets updated to the current color. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ + void UserPaneDraw( ControlRef control, ControlPartCode cpc) { Rect contrlRect; - MacMenuButton * mbPtr; - mbPtr = ( MacMenuButton *)GetControlReference(control); + MacMenuButton *mbPtr = (MacMenuButton *) GetControlReference(control); + GetControlBounds(control,&contrlRect); - RGBBackColor (&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); - EraseRect (&contrlRect); + RGBBackColor(&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); + EraseRect(&contrlRect); } /* @@ -831,14 +814,14 @@ UserPaneDraw( * * UserPaneBackgroundProc -- * - * This function sets up the background of the user pane that will - * lie under checkboxes and radiobuttons. + * This function sets up the background of the user pane that will lie + * under checkboxes and radiobuttons. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * The user pane background gets set to the current color. + * The user pane background gets set to the current color. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -848,54 +831,62 @@ UserPaneBackgroundProc( ControlHandle control, ControlBackgroundPtr info) { - MacMenuButton * mbPtr; - mbPtr = (MacMenuButton *)GetControlReference(control); + MacMenuButton *mbPtr = (MacMenuButton *) GetControlReference(control); + if (info->colorDevice) { - RGBBackColor (&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); + RGBBackColor(&mbPtr->userPaneBackground); } } - -/* + +/* *-------------------------------------------------------------- - * + * * UpdateControlColors -- - * - * This function will review the colors used to display - * a Macintosh button. If any non-standard colors are - * used we create a custom palette for the button, populate - * with the colors for the button and install the palette. - * - * Under Appearance, we just set the pointer that will be - * used by the UserPaneDrawProc. - * + * + * This function will review the colors used to display a Macintosh + * button. If any non-standard colors are used we create a custom palette + * for the button, populate with the colors for the button and install + * the palette. + * + * Under Appearance, we just set the pointer that will be used by the + * UserPaneDrawProc. + * * Results: - * None. - * + * None. + * * Side effects: - * The Macintosh control may get a custom palette installed. + * The Macintosh control may get a custom palette installed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static int -UpdateControlColors(MacMenuButton * mbPtr) +UpdateControlColors( + MacMenuButton *mbPtr) { XColor *xcolor; TkMenuButton * butPtr = ( TkMenuButton * )mbPtr; - + /* - * Under Appearance we cannot change the background of the - * button itself. However, the color we are setting is the color - * of the containing userPane. This will be the color that peeks - * around the rounded corners of the button. - * We make this the highlightbackground rather than the background, - * because if you color the background of a frame containing a - * button, you usually also color the highlightbackground as well, - * or you will get a thin grey ring around the button. + * Under Appearance we cannot change the background of the button itself. + * However, the color we are setting is the color of the containing + * userPane. This will be the color that peeks around the rounded corners + * of the button. We make this the highlightbackground rather than the + * background, because if you color the background of a frame containing a + * button, you usually also color the highlightbackground as well, or you + * will get a thin grey ring around the button. */ xcolor = Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->normalBorder); TkSetMacColor(xcolor->pixel, &mbPtr->userPaneBackground); - + return false; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c index 0fc3473..b43e51d 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ * software in accordance with the terms specified in this * license. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c,v 1.25 2006/09/10 17:06:32 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXMouseEvent.c,v 1.26 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -234,11 +234,8 @@ TkMacOSXProcessMouseEvent(TkMacOSXEvent *eventPtr, MacEventStatus * statusPtr) status = GetEventParameter(eventPtr->eventRef, kEventParamMouseWheelDelta, typeLongInteger, NULL, sizeof(long), NULL, &medPtr->delta); - if (status != noErr ) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr, - "Failed to retrieve mouse wheel delta, %d\n", (int) status); -#endif + if (status != noErr) { + ERR_MSG("Failed to retrieve mouse wheel delta, %d", (int) status); statusPtr->err = 1; return false; } else { @@ -533,21 +530,22 @@ GeneratePollingEvents(MouseEventData * medPtr) */ static void -BringWindowForward(WindowRef wRef, Boolean isFrontProcess) +BringWindowForward( + WindowRef wRef, + Boolean isFrontProcess) { if (!isFrontProcess) { ProcessSerialNumber ourPsn = {0, kCurrentProcess}; OSStatus status = SetFrontProcess(&ourPsn); if (status != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"SetFrontProcess failed, %d\n", (int) status); -#endif + ERR_MSG("SetFrontProcess failed, %d", (int) status); } } - + if (!TkpIsWindowFloating(wRef)) { - if (IsValidWindowPtr(wRef)) + if (IsValidWindowPtr(wRef)) { SelectWindow(wRef); + } } } diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXScale.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXScale.c index 8c5e694..d90791d 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXScale.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXScale.c @@ -1,16 +1,16 @@ -/* +/* * tkMacOSXScale.c -- * - * This file implements the Macintosh specific portion of the - * scale widget. + * This file implements the Macintosh specific portion of the scale + * widget. * * Copyright (c) 1996 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-2000 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXScale.c,v 1.8 2006/04/28 06:02:49 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXScale.c,v 1.9 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -19,6 +19,7 @@ /* * Defines used in this file. */ + #define slider 1110 #define inSlider 1 #define inInc 2 @@ -43,10 +44,10 @@ static ControlActionUPP scaleActionProc = NULL; /* Pointer to func. */ * Forward declarations for procedures defined later in this file: */ -static void MacScaleEventProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData, - XEvent *eventPtr)); -static pascal void ScaleActionProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ControlRef theControl, - ControlPartCode partCode)); +static void MacScaleEventProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static pascal void ScaleActionProc(ControlRef theControl, + ControlPartCode partCode); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -65,20 +66,19 @@ static pascal void ScaleActionProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ControlRef theControl, */ TkScale * -TkpCreateScale(tkwin) - Tk_Window tkwin; +TkpCreateScale( + Tk_Window tkwin) { - MacScale *macScalePtr; - - macScalePtr = (MacScale *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacScale)); + MacScale *macScalePtr = (MacScale *) ckalloc(sizeof(MacScale)); + macScalePtr->scaleHandle = NULL; if (scaleActionProc == NULL) { scaleActionProc = NewControlActionUPP(ScaleActionProc); } - + Tk_CreateEventHandler(tkwin, ButtonPressMask, MacScaleEventProc, (ClientData) macScalePtr); - + return (TkScale *) macScalePtr; } @@ -99,14 +99,15 @@ TkpCreateScale(tkwin) */ void -TkpDestroyScale(scalePtr) - TkScale *scalePtr; +TkpDestroyScale( + TkScale *scalePtr) { MacScale *macScalePtr = (MacScale *) scalePtr; - + /* * Free Macintosh control. */ + if (macScalePtr->scaleHandle != NULL) { DisposeControl(macScalePtr->scaleHandle); } @@ -117,8 +118,8 @@ TkpDestroyScale(scalePtr) * * TkpDisplayScale -- * - * This procedure is invoked as an idle handler to redisplay - * the contents of a scale widget. + * This procedure is invoked as an idle handler to redisplay the contents + * of a scale widget. * * Results: * None. @@ -130,8 +131,8 @@ TkpDestroyScale(scalePtr) */ void -TkpDisplayScale(clientData) - ClientData clientData; /* Widget record for scale. */ +TkpDisplayScale( + ClientData clientData) /* Widget record for scale. */ { TkScale *scalePtr = (TkScale *) clientData; Tk_Window tkwin = scalePtr->tkwin; @@ -141,19 +142,13 @@ TkpDisplayScale(clientData) MacScale *macScalePtr = (MacScale *) clientData; Rect r; WindowRef windowRef; - CGrafPtr destPort; - CGrafPtr saveWorld; + CGrafPtr destPort, saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; MacDrawable *macDraw; - SInt32 initialValue; - SInt32 minValue; - SInt32 maxValue; - UInt16 numTicks; - - -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"TkpDisplayScale\n"); -#endif + SInt32 initialValue, minValue, maxValue; + UInt16 numTicks; + + ERR_MSG("TkpDisplayScale"); scalePtr->flags &= ~REDRAW_PENDING; if ((scalePtr->tkwin == NULL) || !Tk_IsMapped(scalePtr->tkwin)) { goto done; @@ -167,8 +162,7 @@ TkpDisplayScale(clientData) if ((scalePtr->flags & INVOKE_COMMAND) && (scalePtr->command != NULL)) { Tcl_Preserve((ClientData) interp); sprintf(string, scalePtr->format, scalePtr->value); - result = Tcl_VarEval(interp, scalePtr->command, " ", string, - (char *) NULL); + result = Tcl_VarEval(interp, scalePtr->command, " ", string, NULL); if (result != TCL_OK) { Tcl_AddErrorInfo(interp, "\n (command executed by scale)"); Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); @@ -183,15 +177,13 @@ TkpDisplayScale(clientData) Tcl_Release((ClientData) scalePtr); /* - * Now handle the part of redisplay that is the same for - * horizontal and vertical scales: border and traversal - * highlight. + * Now handle the part of redisplay that is the same for horizontal and + * vertical scales: border and traversal highlight. */ if (scalePtr->highlightWidth != 0) { - GC gc; - - gc = Tk_GCForColor(scalePtr->highlightColorPtr, Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); + GC gc = Tk_GCForColor(scalePtr->highlightColorPtr,Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); + Tk_DrawFocusHighlight(tkwin, gc, scalePtr->highlightWidth, Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); } @@ -204,6 +196,7 @@ TkpDisplayScale(clientData) /* * Set up port for drawing Macintosh control. */ + macDraw = (MacDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); windowRef = GetWindowFromPort(destPort); @@ -218,79 +211,76 @@ TkpDisplayScale(clientData) #define MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH 10 if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_HORIZONTAL) { - int offset; - offset = (Tk_Height(tkwin) - MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH)/2; - if (offset < 0) { - offset = 0; - } - - r.left = macDraw->xOff + scalePtr->inset; - r.top = macDraw->yOff + offset; - r.right = macDraw->xOff+Tk_Width(tkwin) - scalePtr->inset; - r.bottom = macDraw->yOff + offset + MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH/2; + int offset = (Tk_Height(tkwin) - MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH)/2; + + if (offset < 0) { + offset = 0; + } + + r.left = macDraw->xOff + scalePtr->inset; + r.top = macDraw->yOff + offset; + r.right = macDraw->xOff+Tk_Width(tkwin) - scalePtr->inset; + r.bottom = macDraw->yOff + offset + MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH/2; } else { - int offset; - - offset = (Tk_Width(tkwin) - MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH)/2; - if (offset < 0) { - offset = 0; - } - - r.left = macDraw->xOff + offset; - r.top = macDraw->yOff + scalePtr->inset; - r.right = macDraw->xOff + offset + MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH/2; - r.bottom = macDraw->yOff+Tk_Height(tkwin) - scalePtr->inset; + int offset = (Tk_Width(tkwin) - MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH)/2; + + if (offset < 0) { + offset = 0; + } + + r.left = macDraw->xOff + offset; + r.top = macDraw->yOff + scalePtr->inset; + r.right = macDraw->xOff + offset + MAC_OSX_SCROLL_WIDTH/2; + r.bottom = macDraw->yOff+Tk_Height(tkwin) - scalePtr->inset; } if (macScalePtr->scaleHandle == NULL) { - -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Initialising scale\n"); -#endif - - initialValue = scalePtr->value; - if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_HORIZONTAL) { - minValue = scalePtr->fromValue; - maxValue = scalePtr->toValue; - } else { - minValue = scalePtr->fromValue; - maxValue = scalePtr->toValue; - } - - if (scalePtr->tickInterval == 0) { - numTicks = 0; - } else { - numTicks = (maxValue - minValue)/scalePtr->tickInterval; - } - - CreateSliderControl(windowRef, &r, initialValue, minValue, maxValue, - kControlSliderPointsDownOrRight, numTicks, - 1, scaleActionProc, - &(macScalePtr->scaleHandle)); - SetControlReference(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, (UInt32) scalePtr); + ERR_MSG("Initialising scale"); + + initialValue = scalePtr->value; + if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_HORIZONTAL) { + minValue = scalePtr->fromValue; + maxValue = scalePtr->toValue; + } else { + minValue = scalePtr->fromValue; + maxValue = scalePtr->toValue; + } + + if (scalePtr->tickInterval == 0) { + numTicks = 0; + } else { + numTicks = (maxValue - minValue)/scalePtr->tickInterval; + } + + CreateSliderControl(windowRef, &r, initialValue, minValue, maxValue, + kControlSliderPointsDownOrRight, numTicks, 1, scaleActionProc, + &(macScalePtr->scaleHandle)); + SetControlReference(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, (UInt32) scalePtr); /* * If we are foremost than make us active. */ + if (windowRef == FrontWindow()) { macScalePtr->flags |= ACTIVE; } } else { - SetControlBounds(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, &r); - SetControl32BitValue(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, scalePtr->value); - SetControl32BitMinimum(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, scalePtr->fromValue); - SetControl32BitMaximum(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, scalePtr->toValue); + SetControlBounds(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, &r); + SetControl32BitValue(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, scalePtr->value); + SetControl32BitMinimum(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, scalePtr->fromValue); + SetControl32BitMaximum(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, scalePtr->toValue); } /* * Finally draw the control. */ + SetControlVisibility(macScalePtr->scaleHandle,true,true); HiliteControl(macScalePtr->scaleHandle,0); Draw1Control(macScalePtr->scaleHandle); SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); -done: + done: scalePtr->flags &= ~REDRAW_ALL; } @@ -299,13 +289,12 @@ done: * * TkpScaleElement -- * - * Determine which part of a scale widget lies under a given - * point. + * Determine which part of a scale widget lies under a given point. * * Results: - * The return value is either TROUGH1, SLIDER, TROUGH2, or - * OTHER, depending on which of the scale's active elements - * (if any) is under the point at (x,y). + * The return value is either TROUGH1, SLIDER, TROUGH2, or OTHER, + * depending on which of the scale's active elements (if any) is under + * the point at (x,y). * * Side effects: * None. @@ -314,9 +303,9 @@ done: */ int -TkpScaleElement(scalePtr, x, y) - TkScale *scalePtr; /* Widget record for scale. */ - int x, y; /* Coordinates within scalePtr's window. */ +TkpScaleElement( + TkScale *scalePtr, /* Widget record for scale. */ + int x, int y) /* Coordinates within scalePtr's window. */ { MacScale *macScalePtr = (MacScale *) scalePtr; ControlPartCode part; @@ -324,10 +313,9 @@ TkpScaleElement(scalePtr, x, y) Rect bounds; CGrafPtr saveWorld; GDHandle saveDevice; - GWorldPtr destPort; -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"TkpScaleElement\n"); -#endif + GWorldPtr destPort; + + ERR_MSG("TkpScaleElement"); destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(scalePtr->tkwin)); GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); @@ -335,37 +323,35 @@ TkpScaleElement(scalePtr, x, y) /* * All of the calculations in this procedure mirror those in - * DisplayScrollbar. Be sure to keep the two consistent. + * DisplayScrollbar. Be sure to keep the two consistent. */ - TkMacOSXWinBounds((TkWindow *) scalePtr->tkwin, &bounds); + TkMacOSXWinBounds((TkWindow *) scalePtr->tkwin, &bounds); where.h = x + bounds.left; where.v = y + bounds.top; part = TestControl(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, where); - + SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf (stderr,"ScalePart %d, pos ( %d %d )\n", part, where.h, where.v ); -#endif - + ERR_MSG("ScalePart %d, pos ( %d %d )", part, where.h, where.v); + switch (part) { - case inSlider: - return SLIDER; - case inInc: - if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_VERTICAL) { - return TROUGH1; - } else { - return TROUGH2; - } - case inDecr: - if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_VERTICAL) { - return TROUGH2; - } else { - return TROUGH1; - } - default: - return OTHER; + case inSlider: + return SLIDER; + case inInc: + if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_VERTICAL) { + return TROUGH1; + } else { + return TROUGH2; + } + case inDecr: + if (scalePtr->orient == ORIENT_VERTICAL) { + return TROUGH2; + } else { + return TROUGH1; + } + default: + return OTHER; } } @@ -374,23 +360,23 @@ TkpScaleElement(scalePtr, x, y) * * MacScaleEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by the Tk dispatcher for - * ButtonPress events on scales. + * This procedure is invoked by the Tk dispatcher for ButtonPress events + * on scales. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * When the window gets deleted, internal structures get - * cleaned up. When it gets exposed, it is redisplayed. + * When the window gets deleted, internal structures get cleaned up. When + * it gets exposed, it is redisplayed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -MacScaleEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) - ClientData clientData; /* Information about window. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* Information about event. */ +MacScaleEventProc( + ClientData clientData, /* Information about window. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* Information about event. */ { MacScale *macScalePtr = (MacScale *) clientData; Point where; @@ -400,44 +386,43 @@ MacScaleEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) GDHandle saveDevice; GWorldPtr destPort; -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"MacScaleEventProc\n" ); -#endif + ERR_MSG("MacScaleEventProc"); + /* - * To call Macintosh control routines we must have the port - * set to the window containing the control. We will then test - * which part of the control was hit and act accordingly. + * To call Macintosh control routines we must have the port set to the + * window containing the control. We will then test which part of the + * control was hit and act accordingly. */ + destPort = TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(Tk_WindowId(macScalePtr->info.tkwin)); GetGWorld(&saveWorld, &saveDevice); SetGWorld(destPort, NULL); TkMacOSXSetUpClippingRgn(Tk_WindowId(macScalePtr->info.tkwin)); - TkMacOSXWinBounds((TkWindow *) macScalePtr->info.tkwin, &bounds); + TkMacOSXWinBounds((TkWindow *) macScalePtr->info.tkwin, &bounds); where.h = eventPtr->xbutton.x + bounds.left; where.v = eventPtr->xbutton.y + bounds.top; -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"calling TestControl\n"); -#endif + ERR_MSG("calling TestControl"); part = TestControl(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, where); if (part == 0) { return; } - + part = TrackControl(macScalePtr->scaleHandle, where, scaleActionProc); - + /* * Update the value for the widget. */ + macScalePtr->info.value = GetControlValue(macScalePtr->scaleHandle); /* TkScaleSetValue(&macScalePtr->info, macScalePtr->info.value, 1, 0); */ /* - * The TrackControl call will "eat" the ButtonUp event. We now - * generate a ButtonUp event so Tk will unset implicit grabs etc. + * The TrackControl call will "eat" the ButtonUp event. We now generate a + * ButtonUp event so Tk will unset implicit grabs etc. */ - TkGenerateButtonEventForXPointer(Tk_WindowId(macScalePtr->info.tkwin)); + TkGenerateButtonEventForXPointer(Tk_WindowId(macScalePtr->info.tkwin)); SetGWorld(saveWorld, saveDevice); } @@ -446,9 +431,9 @@ MacScaleEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) * * ScaleActionProc -- * - * Callback procedure used by the Macintosh toolbox call - * TrackControl. This call will update the display while - * the scrollbar is being manipulated by the user. + * Callback procedure used by the Macintosh toolbox call TrackControl. + * This call will update the display while the scrollbar is being + * manipulated by the user. * * Results: * None. @@ -467,13 +452,18 @@ ScaleActionProc( int value; TkScale *scalePtr = (TkScale *) GetControlReference(theControl); -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"ScaleActionProc\n"); -#endif - value = GetControlValue(theControl); + ERR_MSG("ScaleActionProc"); + value = GetControlValue(theControl); TkScaleSetValue(scalePtr, value, 1, 1); Tcl_Preserve((ClientData) scalePtr); Tcl_DoOneEvent(TCL_IDLE_EVENTS); Tcl_Release((ClientData) scalePtr); } - + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c index 1796cf3..a20ac8c 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ * software in accordance with the terms specified in this * license. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c,v 1.18 2006/11/02 15:18:13 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXWindowEvent.c,v 1.19 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -203,39 +203,37 @@ TkMacOSXProcessWindowEvent( sizeof(whichWindow), NULL, &whichWindow); if (status != noErr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf ( stderr, "TkMacOSXHandleWindowEvent:Failed to retrieve window" ); -#endif + ERR_MSG("TkMacOSXHandleWindowEvent: Failed to retrieve window"); return 0; } - + window = TkMacOSXGetXWindow(whichWindow); switch (eventPtr->eKind) { - case kEventWindowActivated: - eventFound |= GenerateActivateEvents(window, 1); - eventFound |= TkMacOSXGenerateFocusEvent(window, 1); - break; - case kEventWindowDeactivated: - eventFound |= GenerateActivateEvents(window, 0); - eventFound |= TkMacOSXGenerateFocusEvent(window, 0); - break; - case kEventWindowUpdate: - if (GenerateUpdateEvent(window)) { - eventFound = true; - } - break; - case kEventWindowExpanded: { - TkDisplay *dispPtr; - TkWindow *winPtr; - dispPtr = TkGetDisplayList(); - winPtr = (TkWindow *)Tk_IdToWindow(dispPtr->display, window); - if (winPtr) { - TkpWmSetState(winPtr, TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed(winPtr) ? - ZoomState : NormalState); - } - break; - } + case kEventWindowActivated: + eventFound |= GenerateActivateEvents(window, 1); + eventFound |= TkMacOSXGenerateFocusEvent(window, 1); + break; + case kEventWindowDeactivated: + eventFound |= GenerateActivateEvents(window, 0); + eventFound |= TkMacOSXGenerateFocusEvent(window, 0); + break; + case kEventWindowUpdate: + if (GenerateUpdateEvent(window)) { + eventFound = true; + } + break; + case kEventWindowExpanded: { + TkDisplay *dispPtr = TkGetDisplayList(); + TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) + Tk_IdToWindow(dispPtr->display, window); + + if (winPtr) { + TkpWmSetState(winPtr, TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed(winPtr) ? + ZoomState : NormalState); + } + break; + } } return 0; } @@ -245,10 +243,10 @@ TkMacOSXProcessWindowEvent( * * GenerateUpdateEvent -- * - * Given a Macintosh window update event this function generates - * all the Expose XEvents needed by Tk. + * Given a Macintosh window update event this function generates all the + * Expose XEvents needed by Tk. * - * Results: + * Results: * True if event(s) are generated - false otherwise. * * Side effects: diff --git a/macosx/tkMacOSXWm.c b/macosx/tkMacOSXWm.c index 8d47c4b..d6a78c2 100644 --- a/macosx/tkMacOSXWm.c +++ b/macosx/tkMacOSXWm.c @@ -2,18 +2,18 @@ * tkMacOSXWm.c -- * * This module takes care of the interactions between a Tk-based - * application and the window manager. Among other things, it - * implements the "wm" command and passes geometry information - * to the window manager. + * application and the window manager. Among other things, it implements + * the "wm" command and passes geometry information to the window + * manager. * * Copyright (c) 1994-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright 2001, Apple Computer, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2006 Daniel A. Steffen * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXWm.c,v 1.46 2007/01/05 00:00:52 nijtmans Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkMacOSXWm.c,v 1.47 2007/04/13 14:51:18 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkMacOSXInt.h" @@ -41,21 +41,19 @@ TkMacOSXWindowList *tkMacOSXWindowListPtr = NULL; /* - * The variable below is used to enable or disable tracing in this - * module. If tracing is enabled, then information is printed on - * standard output about interesting interactions with the window - * manager. + * The variable below is used to enable or disable tracing in this module. If + * tracing is enabled, then information is printed on standard output about + * interesting interactions with the window manager. */ static int wmTracing = 0; /* - * The following structure is the official type record for geometry - * management of top-level windows. + * The following structure is the official type record for geometry management + * of top-level windows. */ -static void TopLevelReqProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData dummy, - Tk_Window tkwin)); +static void TopLevelReqProc(ClientData dummy, Tk_Window tkwin); static const Tk_GeomMgr wmMgrType = { "wm", /* name */ @@ -80,126 +78,119 @@ static int windowHashInit = false; * Forward declarations for procedures defined in this file: */ -static void InitialWindowBounds _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr, - Rect *geometry)); -static int ParseGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp, - char *string, TkWindow *winPtr)); -static void TopLevelEventProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData, - XEvent *eventPtr)); -static void WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkWindow *winPtr, - Display *display, - Tcl_HashTable *table)); -static void TopLevelReqProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData dummy, - Tk_Window tkwin)); -static void UpdateGeometryInfo _ANSI_ARGS_(( - ClientData clientData)); -static void UpdateSizeHints _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -static void UpdateVRootGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_((WmInfo *wmPtr)); -static int WmAspectCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmAttributesCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); +static void InitialWindowBounds(TkWindow *winPtr, Rect *geometry); +static int ParseGeometry(Tcl_Interp *interp, + char *string, TkWindow *winPtr); +static void TopLevelEventProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static void WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(TkWindow *winPtr, + Display *display, Tcl_HashTable *table); +static void TopLevelReqProc(ClientData dummy, + Tk_Window tkwin); +static void UpdateGeometryInfo(ClientData clientData); +static void UpdateSizeHints(TkWindow *winPtr); +static void UpdateVRootGeometry(WmInfo *wmPtr); +static int WmAspectCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmAttributesCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); static Tcl_Obj * WmAttrGetModifiedStatus(WindowRef macWindow); static Tcl_Obj * WmAttrGetTitlePath(WindowRef macWindow); static Tcl_Obj * WmAttrGetAlpha(WindowRef macWindow); static Tcl_Obj * WmAttrGetNotifyStatus(void); static void WmAttrSetNotifyStatus(int state); -static int WmClientCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmColormapwindowsCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmCommandCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmDeiconifyCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmFocusmodelCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmFrameCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmGeometryCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmGridCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmGroupCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconbitmapCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconifyCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconmaskCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconnameCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconphotoCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconpositionCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconwindowCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmMaxsizeCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmMinsizeCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmOverrideredirectCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmPositionfromCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmProtocolCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmResizableCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmSizefromCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmStackorderCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmStateCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmTitleCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmTransientCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmWithdrawCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static void WmUpdateGeom _ANSI_ARGS_((WmInfo *wmPtr, - TkWindow *winPtr)); -static int WmWinStyle _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp, - TkWindow *winPtr, int objc, - Tcl_Obj * CONST objv[])); -static void ApplyWindowAttributeChanges _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkWindow *winPtr, int newAttributes, - int oldAttributes, int create)); - +static int WmClientCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmColormapwindowsCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmCommandCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmDeiconifyCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmFocusmodelCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmFrameCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmGeometryCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmGridCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmGroupCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconbitmapCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconifyCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconmaskCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconnameCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconphotoCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconpositionCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconwindowCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmMaxsizeCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmMinsizeCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmOverrideredirectCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow*winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmPositionfromCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmProtocolCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmResizableCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmSizefromCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmStackorderCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmStateCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmTitleCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmTransientCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmWithdrawCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, + Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static void WmUpdateGeom(WmInfo *wmPtr, TkWindow *winPtr); +static int WmWinStyle(Tcl_Interp *interp, TkWindow *winPtr, + int objc, Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static void ApplyWindowAttributeChanges(TkWindow *winPtr, + int newAttributes, int oldAttributes, int create); + /* *-------------------------------------------------------------- * @@ -2384,12 +2375,12 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ */ static int -WmProtocolCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) -Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ -TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ -Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ -int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ -Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmProtocolCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; register ProtocolHandler *protPtr, *prevPtr; @@ -2405,10 +2396,11 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ /* * Return a list of all defined protocols for the window. */ + for (protPtr = wmPtr->protPtr; protPtr != NULL; - protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { + protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { Tcl_AppendElement(interp, - Tk_GetAtomName((Tk_Window) winPtr, protPtr->protocol)); + Tk_GetAtomName((Tk_Window) winPtr, protPtr->protocol)); } return TCL_OK; } @@ -2417,6 +2409,7 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ /* * Return the command to handle a given protocol. */ + for (protPtr = wmPtr->protPtr; protPtr != NULL; protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { if (protPtr->protocol == protocol) { @@ -2428,9 +2421,8 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ } /* - * Delete any current protocol handler, then create a new - * one with the specified command, unless the command is - * empty. + * Delete any current protocol handler, then create a new one with the + * specified command, unless the command is empty. */ for (protPtr = wmPtr->protPtr, prevPtr = NULL; protPtr != NULL; @@ -2475,12 +2467,12 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ */ static int -WmResizableCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmResizableCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; int width, height; @@ -2550,12 +2542,12 @@ WmResizableCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) */ static int -WmSizefromCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) -Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ -TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ -Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ -int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ -Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmSizefromCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { @@ -2615,12 +2607,12 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ */ static int -WmStackorderCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) -Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ -TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ -Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ -int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ -Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmStackorderCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { TkWindow **windows, **window_ptr; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { @@ -2673,9 +2665,8 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ } /* - * Lookup stacking order of all toplevels that are children - * of "." and find the position of winPtr and winPtr2 - * in the stacking order. + * Lookup stacking order of all toplevels that are children of "." and + * find the position of winPtr and winPtr2 in the stacking order. */ windows = TkWmStackorderToplevel(winPtr->mainPtr->winPtr); @@ -2732,16 +2723,16 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ */ static int -WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) -Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ -TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ -Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ -int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ -Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmStateCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { - "normal", "iconic", "withdrawn", "zoomed", (char *) NULL }; + "normal", "iconic", "withdrawn", "zoomed", NULL }; enum options { OPT_NORMAL, OPT_ICONIC, OPT_WITHDRAWN, OPT_ZOOMED }; int index; @@ -2753,41 +2744,37 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ if (objc == 4) { if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't change state of ", - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), ": it is an icon for ", + Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't change state of ", - winPtr->pathName, ": it is an embedded window", - (char *) NULL); + winPtr->pathName, ": it is an embedded window", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[3], optionStrings, "argument", 0, - &index) != TCL_OK) { + &index) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } if (index == OPT_NORMAL) { TkpWmSetState(winPtr, NormalState); + /* - * This varies from 'wm deiconify' because it does not - * force the window to be raised and receive focus + * This varies from 'wm deiconify' because it does not force the + * window to be raised and receive focus */ } else if (index == OPT_ICONIC) { if (Tk_Attributes((Tk_Window) winPtr)->override_redirect) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", - winPtr->pathName, - "\": override-redirect flag is set", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", winPtr->pathName, + "\": override-redirect flag is set", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (wmPtr->master != None) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", - winPtr->pathName, - "\": it is a transient", (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", winPtr->pathName, + "\": it is a transient", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } TkpWmSetState(winPtr, IconicState); @@ -2806,18 +2793,18 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ ZoomState : NormalState); } switch (wmPtr->hints.initial_state) { - case NormalState: - Tcl_SetResult(interp, "normal", TCL_STATIC); - break; - case IconicState: - Tcl_SetResult(interp, "iconic", TCL_STATIC); - break; - case WithdrawnState: - Tcl_SetResult(interp, "withdrawn", TCL_STATIC); - break; - case ZoomState: - Tcl_SetResult(interp, "zoomed", TCL_STATIC); - break; + case NormalState: + Tcl_SetResult(interp, "normal", TCL_STATIC); + break; + case IconicState: + Tcl_SetResult(interp, "iconic", TCL_STATIC); + break; + case WithdrawnState: + Tcl_SetResult(interp, "withdrawn", TCL_STATIC); + break; + case ZoomState: + Tcl_SetResult(interp, "zoomed", TCL_STATIC); + break; } } } @@ -2842,12 +2829,12 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ */ static int -WmTitleCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) -Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ -TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ -Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ -int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ -Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmTitleCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; char *argv3; @@ -2858,16 +2845,15 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ return TCL_ERROR; } if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_SetResult(interp, - (char *) ((wmPtr->titleUid != NULL) ? wmPtr->titleUid : winPtr->nameUid), - TCL_STATIC); + Tcl_SetResult(interp, (char *) ((wmPtr->titleUid != NULL) + ? wmPtr->titleUid : winPtr->nameUid), TCL_STATIC); return TCL_OK; - } else { - argv3 = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[3], &length); - wmPtr->titleUid = Tk_GetUid(argv3); - if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED) && !Tk_IsEmbedded(winPtr)) { - TkSetWMName(winPtr, wmPtr->titleUid); - } + } + + argv3 = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[3], &length); + wmPtr->titleUid = Tk_GetUid(argv3); + if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED) && !Tk_IsEmbedded(winPtr)) { + TkSetWMName(winPtr, wmPtr->titleUid); } return TCL_OK; } @@ -2890,19 +2876,18 @@ Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ */ static int -WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmTransientCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; Tk_Window master; WmInfo *wmPtr2; char *argv3; - int length; - int oldAttributes = wmPtr->attributes; + int length, oldAttributes = wmPtr->attributes; if ((objc != 3) && (objc != 4)) { Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "window ?master?"); @@ -2935,11 +2920,9 @@ WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) Tk_MakeWindowExist(master); if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - "\" a transient: it is an icon for ", - Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), + "\" a transient: it is an icon for ", + Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -2960,7 +2943,7 @@ WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) "\" its own master", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } - + argv3 = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[3], &length); wmPtr->master = Tk_WindowId(master); wmPtr->masterWindowName = ckalloc((unsigned) length+1); @@ -2996,12 +2979,12 @@ WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) */ static int -WmWithdrawCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Main window of the application. */ - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel to work with */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +WmWithdrawCmd( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of the application. */ + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel to work with */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -3011,22 +2994,22 @@ WmWithdrawCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't withdraw ", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } TkpWmSetState(winPtr, WithdrawnState); return TCL_OK; } - + /* - * Invoked by those wm subcommands that affect geometry. - * Schedules a geometry update. + * Invoked by those wm subcommands that affect geometry. Schedules a geometry + * update. */ + static void -WmUpdateGeom(wmPtr, winPtr) -WmInfo *wmPtr; -TkWindow *winPtr; +WmUpdateGeom( + WmInfo *wmPtr, + TkWindow *winPtr) { if (!(wmPtr->flags & (WM_UPDATE_PENDING|WM_NEVER_MAPPED))) { Tcl_DoWhenIdle(UpdateGeometryInfo, (ClientData) winPtr); @@ -3039,33 +3022,33 @@ TkWindow *winPtr; * Tk_SetGrid -- * * This procedure is invoked by a widget when it wishes to set a grid - * coordinate system that controls the size of a top-level window. - * It provides a C interface equivalent to the "wm grid" command and - * is usually asscoiated with the -setgrid option. + * coordinate system that controls the size of a top-level window. It + * provides a C interface equivalent to the "wm grid" command and is + * usually asscoiated with the -setgrid option. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Grid-related information will be passed to the window manager, so - * that the top-level window associated with tkwin will resize on - * even grid units. If some other window already controls gridding - * for the top-level window then this procedure call has no effect. + * Grid-related information will be passed to the window manager, so that + * the top-level window associated with tkwin will resize on even grid + * units. If some other window already controls gridding for the + * top-level window then this procedure call has no effect. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void Tk_SetGrid( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for window. New window mgr info - * will be posted for the top-level window + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for window. New window mgr info will + * be posted for the top-level window * associated with this window. */ - int reqWidth, /* Width (in grid units) corresponding to - * the requested geometry for tkwin. */ - int reqHeight, /* Height (in grid units) corresponding to - * the requested geometry for tkwin. */ - int widthInc, int heightInc)/* Pixel increments corresponding to a - * change of one grid unit. */ + int reqWidth, /* Width (in grid units) corresponding to the + * requested geometry for tkwin. */ + int reqHeight, /* Height (in grid units) corresponding to the + * requested geometry for tkwin. */ + int widthInc, int heightInc)/* Pixel increments corresponding to a change + * of one grid unit. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -3073,6 +3056,7 @@ Tk_SetGrid( /* * Ensure widthInc and heightInc are greater than 0 */ + if (widthInc <= 0) { widthInc = 1; } @@ -3104,15 +3088,15 @@ Tk_SetGrid( } /* - * If gridding was previously off, then forget about any window - * size requests made by the user or via "wm geometry": these are - * in pixel units and there's no easy way to translate them to - * grid units since the new requested size of the top-level window in - * pixels may not yet have been registered yet (it may filter up - * the hierarchy in DoWhenIdle handlers). However, if the window - * has never been mapped yet then just leave the window size alone: - * assume that it is intended to be in grid units but just happened - * to have been specified before this procedure was called. + * If gridding was previously off, then forget about any window size + * requests made by the user or via "wm geometry": these are in pixel + * units and there's no easy way to translate them to grid units since the + * new requested size of the top-level window in pixels may not yet have + * been registered yet (it may filter up the hierarchy in DoWhenIdle + * handlers). However, if the window has never been mapped yet then just + * leave the window size alone: assume that it is intended to be in grid + * units but just happened to have been specified before this procedure + * was called. */ if ((wmPtr->gridWin == NULL) && !(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { @@ -3120,9 +3104,9 @@ Tk_SetGrid( wmPtr->height = -1; } - /* - * Set the new gridding information, and start the process of passing - * all of this information to the window manager. + /* + * Set the new gridding information, and start the process of passing all + * of this information to the window manager. */ wmPtr->gridWin = tkwin; @@ -3143,16 +3127,15 @@ Tk_SetGrid( * * Tk_UnsetGrid -- * - * This procedure cancels the effect of a previous call - * to Tk_SetGrid. + * This procedure cancels the effect of a previous call to Tk_SetGrid. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: * If tkwin currently controls gridding for its top-level window, - * gridding is cancelled for that top-level window; if some other - * window controls gridding then this procedure has no effect. + * gridding is cancelled for that top-level window; if some other window + * controls gridding then this procedure has no effect. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -3208,34 +3191,32 @@ Tk_UnsetGrid( * None. * * Side effects: - * Tk's internal data structures for the window get modified to - * reflect the structural change. + * Tk's internal data structures for the window get modified to reflect + * the structural change. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void TopLevelEventProc( - ClientData clientData, /* Window for which event occurred. */ - XEvent *eventPtr) /* Event that just happened. */ + ClientData clientData, /* Window for which event occurred. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* Event that just happened. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) clientData; winPtr->wmInfoPtr->flags |= WM_VROOT_OFFSET_STALE; if (eventPtr->type == DestroyNotify) { - Tk_ErrorHandler handler; - if (!(winPtr->flags & TK_ALREADY_DEAD)) { /* * A top-level window was deleted externally (e.g., by the window - * manager). This is probably not a good thing, but cleanup as - * best we can. The error handler is needed because + * manager). This is probably not a good thing, but cleanup as + * best we can. The error handler is needed because * Tk_DestroyWindow will try to destroy the window, but of course * it's already gone. */ - - handler = Tk_CreateErrorHandler(winPtr->display, -1, -1, -1, - (Tk_ErrorProc *) NULL, (ClientData) NULL); + + Tk_ErrorHandler handler = Tk_CreateErrorHandler(winPtr->display, + -1, -1, -1, (Tk_ErrorProc *) NULL, (ClientData) NULL); Tk_DestroyWindow((Tk_Window) winPtr); Tk_DeleteErrorHandler(handler); } @@ -3252,15 +3233,15 @@ TopLevelEventProc( * * TopLevelReqProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by the geometry manager whenever - * the requested size for a top-level window is changed. + * This procedure is invoked by the geometry manager whenever the + * requested size for a top-level window is changed. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Arrange for the window to be resized to satisfy the request - * (this happens as a when-idle action). + * Arrange for the window to be resized to satisfy the request (this + * happens as a when-idle action). * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -3268,8 +3249,8 @@ TopLevelEventProc( /* ARGSUSED */ static void TopLevelReqProc( - ClientData dummy, /* Not used. */ - Tk_Window tkwin) /* Information about window. */ + ClientData dummy, /* Not used. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Information about window. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -3287,44 +3268,40 @@ TopLevelReqProc( * * UpdateGeometryInfo -- * - * This procedure is invoked when a top-level window is first - * mapped, and also as a when-idle procedure, to bring the - * geometry and/or position of a top-level window back into - * line with what has been requested by the user and/or widgets. - * This procedure doesn't return until the window manager has - * responded to the geometry change. + * This procedure is invoked when a top-level window is first mapped, and + * also as a when-idle procedure, to bring the geometry and/or position + * of a top-level window back into line with what has been requested by + * the user and/or widgets. This procedure doesn't return until the + * window manager has responded to the geometry change. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * The window's size and location may change, unless the WM prevents - * that from happening. + * The window's size and location may change, unless the WM prevents that + * from happening. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void UpdateGeometryInfo( - ClientData clientData) /* Pointer to the window's record. */ + ClientData clientData) /* Pointer to the window's record. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) clientData; WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; - int x, y, width, height; - int min, max; + int x, y, width, height, min, max; unsigned long serial; wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_UPDATE_PENDING; /* - * Compute the new size for the top-level window. See the - * user documentation for details on this, but the size - * requested depends on (a) the size requested internally - * by the window's widgets, (b) the size requested by the - * user in a "wm geometry" command or via wm-based interactive - * resizing (if any), and (c) whether or not the window is - * gridded. Don't permit sizes <= 0 because this upsets - * the X server. + * Compute the new size for the top-level window. See the user + * documentation for details on this, but the size requested depends on + * (a) the size requested internally by the window's widgets, (b) the size + * requested by the user in a "wm geometry" command or via wm-based + * interactive resizing (if any), and (c) whether or not the window is + * gridded. Don't permit sizes <= 0 because this upsets the X server. */ if (wmPtr->width == -1) { @@ -3399,10 +3376,10 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo( /* * Compute the new position for the upper-left pixel of the window's - * decorative frame. This is tricky, because we need to include the - * border widths supplied by a reparented parent in this calculation, - * but can't use the parent's current overall size since that may - * change as a result of this code. + * decorative frame. This is tricky, because we need to include the border + * widths supplied by a reparented parent in this calculation, but can't + * use the parent's current overall size since that may change as a result + * of this code. */ if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_X) { @@ -3419,10 +3396,10 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo( } /* - * If the window's size is going to change and the window is - * supposed to not be resizable by the user, then we have to - * update the size hints. There may also be a size-hint-update - * request pending from somewhere else, too. + * If the window's size is going to change and the window is supposed to + * not be resizable by the user, then we have to update the size hints. + * There may also be a size-hint-update request pending from somewhere + * else, too. */ if (((width != winPtr->changes.width) @@ -3436,40 +3413,37 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo( } /* - * Reconfigure the window if it isn't already configured correctly. - * A few tricky points: + * Reconfigure the window if it isn't already configured correctly. A few + * tricky points: * - * 1. If the window is embedded and the container is also in this - * process, don't actually reconfigure the window; just pass the - * desired size on to the container. Also, zero out any position - * information, since embedded windows are not allowed to move. - * 2. Sometimes the window manager will give us a different size - * than we asked for (e.g. mwm has a minimum size for windows), so - * base the size check on what we *asked for* last time, not what we - * got. - * 3. Don't move window unless a new position has been requested for - * it. This is because of "features" in some window managers (e.g. - * twm, as of 4/24/91) where they don't interpret coordinates - * according to ICCCM. Moving a window to its current location may - * cause it to shift position on the screen. + * 1. If the window is embedded and the container is also in this process, + * don't actually reconfigure the window; just pass the desired size on + * to the container. Also, zero out any position information, since + * embedded windows are not allowed to move. + * 2. Sometimes the window manager will give us a different size than we + * asked for (e.g. mwm has a minimum size for windows), so base the + * size check on what we *asked for* last time, not what we got. + * 3. Don't move window unless a new position has been requested for it. + * This is because of "features" in some window managers (e.g. twm, as + * of 4/24/91) where they don't interpret coordinates according to + * ICCCM. Moving a window to its current location may cause it to shift + * position on the screen. */ if (Tk_IsEmbedded(winPtr)) { - TkWindow *contWinPtr; + TkWindow *contWinPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); - contWinPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); - /* * NOTE: Here we should handle out of process embedding. */ - if (contWinPtr != NULL) { + if (contWinPtr != NULL) { /* * This window is embedded and the container is also in this * process, so we don't need to do anything special about the - * geometry, except to make sure that the desired size is known - * by the container. Also, zero out any position information, - * since embedded windows are not allowed to move. + * geometry, except to make sure that the desired size is known by + * the container. Also, zero out any position information, since + * embedded windows are not allowed to move. */ wmPtr->x = wmPtr->y = 0; @@ -3478,6 +3452,7 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo( } return; } + serial = NextRequest(winPtr->display); if (wmPtr->flags & WM_MOVE_PENDING) { wmPtr->configWidth = width; @@ -3508,9 +3483,8 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo( * * UpdateSizeHints -- * - * This procedure is called to update the window manager's - * size hints information from the information in a WmInfo - * structure. + * This procedure is called to update the window manager's size hints + * information from the information in a WmInfo structure. * * Results: * None. @@ -3537,13 +3511,12 @@ UpdateSizeHints( * * ParseGeometry -- * - * This procedure parses a geometry string and updates - * information used to control the geometry of a top-level - * window. + * This procedure parses a geometry string and updates information used + * to control the geometry of a top-level window. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl return value, plus an error message in - * the interp's result if an error occurs. + * A standard Tcl return value, plus an error message in the interp's + * result if an error occurs. * * Side effects: * The size and/or location of winPtr may change. @@ -3554,10 +3527,10 @@ UpdateSizeHints( static int ParseGeometry( Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Used for error reporting. */ - char *string, /* String containing new geometry. Has the + char *string, /* String containing new geometry. Has the * standard form "=wxh+x+y". */ - TkWindow *winPtr) /* Pointer to top-level window whose - * geometry is to be changed. */ + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Pointer to top-level window whose geometry + * is to be changed. */ { WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; int x, y, width, height, flags; @@ -3573,9 +3546,9 @@ ParseGeometry( } /* - * Parse the width and height, if they are present. Don't - * actually update any of the fields of wmPtr until we've - * successfully parsed the entire geometry string. + * Parse the width and height, if they are present. Don't actually update + * any of the fields of wmPtr until we've successfully parsed the entire + * geometry string. */ width = wmPtr->width; @@ -3629,10 +3602,10 @@ ParseGeometry( } /* - * Assume that the geometry information came from the user, - * unless an explicit source has been specified. Otherwise - * most window managers assume that the size hints were - * program-specified and they ignore them. + * Assume that the geometry information came from the user, unless an + * explicit source has been specified. Otherwise most window managers + * assume that the size hints were program-specified and they ignore + * them. */ if ((wmPtr->sizeHintsFlags & (USPosition|PPosition)) == 0) { @@ -3642,9 +3615,9 @@ ParseGeometry( } /* - * Everything was parsed OK. Update the fields of *wmPtr and - * arrange for the appropriate information to be percolated out - * to the window manager at the next idle moment. + * Everything was parsed OK. Update the fields of *wmPtr and arrange for + * the appropriate information to be percolated out to the window manager + * at the next idle moment. */ wmPtr->width = width; @@ -3674,15 +3647,15 @@ ParseGeometry( * * Tk_GetRootCoords -- * - * Given a token for a window, this procedure traces through the - * window's lineage to find the (virtual) root-window coordinates - * corresponding to point (0,0) in the window. + * Given a token for a window, this procedure traces through the window's + * lineage to find the (virtual) root-window coordinates corresponding to + * point (0,0) in the window. * * Results: - * The locations pointed to by xPtr and yPtr are filled in with - * the root coordinates of the (0,0) point in tkwin. If a virtual - * root window is in effect for the window, then the coordinates - * in the virtual root are returned. + * The locations pointed to by xPtr and yPtr are filled in with the root + * coordinates of the (0,0) point in tkwin. If a virtual root window is + * in effect for the window, then the coordinates in the virtual root are + * returned. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -3700,9 +3673,8 @@ Tk_GetRootCoords( TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; /* - * Search back through this window's parents all the way to a - * top-level window, combining the offsets of each window within - * its parent. + * Search back through this window's parents all the way to a top-level + * window, combining the offsets of each window within its parent. */ x = y = 0; @@ -3713,45 +3685,45 @@ Tk_GetRootCoords( if (!(Tk_IsEmbedded(winPtr))) { x += winPtr->wmInfoPtr->xInParent; y += winPtr->wmInfoPtr->yInParent; - break; + break; } else { - TkWindow *otherPtr; - - otherPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); + TkWindow *otherPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); + if (otherPtr != NULL) { /* - * The container window is in the same application. - * Query its coordinates. + * The container window is in the same application. Query + * its coordinates. */ + winPtr = otherPtr; - + /* - * Remember to offset by the container window here, - * since at the end of this if branch, we will - * pop out to the container's parent... + * Remember to offset by the container window here, since + * at the end of this if branch, we will pop out to the + * container's parent... */ - + x += winPtr->changes.x + winPtr->changes.border_width; y += winPtr->changes.y + winPtr->changes.border_width; - } else { Point theOffset; - + if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->getOffsetProc != NULL) { /* - * We do not require that the changes.x & changes.y for - * a non-Tk master window be kept up to date. So we - * first subtract off the possibly bogus values that have - * been added on at the top of this pass through the loop, - * and then call out to the getOffsetProc to give us - * the correct offset. + * We do not require that the changes.x & changes.y + * for a non-Tk master window be kept up to date. So + * we first subtract off the possibly bogus values + * that have been added on at the top of this pass + * through the loop, and then call out to the + * getOffsetProc to give us the correct offset. */ - + x -= winPtr->changes.x + winPtr->changes.border_width; y -= winPtr->changes.y + winPtr->changes.border_width; - - tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->getOffsetProc((Tk_Window) winPtr, &theOffset); - + + tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->getOffsetProc((Tk_Window) winPtr, + &theOffset); + x += theOffset.h; y += theOffset.v; } @@ -3770,14 +3742,14 @@ Tk_GetRootCoords( * * Tk_CoordsToWindow -- * - * This is a Macintosh specific implementation of this function. - * Given the root coordinates of a point, this procedure returns - * the token for the top-most window covering that point, if - * there exists such a window in this application. + * This is a Macintosh specific implementation of this function. Given + * the root coordinates of a point, this procedure returns the token for + * the top-most window covering that point, if there exists such a window + * in this application. * * Results: - * The return result is either a token for the window corresponding - * to rootX and rootY, or else NULL to indicate that there is no such + * The return result is either a token for the window corresponding to + * rootX and rootY, or else NULL to indicate that there is no such * window. * * Side effects: @@ -3788,19 +3760,19 @@ Tk_GetRootCoords( Tk_Window Tk_CoordsToWindow( - int rootX, int rootY, /* Coordinates of point in root window. If - * a virtual-root window manager is in use, + int rootX, int rootY, /* Coordinates of point in root window. If a + * virtual-root window manager is in use, * these coordinates refer to the virtual * root, not the real root. */ - Tk_Window tkwin) /* Token for any window in application; - * used to identify the display. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Token for any window in application; used + * to identify the display. */ { WindowPtr whichWin; Point where; Window rootChild; TkWindow *winPtr, *childPtr; - TkWindow *nextPtr; /* Coordinates of highest child found so - * far that contains point. */ + TkWindow *nextPtr; /* Coordinates of highest child found so far + * that contains point. */ int x, y; /* Coordinates in winPtr. */ int tmpx, tmpy, bd; TkDisplay *dispPtr; @@ -3808,7 +3780,7 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow( /* * Step 1: find the top-level window that contains the desired point. */ - + where.h = rootX; where.v = rootY; FindWindow(where, &whichWin); @@ -3823,10 +3795,10 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow( } /* - * Step 2: work down through the hierarchy underneath this window. - * At each level, scan through all the children to find the highest - * one in the stacking order that contains the point. Then repeat - * the whole process on that child. + * Step 2: work down through the hierarchy underneath this window. At each + * level, scan through all the children to find the highest one in the + * stacking order that contains the point. Then repeat the whole process + * on that child. */ x = rootX - winPtr->wmInfoPtr->xInParent; @@ -3835,12 +3807,12 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow( x -= winPtr->changes.x; y -= winPtr->changes.y; nextPtr = NULL; - + /* * Container windows cannot have children. So if it is a container, * look there, otherwise inspect the children. */ - + if (Tk_IsContainer(winPtr)) { childPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); if (childPtr != NULL) { @@ -3848,7 +3820,7 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow( tmpx = x - childPtr->changes.x; tmpy = y - childPtr->changes.y; bd = childPtr->changes.border_width; - + if ((tmpx >= -bd) && (tmpy >= -bd) && (tmpx < (childPtr->changes.width + bd)) && (tmpy < (childPtr->changes.height + bd))) { @@ -3856,12 +3828,10 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow( } } } - /* * NOTE: Here we should handle out of process embedding. */ - } else { for (childPtr = winPtr->childList; childPtr != NULL; childPtr = childPtr->nextPtr) { @@ -3893,17 +3863,16 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow( * Tk_TopCoordsToWindow -- * * Given a Tk Window, and coordinates of a point relative to that window - * this procedure returns the top-most child of the window (excluding - * toplevels) covering that point, if there exists such a window in this - * application. - * It also sets newX, and newY to the coords of the point relative to the - * window returned. + * this procedure returns the top-most child of the window (excluding + * toplevels) covering that point, if there exists such a window in this + * application. It also sets newX, and newY to the coords of the point + * relative to the window returned. * * Results: - * The return result is either a token for the window corresponding - * to rootX and rootY, or else NULL to indicate that there is no such - * window. newX and newY are also set to the coords of the point relative - * to the returned window. + * The return result is either a token for the window corresponding to + * rootX and rootY, or else NULL to indicate that there is no such + * window. newX and newY are also set to the coords of the point relative + * to the returned window. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -3916,12 +3885,12 @@ Tk_TopCoordsToWindow( Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for a Tk Window which defines the; * coordinates for rootX & rootY */ int rootX, int rootY, /* Coordinates of a point in tkWin. */ - int *newX, int *newY) /* Coordinates of point in the upperMost child of - * tkWin containing (rootX,rootY) */ + int *newX, int *newY) /* Coordinates of point in the upperMost child + * of tkWin containing (rootX,rootY) */ { TkWindow *winPtr, *childPtr; - TkWindow *nextPtr; /* Coordinates of highest child found so - * far that contains point. */ + TkWindow *nextPtr; /* Coordinates of highest child found so far + * that contains point. */ int x, y; /* Coordinates in winPtr. */ Window *children; /* Children of winPtr, or NULL. */ @@ -3933,20 +3902,18 @@ Tk_TopCoordsToWindow( children = NULL; /* - * Container windows cannot have children. So if it is a container, + * Container windows cannot have children. So if it is a container, * look there, otherwise inspect the children. */ if (Tk_IsContainer(winPtr)) { childPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); if (childPtr != NULL) { - if (Tk_IsMapped(childPtr) && - (x > childPtr->changes.x && - x < childPtr->changes.x + - childPtr->changes.width) && - (y > childPtr->changes.y && - y < childPtr->changes.y + - childPtr->changes.height)) { + if (Tk_IsMapped(childPtr) && + x > childPtr->changes.x && + x < childPtr->changes.x+childPtr->changes.width && + y > childPtr->changes.y && + y < childPtr->changes.y+childPtr->changes.height)) { nextPtr = childPtr; } } @@ -3988,8 +3955,8 @@ Tk_TopCoordsToWindow( * * UpdateVRootGeometry -- * - * This procedure is called to update all the virtual root - * geometry information in wmPtr. + * This procedure is called to update all the virtual root geometry + * information in wmPtr. * * Results: * None. @@ -4020,7 +3987,7 @@ UpdateVRootGeometry( wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_VROOT_OFFSET_STALE; if (wmPtr->vRoot == None) { - noVRoot: + noVRoot: wmPtr->vRootX = wmPtr->vRootY = 0; wmPtr->vRootWidth = DisplayWidth(winPtr->display, winPtr->screenNum); wmPtr->vRootHeight = DisplayHeight(winPtr->display, winPtr->screenNum); @@ -4044,7 +4011,7 @@ UpdateVRootGeometry( Tk_DeleteErrorHandler(handler); if (status == 0) { /* - * The virtual root is gone! Pretend that it never existed. + * The virtual root is gone! Pretend that it never existed. */ wmPtr->vRoot = None; @@ -4057,16 +4024,15 @@ UpdateVRootGeometry( * * Tk_GetVRootGeometry -- * - * This procedure returns information about the virtual root - * window corresponding to a particular Tk window. + * This procedure returns information about the virtual root window + * corresponding to a particular Tk window. * * Results: - * The values at xPtr, yPtr, widthPtr, and heightPtr are set - * with the offset and dimensions of the root window corresponding - * to tkwin. If tkwin is being managed by a virtual root window - * manager these values correspond to the virtual root window being - * used for tkwin; otherwise the offsets will be 0 and the - * dimensions will be those of the screen. + * The values at xPtr, yPtr, widthPtr, and heightPtr are set with the + * offset and dimensions of the root window corresponding to tkwin. If + * tkwin is being managed by a virtual root window manager these values + * correspond to the virtual root window being used for tkwin; otherwise + * the offsets will be 0 and the dimensions will be those of the screen. * * Side effects: * Vroot window information is refreshed if it is out of date. @@ -4097,8 +4063,8 @@ Tk_GetVRootGeometry( wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; /* - * Make sure that the geometry information is up-to-date, then copy - * it out to the caller. + * Make sure that the geometry information is up-to-date, then copy it out + * to the caller. */ if (wmPtr->flags & WM_VROOT_OFFSET_STALE) { @@ -4115,18 +4081,17 @@ Tk_GetVRootGeometry( * * Tk_MoveToplevelWindow -- * - * This procedure is called instead of Tk_MoveWindow to adjust - * the x-y location of a top-level window. It delays the actual - * move to a later time and keeps window-manager information - * up-to-date with the move + * This procedure is called instead of Tk_MoveWindow to adjust the x-y + * location of a top-level window. It delays the actual move to a later + * time and keeps window-manager information up-to-date with the move * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: * The window is eventually moved so that its upper-left corner - * (actually, the upper-left corner of the window's decorative - * frame, if there is one) is at (x,y). + * (actually, the upper-left corner of the window's decorative frame, if + * there is one) is at (x,y). * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -4134,8 +4099,7 @@ Tk_GetVRootGeometry( void Tk_MoveToplevelWindow( Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window to move. */ - int x, int y) /* New location for window (within - * parent). */ + int x, int y) /* New location for window (within parent). */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -4154,9 +4118,8 @@ Tk_MoveToplevelWindow( /* * If the window has already been mapped, must bring its geometry - * up-to-date immediately, otherwise an event might arrive from the - * server that would overwrite wmPtr->x and wmPtr->y and lose the - * new position. + * up-to-date immediately, otherwise an event might arrive from the server + * that would overwrite wmPtr->x and wmPtr->y and lose the new position. */ if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { @@ -4165,7 +4128,8 @@ Tk_MoveToplevelWindow( } UpdateGeometryInfo((ClientData) winPtr); } -} +} + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * @@ -4177,9 +4141,9 @@ Tk_MoveToplevelWindow( * None. * * Side effects: - * WinPtr gets restacked as specified by aboveBelow and otherPtr. - * This procedure doesn't return until the restack has taken - * effect and the ConfigureNotify event for it has been received. + * WinPtr gets restacked as specified by aboveBelow and otherPtr. This + * procedure doesn't return until the restack has taken effect and the + * ConfigureNotify event for it has been received. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -4189,9 +4153,9 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window to restack. */ int aboveBelow, /* Gives relative position for restacking; * must be Above or Below. */ - TkWindow *otherPtr) /* Window relative to which to restack; - * if NULL, then winPtr gets restacked - * above or below *all* siblings. */ + TkWindow *otherPtr) /* Window relative to which to restack; if + * NULL, then winPtr gets restacked above or + * below *all* siblings. */ { WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -4200,17 +4164,17 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; /* - * Get the mac window. Make sure it exists & is mapped. + * Get the mac window. Make sure it exists & is mapped. */ + if (winPtr->window == None) { Tk_MakeWindowExist((Tk_Window) winPtr); } if (winPtr->wmInfoPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED) { - /* - * Can't set stacking order properly until the window is on the - * screen (mapping it may give it a reparent window), so make sure - * it's on the screen. + * Can't set stacking order properly until the window is on the screen + * (mapping it may give it a reparent window), so make sure it's on + * the screen. */ TkWmMapWindow(winPtr); @@ -4220,6 +4184,7 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( /* * Get the window in which a raise or lower is in relation to. */ + if (otherPtr != NULL) { if (otherPtr->window == None) { Tk_MakeWindowExist((Tk_Window) otherPtr); @@ -4227,7 +4192,8 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( if (otherPtr->wmInfoPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED) { TkWmMapWindow(otherPtr); } - otherMacWindow = GetWindowFromPort(TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(otherPtr->window)); + otherMacWindow = GetWindowFromPort( + TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(otherPtr->window)); } else { otherMacWindow = NULL; } @@ -4236,13 +4202,13 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( if (aboveBelow == Above) { if (macWindow == frontWindow) { - /* + /* * Do nothing - it's already at the top. */ } else if (otherMacWindow == frontWindow || otherMacWindow == NULL) { /* - * Raise the window to the top. If the window is visible then - * we also make it the active window. + * Raise the window to the top. If the window is visible then we + * also make it the active window. */ if (wmPtr->hints.initial_state == WithdrawnState) { @@ -4252,11 +4218,12 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( } } else { /* - * Find the window to be above. (Front window will actually be the - * window to be behind.) Front window is NULL if no other windows. + * Find the window to be above. (Front window will actually be the + * window to be behind.) Front window is NULL if no other windows. */ + while (frontWindow != NULL && - ( tmpWindow = GetNextWindow (frontWindow) ) != otherMacWindow) { + (tmpWindow=GetNextWindow(frontWindow)) != otherMacWindow) { frontWindow = tmpWindow; } if (frontWindow != NULL) { @@ -4265,10 +4232,12 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( } } else { /* - * Send behind. If it was in front find another window to make active. + * Send behind. If it was in front find another window to make active. */ + if (macWindow == frontWindow) { - if ( ( tmpWindow = GetNextWindow ( macWindow )) != NULL) { + tmpWindow = GetNextWindow(macWindow); + if (tmpWindow != NULL) { SelectWindow(tmpWindow); } } @@ -4282,30 +4251,28 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel( * TkWmAddToColormapWindows -- * * This procedure is called to add a given window to the - * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level, if it - * isn't already there. It is invoked by the Tk code that - * creates a new colormap, in order to make sure that colormap - * information is propagated to the window manager by default. + * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level, if it isn't already + * there. It is invoked by the Tk code that creates a new colormap, in + * order to make sure that colormap information is propagated to the + * window manager by default. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * WinPtr's window gets added to the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS - * property of its nearest top-level ancestor, unless the - * colormaps have been set explicitly with the - * "wm colormapwindows" command. + * WinPtr's window gets added to the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property of its + * nearest top-level ancestor, unless the colormaps have been set + * explicitly with the "wm colormapwindows" command. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void TkWmAddToColormapWindows( - TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window with a non-default colormap. - * Should not be a top-level window. */ + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window with a non-default colormap. Should + * not be a top-level window. */ { - TkWindow *topPtr; - TkWindow **oldPtr, **newPtr; + TkWindow *topPtr, **oldPtr, **newPtr; int count, i; if (winPtr->window == None) { @@ -4315,7 +4282,7 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows( for (topPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; ; topPtr = topPtr->parentPtr) { if (topPtr == NULL) { /* - * Window is being deleted. Skip the whole operation. + * Window is being deleted. Skip the whole operation. */ return; @@ -4342,9 +4309,8 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows( } /* - * Make a new bigger array and use it to reset the property. - * Automatically add the toplevel itself as the last element - * of the list. + * Make a new bigger array and use it to reset the property. Automatically + * add the toplevel itself as the last element of the list. */ newPtr = (TkWindow **) ckalloc((unsigned) ((count+2)*sizeof(TkWindow*))); @@ -4364,9 +4330,8 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows( topPtr->wmInfoPtr->cmapCount = count+1; /* - * On the Macintosh all of this is just an excercise - * in compatability as we don't support colormaps. If - * we did they would be installed here. + * On the Macintosh all of this is just an excercise in compatability as + * we don't support colormaps. If we did they would be installed here. */ } @@ -4376,16 +4341,16 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows( * TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows -- * * This procedure is called to remove a given window from the - * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level. It is invoked - * when windows are deleted. + * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level. It is invoked when + * windows are deleted. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * WinPtr's window gets removed from the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS - * property of its nearest top-level ancestor, unless the - * top-level itself is being deleted too. + * WinPtr's window gets removed from the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property of + * its nearest top-level ancestor, unless the top-level itself is being + * deleted too. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -4394,18 +4359,17 @@ void TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows( TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window that may be present in * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its - * top-level. Should not be a top-level + * top-level. Should not be a top-level * window. */ { - TkWindow *topPtr; - TkWindow **oldPtr; + TkWindow *topPtr, **oldPtr; int count, i, j; for (topPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; ; topPtr = topPtr->parentPtr) { if (topPtr == NULL) { /* - * Ancestors have been deleted, so skip the whole operation. - * Seems like this can't ever happen? + * Ancestors have been deleted, so skip the whole operation. Seems + * like this can't ever happen? */ return; @@ -4416,16 +4380,15 @@ TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows( } if (topPtr->flags & TK_ALREADY_DEAD) { /* - * Top-level is being deleted, so there's no need to cleanup - * the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property. + * Top-level is being deleted, so there's no need to cleanup the + * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property. */ return; } /* - * Find the window and slide the following ones down to cover - * it up. + * Find the window and slide the following ones down to cover it up. */ count = topPtr->wmInfoPtr->cmapCount; @@ -4449,10 +4412,10 @@ TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows( * Fetch the position of the mouse pointer. * * Results: - * *xPtr and *yPtr are filled in with the (virtual) root coordinates - * of the mouse pointer for tkwin's display. If the pointer isn't - * on tkwin's screen, then -1 values are returned for both - * coordinates. The argument tkwin must be a toplevel window. + * *xPtr and *yPtr are filled in with the (virtual) root coordinates of + * the mouse pointer for tkwin's display. If the pointer isn't on tkwin's + * screen, then -1 values are returned for both coordinates. The argument + * tkwin must be a toplevel window. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -4474,10 +4437,10 @@ TkGetPointerCoords( * * InitialWindowBounds -- * - * This function calculates the initial bounds for a new Mac - * toplevel window. Unless the geometry is specified by the user - * this code will auto place the windows in a cascade diagonially - * across the main monitor of the Mac. + * This function calculates the initial bounds for a new Mac toplevel + * window. Unless the geometry is specified by the user this code will + * auto place the windows in a cascade diagonially across the main + * monitor of the Mac. * * Results: * The bounds are returned in geometry. @@ -4498,11 +4461,13 @@ InitialWindowBounds( static int defaultY = 45; if (!(wmPtr->sizeHintsFlags & (USPosition | PPosition))) { - /* - * We will override the program & hopefully place the - * window in a "better" location. + /* + * We will override the program & hopefully place the window in a + * "better" location. */ + BitMap screenBits; + GetQDGlobalsScreenBits(&screenBits); if (((screenBits.bounds.right - defaultX) < 30) || ((screenBits.bounds.bottom - defaultY) < 30)) { @@ -4526,9 +4491,9 @@ InitialWindowBounds( * * TkMacOSXResizable -- * - * This function determines if the passed in window is part of - * a toplevel window that is resizable. If the window is - * resizable in the x, y or both directions, true is returned. + * This function determines if the passed in window is part of a toplevel + * window that is resizable. If the window is resizable in the x, y or + * both directions, true is returned. * * Results: * True if resizable, false otherwise. @@ -4551,7 +4516,7 @@ TkMacOSXResizable( while (winPtr->wmInfoPtr == NULL) { winPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; } - + wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; if ((wmPtr->flags & WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE) && (wmPtr->flags & WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE)) { @@ -4566,10 +4531,10 @@ TkMacOSXResizable( * * TkMacOSXGrowToplevel -- * - * The function is invoked when the user clicks in the grow region - * of a Tk window. The function will handle the dragging - * procedure and not return until completed. Finally, the function - * may place information Tk's event queue is the window was resized. + * The function is invoked when the user clicks in the grow region of a + * Tk window. The function will handle the dragging procedure and not + * return until completed. Finally, the function may place information + * Tk's event queue is the window was resized. * * Results: * True if events were placed on event queue, false otherwise. @@ -4630,7 +4595,7 @@ TkMacOSXGrowToplevel( LoWord(growResult), HiWord(growResult), true); InvalWindowRect(whichWindow, &portRect); /* TODO: may not be needed */ TkMacOSXInvalClipRgns((Tk_Window) winPtr); - TkGenWMConfigureEvent((Tk_Window) winPtr, -1, -1, + TkGenWMConfigureEvent((Tk_Window) winPtr, -1, -1, (int) LoWord(growResult), (int) HiWord(growResult), TK_SIZE_CHANGED); return true; @@ -4645,8 +4610,8 @@ TkMacOSXGrowToplevel( * * TkSetWMName -- * - * Set the title for a toplevel window. If the window is embedded, - * do not change the window title. + * Set the title for a toplevel window. If the window is embedded, do not + * change the window title. * * Results: * None. @@ -4662,30 +4627,30 @@ TkSetWMName( TkWindow *winPtr, Tk_Uid titleUid) { - CFStringRef title; - WindowRef macWin; - + CFStringRef title; + if (Tk_IsEmbedded(winPtr)) { return; } - + title = CFStringCreateWithBytes(NULL, (unsigned char*) titleUid, - strlen(titleUid), kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); + strlen(titleUid), kCFStringEncodingUTF8, false); if (title) { - macWin = GetWindowFromPort(TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(winPtr->window)); + WindowRef macWin = GetWindowFromPort( + TkMacOSXGetDrawablePort(winPtr->window)); + SetWindowTitleWithCFString(macWin, title); CFRelease(title); } } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkGetTransientMaster -- * - * If the passed window has the TRANSIENT_FOR property set this - * will return the master window. Otherwise it will return None. + * If the passed window has the TRANSIENT_FOR property set this will + * return the master window. Otherwise it will return None. * * Results: * The master window or None. @@ -4743,10 +4708,9 @@ TkMacOSXGetXWindow( * * TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed -- * - * Ask Carbon if the given window is in the zoomed out state. - * Because dragging & growing a window can change the Carbon - * zoom state, we cannot rely on wmInfoPtr->hints.initial_state - * for this information. + * Ask Carbon if the given window is in the zoomed out state. Because + * dragging & growing a window can change the Carbon zoom state, we + * cannot rely on wmInfoPtr->hints.initial_state for this information. * * Results: * True if window is zoomed out, false otherwise. @@ -4763,7 +4727,7 @@ TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed( { WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; Point idealSize; - + if ((wmPtr->flags & WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE) && (wmPtr->flags & WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE)) { return false; @@ -4789,11 +4753,10 @@ TkMacOSXIsWindowZoomed( * * TkMacOSXZoomToplevel -- * - * The function is invoked when the user clicks in the zoom region - * of a Tk window or when the window state is set/unset to "zoomed" - * manually. If the window is to be zoomed (in or out), the window - * size is changed and events are generated to let Tk know what - * happened. + * The function is invoked when the user clicks in the zoom region of a + * Tk window or when the window state is set/unset to "zoomed" manually. + * If the window is to be zoomed (in or out), the window size is changed + * and events are generated to let Tk know what happened. * * Results: * True if events were placed on event queue, false otherwise. @@ -4822,7 +4785,7 @@ TkMacOSXZoomToplevel( dispPtr = TkGetDisplayList(); winPtr = (TkWindow *) Tk_IdToWindow(dispPtr->display, window); wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; - + if ((wmPtr->flags & WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE) && (wmPtr->flags & WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE)) { return false; @@ -4839,7 +4802,7 @@ TkMacOSXZoomToplevel( } /* Do nothing if already in desired zoom state */ - if (!IsWindowInStandardState(whichWindow, &idealSize, NULL) == + if (!IsWindowInStandardState(whichWindow, &idealSize, NULL) == (zoomPart == inZoomIn)) { return false; } @@ -4857,7 +4820,7 @@ TkMacOSXZoomToplevel( location.h -= xOffset; location.v -= yOffset; GetPortBounds(GetWindowPort(whichWindow), &portRect); - TkGenWMConfigureEvent((Tk_Window) winPtr, location.h, location.v, + TkGenWMConfigureEvent((Tk_Window) winPtr, location.h, location.v, portRect.right - portRect.left, portRect.bottom - portRect.top, TK_BOTH_CHANGED); return true; @@ -4871,10 +4834,9 @@ TkMacOSXZoomToplevel( * * TkUnsupported1Cmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the - * "::tk::unsupported::MacWindowStyle" Tcl command. - * This command allows you to set the style of decoration - * for a Macintosh window. + * This procedure is invoked to process the + * "::tk::unsupported::MacWindowStyle" Tcl command. This command allows + * you to set the style of decoration for a Macintosh window. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -4917,12 +4879,12 @@ TkUnsupported1ObjCmd( if (!(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL)) { Tcl_ResetResult(interp); Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", winPtr->pathName, - "\" isn't a top-level window", (char *) NULL); + "\" isn't a top-level window", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } - if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[1], subcmds, "option", - 0, &index) != TCL_OK) { + if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[1], subcmds, "option", 0, + &index) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } if (((enum SubCmds) index) == TKMWS_STYLE) { @@ -4941,10 +4903,9 @@ TkUnsupported1ObjCmd( * * WmWinStyle -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the - * "::tk::unsupported::MacWindowStyle style" subcommand. - * This command allows you to set the style of decoration - * for a Macintosh window. + * This procedure is invoked to process the + * "::tk::unsupported::MacWindowStyle style" subcommand. This command + * allows you to set the style of decoration for a Macintosh window. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -4954,6 +4915,7 @@ TkUnsupported1ObjCmd( * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static int WmWinStyle( Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ @@ -5044,7 +5006,7 @@ WmWinStyle( if (wmPtr->style != -1) { for (i = 0; styleMap[i].strValue != NULL; i++) { if (wmPtr->style == styleMap[i].intValue) { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, + Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, Tcl_NewStringObj(styleMap[i].strValue, -1)); return TCL_OK; } @@ -5070,7 +5032,7 @@ WmWinStyle( for (i = 0; compositeAttrMap[i].strValue != NULL; i++) { if (wmPtr->attributes == compositeAttrMap[i].intValue) { Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, attributeList, - Tcl_NewStringObj(compositeAttrMap[i].strValue, -1)); + Tcl_NewStringObj(compositeAttrMap[i].strValue,-1)); usesComposite = 1; break; } @@ -5088,7 +5050,7 @@ WmWinStyle( } } else if (objc == 4) { if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObjStruct(interp, objv[3], styleMap, - sizeof(struct StrIntMap), "style", 0, &index) != TCL_OK) { + sizeof(struct StrIntMap), "style", 0, &index) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } wmPtr->style = styleMap[index].intValue; @@ -5099,7 +5061,7 @@ WmWinStyle( int oldAttributes = wmPtr->attributes; if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObjStruct(interp, objv[3], classMap, - sizeof(struct StrIntMap), "class", 0, &index) != TCL_OK) { + sizeof(struct StrIntMap), "class", 0, &index) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objv[4], &attrObjc, &attrObjv) @@ -5110,12 +5072,11 @@ WmWinStyle( wmPtr->attributes = kWindowNoAttributes; for (i = 0; i < attrObjc; i++) { if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObjStruct(interp, attrObjv[i], - compositeAttrMap, sizeof(struct StrIntMap), - "attribute", 0, &index) == TCL_OK) { + compositeAttrMap, sizeof(struct StrIntMap), "attribute", + 0, &index) == TCL_OK) { wmPtr->attributes |= compositeAttrMap[index].intValue; - } else if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObjStruct(interp, attrObjv[i], - attrMap, sizeof(struct StrIntMap), - "attribute", 0, &index) == TCL_OK) { + } else if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObjStruct(interp, attrObjv[i], attrMap, + sizeof(struct StrIntMap), "attribute", 0,&index)==TCL_OK){ Tcl_ResetResult (interp); wmPtr->attributes |= attrMap[index].intValue; } else { @@ -5137,8 +5098,8 @@ WmWinStyle( * * TkpMakeMenuWindow -- * - * Configure the window to be either a undecorated pull-down - * (or pop-up) menu, or as a toplevel floating menu (palette). + * Configure the window to be either a undecorated pull-down (or pop-up) + * menu, or as a toplevel floating menu (palette). * * Results: * None. @@ -5152,19 +5113,21 @@ WmWinStyle( void TkpMakeMenuWindow( Tk_Window tkwin, /* New window. */ - int transient) /* 1 means menu is only posted briefly as - * a popup or pulldown or cascade. 0 means - * menu is always visible, e.g. as a - * floating menu. */ + int transient) /* 1 means menu is only posted briefly as a + * popup or pulldown or cascade. 0 means menu + * is always visible, e.g. as a floating + * menu. */ { + TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; + if (transient) { - ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->wmInfoPtr->macClass = kSimpleWindowClass; - ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->wmInfoPtr->attributes = kWindowNoActivatesAttribute; + winPtr->wmInfoPtr->macClass = kSimpleWindowClass; + winPtr->wmInfoPtr->attributes = kWindowNoActivatesAttribute; } else { - ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->wmInfoPtr->macClass = kFloatingWindowClass; - ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->wmInfoPtr->attributes = kWindowStandardFloatingAttributes; - ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->wmInfoPtr->flags |= WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE; - ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->wmInfoPtr->flags |= WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE; + winPtr->wmInfoPtr->macClass = kFloatingWindowClass; + winPtr->wmInfoPtr->attributes = kWindowStandardFloatingAttributes; + winPtr->wmInfoPtr->flags |= WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE; + winPtr->wmInfoPtr->flags |= WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE; } } @@ -5173,8 +5136,8 @@ TkpMakeMenuWindow( * * TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist -- * - * This function finally creates the real Macintosh window that - * the Mac actually understands. + * This function finally creates the real Macintosh window that the Mac + * actually understands. * * Results: * None. @@ -5190,12 +5153,12 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( TkWindow *winPtr) /* Tk window. */ { WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; - WindowRef newWindow = NULL; + WindowRef newWindow = NULL; ControlRef rootControl = NULL; MacDrawable *macWin; Rect geometry = {0,0,0,0}; Tcl_HashEntry *valueHashPtr; - int new; + int isNew; TkMacOSXWindowList *listPtr; if (TkMacOSXHostToplevelExists(winPtr)) { @@ -5205,8 +5168,8 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( macWin = (MacDrawable *) winPtr->window; /* - * If this is embedded, make sure its container's toplevel exists, - * then return... + * If this is embedded, make sure its container's toplevel exists, then + * return... */ if (Tk_IsEmbedded(winPtr)) { @@ -5214,36 +5177,40 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( contWinPtr = TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr); if (contWinPtr != NULL) { - TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist(contWinPtr->privatePtr->toplevel->winPtr); + TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( + contWinPtr->privatePtr->toplevel->winPtr); macWin->flags |= TK_HOST_EXISTS; return; - } else if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler != NULL) { - if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->containerExistProc != NULL) { - if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->containerExistProc((Tk_Window) winPtr) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_Panic("ContainerExistProc could not make container"); - } + } + + if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler == NULL) { + Tcl_Panic("TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist could not find container"); + } + + if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->containerExistProc != NULL) { + if (tkMacOSXEmbedHandler->containerExistProc((Tk_Window) winPtr) + != TCL_OK) { + Tcl_Panic("ContainerExistProc could not make container"); } return; - } else { - Tcl_Panic("TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist could not find container"); } /* * NOTE: Here we should handle out of process embedding. */ - } InitialWindowBounds(winPtr, &geometry); if (wmPtr->style == -1) { OSStatus err; + /* - * There seems to be a bug in CreateNewWindow: If I set the - * window geometry to be the too small for the structure region, - * then the whole window is positioned incorrectly. - * Adding this here makes the positioning work, and the size will - * get overwritten when you actually map the contents of the window. + * There seems to be a bug in CreateNewWindow: If I set the window + * geometry to be the too small for the structure region, then the + * whole window is positioned incorrectly. Adding this here makes the + * positioning work, and the size will get overwritten when you + * actually map the contents of the window. */ geometry.right += 64; @@ -5253,7 +5220,6 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( if (err != noErr) { newWindow = NULL; } - } else { newWindow = NewCWindow(NULL, &geometry, "\p", false, (short) wmPtr->style, (WindowRef) -1, true, 0); @@ -5282,9 +5248,10 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( if ((wmPtr->master != None) && winPtr->atts.override_redirect) { /* - * If we are transient and overrideredirect, use the utility class - * to ensure we are topmost (for dropdowns). + * If we are transient and overrideredirect, use the utility class to + * ensure we are topmost (for dropdowns). */ + WindowGroupRef group = GetWindowGroupOfClass(kUtilityWindowClass); if (group != NULL) { SetWindowGroup(newWindow, group); @@ -5297,8 +5264,8 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( windowHashInit = true; } valueHashPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&windowTable, - (char *) newWindow, &new); - if (!new) { + (char *) newWindow, &isNew); + if (!isNew) { Tcl_Panic("same macintosh window allocated twice!"); } Tcl_SetHashValue(valueHashPtr, macWin); @@ -5311,11 +5278,10 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( * * TkMacOSXRegisterOffScreenWindow -- * - * This function adds the passed in Off Screen Port to the - * hash table that maps Mac windows to root X windows. + * This function adds the passed in Off Screen Port to the hash table + * that maps Mac windows to root X windows. * - * FIXME: This is not currently used. Is there any reason - * to keep it? + * FIXME: This is not currently used. Is there any reason to keep it? * * Results: * None. @@ -5326,23 +5292,21 @@ TkMacOSXMakeRealWindowExist( *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void +void TkMacOSXRegisterOffScreenWindow( - Window window, /* Window structure. */ - GWorldPtr portPtr) /* Pointer to a Mac GWorld. */ + Window window, /* Window structure. */ + GWorldPtr portPtr) /* Pointer to a Mac GWorld. */ { - MacDrawable *macWin; + MacDrawable *macWin = (MacDrawable *) window; Tcl_HashEntry *valueHashPtr; - int new; + int isNew; - macWin = (MacDrawable *) window; if (!windowHashInit) { Tcl_InitHashTable(&windowTable, TCL_ONE_WORD_KEYS); windowHashInit = true; } - valueHashPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&windowTable, - (char *) portPtr, &new); - if (!new) { + valueHashPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&windowTable, (char *)portPtr, &isNew); + if (!isNew) { Tcl_Panic("same macintosh window allocated twice!"); } Tcl_SetHashValue(valueHashPtr, macWin); @@ -5353,9 +5317,8 @@ TkMacOSXRegisterOffScreenWindow( * * TkMacOSXUnregisterMacWindow -- * - * Given a macintosh port window, this function removes the - * association between this window and the root X window that - * Tk cares about. + * Given a macintosh port window, this function removes the association + * between this window and the root X window that Tk cares about. * * Results: * None. @@ -5366,23 +5329,20 @@ TkMacOSXRegisterOffScreenWindow( *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void +void TkMacOSXUnregisterMacWindow( WindowRef macWinPtr) /* Reference to a Mac Window */ { Tcl_HashEntry *entryPtr; + if (!windowHashInit) { Tcl_Panic("TkMacOSXUnregisterMacWindow: unmapping before inited"); } entryPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&windowTable,(char *) macWinPtr); if (!entryPtr) { -#ifdef TK_MAC_DEBUG - fprintf(stderr,"Unregister:failed to find window %08x\n", - (int) macWinPtr ); -#endif - } - else { - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(entryPtr); + ERR_MSG("Unregister:failed to find window %08x", (int) macWinPtr); + } else { + Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(entryPtr); } } @@ -5391,9 +5351,8 @@ TkMacOSXUnregisterMacWindow( * * TkMacOSXSetScrollbarGrow -- * - * Sets a flag for a toplevel window indicating that the passed - * Tk scrollbar window will display the grow region for the - * toplevel window. + * Sets a flag for a toplevel window indicating that the passed Tk + * scrollbar window will display the grow region for the toplevel window. * * Results: * None. @@ -5404,7 +5363,7 @@ TkMacOSXUnregisterMacWindow( *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void +void TkMacOSXSetScrollbarGrow( TkWindow *winPtr, /* Tk scrollbar window. */ int flag) /* Boolean value true or false. */ @@ -5418,22 +5377,22 @@ TkMacOSXSetScrollbarGrow( winPtr->privatePtr->toplevel->winPtr->wmInfoPtr->scrollWinPtr = NULL; } } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkWmFocusToplevel -- * * This is a utility procedure invoked by focus-management code. It - * exists because of the extra wrapper windows that exist under - * Unix; its job is to map from wrapper windows to the - * corresponding toplevel windows. On PCs and Macs there are no - * wrapper windows so no mapping is necessary; this procedure just - * determines whether a window is a toplevel or not. + * exists because of the extra wrapper windows that exist under Unix; its + * job is to map from wrapper windows to the corresponding toplevel + * windows. On PCs and Macs there are no wrapper windows so no mapping is + * necessary; this procedure just determines whether a window is a + * toplevel or not. * * Results: - * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the - * window; otherwise returns NULL. + * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the window; + * otherwise returns NULL. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -5457,13 +5416,13 @@ TkWmFocusToplevel( * * TkpGetWrapperWindow -- * - * This is a utility procedure invoked by focus-management code. It - * maps to the wrapper for a top-level, which is just the same - * as the top-level on Macs and PCs. + * This is a utility procedure invoked by focus-management code. It maps + * to the wrapper for a top-level, which is just the same as the + * top-level on Macs and PCs. * * Results: - * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the - * window; otherwise returns NULL. + * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the window; + * otherwise returns NULL. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -5487,8 +5446,8 @@ TkpGetWrapperWindow( * * TkpWmSetState -- * - * Sets the window manager state for the wrapper window of a - * given toplevel window. + * Sets the window manager state for the wrapper window of a given + * toplevel window. * * Results: * None. @@ -5500,14 +5459,14 @@ TkpGetWrapperWindow( */ void -TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel window to operate on. */ - int state; /* One of IconicState, ZoomState, NormalState, +TkpWmSetState( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel window to operate on. */ + int state) /* One of IconicState, ZoomState, NormalState, * or WithdrawnState. */ { WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; WindowRef macWin; - + wmPtr->hints.initial_state = state; if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED) { return; @@ -5519,9 +5478,10 @@ TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state) Tk_UnmapWindow((Tk_Window) winPtr); } else if (state == IconicState) { /* - * The window always gets unmapped. If we can show the - * icon version of the window we also collapse it. + * The window always gets unmapped. If we can show the icon version of + * the window we also collapse it. */ + if (IsWindowCollapsable(macWin) && !IsWindowCollapsed(macWin)) { CollapseWindow(macWin, true); } @@ -5558,14 +5518,15 @@ TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state) */ int -TkpIsWindowFloating(WindowRef wRef) +TkpIsWindowFloating( + WindowRef wRef) { WindowClass class; if (wRef == NULL) { return 0; } - + GetWindowClass(wRef, &class); return (class == kFloatingWindowClass); } @@ -5587,7 +5548,8 @@ TkpIsWindowFloating(WindowRef wRef) */ MODULE_SCOPE WindowClass -TkMacOSXWindowClass(TkWindow *winPtr) +TkMacOSXWindowClass( + TkWindow *winPtr) { WindowRef wRef; WindowClass class; @@ -5603,21 +5565,21 @@ TkMacOSXWindowClass(TkWindow *winPtr) GetWindowClass(wRef, &class); return class; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkMacOSXWindowOffset -- * - * Determines the x and y offset from the orgin of the toplevel - * window dressing (the structure region, ie. title bar) and the - * orgin of the content area. + * Determines the x and y offset from the orgin of the toplevel window + * dressing (the structure region, i.e. title bar) and the orgin of the + * content area. * * Results: - * The x & y offset in pixels. + * The x & y offset in pixels. * * Side effects: - * None. + * None. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -5635,14 +5597,14 @@ TkMacOSXWindowOffset( *yOffset = widths.top; return; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpGetMS -- * - * Return a relative time in milliseconds. It doesn't matter - * when the epoch was. + * Return a relative time in milliseconds. It doesn't matter when the + * epoch was. * * Results: * Number of milliseconds. @@ -5656,22 +5618,22 @@ TkMacOSXWindowOffset( unsigned long TkpGetMS() { - long long * int64Ptr; + long long *int64Ptr; UnsignedWide micros; - + Microseconds(µs); int64Ptr = (long long *) µs; /* - * We need 64 bit math to do this. This is available in CW 11 - * and on. Other's will need to use a different scheme. + * We need 64 bit math to do this. This is available in CW 11 and on. + * Other's will need to use a different scheme. */ *int64Ptr /= 1000; return (long) *int64Ptr; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * @@ -5696,7 +5658,7 @@ XSetInputFocus( Time time) { /* - * Don't need to do a thing. Tk manages the focus for us. + * Don't need to do a thing. Tk manages the focus for us. */ } @@ -5705,15 +5667,14 @@ XSetInputFocus( * * TkpChangeFocus -- * - * This procedure is a stub on the Mac because we always own the - * focus if we are a front most application. + * This procedure is a stub on the Mac because we always own the focus + * if we are a front most application. * * Results: - * The return value is the serial number of the command that - * changed the focus. It may be needed by the caller to filter - * out focus change events that were queued before the command. - * If the procedure doesn't actually change the focus then - * it returns 0. + * The return value is the serial number of the command that changed + * the focus. It may be needed by the caller to filter out focus change + * events that were queued before the command. If the procedure doesn't + * actually change the focus then it returns 0. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -5722,15 +5683,15 @@ XSetInputFocus( */ int -TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window that is to receive the X focus. */ - int force; /* Non-zero means claim the focus even - * if it didn't originally belong to - * topLevelPtr's application. */ +TkpChangeFocus( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window that is to receive the X focus. */ + int force) /* Non-zero means claim the focus even if it + * didn't originally belong to topLevelPtr's + * application. */ { /* - * We don't really need to do anything on the Mac. Tk will - * keep all this state for us. + * We don't really need to do anything on the Mac. Tk will keep all this + * state for us. */ if (winPtr->atts.override_redirect) { @@ -5738,28 +5699,26 @@ TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) } /* - * Remember the current serial number for the X server and issue - * a dummy server request. This marks the position at which we - * changed the focus, so we can distinguish FocusIn and FocusOut - * events on either side of the mark. + * Remember the current serial number for the X server and issue a dummy + * server request. This marks the position at which we changed the focus, + * so we can distinguish FocusIn and FocusOut events on either side of the + * mark. */ return NextRequest(winPtr->display); } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap -- * - * This procedure will create a table that maps the reparent wrapper - * X id for a toplevel to the TkWindow structure that is wraps. - * Tk keeps track of a mapping from the window X id to the TkWindow - * structure but that does us no good here since we only get the X - * id of the wrapper window. Only those toplevel windows that are - * mapped have a position in the stacking order. - * + * This procedure will create a table that maps the reparent wrapper X id + * for a toplevel to the TkWindow structure that is wraps. Tk keeps track + * of a mapping from the window X id to the TkWindow structure but that + * does us no good here since we only get the X id of the wrapper window. + * Only those toplevel windows that are mapped have a position in the + * stacking order. * * Results: * None. @@ -5769,11 +5728,12 @@ TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static void -WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* TkWindow to recurse on */ - Display *display; /* X display of parent window */ - Tcl_HashTable *table; /* Maps mac window to TkWindow */ +WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* TkWindow to recurse on */ + Display *display, /* X display of parent window */ + Tcl_HashTable *table) /* Maps mac window to TkWindow */ { TkWindow *childPtr; Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; @@ -5802,8 +5762,8 @@ WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) * This procedure returns the stack order of toplevel windows. * * Results: - * An array of pointers to tk window objects in stacking order - * or else NULL if there was an error. + * An array of pointers to tk window objects in stacking order or else + * NULL if there was an error. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -5812,8 +5772,8 @@ WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) */ TkWindow ** -TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) - TkWindow *parentPtr; /* Parent toplevel window. */ +TkWmStackorderToplevel( + TkWindow *parentPtr) /* Parent toplevel window. */ { WindowRef frontWindow; TkWindow *childWinPtr, **windows, **window_ptr; @@ -5828,12 +5788,11 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) Tcl_InitHashTable(&table, TCL_ONE_WORD_KEYS); WmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(parentPtr, parentPtr->display, &table); - windows = (TkWindow **) ckalloc((table.numEntries+1) - * sizeof(TkWindow *)); + windows = (TkWindow**) ckalloc((table.numEntries+1) * sizeof(TkWindow*)); /* - * Special cases: If zero or one toplevels were mapped - * there is no need to enumerate Windows. + * Special cases: If zero or one toplevels were mapped there is no need to + * enumerate Windows. */ switch (table.numEntries) { @@ -5889,8 +5848,11 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) */ static void -ApplyWindowAttributeChanges(TkWindow *winPtr, int newAttributes, - int oldAttributes, int create) +ApplyWindowAttributeChanges( + TkWindow *winPtr, + int newAttributes, + int oldAttributes, + int create) { if (newAttributes != oldAttributes) { if (winPtr->window == None) { @@ -5913,3 +5875,11 @@ ApplyWindowAttributeChanges(TkWindow *winPtr, int newAttributes, oldAttributes & (newAttributes ^ oldAttributes)); } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ -- cgit v0.12